Fujifilm - FCR Xg-1 Service Manual
Fujifilm - FCR Xg-1 Service Manual
FCR XG-1
       CR-IR346RU
                Service Manual
1 mR = 0.258 µC/kg
1. Getting Started
■ Scope
           This Service Manual is applicable to Fuji Computed Radiography CR-IR346RU. The ma-
           chine is categorized as Class 1 according to IEC classification.
               WARNING
               Used when death or serious injury may occur if the instruction is not observed.
               CAUTION
               Used when minor or medium levels of physical injury may be incurred if the instruction is
               not observed.
               Also used when the machine may suffer serious trouble (such as unrecoverable or
               difficult-to-recover trouble).
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               Used when the machine may suffer damage, or any failure or malfunction may occur, if
               the instruction is not observed.
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Used to indicate the matters that need attention during steps of the procedure.
                    REFERENCE
               Used to indicate terminology or supplemental explanations.
■ Notation of Symbols
           • Check/Adjustment indicator:           Indicates that it is necessary to check or adjust the installa-
                                                   tion location when the part or component removed is to be
                                                   reinstalled.
                                                   This indicator is placed in the illustration that depicts the
                    CHECK                          procedures for removing the parts and components.
                                                   When you see this indicator, refer to its relevant “■ Check/
                                                   Adjustment Procedures.”
Dosimeter – ❍
             Calipers                  ❍(✻)           –
            ✻ : A block gauge for use in inspection requires calibration.                                       TR2H0001.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                             0.3
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058
                                                                                                      0.4
2.         Safety Precautions
           Warnings and cautions regarding the procedures should be observed to avoid possible
           physical hazards and serious accidents that may occur during installation and servicing.
           Labels that describe relevant precautions are attached on the machine.
           The instructions on such labels should also be observed during procedures.
■ Power Supply
           ● Unless otherwise instructed in the Service Manual, be sure to turn OFF the power of the
             machine and unplug the power plug before servicing. With the power plug still plugged,
             you may experience electric shock, burn, or secondary damage due to short circuit even
             when the machine is powered OFF. It should be noted, however, that some servicing
             procedures, such as voltage measurement, cannot be performed under power-OFF
             condition. In such cases, use due care to avoid electric shock, burn, or secondary
             damage due to short circuit, as instructed in this manual.
           ● To restart or reboot the machine, power it OFF and wait more than five seconds before
             powering it ON again. If the machine is powered ON within five seconds, it may
             automatically shut down for protection against overcurrent and overvoltage.
■ Drive Mechanism
           Be sure to turn OFF the power before servicing the gears, cams, belts, and other drive
           mechanism parts. Otherwise, your body or clothing may be entangled.
           However, there may be cases where the procedures cannot be performed under power-OFF
           condition. In such cases, use due care to avoid entanglement of your hand, foot, hairs, and
           clothing with any rotating mechanism, as instructed in this manual.
■ Heavy Objects
           Exercise due care regarding your working posture to avoid back pain during removal and
           installation of heavy objects.
■ Safety Devices
           Safety devices (such as fuses, circuit breakers, interlock switches, panels, and covers)
           should always be enabled. Never attempt to make any alteration or modification that may
           impair their safety features.
■ Optical Parts
           Observe the following rules when servicing the optical parts. Otherwise, the image quality
           may be degraded.
           ● Before removing the protective housings, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch (HV
             switch). If the machine is powered ON with any of the protective housings removed, the
             photomultiplier will be damaged.
           ● Never remove the scanning optics unit covers. If the covers are removed, the image
             quality may degrade.
           ● For dust removal procedures, observe the instructions described in the manual.
           ● Some high-voltage parts, such as the photomultiplier, may not be sufficiently discharged
             even after power is turned OFF. When servicing such parts, exercise due care to avoid
             electric shock hazards (not to touch the connector and terminal carelessly).
Front cover
HHS Label #2
                                            O   NT
                                       FR                                                         FR6H0005.EPS
● Machine
HHS Label #1
HHS Label #1
                                                                              EN 60825-1: 1996
                                                                              Class 3B Panel Label
HHS Label #2
                                  T
                                ON
                              FR       EN 60825-1: 1996
                                                                                         FR6H0006.EPS
                                       Class 3B Panel Label
                                                                           NT
                                                                       O
                                                                  FR
            EN 60825-1: 1996
               Warning Label
FR6H0001.EPS
FR6H0022.EPS
● HHS Label #1
                                 DANGER
                         Laser radiation when open
                    AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO BEAM
                                                         FR6H0008.EPS
● HHS Label #2
                                  DANGER
                             Laser radiation
                         when open external cover
                    AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO BEAM
                                                          FR6H0009.EPS
FR6H0014.EPS
FR6H0015.EPS
FR6H0010.EPS
Pharmaceutical Label
Manufacturer Label
FR6H0011.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual          0.12
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887
                                                                                  0.13
                     SN
                                                                  405N2887
                                                                  FR6H0023.EPS
FR6H0024.EPS
● Pharmaceutical Label
                                                                 405N2676A
                                                                 FR6H0026.EPS
● Manufacturer Label
FR6H0025.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual          0.13
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887
                                                                                                          0.14
■ Dimensions
                    W550xD515xH1065 (mm)
1065
                            550
                                                      515
                                                            Unit: mm
                                                            FR6H0002.EPS
■ Weight
                       155 kg approx.
■ Center of Gravity
                       Height: 500 mm
                       From the right-hand side: 275 mm
                       From the rear: 242 mm
■ Moving Means
                    • Four two-wheel casters (variable direction/no brake)
■ Fixing Means
adjustable feet
                    • Two machine retainers (optional)       • One table and two retainers (optional)
                                                                                        Table
                                                               Retainer
                                                                                                FR6H0027.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                0.17
10.10.2000
08.20.2001
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058
                                                                                                     0.18
■ Atmospheric Requirements
■ Floor Levelness
           10 mm/m (1/100 of inclination) or less for both front and rear and both right and left
■ Floor Flatness
           10 mm or less
010-051-01
010-051-00                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                            0.18
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887
                                                                                                 0.19
■ Frequency
           50Hz/60Hz, single-phase, common specification
■ Line Voltage
           For use in Japan: 100 VAC ±10%
           For use in the U.S.: 100-120 VAC ±10%
           For use in Europe: 200-240 VAC ±10%
■ Power Capacity
           0.4 kVA
■ Power Cord
           3m, with 3P plug/connector
■ Rated Amperage
           100 VAC, 50/60Hz: 3A
           120-240 VAC, 50/60Hz: 2.6A-1.3A
■ Overload Protection
           100 VAC, 50/60Hz: 10A
           120-240 VAC, 50/60Hz: 10A
■ Power Consumption
           Maximum operation: 230 W
           Idling: 125 W
           Standby: 100 W
010-051-00
010-051-01                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               0.19
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058
                                                                             0.20
■ Noise
                    Standby: 40 dB or less
                    Operation: 60 dB or less
                    Single-shot noise: 70 dB or less
■ Warm-up Time
                    ● Setup without power interlink
                    (when the CR-IR346RU is booted in standalone fashion)
                    1 min approx.
                    ● Setup with RU power interlink
                    (when the CR-IR346RU is booted with the CR-IR346CL)
                    3 min approx.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual      0.20
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887
                                                                                                     0.21
■ Installation Space
Machine 515
                                  Front
                                             550
                                             1,000 or more
                                                                    Unit: mm
                                                                    FR6H0020.EPS
Machine 515
                                          Front
                                                    664
                                                   1,000 or more
                                                                            Unit: mm
                                                                            FR6H0017.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       0.21
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058
                                                                                                 0.22
             ● When the machine is secured by the table and table retainers (without
               cassette pocket)
Table
Machine 500
                                 Front
                                           620
                                          1,000 or more
                                                               Unit: mm
                                                               FR6H0018.EPS
             ● When the machine is secured by the table (full option) and table retainers
               (with cassette pocket)
                    REFERENCE
               If the user uses small-size cassettes, the machine and table should be moved forward
               until the cassette is readily accessible.
                              Table
               Cassette pocket
                                                                                  420
                                                 Machine
620
                                                     1,000 or more
                                                                              Unit: mm
                                                                              FR6H0019.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                     0.22
10.10.2000 FM3058
08.30.2001 FM2887
                                                                                                      0.23
■ Servicing Space
                    Sufficient space should be secured for servicing, as indicated below
800
                                    Rear
                                                                 800
                    800                                                         800
                                            Machine
                                    Front
                                                        800
                                                                                  Unit: mm
                                                                                  FR6H0004.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               If there is sufficient space to rotate the machine (800 mm around it), installation may be
               performed with 1,000 mm or more space secured only on one side.
010-051-00
010-051-01                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               0.23
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058
                                                                                                                                        0.24
Troubleshooting (MT)
   1.    Overview of Troubleshooting .......................................................................................... MT-2
         1.1        Flow of Troubleshooting ........................................................................................ MT-2
         1.2        Analysis and Check Flow Marks .......................................................................... MT-3
         1.3        How to View "1.4 Troubleshooting with Error Log" ............................................. MT-3
         1.4        Troubleshooting with Error Log ........................................................................... MT-4
                    1.4.1 Viewing the Error Log ................................................................................. MT-4
                    1.4.2 Determining the Error Code of the Encountered Trouble ........................ MT-5
                    1.4.3 Viewing the Error Code Table to Locate the Associated Analysis
                          Flow ............................................................................................................... MT-6
                    1.4.4 Viewing the Check Flows in Accordance with an Analysis Flow ............ MT-7
   2.    Error Code Table ............................................................................................................... MT-9
   3.    Detail Code ..................................................................................................................... MT-52
         3.1 How to Understand Detail Code ......................................................................... MT-52
         3.2        Detail Codes for Scanner Errors......................................................................... MT-54
   4.    Error Code Analysis Flow (Mechanism) ....................................................................... MT-55
         10300, 10302, 12302 ....................................................................................................... MT-55
         10301, 12301 ................................................................................................................... MT-56
         10303, 10304, 10305, 11303, 12304, 12305 .................................................................... MT-57
         10306, 10307 ................................................................................................................... MT-59
         10318, 12318, 12326, 14315, 14316, 14317 .................................................................... MT-60
         10334, 12334, 14331, 14332, 14333 ............................................................................... MT-61
         10338, 12338, 14335, 14336, 14337 ............................................................................... MT-62
         10340, 10341, 11340, 11341, 14340, 14341 .................................................................... MT-63
         10346, 10348, 10353, 10355, 12346, 12348, 12353, 13355, 14346, 14348, 14354,
         14355 ............................................................................................................................... MT-64
         10347, 10349, 10354, 10356, 10357, 12347, 12349, 12352, 12354, 12355, 12356,
         12357, 14347, 14349, 14356, 14357 ................................................................................ MT-66
         10370, 10371 ................................................................................................................... MT-68
         10390, 10391, 10392, 10393, 12390, 12391, 12392, 12393, 12394, 12395, 13391,
         13392, 13395 ................................................................................................................... MT-69
         10394 ............................................................................................................................... MT-71
         11310, 11311, 14310, 14312 ........................................................................................... MT-72
         11312 ............................................................................................................................... MT-73
         11319, 11320, 11321, 11322, 14319, 14320, 14321, 14322 ............................................ MT-74
         10360, 10361, 11323, 14323 ........................................................................................... MT-76
         11325, 12325 ................................................................................................................... MT-77
         11342, 11343, 11344 ....................................................................................................... MT-78
         11350 ............................................................................................................................... MT-79
BLANK PAGE
Installation (IN)
   1.    Specifications of Machine ................................................................................................ IN-2
   2.    Installation Work Flowchart .............................................................................................. IN-4
   3.    Preparation for Installation .............................................................................................. IN-6
           3.1      Precautions Regarding Installation....................................................................... IN-6
           3.2      Unloading ................................................................................................................ IN-7
           3.3      Transfer.................................................................................................................. IN-12
           3.4      Temporary Placement .......................................................................................... IN-13
           3.5      Checking the Items Supplied ............................................................................... IN-14
   4.    Installation Procedures .................................................................................................. IN-15
           4.1      Removing the Machine-Wrapping Packing Materials........................................ IN-15
           4.2      Removing the Light Protect Plates ..................................................................... IN-16
           4.3      Repositioning the Retaining Members ............................................................... IN-17
   5.    Installing the Options ..................................................................................................... IN-18
           5.1      Assembling the Table ........................................................................................... IN-18
   6.    Setting the CPU12A Board ............................................................................................. IN-22
   7.    Connecting the Cables ................................................................................................... IN-24
           7.1      Connecting the Power Cable and Checking Resistance Value ........................ IN-24
           7.2      Connecting the Interface Cable ........................................................................... IN-25
                    7.2.1 Direct Connection of the CL/RU ............................................................... IN-26
                    7.2.2 Network Connection .................................................................................. IN-27
   8.    Installing the Cover ......................................................................................................... IN-28
   9.    CL Installation Procedures ............................................................................................. IN-28
 10.     Final Placement ............................................................................................................... IN-29
         10.1       Securing the Machine with the Adjustable Feet ................................................ IN-29
         10.2       Securing the Machine with the Retainers ........................................................... IN-30
         10.3       Securing the Table and Machine Together......................................................... IN-32
         10.4       Securing the Machine with the Retainers and Table ......................................... IN-33
 11.     Powering ON the CL/RU ................................................................................................. IN-36
 12.     Image/Conveyance Checks ............................................................................................ IN-37
         12.1       Conveyance Checks ............................................................................................. IN-38
         12.2       Image Checks ........................................................................................................ IN-38
 13.     Powering OFF the CL/RU ................................................................................................ IN-39
 14.     Cleaning the CL/RU ......................................................................................................... IN-39
 15.     Attaching the Cassette Handling Precaution Label ..................................................... IN-40
010-051-06                                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                         0.44
04.20.2002 FM3386
                                                                                                                                      0.45
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                  Reason                           Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)                   All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Revisions associated with release of   MD-1–3, 5, 9–11, 14–21,
                                          version A05 (FM3058)                   21.1–21.4, 32, 42, 43, 46, 47, 49,
                                                                                 50
          02/20/2002    05                Revisions associated with release of   MD-1–3, 13–39, 39.1–39.4, 52,
                                          version A07 (FM3328)                   56, 186
1.         Machine Overview
1.1        Features
CR-IR346RU CR-IR346CL
E-I/F
                        Cross cable
                                                      Printer
                                                                 FR6H1301.EPS
HUB
Network
Straight cable
                                                                                   Printer
                     CR-IR346RU                        CR-IR346CL
                                                                                             FR6H1302.EPS
CR-IR346CL
Network
                                      Straight cable
                                      ru1                              ru2         Printer
                    CR-IR346RU                         CR-IR346RU
                                                                                             FR6H1421.EPS
Top cover
Display panel
                                                                      Right-hand
                                                                      side cover
Front cover
Power switch
Reset switch
FR6H1318.EPS
                                                                                       Left-hand
                  Upper rear cover                                                     side cover
                                                                                                             7. Power lamp
                                                                                                         6. Erasure processing switch
                                                                                                 5. Erasure processing indication display
                                                                                                                                  FR6H1305.EPS
Cassette
Housing
                                                                        Side-positioning
                                                                        conveyor (C)
            Light-collecting unit
FRONT
FR6H1312.EPS
FRONT
                                                   : Grip roller
                                                   : Conveyance path
                                                   : IP conveyance sensor
                                                                   FR6H1313.EPS
SA5
                                                                        Erasure conveyor
                                          SA4
                                    SA2
                      SA1                                                                              SB1
                              SA3
TSWB1
THB1
Side-positioning conveyor
  Subscanning unit
      SZ2                                                                                   SC4
                    SZ3
    SZ5
SC2
SC1
SC3
                                SZ4
                              SZ1
                                                                                                  FR6H1317.EPS
● Erasure conveyor
● Side-positioning conveyor
           ● Subscanning unit
           Symbol               Name                           Type                                   Function
          SZ1         IP leading-edge sensor           Laser light receptor   Detects the leading edge of the IP during reading.
          SZ2         Driving-side grip operation sensor PI (5mm)             Detects the driving-side grip condition.
          SZ3         Driven-side grip operation sensor PI (5mm)              Detects the driven-side grip condition.
          SZ4         IP stopper HP sensor              PI (5mm)              Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
          SZ5         Dust removal HP sensor            PI (5mm)              Detects that the dust removal brush is in its home position.
                                                                                                                                     TR6H1305.EPS
■ I/O Locations (Motors, Clutch, Solenoids, Pump, Valves, Solenoid Valve, Fans)
                                SVA1
               MA1                     PA1
                                                                       Erasure conveyor
             CLA1
                                                                          MB1
                                                      FAN3
                        SOLA1
Side-positioning conveyor
FAN4
  Subscanning unit
                     MZ3
   MZ1                MZ2
                                                                                             MC2
 (FMM)
MC3
MC1
    SOLZ1
                                                             Controller
FAN2
FAN1
FR6H1314.EPS
■ I/O List (Motors, Clutch, Solenoids, Pump, Valves, Solenoid Valve, Fans)
● Erasure conveyor
● Side-positioning conveyor
● Subscanning unit
● Controller
● Housing
                                                                               LED board
                                                                               (LED12A)
 Inverter board
      (INV12B)
    Fluorescent
    lamp ballast
       (INV12A)
   Photomultiplier board
             (PMT12A)
                                                                             Leading-edge
                                                                            detection board
                                                                                 (SED12A)
                                                                        Motherboard
                                                                        (MTH12A)
FR6H1316.EPS
                                                 AC IN
                                              (85V–265V)                                                                                  Network
                                                                                                                                           or CL
                                                                                    Power supply unit
                                                                                                                               Connector board
                                                                                                                                  CNN12A
                                                                                   +15V          +24V           +5V
                                                                                                                                CPU board
                                                                                                                                 CPU12A
                                             +24V                          Motherboard
                                                                                                                             Image processing
                                                                            MTH12A                                             frame memory
                                   +24V
                        P                                                                                             +24V      Polygon driver
                                                                                                                                    board
                              +15V/5V                                                                                             POL12A
                      FFM
                                                                                                                      +15V      Photomultiplier
                                                                                                                                    board
                                                                                                                                  PMT12A
                                                                                              A/D converter
■ Signal System
                                                AC IN
                                                                                                                           Network
                                             (85V–265V)
                                                                                                                            or CL
                                                                          Power supply unit
                                                                                                               Connector board
                                                                                                                  CNN12A
                                                                          +15V      +24V           +5V
                                                                                                                CPU board
                                                                                                                 CPU12A
                                         +24V                      Motherboard
                                                                                                               Image processing
                                                                    MTH12A                                       frame memory
                            M
                                                                                                                 Start-point
                                         Driver board       Sensor board         Scanner board                 detection board
                          SOL
                                          DRV12A              SNS12A               SCN12A                         SYN12A
                           SV
                                                                                                               LD driver board
                                                                                                                  LDD12A
                           CL
                            P                                                                                  Polygon driver
                                                                                                                   board
                                                                                                                  POL12A
                          FFM
                                                                                                          Scanned image data
                                                                                                               Photomultiplier
                                                                                                                   board
                                                                                                                 PMT12A
                                                                                 A/D converter
RU-OS
                    RU-AP                                                             RU-Config
                    CD-ROM         FTP server                                         Machine shipment
                                                                                      control data
                                                COMMON
           Those marked by                 represent data that is temporarily stored in the FTP server, exclusively
           for transferring the data to the RU.
           Those marked by                 represent data that is always stored for comparison with the data in the
           RU’s flash ROM.                                                                              FR6H1415.EPS
               REFERENCE
           The RU message file is a file that contains details on the RU’s error information. It is used to
           cause the error code and error information detail to be displayed on the CL monitor by using,
           as a key, the error code generated on the RU.
              RU
                          FLASH ROM
                    (1)                                           (1)
                           RU-OS                  RU-Config
                    (1)                        Machine shipment   (1)
                           RU-AP               control data
                          Backup memory
                           RU-Config default         (2)
                           setup data*
Memory (SRAM)
RU-OS RU-Config
           When the RU is booted, the data in the flash ROM is copied into the memory (SDRAM)
           (arrow (1)).
           If the default setup data of the RU-Config resides in the backup memory, that data is used to
           overwrite the RU-Config in the memory (arrow (2)).
               REFERENCE
           Normally, the backup memory does not contain the default setup data of the RU-Config. Only
           when one of the following operations is performed, it is written into the backup memory.
           • When the RU is powered ON while holding down the <erasure processing> switch.
           • When “Temporary Setting” for the backup memory is performed in the RU’s Maintenance
             Utility.
                                                            Backup memory
                FTP server
                                COMMON                       Log data
                                                             Image data
                                                             RU-Config
                    RU-Config
                                                             RU-OS
                    Log data                                 Machine shipment
                            RU-specific data                 control data
FR6H1417.EPS
       ● Image data
           The image data scanned from the IP is temporarily stored in the SRAM, and then transferred
           to the CL via the network.
       ● Log data
           • The log data is written, upon shutdown processing or upon occurrence of a FATAL error,
             from the RU BACKUP MEMORY (SAM) to the FTP server.
           • The RU BACKUP MEMORY (SAM) retains the log data that is logged while the RU is
             powered ON.
           • The FTP server retains a certain amount of the log data, which is overwritten by newer
             data on a first-in-first-out basis when a predetermined level is exceeded.
                          CL                                  RU
                                                                 FLASH ROM
                             Machine shipment
                             control data                        Backup memory
                             RU-Config                             Log data
                             Log data
           Backup FD
                                    RU-specific data
                                                                 Memory (SRAM)
FR6H1418.EPS
       ● Log data
           A set of log data stored in the backup memory is backed up to the FD in accordance with the
           flow as illustrated above.
           Note, however, that the log data cannot be restored.
       ● RU-Config
           The RU-Config stored in the FTP server is backed up to the FD. For restore, the data in the
           FD is copied to the FTP server.
CL RU
                                                RU-Config                            RU-Config
           CD-ROM
                                                                                         ••
                                                                                          •
Reboot the CL or RU
                         CL                                    Comparison
                                                                               RU
                                                                  and
                                           FTP server          downloading      FLASH ROM
                           RU M-Utility
                                                RU-AP(A01)                           RU-AP(A01)
                                                RU-Config                            RU-Config
                                                               Comparison                ••
                                                                  only                    •
FR6H2008.EPS
CL RU
                                                RU-Config                    RU-Config
           CD-ROM
                                                                                ••
                                                                                 •
FR6H2010.EPS
               REFERENCE
           Only for the SCN-related data, RESTORE of the PC-MUTL should be used to update them.
           • SCN ALL DATA
           • SCN OPTICAL DATA
           • SCN LIGHT COLLECTING DATA
CL RU
                                 RU-Config                              RU-Config
                                                   Comparison              ••
                                                                            •
CL RU
                                 RU-Config                              RU-Config
                                                   Downloading             ••
                                                                            •
                                                                                       FR6H2009.EPS
               REFERENCES
           • In geographical regions where the PC’s time zone is set for automatically adjusting clock
             for daylight saving changes, the auto update feature is initiated upon daylight saving
             change.
           • When the user boots up the RU, he may be surprised at the blinking LED and alarm
             sound, and consequently power it OFF while the flash ROM is being accessed.
           • As the power is turned OFF while the flash ROM is being accessed, the contents of the
             flash ROM will be damaged, resulting in the failure of the RU to boot up.
           ● Retry operation
              • If an I/O (mechanism, scanner, etc.) abnormality occurs between cassette insertion and
                IP read, the system returns the IP to the cassette.
              • If a scanner unit I/O (mechanism, scanner, etc.) abnormality occurs at the beginning of
                an IP read, the system continues processing as needed to achieve cassette ejection.
Image ROM
                                                                                            Image
                                                                                            SDRAM
               REFERENCES
           • The diagnostics include checking for availability (provided or not provided) and canceling
             each of the internal reset conditions of the hardware.
           • For the sub-CPU, its self diagnostics will be activated by canceling its internal reset
             condition.
           (6) Perform scanner diagnostics (including communication checks for the CPU12A
               and SCN12A boards).
                    ➮ When the scanner diagnostics are completed normally, the “Main CPU LED” seg-
                      ments on the CPU12A board flash right and left.
               REFERENCES
           • The date and time for any error code that has occurred until the date and time data was
             acquired from the CL is indicated as “0000.00.00.00.00:AA”.
           • “AA” denotes a counter that counts time in seconds since power is turned ON.
           (5) Perform scanner diagnostics (including communication checks for the CPU12A
               and SCN12A boards).
                    ➮ When the scanner diagnostics are completed normally, the “Main CPU LED”
                      segments on the CPU12A board flash right and left.
           (3) Load (a) and (b) from the flash ROM on the CPU12A board into the DRAM
               memory.
                (a) MAIN CPU IPL (OS)
                (b) MAIN CPU APPL
                                                              5AT                                                 CNN12A             CL
                                                              A11
                                                              5AT
                                                                                      GND         CPU12A
                                                              A41                     TP1
                                                              +5V circuit
                                                                                                  SCN12A
                                                              5AT A21P         +5V               1.5AT A22P
                                                              A21                                 A22             SED12A
                                                                                     +15V        1.5AT H 12P
                                                                                                  H 12
                                                                                                 1.5AT H14P
                                                                                                  H 14
                                                                                           1.5AT J12P
 Power supply                                                                          -15V J12
                                                                                                                  SYN12A
    SLOT1(+5V)
                     A1
         A           A2                                                                                           PM T12A
                                         4AT   B11P
                                         B11                                                     1.5AT H13P
    SLOT2(+24V)
                     B            BP     4AT   B21P           FA N1                               H 13
                                         B21
       B,C                               4AT   C11P
                                                              FA N2                                               L DD12A
                     C
                                         C11
                                                                                      +24V
    SLOT3(+24V) D                        3AT   C21P
                                         C21                                                                       POL
       D,E                               3AT   C31P
                     E
                                         C31
    SLOT4(+15V) H                 HP     5AT   H11P                                         GND_A        GND_F
                                         H11
         H                                     J11P                                           TP2
    SLOT4(-15V)      J            JP     5AT
          J                              J11
    SLOT5(+24V) K                 KP     2AT   K11P
         K                               K11                                                       SNS12A
    SLOT5(+15V) L
                                                              5AT                     0.5A
         L                                                    A31                     A35                A35P
                                                                                                                               Sensor
                                                                                      1.5AT
                                                                                                         A33P
                                                                                      A33                                      L ED12A
                                                                                      1AT                A34P
                                                                                      A34                                      BCR
                                                                                      1.5AT
                                                                                      A32                A32P
                                                             MTH12A
                                                                                                 2A
                                                                                       L2 1                        MZ2
                                                                                                 3AT    L 31P
                                                                                       L3 1                        MZ3(+12V)
                                                             DP
                                                                                       3AT              D11P
                                                                                                  D11              MA1
                                       +24V                                            3AT              D51P
                                                                                                  D51              MB1
                                                            +24V            D41P
                                                                    3AT
                                                                    D41                3AT D21 D21P
                                                                                                                   SolA1
                           TP4                                        +5V circuit           2A          D31P
                                       GND                                                        D31              SVA1,PA1
                          THB1S                                                        3AT              E11P
                                                                                                  E11              MC1
                                   INV12B
                                                                                       3AT E21 E21P
                           FA N3                                                                                   MC3
                           FA N4,TSWB1                                                 3AT              E31P
                                                                                                  E31              SolZ1
                           LA M P3
                                                                                            2A          E41P
                           LA M P2                                                                E41              CL A1
                           LA M P1                                                     3AT E51 E51P
                                                                                                                   MC2
                                               INV12A
                                                             LP      +15V            2AT                L11P     +15V
                                                                                       L11
       : For board operation                                         +5V                                         +5V
                                                                                    +5VFFM
       : Regulator                                                                                      L 12P
       : Current detection circuit                                                                                MZ1(FFM12A)
        : Fuse
                                                                             GND                  DRV12A
                                                                            TP3
              : Voltage check connector
                (TP1 to TP4)                                                                                                   FR6H1353.EPS
                                                       Detection Point
                    Error Code                                                                              Error Name
                                    A21      A22        A32       A33        A34       A35
                      12810          1        1          1         1          1         1      Power supply A error
                      12811          1        1          0         0          0         0      Power supply A21 error
                      12812          0        1          0         0          0         0      Power supply A22 error
                      12813          0        0          1         0          0         0      Power supply A32 error
                      12814          0        0          0         1          0         0      Power supply A33 error
                      12815          0        0          0         0          1         0      Power supply A34 error
                      12816          0        0          0         0          0         1      Power supply A35 error
                      12817          0        0          1         1          1         1      Power supply A3 error
                      12818          1        0                                                Power supply A row abnormal detected
                      12819                                                                    Power supply A system error
                                                              *
              <Bit indication>
                             1: Error
                                 0: Normal
* When the error combination is other than from 12810 to 12818. TR6H1315.EPS
                                                      Detection Point
                    Error Code                                                                           Error Name
                                      B       B11         B21          C11        C21
                      12820           1        1           1            1          1        Power supply BC error
                      12823           0        1           0            0          0        Power supply B11 error
                      12824           0        0           1            0          0        Power supply B21 error
                      12825           0        0           0            1          0        Power supply C11 error
                      12826           0        0           0            0          1        Power supply C21 error
                      12821           0           0          0          1          1        Power supply C error
                      12822           1           1          1          0          0        Power supply B error
                                      1           0                                         Power supply B row abnormal detected
                      12827
                                      1                      0                              Power supply B row abnormal detected
                      12828                                                                 Power supply BC system error
                                                             *
              <Bit indication>
                             1: Error
                                 0: Normal
              * When the error combination is other than from 12820 to 12827 and any bit is 1.
                                                                                                                            TR6H1316.EPS
                                     Detection Point
  Error Code                                                         Error Name
                     D   D11 D21 D31 D41 E11 E21 E31 E41
     12830           1    1   1   1   1   1   1   1   1 Power supply DE error
     12831           1    1   1   1   1   0   0   0   0 Power supply D error
     12832           0    0   0   0   0   1   1   1   1 Power supply E error
     12833           0    1   0   0   0   0   0   0   0 Power supply D11 error
     12834           0    0   1   0   0   0   0   0   0 Power supply D21 error
     12835           0    0   0   1   0   0   0   0   0 Power supply D31 error
     12836           0    0   0   0   1   0   0   0   0 Power supply D41 error
     12837           0    0      0       0    0       1       0        0    0    Power supply E11 error
     12838           0    0      0       0    0       0       1        0    0    Power supply E21 error
     12839           0    0      0       0    0       0       0        1    0    Power supply E31 error
     12840           0    0      0       0    0       0       0        0    1    Power supply E41 error
                     1    0                                                      Power supply D row abnormal detected
                     1           0                                               Power supply D row abnormal detected
     12841
                     1                   0                                       Power supply D row abnormal detected
                     1                        0                                  Power supply D row abnormal detected
     12842                                                                       Power supply DE system error
                                              *
<Bit indication>
               1: Error
               0: Normal
* When the error combination is other than from 12830 to 12841 and any bit is 1. TR6H1317.EPS
                                              Detection Point
                    Error Code                                                                Error Name
                                     H       H11      H12         H13      H14
                      12850          1        1        1           1        1    Power supply H error
                      12851          0        1        1           1        1    Power supply H11 error
                      12852          0        0        1           0        0    Power supply H12 error
                      12853          0        0        0           1        0    Power supply H13 error
                      12854          0        0        0           0        1    Power supply H14 error
                                              1        0                         Power supply H row abnormal detected
                                              1                    0             Power supply H row abnormal detected
                      12855
                                              1                             0    Power supply H row abnormal detected
                                     1        0                                  Power supply H row abnormal detected
                      12856                                                      Power supply H system error
                                                          *
               <Bit indication>
                              1: Error
                              0: Normal
* When the error combination is other than from 12850 to 12855. TR6H1318.EPS
                                      Detection Point
                    Error Code                                             Error Name
                                     J       J11     J12
                      12860          1        1       1     Power supply J error
                      12861          0        1       1     Power supply J11 error
                      12862          0        0       1     Power supply J12 error
                                     1        0             Power supply J row abnormal detected
                      12863
                                              1        0    Power supply J row abnormal detected
                      12864                                 Power supply J system error
                                             *
              <Bit indication>
                             1: Error
                             0: Normal
                                   Detection Point
                    Error Code                                      Error Name
                                      K       K11
                      12870           1        1       Power supply K error
                      12871           0        1       Power supply K11 error
                      12872           1        0       Power supply J row abnormal detected
              <Bit indication>
                             1: Error
                                 0: Normal                                              TR6H1320.EPS
                                               Detection Point
                    Error Code                                                Error Name
                                      L      L11      L12    L21     L31
                      12880           1       1        1      1       1       Power supply L error
                      12881           0       1        1      0       0       Power supply L11 error
                      12882           0       0        1      0       0       Power supply L12 error
                      12883           0       0        0      1       1       Power supply L21 error
                      12884           0       0        0      0       1       Power supply L31 error
                                      1       0                               Power supply L row abnormal detected
                                      1                       0               Power supply L row abnormal detected
                      12885                   1         0                     Power supply L row abnormal detected
                                                              1       0       Power supply L row abnormal detected
                                                                              Power supply L row abnormal detected
                      12886                                                   Power supply L system error
                                                       *
               <Bit indication>
                              1: Error
                              0: Normal
* When the error combination is other than from 12880 to 12885. TR6H1321.EPS
■ Overview
           The erasure unit provides idle illumination control, IP erasure control, and fan control.
           Feature: Erasure unit initialization is effected after verifying that the machine is emptied of
                    IPs.
           ● IP erasure control
               To effect IP erasure, the erasure unit pass time is controlled in accordance with the dose
               received by a processed IP.
           ● Fan control
               Control is exercised so as to operate a fan when the internal temperature of the erasure
               unit is high.
■ Components
FAN3
CPU12A THB1
                                                                      FAN4
    MTH12A
LAMP1
LAMP2
                                                                      TSWB1
                             FAN3:    Erasure unit cooling fan
                             FAN4:    Inverter cooling fan
                             TSWB1:   Thermal switch
                             THB1:    Temperature thermistor                    FR6H1356.EPS
■ Function descriptions
INV12A board
                    CN4
                                                                                              CN11
CN12
Heat-radiation plate
CN13
CN1
                    INV12B board
                     LED circuit
                                                                                                Erasure
Temperature                                                                                     unit control
thermistor             CN14                                                                     circuit
circuit                              D1 D3 D5 D13 D16 D15                          CN5
                                                                        TP4    1
                                     D12 D7 D8 D11 D18                                GND
FRONT
                                                                                                Power
                                                                               2      +24V(C)
                                                                                                supply
 Cooling fan            CN2
 circuit
                                                                                                     : GND
                        CN3
                     Board LED
                                               Status in the Erasure Unit
             TH     HERR     FA       LT
              0      0        0       1     Thermistor failure
              1      0        0       1     Excessively high temperature
              1      1        0       1     Fan operation
              1      1        1       1     Ready for use
              1      1        1       0     Request for idle illumination ON
              0      1        1       0     Thermistor failure
                                                                                                          LED Status
            LED     Silk Indication                              Meaning
                                                                                                       OFF          ON
            D1      1PRE              Pre-heating signal issued to LAMP1.                             GOOD           NG
            D2      1ON               ON signal issued to LAMP1.                                      GOOD           NG
            D12     1O                LAMP 1 is ON.                                                   GOOD           NG
            D3      2PRE              Pre-heating signal issued to LAMP2.                             GOOD           NG
            D4      2ON               ON signal issued to LAMP2.                                      GOOD           NG
            D7      2O                LAMP 2 is ON.                                                   GOOD           NG
            D5      3PRE              Pre-heating signal issued to LAMP3.                             GOOD           NG
            D6      3ON               ON signal issued to LAMP3.                                      GOOD           NG
            D8      3O                LAMP 3 is ON.                                                   GOOD           NG
            D10     FAN               ON signal notified from the INV12A board to the SNS12A board.     OFF          ON
            D11     HERR              The INV12B board detected high temperature.                     Detected   Not detected
            D13     LT                The INV12B board detected low temperature.                      Detected   Not detected
            D16     FUS1              LAMP1 fuse on the INV12A board is blown.                          NG          GOOD
            D17     FUS2              LAMP2 fuse on the INV12A board is blown.                          NG          GOOD
            D18     FUS3              LAMP3 fuse on the INV12A board is blown.                          NG          GOOD
            D15     TH                Temperature thermistor (THB1) broken.                             NG          GOOD
            D14     VCC               5V output on the INV12A board.                                  GOOD           NG
                                                                                                                     TR6H1322.EPS
SNS12A board
LED position I/O No. Sensor name LED position I/O No. Sensor name
                                   Cassette ejection
                          SA1                                            SC4      IP sensor
                                   sensor
                                                                                  Driven-side grip
                          SA5      Suction sensor                        SZ3      operation sensor
                                                                                  Driving-side grip
                          SB1      IP sensor                             SZ2      operation sensor
                                                                                  Dust removal HP
                          SZ4      IP stopper HP sensor                  SZ5
                                                                                  sensor
TR6H2023.EPS
DRV12A board
LED position I/O No. Load name LED position I/O No. Load name
TR6H2025.EPS
           Load name Control signal in the board       Drive signal to the load
           SOLA1                 ❍
           PA1                                                   ❍
           MA1                   ❍
           SVA1                                                  ❍
           SOLZ1                 ❍
           MB1                   ❍
           MZ3                                                   ❍
           MC3                   ❍
           MC2                   ❍
           MC1                   ❍
           MZ2                                                   ❍
           FFM                   ❍
           CLA1                                                  ❍
       CAUTIONS
       • When servicing a PC board, be sure to wear a wrist band to ground your body. If you do not
         ground your body, the buildup of static electricity on your body may damage electronic
         components on the PC board.
       • Do not uncover the optical unit.
       • Never remove screws painted red.
       • When returning a replaced optical unit for repairs, be sure to use the same packing materials
         that were used for initial shipment. Otherwise, the returned unit cannot be repaired.
■ Components
           Optical unit
                                          Start-point               Shading
                                          detector                  correction            Main CPU
                                          (SYN)
                                                                           H8
                                                                          CPU
Sub-CPU
             Polygon
               (POL)
                                              Long lens
               Laser
               (LDD)
                                                                                 Image data
                                                fθ2
Long lens
PMT12A board
                                                        Photomultiplier
              Driving grip                            Driven grip
■ I/O components
           ● Optical unit
               This unit consists of the laser (LDD: 50 mW), polygon (POL), start-point detector (SYN), f
               θ lens, and long lens.
           ● Sub-scanner unit
               This unit consists of the driven grip, driving grip, photomultiplier (PMT), and leading-edge
               detector (SED).
■ Descriptions of operations
               The H8 CPU on the SCN12A board controls the optical unit and photomultiplier and
               communicates with the main CPU on the CPU12A board.
           ● Features
                 • The control signal status of each I/O is indicated by the LEDs on the SCN12A board.
                 • The scanner error code is formulated by combining an I/O control signal and PC board
                   reference signal.
                       It is structured so as to facilitate problem cause identification.
                 • The polygon data, shading correction data, sensitivity data, and format data are stored
                   in the backup memory on the CPU12A board. They are fed to the SCN12A board for
                   use in operations.
                                                                                                                      Polygon ON
                                                                                                                           Quasi-reading
                                                                                                                           LED ON
                                                                                                                               Quasi-reading
                                                                                                                               PMT data issue
                                                                                                                                                       Check
                                                                                                                                                       unnecessary
                                                     POLLOCK
                                                                                                                                                       ON
                                                                                            LD11DLE
                                                                                                                            PMTD1G
                                                                                                            POLON
                                                                           LD1ON
                                                                                    LD2ON
               LD1OK
ZLCLK
                                                                                                                    LIGHT
                        HVOK
                                              PCLK
                               FCLK
                                                                                                                                                       Blinking
                                                                     SOH
                                                               SOS
OFF
                                                                                                                                       S1
                                                                                                                                                HVON
                                                                                   CN5
                               CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                CN4           S1
                                                                SCN12A
                                                                                                                                                       FR6H1285.EPS
                                                                                            LED
                    LED                              Meaning                                             LED OFF
                                                                                         ON/Blinking
            LD1 OK        OK signal (laser power 50% or more) from the laser (LDD)         GOOD            NG
                          High-voltage power supply OK signal from the photomultiplier
            HV OK                                                                          GOOD            NG
                          (PMT)
            FCLK,PCLCK Reference signal issued by the SCN12A board                            -             -
                                                                                           GOOD
            ZLCLK         H8 CPU operation status signal                                                   NG
                                                                                          (blinking)
            POL LOCK      OK signal from the polygon (POL)                                 GOOD            NG
                                                                                                           Not
            SOS           Detection signal from the start-point detector (SYN)            Detected
                                                                                                         detected
                                                                                                           Not
            SOH           Detection signal from the leading-edge detector (SED)           Detected
                                                                                                         detected
            LD1 ON        ON signal from the SCN12A board to the laser (LDD)                 ON            OFF
            LD2 ON        Not used                                                            -             -
                          Control signal from the SCN12A board to the laser (LDD)
                          ON: Output generation is in progress.
            LD1 IDLE                                                                         ON            OFF
                          OFF: No output is being generated.
            POL ON        ON signal from the SCN12A board to the polygon (POL)               ON            OFF
                          Quasi-data output signal with the PMT12A board LED
            LIGHT                                                                            ON            OFF
                          illuminated
                          Quasi-data output signal generated by the LOG amplifier
            PMT D1G                                                                          ON            OFF
                          on the PMT12A board
                          High-voltage switch status signal
                          ON: The ON setting is selected by both the software and
            HV ON               the hardware.                                                ON            OFF
                          OFF: The OFF setting is selected by either the software or
                                the hardware.
                                                                                                           TR6H1101.EPS
              (2) The PMT12A board (photomultiplier) sends the data, in analog form, to the SCN12A
                  board.
              (3) The analog data thus sent is subjected to shading correction and other processes on
                  the SCN12A board, and then converted to its digital data equivalent (A/D conversion).
              (4) The SCN12A board sends the data, in digital data form, to the CPU12A board via the
                  MTH12A board.
              (5) The sub-CPU on the CPU12A board subjects the data to 2/3 line reduction and then
                  transmits it to the CL via the network.
                                                                     [Photomultiplier]
                                                                               PMT12A
                               Optical unit
                                                                           LOG amplifier
HV
Laser light
                    Light-collection                  Light-collection
                         mirror                       guide
                                                                               SCN12A
                                                                               Shading
                                                                               correction
IP
AD conversion
                                                                               CPU12A
                                                                               Sub-CPU
Printer
                                              CL
                                                                                         MTH12A
■ RU common parts
           ● E-ringless housings
               The employed housings can be secured to side plates without E-rings.
FR6H1281.EPS
               CAUTION
               When installing the pinion gear over the shaft, ensure that it is properly oriented. If you
               install it over the shaft while it is reversed, its claws may become damaged.
Pinion gear
Claws Shaft
Claws
                     GOOD                                                NG
                                                                                         FR6H1282.EPS
           ● Photosensors
               In marked contrast to the previously used screw-on type, the currently employed
               photosensors are to be claw-locked (for displacement prevention).
               CAUTION
               When removing or installing the photosensor, use a steel rule or the like and exercise
               care not to damage the sensor claws.
                                              Sensor
                                                                                Steel rule
Claw
FR6H1283.EPS
                                                                                     Suction cup
                                                                                     assembly
FR6H1284.EPS
■ IP feed suction
           The suction cup drive motor (MA1) rotates to move the suction arm toward the cassette
           cover. The moment the suction cup assembly reaches the IP suction position, the suction
           pump (PA1) operates to suction the IP. If the suction sensor (SA5) does not close within a
           period of 1 second in this instance, a suction failure occurs.
■ IP feed leak
           After the suction cup assembly is moved to the feed roller in the erasure conveyor unit, the
           leak valve (SVA1) operates to separate the suctioned IP from the suction cup assembly.
           To verify the subsequent IP feed operation, the cassette inlet IP detection sensor (SB1)
           detects the IP leading edge.
■ IP load suction
           When the IP is loaded from the erasure conveyor unit into the cassette, the suction pump
           (PA1) operates to suction the IP trailing edge.
           In this instance, the suction cup assembly is in the home position.
■ IP load leak
           The suction cup drive motor (MA1) rotates to move the suction arm toward the cassette
           cover, thereby loading the IP into the cassette. Once the IP loading is completed, the leak
           valve (SVA1) operates to release the suction of the suction cup.
■ Cassette ejection
           After the IP suction is released, the solenoid (SOLA1) operates to release the cassette hold
           pin that secures the cassette in place.
           At this time, the extrusion clutch (CLA1) operates so that the driving force of the IP removal
           arm is transmitted to the rubber roller. Thus, the moment the IP removal arm is moved to its
           home position, the rubber roller rotates, so that the cassette is ejected.
           Once the cassette ejection is completed, the extrusion clutch (CLA1) turns off, and the
           processing status lamp goes off, while the cassette removal lamp lights up.
                        Cam
                                                      Guide
Cam
FR6H1400.EPS
■ IP feed conveyance
           The IP conveyance motor (MC3) operates to transport the IP to the IP stopper section in the
           sub-scanner unit. In this instance, the solenoid (SOLZ1) operates to raise the IP stoppers.
           Further, the driven and driving shaft roller grips in the sub-scanner unit are released.
                                           M
                     Sub-scanner                           M
                                                                                                Side-positioning
                                                                                                conveyor
                                                                                                IP conveyance
                                                                           M                    motor (MC3)
                Driving shaft roller                                                M
                                                                               M
FRONT
FR6H1401.EPS
                                 M                                                Grip release HP
           Sub-scanner                            M                               sensor (SC2)
                                                                 M                Grip roller
                                                                         M
                                                                     M
                    FRONT
                                                                                  Grip release motor
                                                                                  (MC2)
                                                                                                   FR6H1402.EPS
■ Side-positioning operation
           When the side-positioning sensor (SC1) detects that the claw assembly is in its home posi-
           tion, the side-positioning motor (MC1) drives to perform side-positioning operation twice.
           The side-positioning operation causes the edge of the IP to align closely to the side guide of
           the side-positioning conveyor, thereby determining the orientation and position of the IP.
           After the side-positioning operation is completed, the claw assembly moves to its home
           position and the IP is conveyed to the scanner unit.
                                                                                  Side-positioning
                                                                                  conveyor
                                 M
           Sub-Scanner                           M
                                                                                  Side-positioning HP
                                                                                  sensor (SC1)
                                                                 M                Side-positioning
                                                                                  motor (MC1)
                                                                         M
                                                                     M
FRONT
IP stopper mechanism
FR6H1404.EPS
FR6H1405.EPS
                                            M
                    Sub-scanner                             M
                                                                                                 Side-positioning
                                                                                                 conveyor
                                                                           M
                                                                                   M
                                                                               M
FRONT
FR6H1406.EPS
                                         M
                    Sub-scanner                           M
                                                                                               Side-positioning
                                                                                               conveyor
                                                                         M
            Driving shaft roller                                                 M
                                                                             M
FRONT
■ IP load conveyance
            After the completion of the image read process, the grip drive motor (MZ2) operates to grip
            the released driven shaft roller.
            The moment the driven shaft roller is gripped, the sub-scanner motor (MZ1) operates to
            transport the IP to the side-positioning conveyor.
            Sub-scanner
            motor (MZ1)
                                        M
            Sub-scanner                                   M
                                                                                                Side-positioning
                                                                                                conveyor
                                                                          M
                                                                                  M
                                                                              M
FRONT
                                        M
            Sub-scanner                                   M
                                                                                                Side-positioning
                                                                                                conveyor
                                                                                                IP conveyance motor
                                                                          M                     (MC3)
                                                                                  M
                                                                              M
FRONT
Delay: 100ms
                          A
                                                                                                                 FR6H1137.EPS
                               Open
              SA2: Close?
             Close
                                                B
                               NO
             Any remaining
                  IP?
            YES
                                                                         C
              CMOS info         NO
             CMOS clear ?
                                                 CMOS info        NO
              YES                              Before reading?
                                                                         CMOS info          NO
                                                    YES                Before erasure?
YES
                              Conveyance
                 13386                                                       11387       Recovery IP processing
                              CMOS clear
                                                          1
Message display
Delay: 50ms
Open
Delay: 100ms
                  END
                                                                                                     FR6H1278.EPS
                          Open
         SA1: Close?                          1
Close
         CMOS info         NO
        CMOS clear?
                                               CMOS info       NO
          YES                                Before reading?
                                                                      CMOS info       NO
                                               YES                  Before erasure?
                                                                      YES
                         Conveyance CMOS
            13386                                  D                    11387     Recovery IP processing
                         clear
Message display
Open
D FR6H1279.EPS
                No IP
NG
                             Suction cup movement (HP → feed suction)
                             [MA1: CCW2195P]: Drive
Delay: 50ms
Open
5.1.1 Sensor ON
<Fig. 1 Sensor ON Flow>
                           START
                                         Suction cup HP sensor (SA4):                 ON
                                         Cassette inlet IP sensor (SB1):              ON
                                         Side-positioning HP sensor (SC1):            ON
                                         Grip release HP sensor (SC2):                ON
                                         Side-positioning IP sensor (SC3):            ON
                                         Erasure positioning IP sensor (SC4):         ON
                                         Driving-side grip release HP sensor (SZ2):   ON
                                         Driven-side grip release HP sensor (SZ3):    ON
                                         Stopper HP sensor (SZ4):                     ON
                                         Dust removal HP sensor (SZ5):                ON
                         SA1: Open?
  Open                                   Close (With cassette)
  (Without cassette)
                         SA2: Open?
   Open                                  Close (With cassette)
   (Without cassette)
                          SA3: Open?
   Open                                  Close (With cassette)
   (Without cassette)
Yes
                                           SA1open&SA2open&SA3close
                        NO                                                    10300        IP sensor logical
                                                                                           inconsistency SA3
                                                             Yes
                                           SA1open&SA2close&SA3open
                        NO                                                    10300
                                                                                           IP sensor logical
                                                                                           inconsistency SA2
                                                             Yes
                                           SA1open&SA2close&SA3close
                        NO                                                    10300        IP sensor logical
                                                                                           inconsistency SA2
FR6H2024.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                  Cassette set unit
                  A unit
                                                                                       Suction cup HP sensor
     Cassette ejection sensor                                                          SA4
     SA1
                                                                                                 Side-positioning HP sensor
                                                                                                 SC1
    Dust removal sensor
    SZ5
 Subscanning unit
 Z unit                      IP stopper HP sensor                                             IP sensor
                             SZ4                                                              SC3                 FR6H1219.EPS
<I/O Table>
    Symbol                      Name                     Type                           Function
     SA1        Cassette ejection sensor               PI (5mm)    Detects that the cassette has been ejected.
      SA2       Cassette IN sensor                     PI (5mm)    Detects that the cassette has been inserted.
      SA3       Cassette hold sensor                   PI (5mm)    Detects the cassette hold completion.
      SA4       Suction cup HP sensor                  PI (5mm)    Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
      SB1       Cassette inlet IP sensor               PI (19mm)   Detects the IP.
      SC1       Side-positioning HP sensor             PI (5mm)    Detects that it is in the side-positioning home position.
      SC2       Grip release HP sensor                 PI (5mm)    Detects that it is in the grip release home position.
      SC3       Side-positioning IP sensor             PI (19mm)   Detects the IP.
      SC4       Erasure positioning IP sensor          PI (19mm)   Detects the IP.
      SZ2       Driving-side grip release HP sensor    PI (5mm)    Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
      SZ3       Driven-side grip release HP sensor     PI (5mm)    Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
      SZ4       Stopper HP sensor                      PI (5mm)    Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
      SZ5       Dust removal HP sensor                 PI (5mm)    Detects that the dust removal brush is in its home position.
                                                                                                                           TR6H1079.EPS
SA2
SB1/SC3/SC4
BLANK PAGE
                        Close
     Stopper                                                                  Within 5 times [NZ12]
                        (Retreat                             Retry?
     retreat
                        OK)
                                              6 times or more
                                                                          IP stopper                          IP stopper
                                                             10341        retreat failure       14341
                                                                                                              retreat retry
                                                     Close
                                                     (Blocked)
Wait for MZ3CW                                                                                                      Dust removal driving
SZ5 Close                                                            Delay [TZ58: 0.2sec]
                                                                                                                    MZ3: OFF
(preparation for
HP detection)                                                        Dust removal driving
                                                                     MZ3: OFF                           5.2.14, Fig. 1        Sensor confirmation 1
                                                                                                                                                      FR6H1160.EPS
                                    A
                                                    Close (Blocked)
                                                    Timeout [TZ57: within 10 sec]
                                  SZ5: Open?
                           Open
                           (Not blocked)
Elapsed time count timer stop Elapsed time count timer stop
                                          C                        2
                                                                                                                           FR6H1161.EPS
                                                Close (blocked)
                                                Timeout [TZ57: within 10 sec]
                                SZ5: Open?
                         Close
                         (Blocked)
                                                                                             Dust removal driving
                                            Delay [TZ58: 0.2sec]
                                                                                             MZ3: OFF
                         Open
                         (Blocked)
    Wait for MZ3CCW
    SZ5 Open                                                                                 Dust removal driving
                                            Delay [TZ55: 0.6sec]
    (HP detection)                                                                           MZ3: OFF
                                     END
                                                                                                                          FR6H1163.EPS
                                                  Close (Blocked)
                                                  Timeout [TZ57: within 10 sec]
                                SZ5: Open?
                                                                                                           Close (Blocked)
                                                                                                           Timeout [TZ57: within 10 sec]
                                                                                         SZ5: Open?
                                                                            2 times or more
                                                                                                                                           A
                                                                                           10394       Dust removal CCW driving error
                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H1162.EPS
<I/O Locations>
FRONT
         Subscanning unit
         Z unit                       IP stopper solenoid      IP stopper HP sensor
                                      SolZ1                    SZ4
                                                                                 FR6H1220.EPS
<I/O Table>
BLANK PAGE
                                          Open
                          SC2: Close?
                                                                                                              Side-positioning grip
                                      MC2 [PC61: CW400P]: Drive                                  14335        HP detection preparation
                                                                                                              positioning retry
                                          Close
                                          Timeout [TC62: within 2.8 sec]
                          SC2: Close?
HP detection                                                            Grip release motor
preparation return        Open                                          MC2: OFF
                                      Grip release motor                    Side-positioning
                                      MC2: OFF                  14336       grip HP detection
                                                                            preparation return
                                      Delay [TC61: 0.1sec]                  retry
                        Open
                                           Timeout [TC64: within 2.5 sec]
                          SC2: Close?
                                                                                                                                     2
                          Close
                                                                                                              Within 3 times [NC61]
                                      Delay [TC61: 0.1sec]                                       Retry?
                                                                            2
                                                                                                                               FR6H1216.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                           Side-positioning conveyor
                                                           C unit
                                         M
            FRONT
<I/O Table>
           Symbol                Name                      Type                                  Function
           SC2          Grip release HP sensor     Pl (5mm)                  Detects that it is in the grip release home position.
            MC2         Grip release motor         Pulse motor               Drives to release the grip.
                                                                                                                          TR6H1091.EPS
SA2
          SZ2: Open?    NO
          SZ3: Close?
SZ2: Open
                                                             NO
SZ3: Close                                    SZ2: Open?
(When both                                    SZ3: Open?
grips complete
normally)                         SZ2: Open
                                  SZ3: Open
                                                                      A
                                                      MZ2: ON
                                                      DA value: 204
                               Soft monitoring
                                                            Timeout [TZ24: 5 sec] (Soft)
                                              MZ2 stop?
                                              Stop
                                                                                                                                         MZ2: OFF
                                                     MZ2: OFF (Hard)
Delay: 50ms
                                                             SZ2: Open
                                                             SZ3: Open
                                              SZ2: Open?     (Not changed)
                                              SZ3: Open?
                                               NO                                                            2 times or more
                                                                                              Retry?
                                                     Register reset
                                                                                  Within 1 time
                                                                                  [NZ13]
                                                     Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]                                  Initialization grip               Initialization grip
                                                                                              14355                              10355
                                                                                                           movement 2 error                  movement 2 error
                                                             SZ2: Close
                                                                                                       Register reset                    Register reset
                                                             SZ3: Open
                                                             (Both grips in released state)
                                          Status of SZ2
      D                                     and SZ3?                                                   Delay                             Delay
                                                                                                       [TZ25: 0.1sec]                    [TZ25: 0.1sec]
                             SZ2: Open
                             SZ3: Close
                             (Both grips in
                             ejected state)
                                                                      B
                                                                                                  1                               NG
             END
                                                                                                                                                      FR6H1151.EPS
             SZ2: Close?       NO
             SZ3: Open?
    SZ2: Close
    SZ3: Open
         B                                                  SZ2: Close?            NO
                                                            SZ3: Close?
                                                    SZ2: Close
                                         2          SZ3: Close
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Close
                               SZ3: Open
             SZ2: Close?       (Not changed)
             SZ3: Open?
              NO                                                              2 times or more
                                                             Retry?
                                                  Within 1 time
                                                  [NZ13]
                        Register reset
                                                                             Initialization grip                   Initialization grip
                                                             14354                                     10354
                                                                             movement 1 error                      movement 1 error
2 NG
                    C
                                                                                                                                FR6H1152.EPS
               Soft monitoring
                                            Timeout [TZ21: within 10 sec] (Soft)
                          MZ2 stop?
  Driving-
  shaft grip
                                     Delay: 50ms
                                             SZ2: Close
                                             SZ3: Open
                          SZ2: Close?        (Not changed)
                          SZ3: Open?
                           NO                                                             2 times or more
                                                                           Retry?
                                                                Within 1 time
                                                                [NZ13]
                                     Register reset
                                 D                                              4                                   NG
                                                                                                                                              FR6H1153.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                 Driven-side grip release HP sensor
                 SZ3
                                                                                FRONT
                 Driving-side grip release HP sensor
                 SZ2
         Subscanning unit
         Z unit
                                                                                        FR6H1221.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                      Name                         Type                                  Function
           SZ2          Driving-side grip release HP sensor   PI (5mm)              Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
           SZ3          Driven-side grip release HP sensor    PI (5mm)              Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
           MZ2          Grip driving                          DC motor              Speed correction capability (equivalent to DPR).
                                                                                                                                 TR6H1074.EPS
                                       Open                                                         F
                        SC1: Close?                                                                 R
                                                                                                    O
                                                                                                    N
                                                                                                    T
                                                             MC1 [PC53: CW4800 P]: Drive
                      Close
                                                                  Open
                                                                  Timeout [TC53: within 11.6 sec]
                                                  SC1: Close?
                               HP detection                                                             Side-positioning motor
                                                 Close                                                  MC1: OFF
                               preparation
                               positioning                   Side-positioning motor
                                                             MC1: OFF                                          Sensor confirmation
                                                                                            5.2.14, Fig. 1     (SC1)
                                                             Delay [TC51: 0.1sec]
                                                                                                             Side-positioning HP detection
                                   MC1 [PC51: CCW533P]: Drive                                   14331
                                                                                                             preparation positioning retry
                                       Close
                                       Timeout [TC52: within 3.1 sec]
                        SC1: Close?
  HP preparation                                                       Side-positioning motor
  return                Open                                           MC1: OFF
                                   Side-positioning motor
                                   MC1: OFF                               Side-positioning HP
                                                              14332
                                                                          detection preparation
                                                                          return retry
                                   Delay [TC51: 0.1sec]
                      Open
                                       Timeout [TC54: within 2.5 sec]                                                                2
                        SC1: Close?
                                       Open
                        SC1: Close?
                       Close
                                                                                     Sensor confirmation 2
                                                                  5.2.14, Fig. 2
                                                                                     (SC1)
                             END
                                                                                     Side-positioning HP
                                                                        14333
                                                                                     detection retry
2 FR6H1217.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                          Side-positioning conveyor
                                                          C unit
                                                         Side-positioning HP sensor
                                                         SC1
                                    M                    Side-positioning motor
                                                         MC1
           FRONT
                                                                                 FR6H1244.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                      Type                                     Function
           SC1          Side-positioning HP sensor     Pl (5mm)           Detects that it is in the side-positioning home position.
            MC1         Side-positioning motor         Pulse motor        Drives the side-positioning mechanism.
                                                                                                                          TR6H1092.EPS
5.1.6 IP Search
<Fig. 1 IP Search Flow>
                                                             START
                                                                            SB1: Close
                                                                                       (IP found by both sensors)
                                                        SB1: Open?          SC4: Close
                                                        SC4: Open?
                                                                                                                           IP sensor logical
                                                                                                               10300
                                                                                                                           inconsistency SB1
                                SB1 and SC4: Open (No IP)
                                SB1 or SC4: Open
                                                                                                                           IP sensor logical
                                (IP found by either sensor)                                                    10300
                                                                                                                           inconsistency SC4
                                                                               SB1: Close
                                                                               SC3: Close
                                                        SB1: Open?             SC4: Close (IP found by all sensors)
                                                        SC3: Open?
                                                        SC4: Open?                                                         IP sensor logical
                                                                                                               10300
                                                                                                                           inconsistency SB1
                        SB1 and SC3 and SC4: Open (No IP)
                        SB1 or SC3 or SC4: Open                                                                            IP sensor logical
                                                                                                               10300
                        (IP found by either sensor)                                                                        inconsistency SC3
                                                                                                                           IP sensor logical
                                                                                                               10300
                                                                                                                           inconsistency SC4
                                                                             SB1 and SC3 and SC4: Close
                                                                             (IP found by all sensors)
                                                                             SB1 or SC3 or SC4: Close
                                                        SB1: Open?           (IP found by either sensor)
                                                        SC3: Open?
                                                        SC4: Open?
                                                 SB1: Open
                                                 SC3: Open
                                                 SC4: Open
                                                 (No IP)
                                                                     Erasure conveyor/                           B
                                                                     side-positioning conveyor search
                                                                     MB1 [PB27: CW2077P]: Drive
                                                                            SB1: Open
                                                                                        (No IP)
                                       SB1: Close                           SC4: Open
                                       (IP found)       SB1: Close?         Timeout [TC81: within 4.6 sec]
                                                            or
                                                        SC4: Close?
                                                SC4: Close
                                                (IP found)           Erasure conveyor/                       Erasure conveyor/
IP search                   CMOS info
at erasure conveyor/                                                 side-positioning conveyor               side-positioning conveyor
                            "No IP" is rewritten to                  search stop                             search stop
side-positioning            "IP found within machine"
conveyor                                                             MB1: OFF                                MB1: OFF
                           Erasure conveyor/
                           side-positioning conveyor                 IP found within machine                  No IP within machine
                           search stop
                           MB1: OFF
                            IP found within machine
                                                              A
                                                                                                                                     FR6H1175.EPS
                                         A
                                                        SB1 and SC3 and SC4: Close
                                                        (IP found by all sensors)
                                                        SB1 or SC3 or SC4: Close
                                   SB1: Open?           (IP found by either sensor)
                                   SC3: Open?
                                   SC4: Open?
                           SB1: Open
                           SC3: Open
                           SC4: Open                                             B
                           (No IP)
                                               Scanner unit search
                                               MC3 [PC38: CW5000P]: Drive
                                               MZ1 [V0: CCW212.8mm/s]: Drive
                                                      SC3: Open
                                                                (No IP)
                                                      SC4: Open
                                   SC3: Close?        Timeout [TC82: within 7.4 sec]
                                        or
                                   SC4: Close?
                        SC3: Close
Scanner unit            SC4: Close
IP search               (IP found by
                        either sensor)         Scanner unit search stop        Scanner unit search stop
                                               MC3: OFF                        MC3: OFF
                                               MZ1: OFF                        MZ1: OFF
                                                IP found within
                                                                                No IP within machine
                                                machine
                           SB1: Open
                           SC3: Open
                           SC4: Open
                           (No IP)
                                                                                 B
                                         END
                                                                                           FR6H1177.EPS
                                              Close
                                              (IP found)
                             SC3: Open?
                         Open
                         (No IP)
                                     C
                                                                                                                     FR6H1176.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                     M
                                                                                                     Transport motor
                                                                                                     MB1
                                                                                                     IP sensor
                                                                                                     SB1
                                                                                                     IP sensor
                                                                                                     SC4
                                                                                                      Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                      C unit
  Subscanning motor                          M
  MZ1
                                                                                                     Transport motor
                                                                                                     MC3
Subscanning unit                                                                      M
Z unit
                                                                                 IP sensor
                                                                                 SC3                                    FR6H1222.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                     Name                           Type                           Function
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor           PI (19mm)             Detects the presence of an IP.
           SC3          Side-positioning IP sensor         PI (19mm)             Detects the IP.
           SC4          Erasure positioning IP sensor      PI (19mm)             Detects the IP.
           MB1          IP transport motor                 Pulse motor           Conveys the IP.
           MC3          IP transport motor                 Pulse motor           Conveys the IP.
           MZ1          Subscanning motor                  FFM                   Conveys the IP.
                                                                                                                        TR6H1081.EPS
START
                                                                                                  1
                                                 Motor operation (1-pulse driving)
                                                 MA1 [PA52: CCW1P]: Drive
                   Open
                   (HP position NG)                  Open (HP position NG)
                                                     Timeout [TA84: 5.5 sec]
                                  SA4: Close?
                     Close
                     (HP position OK)
                                                                                                                                               1
                                                       Open (HP position NG)
                                    SA4: Close?
                        Close
                        (HP position OK)                                                                                  Within 3 times [NA51]
                                                                                                           Retry?
4 times or more
                                                                                                                         Suction cup HP
                                           END                                                             10318                                       2
                                                                                                                         operation error                             FR6H1214.EPS
<I/O Locations>
         Suction cup driving motor                  Cassette set unit                           Suction cup HP sensor
         MA1                                        A unit                                      SA4
                                                            FRONT
                                                                                                                  FR6H1245.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                    Type                                     Function
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor         Pl (5mm)          Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor     Pulse motor       Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
                                                                                                                                 TR6H1093.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                Cleared
                                                                                                                                       CMOS cleared?
                                          Process
                                          continued
                                                       END
                                                                                                                                                                                      FR6H1182.EPS
                                                                                                              Open
                                Open                                                            SC3: Close?
                  SB1: Close?
Broken wire
                                                                                                Close             No sensor error
sensor           Close              No sensor error
                                                                                                              Broken wire
                                Broken wire                               Open                     10302
                        10302                               SC4: Close?                                       sensor
                                sensor
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                               IP sensor
                                                                                               SB1
                                                                                               IP sensor
                                                                                               SC4
                                                                                                Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                C unit
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                   Name                            Type                             Function
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor           PI (19mm)              Detects the presence of an IP.
           SC3          Side-positioning IP sensor         PI (19mm)              Detects the IP.
           SC4          Erasure positioning IP sensor      PI (19mm)              Detects the IP.
                                                                                                                     TR6H1077.EPS
BLANK PAGE
START
                           Any            No IP
                        remaining IP
                             ?
                   IP found
                         Measurement       NO
                        time > 1.35 sec
                             [TB15]
                        YES
                                                    Measurement        NO
                                     IP = 14x17
                                                   time > 1.14 sec
                                                        [TB14]
                                                    YES
IP                                                                                                        Metric
                                                                IP = 14x14          IP type
determination
                                                                             Inch
                                                                                                                    Measurement      NO
                                                                                                                   time > 0.89 sec
                                                                               Measurement           NO                 [TB13]
                                                                              time > 0.89 sec
                                                                                   [TB13]                          YES
                                                                              YES                                               IP = 24-30     IP = 18-24
IP = 8x12 IP = 8x10
                              A
                                                                                                                                                 FR6H1197.EPS
                                         Side-positioning
                                         MC3 [PC35: CW3000P]: Drive
                                         MB1 [PB23: CW4535P]: Drive
Cassette IN
sensor
confirmation
                                              Open (Without cassette)
                              SA2: Close?
                   Close
                   (With cassette)
                                                                 5.2.1, Fig. 2      Cassette hold release
Message display
                                                                                   Close
                                                                 SA2: Close?
                                                                 Open
                                                                                                        Message Cancel
                                              Not activated
                                                                 Remove key:
                                                                  Activation
Activated
                                                         NG
                                                                 5.2.1, Fig. 1      Cassette IN detection
C Delay: 50ms
                                 END
                                                                                                                    FR6H1198.EPS
<I/O Locations>
      Suction cup driving motor            Cassette set unit   Cassette IN sensor   Suction cup HP sensor
      MA1                                  A unit              SA2                  SA4
                                                                                    M
                  Cassette hold solenoid                                                        Transport motor
                  SolA1                                                                         MB1
               Hold sensor
               SA3
                                                                                                 Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                 C unit
                                                                             M                  Side-positioning motor
                                                                                                MC1
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                         Type                                     Function
           SA1          Cassette ejection sensor     PI (5mm)                   Detects that the cassette has been ejected.
           SA2          Cassette IN sensor           PI (5mm)                   Detects that the cassette has been inserted.
           SA3          Cassette hold sensor         PI (5mm)                   Detects the cassette hold completion.
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor        PI (5mm)                   Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           SC3          Side-positioning IP sensor   PI (19mm)                  IP conveyance sensor
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor    Pulse motor                Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
           MB1          IP transport motor           Pulse motor                Conveys the IP.
           MC1          Side-positioning motor       Pulse motor                Drives the side-positioning mechanism.
           SolA1        Cassette hold SOL            Power-down solenoid Retreats the cassette hold pin when turned ON.
           CLA1         Cassette ejection clutch     Clutch
                                                                                                                                   TR6H1087.EPS
SA2
SC3
                                  SZ2: Open?         NO
                                  SZ3: Close?
                        SZ2: Open
                        SZ3: Close                                 SZ2: Open?   NO
                        (Status of both                            SZ3: Open?
                        grips when
                        normally                      SZ2: Open
                        completed)                    SZ3: Open
                                                                                           SZ2: Close?          NO
                                                                       A                   SZ3: Open?
                                                                                                                               NO
                                                               1                SZ2: Close
                                                                                SZ3: Open
                                                                                                                     SZ2: Close?
                                              MZ2: ON                                           G                    SZ3: Close?
                                              DA value: 204
                                                                                                            SZ2: Close
                                                                                                            SZ3: Close
                                                                                                                           I
                        Soft monitoring
                                                  Timeout [TZ31: within 10 sec] (Soft)
                                   MZ2 stop?
Delay: 50ms
                                                     SZ2: Open
                                                     SZ3: Close
                                  SZ2: Open?         (Not changed)
                                  SZ3: Close?
NO
Register reset
                                                                                                 2 times or more
                                                                                 Retry?
                                          A                                                                           NG
                                                                                     1                                                      FR6H1143.EPS
                            MZ2: ON
                            DA value: 204
   Soft monitoring
                                     NO
                                     Timeout [TZ24: within 5 sec] (Soft)
                 MZ2 stop?
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                                   SZ2: Open
                                   SZ3: Open
                 SZ2: Open?        (Not changed)
                 SZ3: Open?
                  NO                                                            2 times or more
                                                                 Retry?
                        B                    G
                                                                                                                         FR6H1144.EPS
 B
              5.1.10, Fig. 7   Subscanning ejection grip
                                 Logged
            12352 or 12355
               logged?
Not logged
                   END
                                                      FR6H1320.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                     FRONT
           Subscanning unit
           Z unit                                                                     FR6H1225.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                      Name                          Type                               Function
            SZ2         Driving-side grip release HP sensor   PI (5mm)            Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
            SZ3         Driven-side grip release HP sensor    PI (5mm)            Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
            MZ2         Grip driving                          DC motor            Speed correction capability (equivalent to DPR).
                                                                                                                               TR6H1074.EPS
START
                                         3
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay : 50ms
                               SZ2: Open
                               SZ3: Close
            SZ2: Open?         (Stop by noise)
            SZ3: Close?
              NO
                                                                         2 times or more
                                                            Retry?
                  END                                            3                           NG
                                                                                                                     FR6H1321.EPS
START
                                          4
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Open
                               SZ3: Open
             SZ2: Open?        (Not changed)
             SZ3: Open?
               NO                                                              2 times or more
                                                               Retry?
                        Register reset
                                               Within 1 time
                                               [NZ13]
                                                                            Both-grip release                Both-grip release
                        Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]                   14348                             10348
                                                                            error                            error
                  END                                              4                              NG
                                                                                                                          FR6H1322.EPS
START
                                          5
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Close
                               SZ3: Open
             SZ2: Close?       (Not changed)
             SZ3: Open?
               NO                                                          2 times or more
                                                             Retry?
                  END                                            5                             NG
                                                                                                                       FR6H1323.EPS
START
Soft monitoring
                             Timeout [TZ34: within 15 sec] (Soft)
             MZ2 stop?                                                                                   Driving-shaft slow grip
                                                                                                         stop
            Stop                                                                                         MZ2: OFF
                                                                                                             Driving-shaft correction
                        MZ2: OFF (Hard)                                                          10353
                                                                                                             grip error
                                                                                                         Register reset
                        Timer stop
                                                                                                         Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]
                                NG
                                (±3% deviation)
         4.39 ≤ Timer ≤ 4.67
                                                                                                         Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]
             OK
                                                                         Close (noise stop)
                                                                                               SZ2: Close?
                                                              Driving-shaft grip error
                                                  12352
                                                              stop                            Open
Register reset
                  END
                                                                                                                          FR6H1324.EPS
START
 Soft monitoring
                             Timeout [TZ31: within 10 sec] (Soft)
               MZ2 stop?
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                                SZ2: Open
                                SZ3: Close
                                (Not changed)
              SZ2: Open?
              SZ3: Close?
               NO                                                         2 times or more
                                                            Retry?
                         Register reset
                                                  Within 1 time
                                                  [NZ13]
                   END                                           7
                                                                                                                FR6H1325.EPS
START
Soft monitoring
                            Timeout [TZ31: within 10 sec] (Soft)
              MZ2 stop?
             Stop
                                                                                                         Subscanning ejection
                        MZ2: OFF (Hard)                                                                  grip stop
                                                                                                         MZ2: OFF
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Open
                               SZ3: Open
                               (Not changed)
             SZ2: Open?
             SZ3: Open?
              NO                                                            2 times or more
                                                              Retry?
                        Register reset
                                                    Within 1 time
                                                    [NZ13]
                  END                                           7
                                                                                                                          FR6H1326.EPS
START
                                          5
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                                SZ2: Close
                                SZ3: Open
             SZ2: Close?        (Not changed)
             SZ3: Open?
               NO                                                          2 times or more
                                                             Retry?
                  END                                            5                              NG
                                                                                                                        FR6H1327.EPS
BLANK PAGE
START
6 times or more
END 1 FR6H1198A.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                          FRONT
          Subscanning unit
          Z unit                    IP stopper solenoid            IP stopper HP sensor
                                    SolZ1                          SZ4           FR6H1246.EPS
<I/O Table>
 Symbol                 Name                   Type                                           Function
  SZ4       Stopper HP sensor       PI (5mm)                      Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
  SolZ1     Stopper driving SOL     Power-down solenoid           Protrudes the stopper when turned ON.
                                                                                                                         TR6H1072.EPS
1 FR6H1215.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                               FRONT
          Subscanning unit
          Z unit                       IP stopper solenoid              IP stopper HP sensor
                                       SolZ1                            SZ4          FR6H1274.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                Name                         Type                                   Function
            SZ4         Stopper HP sensor        Pl (5mm)                       Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
            SolZ1       Stopper driving SOL      Power-down solenoid            Protrudes the stopper when turned ON.
                                                                                                                          TR6H1094.EPS
SZ4
START
Delay: 50ms
                          IP load return
        5.2.11, Fig. 1
                          (Without cassette ejection)
             END
                                                FR6H1341.EPS
<I/O Locations>
          Suction cup                   Cassette set unit                      Suction cup HP sensor
          driving motor                 A unit                                 SA4
                                                                                           Leak valve
          MA1
                                                                                           SVA1
                                                                                                Suction pump
                                              M                                                 PA1
                                                                                                Suction sensor
                                                                                                SA5
                                                                                M
                                                                                                Transport motor
                                                                                                MB1
                                                                                                IP sensor
                                                                                                SB1
                                                                                                Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                C unit
Subscanning unit
Z unit
                        IP stopper solenoid
                        SolZ1                                                                                      FR6H1346.EPS
<I/O Table>
 Symbol                 Name                          Type                           Function
  MA1       Suction cup driving motor     Pulse motor             Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
  MB1       IP transport motor            Pulse motor             Conveys the IP.
  PA1       IP suction                    DC pump                 Sucks when turned ON.
  SA4       Suction cup HP sensor         PI (5mm)                Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
  SA5       Suction sensor                Suction sensor          Detects that it is sucked.
  SB1       Cassette inlet IP sensor      PI (19mm)                IP conveyance sensor
  SolZ1     Stopper driving SOL           Power-down solenoid     Protrudes the stopper when turned ON.
  SVA1      IP leak                       Solenoid valve          Leaks when turned ON.
                                                                                                                      TR6H1096.EPS
START
                    Close
                    (HP position OK)                         5.2.14, Fig. 2     Sensor confirmation 2 (SA4)
                                                                                            IP load return
                                                                        5.2.11, Fig. 1
                                                                                            (Without cassette ejection)
                                       A
                                                                                    No IP
                                                                                                              FR6H1342.EPS
(Synchronize)
                                                                                                                                           Conveyance (Discharge)
                                                                               2 times                                                     MB1 [PB14: CCW2559P]: Drive
                                                                               or more
                          B
                                                                                                                                                                FR6H1343.EPS
(Synchronize)
                                                                                  Delay: 50ms
Cassette inlet
IP confirmation
                                      Conveyance driving
                                      MB1 [PB13: CW2559P]
                                            Open (No IP)
                                            Timeout [TA44: within 1 sec]
                        SB1: Close?
                                                                           4 times or more
                                                                                                 Conveyance (Discharge)                        Conveyance (Discharge)
                                                                                                 MB1                                           MB1
                                                                                                 [PB14: CCW2559P]: Drive                       [PB14: CCW2559P]: Drive
                                                                                                                                                       Suction cup
                                                                                      5.1.7, Fig. 1      Suction cup                5.1.7, Fig. 1      home positioning
                                                                                                         home positioning
                                                                                                      Message display
                                                                                                                                         D
                                                                                                         Cassette ejection
                                C                                                    5.2.16, Fig. 1      (after home positioning)                              FR6H1344.EPS
                 Conveyance (Grip)
                 MB1 [PB16: 2559P] :Drive
Delay: 50ms
Message display
                                                                       Cassette ejection
        END                                          5.2.16, Fig 1     (after home positioning)
                                                                                                    FR6H1345.EPS
START
       Retry
                   5.2.3, Fig. 1         Feed conveyance
       Retry
                   5.2.4, Fig. 1         Side-positioning operation
       Retry
                   5.2.5, Fig. 1         Reading
Notified
            Not notified
                                                                               IP load return
                                                              5.2.11, Fig. 1
                                                                               (Without cassette ejection)
                                                                               User notification item
                                                              5.2.12, Fig. 1
                                                                               confirmation
                                                                               Cassette ejection
                   5.2.16, Fig. 1        Cassette ejection    5.2.16, Fig. 1   (after home positioning)
                        END
                                                                                               FR6H1140.EPS
START
                        B
                                            5.2.1, Fig. 1        Cassette IN detection
                              Retry
                                            5.2.3, Fig. 1        Feed conveyance
                              Retry
                                            5.2.4, Fig. 1        Side-positioning operation
                              Retry
                                            5.2.5, Fig. 1        Reading
Notified
                                   Not notified
                                                                                                        IP load return
                                                                                      5.2.11, Fig. 1
                                                                                                        (Without cassette ejection)
                                                                                                        User notification item
                                                                                      5.2.12, Fig. 1
                                                                                                        confirmation
                                                                                                                  B
                                             End                                         End
                        IP load return
     5.2.11, Fig. 1
                        (Without cassette
                        ejection)
                                                                                                        Cassette ejection
                                         5.2.13, Fig. 1          Cassette ejection    5.2.16, Fig. 1    (after home positioning)
           B
                                                END
                                                                                                                        FR6H1328.EPS
                                                                                   1
                                                 Cassette insertable LED display
                                                 LEDIN: ON
                                                 LED1: OFF
                                                      Close timeout
                                                      [TA14: within 0.5 sec]
                                   SA3: Open?
                            Open
                            (Cassette
                            hold)
C B
                                                                                                                           Open
                                                                                                                                     SA1 : Open?
                                                 Cassette inserted status LED display
                                                 LEDIN: OFF
                                                                                                                                    Close
                                                 LED1: ON
                                                                                                                Message cancel
                                           END
                                                                                                                                                        Open
                                                                                                                                      SA2: Open?
                                                                                                                                 Activated
                                                                                                                                                Processing complete LED display
                                                                                                                                                LEDOUT: ON
                                                                                                                                                      Close
                                                                                                                                     SA1: Open?
                                                                                                                                             Open
                                                                                                                                                Call LED not-displayed
                                                                                                                                                LEDCALL: OFF
1 FR6H1110.EPS
6 times or more
                                                         E
                                                                                              FR6H1112.EPS
<I/O Locations>
         Suction cup driving motor                  Cassette set unit            Cassette IN sensor
         MA1                                        A unit                       SA2            Suction cup HP sensor
                                                                                                SA4
               Cassette ejection clutch
               CLA1
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                         Type                                     Function
            SA1         Cassette ejection sensor     PI (5mm)                 Detects that the cassette has been ejected.
            SA2         Cassette IN sensor           PI (5mm)                 Detects that the cassette has been inserted.
            SA3         Cassette hold sensor         PI (5mm)                 Detects the cassette hold completion.
            SA4         Suction cup HP sensor        PI (5mm)                 Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           SolA1        Cassette hold SOL            Power-down solenoid Retreats the cassette hold pin when turned ON.
            MA1         Suction cup driving motor    Pulse motor              Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
          LEDIN         Cassette insertable          LED                      Indicates that the cassette can be inserted.
           LED1         Progress 1                   LED                      Indicates that the progress is "1"
           CLA1         Cassette ejection clutch     Clutch                   Power connection for actuating cassette ejection operation.
                                                                                                                                  TR6H1005.EPS
SA2
Cassette
hold release                                       Open (Not blocked)
                                                   Timeout [TA11: within 0.5 sec]
                              SA3: Close?
                        Close
                        (Blocked)
6 times or more
                                                                                                                           Sensor confirmation 2
                                                                               Cassette hold             5.2.14, Fig. 2    (SA3)
                                                                 11312
                                                                               release failure
                                                               User
                                                             selection
Hold release
                                                                   F
                                                                                                                                     FR6H1113.EPS
5.2.2 IP Feed
<Fig. 1 IP Feed Flow>
START
                  Close
                  (HP position                            5.2.14, Fig. 2        Sensor confirmation 2 (SA4)
                  OK)
Message display
(Synchronize)
                               B
                                                                                                                                                                         FR6H1165.EPS
                                                                                 Leak valve
                                                                                 (SVA1): OFF (Close)
(Synchronize)
                                    Stopper protrusion
                                    Solenoid (SolZ1): ON (Protrusion)
                                                                             Delay: 50ms
Cassette inlet
IP confirmation
                                 Conveyance driving
                                 MB1 [PB13: CW2559P]
                                      Open (No IP)
                                      Timeout [TA44: within 1 sec]
                        SB1: Close?
4 times or more
                                                                                                 Message display
                                                                                                                                                D
                                                                                            Suction cup movement
                                         Close (Stopper protrusion NG)                      (Load standby → load suction)
                                         Timeout [TZ41: within 0.5 sec]                     MA1 [PA11: CCW2195P]: Drive
                        SZ4: Open?
IP stopper        Open
                                                                                5.2.13, Fig. 1     Cassette ejection
protrusion        (Stopper
confirmation      protrusion
                  OK)
                                                                          Within 1 time (NZ21)
                                                           Retry?
                                                                                                         14340        IP stopper protrusion retry
                                            2 times or more
                           END
                                                                                                                   Stopper retreat
                                                                                                                   Solenoid (SolZ1): OFF (Retreat)
                                                                           Sensor confirmation 2
                                                        5.2.14, Fig. 2
                                                                           (SZ4)
                                                                                                                   Delay [TZ43: 2sec]
                                                           11340         IP stopper protrusion failure
                                                                                                                   Stopper protrusion
                                                                                                                   Solenoid (SolZ1): ON (Protrusion)
                                                              C                                            2
                                                                                                                                                                                  FR6H1166.EPS
             Conveyance (grip)
             MB1 [PB16: 2559P]: Drive
Delay: 50ms
                    IP load return
  5.2.11, Fig. 1                                                Message display
                    (Without cassette ejection)
                                                              Suction cup movement
                  Message display                             (Load standby → load suction)
                                                              MA1 [PA15: CCW192P]: Drive
<I/O Locations>
     Suction cup driving motor                    Cassette set unit                         Suction cup HP sensor
     MA1                                          A unit                                    SA4
                                                                                                         Leak valve
                                                                                                         SVA1
                                                                                                           Suction pump
                                                        M                                                  PA1
                                                                                                           Suction sensor
                                                                                                           SA5
                                                                                            M
                                                                                                           Transport motor
                                                                                                           MB1
                                                                                                           IP sensor
                                                                                                           SB1
                                                                                                            Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                            C unit
   Subscanning unit
   Z unit
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                   Name                         Type                                   Function
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor Pulse motor                 Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
           MB1          IP transport motor              Pulse motor           Conveys the IP.
           PA1          IP suction                      DC pump               Sucks when turned ON.
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor           PI (5mm)              Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           SA5          Suction sensor                  Suction sensor        Detects that it is sucked.
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor        PI (19mm)             IP conveyance sensor
           SZ4          Stopper HP sensor               PI (5mm)              Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
           SolZ1        Stopper driving SOL             Power-down solenoid   Protrudes the stopper when turned ON.
           SVA1         IP leak                         Solenoid valve        Leaks when turned ON.
                                                                                                                                TR6H1088.EPS
SB1
FR6H1168.EPS
                                                                                       4 times or more
                                         END
                                                                                                                    Suction cup HP
                                                                                                      10318                                   F
                                                                                                                    operation error
FR6H1169.EPS
                                            Available
                          No BCR?
                 Unavailable
                                                            Delay [TB18: 0.4sec]
BCR: ON
                   Open
                   (No IP)                                    B
                        Measurement time      NO
                        > 1.35 sec [TB15]
                         YES
                                                        Measurement time     NO
                                     IP = 14x17
                                                        > 1.14 sec [TB14]
                                                         YES
IP                                                                                                              Metric
determination                                                         IP = 14x14          IP type
                                                                                   Inch
                                                                                                                         Measurement time NO
                                                                                                                           > 0.89 [TB13]
                                                                                   Measurement time       NO
                                                                                      > 0.89 sec
                                                                                                                          YES
                                                                                        [TB13]
                                                                                    YES                                             IP = 24-30      IP = 18-24
IP = 8x12 IP = 8x10
                               A
                                                                                                                                                      FR6H1179.EPS
                               Available
                 No BCR?
                                                        NG
       Unavailable
                                       BCR data         (Not acquired)
                                       acquired?
                                 OK
                                 (Acquired)
           Close
           (IP found)
                           High-speed conveyance driving stop           High-speed conveyance driving stop
                           MC3: OFF                                     MC3: OFF
                           MB1: OFF                                     MB1: OFF
          YES                                 C
          (Acquired)
                                                                              Within 3 times [NB11]
                                                               Retry?
                                                                             Message display
                                                                                                        Return to the start
                                                                                                        of "IP feed" routine.
                                                                                Cassette ejection
                                                            5.2.16, Fig. 1      (after home positioning)
                                                                                                                                             FR6H1180.EPS
                        Conveyance (grip)
                        MB1 [PB16: CCW2559P]: Drive
4 times or more
11323 Length measurement conveyance failure 14323 Length measurement conveyance retry
                                                                                              IP load return
                            Message display                             5.2.11, Fig. 1        (Without cassette ejection)
BCR : OFF
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                    M
                                                                                                   Transport motor
                                                                                                   MB1
                                                                                                   IP sensor
                                                                                                   SB1
                                                                                                   Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                   C unit
   Subscanning motor                         M
   MZ1
                                                                                    M
                                                                                                   Transport motor
                                                                                                   MC3
Subscanning unit
Z unit                                                                             IP sensor
                                                                                   SC3                                 FR6H1230.EPS
<I/O Table>
                                                                                                                                      Grip roller
                                          START
                                                   Delay [0.01sec]
                                                                                                                                      SC2
                                                   FFM reading conveyance driving                                           M
                                                   MZ1 [V1: CW13.3mm/s]: Drive
                                                                                                             Stopper              MC2
                                                   Delay [TC11: 0.8sec]                     MZ1 (FFM)
                                                       Side-positioning                                              IP
                                                       (HP → side-positioning 1)
        Side-position the IP                           MC1 [PC11]: Drive
        fed from the erasure
        conveyor to the side-                          Delay [0.1sec]
        positioning conveyor.                                                                                                     MC1
                                                   FFM reading conveyance driving
                                                   MZ1: OFF
        Perform side-
                                                   Side-positioning                                          M
                                                   (Side-positioning 1 → back)
        positioning                                MC1 [PC12]: Drive
        operation twice.
                                                   Delay [0.1sec]
                                                   Side-positioning
                                                   (Back → side-positioning 2)                          Front view
                                                   MC1 [PC13]: Drive
                                                                             Latch                              IP
                                                   Delay [0.1sec]                                                                 Latch
                                                  Delay: 50ms
Subscanning
driven-shaft grip
                                                             SZ2: Close
                                                             SZ3: Open
                                      SZ2: Close?            (Not changed)
                                      SZ3: Open?
NO C
Register reset
                                              A
                                                                                                                                                 FR6H1103.EPS
                                                                    Side-positioning
                                                5.1.5, Fig. 1       home positioning
                   Continue
        Continue in the case                        E
          of primary erasure
                              END
                                                                                                                                            FR6H1104.EPS
                                                                                                       IP size
Symbol                      Operation                                                                                         Metric       Metric
                                                                14x17         14x14           10x12              8x10         18x24        24x30
 PC11      Side-positioning (HP → side-positioning 1)        CCW177P       CCW177P          CCW617P        CCW617P          CCW730P       CCW730P
 PC12      Side-positioning (Side-positioning 1 → back)      CW39P            CW39P            CW32P             CW32P         CW60P        CW60P
 PC13      Side-positioning (Back → side-positioning 2)      CCW39P          CCW39P          CCW32P          CCW32P          CCW60P        CCW60P
 PC14      Side-positioning (Side-positioning 2 → HP)        CW177P          CW177P          CW617P          CW617P          CW730P        CW730P
                                                                                                                                            TR6H1055.EPS
C B
                             2 times or more
              Retry?
Within 1 time
[NZ13]
                D                                  F
                                                                          FR6H1329.EPS
                                 Secondary erasure
            Reading/secondary
                 erasure
                                   Subscanning driving-shaft
             5.2.4, Fig. 4         slow grip
                                   Subscanning driven-shaft
             5.2.4, Fig. 5
                                   slow grip release
    NG
            5.1.10, Fig. 2         Subscanning no-load running
                                   Error handling
            5.2.15, Fig. 1         (recovery IP load)
        3 times
        or more
                                Message display
<I/O Locations>
Driven-side grip release HP sensor
                                                             FRONT
SZ3
                                                                                      M                      Side-positioning motor
                                                                                                             MC1
                                                                                          M
<I/O Table>
            Symbol                    Name                         Type                                    Function
              SC1       Side-positioning HP sensor         PI (5mm)                   Detects that it is in the side-positioning home position.
              SC2       Grip release HP sensor             PI (5mm)                   Detects that it is in the grip release home position.
              SZ2       Driving-side grip release HP sensor PI (5mm)                  Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
              SZ3       Driven-side grip release HP sensor PI (5mm)                   Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
              SZ4       IP stopper HP sensor               PI (5mm)                   Detects that it is in the IP stopper home position.
             SolZ1      IP stopper driving SOL             Power-down solenoid Protrudes the IP stopper when turned ON.
              MC1       Side-positioning motor             Pulse motor                Drives the side-positioning mechanism.
              MC2       Grip release motor                 Pulse motor                Drives to release the grip.
              MZ1       Subscanning motor                  FFM                        Drives to convey the IP.
              MZ2       Grip driving motor                 DC motor                   Drives the driven-shaft grip.
                                                                                                                                     TR6H1056.EPS
                                            Open
                            SC2: Close?
                                                                                                                 Side-positioning grip HP
                                        MC2 [PC61: CW400P]: Drive                                   14335        detection preparation
                                                                                                                 positioning retry
                                             Close
                                             Timeout [TC62: within 2.8 sec]
                            SC2: Close?
HP detection                                                                   Grip release motor
preparation return          Open                                               MC2: OFF
                                         Grip release motor                       Side-positioning
                                         MC2: OFF                    14336        grip HP detection
                                                                                  preparation return
                                        Delay [TC61: 0.1sec]                      retry
                                   D
                                                                                                                 Within 3 times [NC61]
                                                                                                    Retry?
                                                                                    4 times or more
                                                                                                                                     2
                                                                                                                 Side-positioning grip
                                                                                                    10338
                                                                                                                 HP operation error
                                                                                                                                  FR6H1068.EPS
                        Open
                                           Timeout [TC64: within 2.5 sec]
                          SC2: Close?
Close
HP detection
                                      MC2 [PC64: CCW19P]: Drive
                                          Open
                          SC2: Close?
                                                                            E
                                                                                                    FR6H1069.EPS
                                         Open                                                           F
                                                                                                        R
                         SC1: Close?                                                                    O
                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                        T
                                                               MC1 [PC53: CW4800 P]: Drive
                        Close
                                                                     Open
                                                                     Timeout [TC53: within 11.6 sec]
                                                     SC1: Close?
                                                                                                             Side-positioning motor
                                    HP detection    Close                                                    MC1: OFF
                                    preparation
                                    positioning                 Side-positioning motor
                                                                MC1: OFF                                           Sensor confirmation 1
                                                                                                5.2.14, Fig. 1     (SC1)
                                                               Delay [TC51: 0.1sec]
                                                                                                                 Side-positioning HP
                                     MC1 [PC51: CCW533P]: Drive                                      14331
                                                                                                                 detection preparation retry
                                          Close
                                          Timeout [TC52: within 3.2 sec]
                         SC1: Close?
HP preparation                                                              Side-positioning motor
return                   Open                                               MC1: OFF
                                     Side-positioning motor
                                     MC1: OFF                                  Side-positioning HP
                                                                  14332
                                                                               detection preparation
                                                                               return retry
                                     Delay [TC51: 0.1sec]
                                F
                                                                                                                 3 times or less [NC51]
                                                                                                     Retry?
                                                                                     4 times or more
                                                                                                                                      3
                                                                                                     10334       Side-positioning HP
                                                                                                                 operation error
                                                                                                                              FR6H1070.EPS
                        Open
                                         Timeout [TC54: within 2.5 sec]
                         SC1 : Close?
Close
                                         Open
                          SC1: Close?
                         Close
                                                                                    Sensor confirmation 2
                                                                   5.2.14, Fig. 2
                                                                                    (SC1)
                               END
                                                                                    Side-positioning
                                                                          14333
                                                                                    HP detection retry
                                                                           G
                                                                                                  FR6H1071.EPS
                  Soft monitoring
                                               Timeout [TZ21: within 10 sec] (Soft)
                              MZ2 stop?
Register reset
                                          Timer stop
                                                                                                                     Delay [TZ35: 0.1sec]
NG
                                                 NG (out of spec)
                          4.39 ≤ Timer ≤ 4.67
  Driving-shaft
  slow grip                                                                                                  Delay: 50ms
                              OK
                                                                         Close (noise stop)
                                                                                               SZ2: Close?
                                                                         Driving-shaft
                                                                 12352                        Open
                                                                         grip error stop
                                                                                                                Subscanning grip
                                                                                                     13355
                                                                                                                speed data update
Register reset
                                    END
                                                                                                                                       FR6H1330.EPS
START
                Soft monitoring
                                               Timeout [TZ31: within 10 sec] (Soft)
Driven-shaft                 MZ2 stop?
slow grip
release                                                                               Driven-shaft slow grip
                          Stop                                                        release stop
                                                                                      MZ2: OFF
                                  END
                                                                                                                  FR6H1331.EPS
START
                                               7                                                                                    Side-positioning grip
                                                                                                                                    MC2 [PC22: CCW375P]: Drive
                              Set speed data
                              DA value: 204                                                                                               Open (Grip NG)
                                                                                                                           SC2 : Close?
                                                                                                                                                                      Sensor
                              Subscanning ejection grip
                                                                                                                        Close                      5.2.14, Fig. 2     confirmation 2
                              MZ2: ON
                                                                                                                        (Grip OK)                                     (SC2)
                                                                                         Side-positioning grip
           Soft                                                                          HP confirmation                                                              Side-positioning
           monitoring                                                                                                                                 12338           grip operation
                                    Timeout [TZ34: within 15 sec] (Soft)                                                                                              failure
                   MZ2 stop?
                                                                                                                                                                      Side-positioning
                                                                                                                                                    5.1.3, Fig. 1     grip home
           Stop                                                                                                                                                       positioning
                              MZ2: OFF
                              (Hard)                                                         MZ2: OFF
                              Delay: 50ms
Ejection
grip
                                                                   2 times
                                                                   or more
                                                    Retry?
                                        Within 1 time
                                        [NZ13]
                                                                                                      Subscanning
                                                                                  5.1.10, Fig. 4      driven-shaft grip
                                                        7
                                                                                                      Subscanning
                                                                                  5.1.10, Fig. 5      driving-shaft
                                                                                                      correction grip
                                                                                                      Subscanning
                                                                                  5.1.10, Fig. 6      driven-shaft
                                                                                                      grip release
                                                                                                      Subscanning
                                                                                  5.1.10, Fig. 7      ejection grip
                        END
                                                                                                                                                                       FR6H1332.EPS
5.2.5 Reading
<Fig. 1 Reading Flow>
START
                    Image         Setup NG
                 processing
                   ready?
             Ready                                                            E
                                                                                                                      IP size?
                            Laser : ON
                                                                                                        Other than 14x17
                                                                                                                                 IP size = 14x17
                            FFM reading conveyance driving
                            MZ1 [V1: CW13.3mm/s]: Drive
                                                                                                                                 Lamp preheat ON
Leading-edge
    detection                   Open (No IP)
     interrupt                  Timeout [TZ11: within 2.4sec]                                      Erasure lamp lit              Delay [TB50: 3sec]
                 SZ1: Close?
                                                                                                                                 Lamp preheat OFF
           Close
           (IP found)
                                                                                                                                 Lamp fully lit
                                                                           Close (IP found)
                                                                           Timeout [TC32]
                                                       SC3: Open?
                            CMOS
                                                     Open
                            No IP before reading
                                                     (No IP)
                                                                          Read IP leading-                 Subscanning conveyance
                                                          11342                                 11343
                                                                          edge detection                   failure 1
                                                                          error
MZ1NGCLR set
Timer start
                                                           MZ1NG           Abnormal
                                                       reading normal?
                                                                                          Timer data recording
                                                   Normal
                                                                                              FFM driving
                                                                                  12345
                                                                                              W.F. disorder
MZ1NGCLR set
                                                           End-of-         NO
                                                       image interrupt?
YES
                        A                                      Z
                                                                                                                                            FR6H1186.EPS
Timer1 start
IP size?
                                                                                                         14x17
                                                       Subscanning driving-shaft
                                      5.2.4, Fig. 4    slow grip                                                      IP size = 14x17
Lamp preheat ON
                                                      Timeout [TZ15]
                                      End-of-image
                                       interrupt?
                                     YES                                    11350       End-of-image timeout error
            Timeout [TZ15]
                                      SC3: Open?           Z                        Laser: OFF
                                   Open
                                                                                                     1
Laser: OFF
       1
                                      5.2.4, Fig. 6    Ejection grip
                                         END
                                                                                                                                 FR6H1333.EPS
                                                                                              IP size
 Symbol                      Operation                                                                            Metric        Metric
                                                                  14x17      14x14         10x12         8x10     18x24         24x30
 TC32       Read IP trailing-edge detection timeout              31.7 sec    26.0 sec     22.1 sec   14.5 sec     12.7 sec      21.8 sec
  TZ13      Driven-shaft grip release start                    26.27 sec    20.55 sec 16.72 sec      9.05 sec     7.32 sec     16.34 sec
  TZ15      XXXXXX                                               34.3 sec    28.6 sec     24.8 sec   17.1 sec     15.4 sec      24.4 sec
                                                                                                                                 TR6H1090.EPS
Laser: OFF
               FFM stop
               MZ1: OFF
                        Subscanning
   5.2.4, Fig. 4        driving-shaft slow grip
                        Subscanning
   5.2.4 , Fig. 5       driven-shaft slow grip release
                        Error handling
  5.2.15, Fig. 1
                        (Recovery IP load)
Message display
               FFM stop
               MZ1: OFF
                        Error handling
   5.2.15, Fig. 1
                        (Recovery IP load)
Message display
 <I/O Locations>
                                                        FRONT
    Driven-side grip release HP sensor
    SZ3
                                                                                      M
Subscanning unit
Z unit                                                                                                Transport motor
                                                                                                      MC3
                                                                                     IP sensor
                                                                                     SC3                                    FR6H1232.EPS
<I/O Table>
SC3
BLANK PAGE
                After-reading conveyance
                driving stop                                11362            After-reading conveyance failure
                MZ1: OFF
                After-reading conveyance
                driving stop
                MB1: OFF                                 5.2.15, Fig. 1        Error handling (Recovery IP load)
                MC3: OFF
                                                                   Reading
                                                         5.2.6, Fig. 2         Subscanning no-load running
                                                                               Subscanning both
                                                         5.2.6, Fig. 3         grips release
Message display
         END
                                                                                                        FR6H1178.EPS
START
                                         3
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Open
                               SZ3: Close
             SZ2: Open?        (Stop by noise)
             SZ3: Close?
               NO
                                                                         2 times or more
                                                            Retry?
                  END                                          3                             NG
                                                                                                                     FR6H1336.EPS
START
                                          4
                        Set speed data
                        DA value: 204
Stop
Delay: 50ms
                               SZ2: Open
                               SZ3: Open
            SZ2: Open?         (not change)
            SZ3: Open?
              NO                                                               2 times or more
                                                               Retry?
                        Register reset
                                               Within 1 time
                                               [NZ13]
                                                                            Both-grip release                Both-grip release
                        Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]                   14343                             12348
                                                                            error                            error
                  END                                              4                              NG
                                                                                                                          FR6H1337.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                    M
                                                                                                  Transport motor
                                                                                                  MB1
                                                                                                  IP sensor
                                                                                                  SB1
                                                                                                  IP sensor
                                                                                                  SC4
                                                                                                  Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                  C unit
   Subscanning motor                         M
   MZ1
                                                                                    M
                                                                                                  Transport motor
                                                                                                  MC3
Subscanning unit
Z unit                                                                                                               FR6H1233.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                   Name                            Type                           Function
           MZ1          Subscanning motor                FFM                    Conveys the IP.
            MB1         IP transport motor               Pulse motor            Conveys the IP.
            MC3         IP transport motor               Pulse motor            Conveys the IP.
            SC4         Erasure positioning IP sensor    PI (19mm)              Detects the IP.
                                                                                                                     TR6H1084.EPS
START
                                                                                      Erasure
                                                                      18741
                                                                                      incomplete
Delay: 20ms
                                        Close
                                        (IP found)                                                          Reading         Secondary erasure
                        SC4: Open?                                                          C            or secondary
                 Open                                                                                       erasure?
                 (No IP)                                       Erasure conveyance
                                                 11363         failure                               Reading
                                                                                                                                                 1
                                                                  Error handling
                                              5.2.15, Fig. 1
                                                                  (Recovery IP load)                     5.2.6, Fig. 2        Subscanning no-load running
                                                               Message display
                  D                                                                                      5.2.6, Fig. 3        Subscanning both-grip release
                                                                                                               D
                                                     1
                           END
                                                                                                                                                  FR6H1184.EPS
                                                                                                   IP size
 Symbol                Operation                                                                                Metric   Metric
                                                         14x17             14x14                10x12              8x10
                                                                                                                18x24    24x30
  PB25     Erasure conveyance driving                CCW14568P CCW12624P                   CCW11316P CCW8706P CCW8118P CCW11190P
  PC37     Erasure conveyance driving                CCW12140P CCW10520P                   CCW9430P          CCW7255P CCW6765P CCW9325P
                                                                                                                                                TR6H1312.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                    M
                                                                                                  Transport motor
                                                                                                  MB1
                                                                                     M
                                                                                                  Transport motor
                                                                                                  MC3
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                       Name                         Type                              Function
           SZ2          Driving-side grip release HP sensor       PI (5mm)      Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
           SZ3          Driven-side grip release HP sensor        PI (5mm)      Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
           MZ2          Grip driving                              DC motor      Speed correction capability (equivalent to DPR).
           LDSN         Unlit lamp sensor
           MB1          IP transport motor                        Pulse motor   Conveys the IP.
           MC3          IP transport motor                        Pulse motor   Conveys the IP.
           SC3          Side-positioning IP sensor                PI (19mm)     Detects the IP.
           SC4          Erasure positioning IP sensor             PI (19mm)     Detects the IP.
                                                                                                                                       TR6H1080.EPS
SC3/SC4
BLANK PAGE
                  After-erasure conveyance
                  MB1 [PB18: CCW630P]: Drive
Delay : 20 ms
                  Load conveyance
                  MB1 [PB19: CCW3342P]: Drive
                                                              No IP                                            IP found
                                                                               After-erasure                          After-erasure
                                                                 10360         conveyance failure       12360
                                                                                                                      conveyance failure
                                                                                                          1
                          Close (IP found)
                          Timeout [TB11: within 20 sec]
     SB1: Open?
  Open
  (No IP)
<I/O Locations>
                                               M
                                                           Transport motor
                                                           MB1
                                                           IP sensor
                                                           SB1
FR6H1235.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                Name                           Type                                        Function
           MB1          IP transport motor         Pulse motor                           Conveys the IP.
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor   PI (19mm)                             Detects the presence of an IP.
                                                                                                                             TR6H1078.EPS
5.2.9 IP Load
<Fig. 1 IP Load Flow>
START
                                       A
                                                                                             FR6H1133.EPS
                                       Open (Leak)
                                       Timeout [TA41: within 1 sec]
                        SA5: Close?
  Suction sensor                                                      IP leak
  confirmation        Close                                           Suction pump (PA1): OFF
                   (Suction)                                          Leak valve (SVA1): ON (Open)
                                                                                                                 Conveyance (Grip)
                                                                           Message display                       MB1 [PB16: CW2559P]: Drive
                                                                                                                 Delay: 50ms
                                                                      Suction cup movement
                                                                      (Load standby → load suction)              Feed conveyance UP direction
                                                                      MA1 [PA15: CCW192P]: Drive                 MB1 [PB19: CCW3342P]: Drive
Message display
                                                            IP leak
                                                            Leak valve (SVA1): ON (Open)
                                                            Suction pump (PA1): OFF
5.1.7, Fig. 1 Suction cup home positioning 5.1.7, Fig. 1 Suction cup home positioning
                                                                                                                Conveyance (Grip)
                                                                   Message display                              MB1 [PB16: CW2559P]: Drive
                                                                                                                                               Conveyance (Discharge)
                                                                                                            C                                  MB1 [PB14: CCW2559P]
                                                                                                                                               : Drive
Message display
                                        Close (Suction)
                                        Timeout [TA49: 5 sec]: Drive
                           SA5: Open?
Suction sensor
                                                         Delay [TA50: 500sec]
confirmation            Open
                        (Leak)
                                                         Leak valve (SVA1): OFF (Close)
Message display
                                 END
                                                                                      FR6H1136.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                     Suction cup HP sensor
      Suction cup driving motor                    Cassette set unit                 SA4
                                                                                                        Leak valve
      MA1                                          A unit                                               SVA1
                                                                                                           Suction pump
      Cassette ejection sensor                         M                                                   PA1
      SA1
                                                                                                           Suction sensor
                                                                                                           SA5
                                                                                            M
                                                                                                           Transport motor
                                                                                                           MB1
                                                                                                           IP sensor
                                                                                                           SB1
                                                                                                            Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                            C unit
Subscanning unit
Z unit
                                                              IP stopper HP sensor
                                                              SZ4                                                               FR6H1236.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                  Name                         Type                                 Function
           SA1          Cassette ejection sensor      PI (5mm)                Detects that the cassette has been ejected.
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor         PI (5mm)                Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           SA5          Suction sensor                Suction sensor          Detects that it is sucked.
           SVA1         IP leak                       Solenoid valve          Leaks when turned ON.
           PA1          IP suction                    DC pump                 Sucks when turned ON
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor Pulse motor                 Open the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
           MB1          IP transport motor            Pulse motor             Conveys the IP.
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor      PI (19mm)               Sensor that detects the presence of an IP.
           SZ4          Stopper HP sensor             PI (5mm)                Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
                                                                                                                                TR6H1065.EPS
SB1
START
                                                  No. of
                             2 lamps lit                           1 or less lamp lit
                                             erasure lamps lit
3 lamps lit
Routine
                                                                 Overexposure
                                              IP exposure?
Usual
                                                Erasure
                                           temporarily disabled?    Disabled
Normal
Normal
Normal
<I/O Locations>
                                                                  FRONT
         Subscanning unit
         Z unit                                                                        FR6H1276.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                       Name                       Type                                     Function
           SZ2          Driving-side grip release HP sensor   PI (5mm)              Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
           SZ3          Driven-side grip release HP sensor    PI (5mm)              Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
           MZ2          Grip driving                          DC motor              Speed correction capability (equivalent to DPR).
                                                                                                                                 TR6H1095.EPS
SZ2/SZ3
START
                                   END
                                                                                                                    FR6H1120.EPS
<I/O Locations>
         Suction cup driving motor               Cassette set unit                             Suction cup HP sensor
         MA1                                     A unit                                        SA4
                                                                                                 Leak valve
                                                                                                 SVA1
                                                         FRONT
                                                                                                                  FR6H1239.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                  Name                   Type                                      Function
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor    PI (5mm)                  Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           SVA1         IP leak                  Solenoid valve            Leaks when turned ON.
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor Pulse motor              Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
                                                                                                                                 TR6H1063.EPS
START
                                               No. of
                          2 lamps lit                           1 or less lamp lit
                                          erasure lamps lit
                                                              Overexposure
                                           IP exposure?
Message display
                                                                 Disabled
                                        Erasure temporarily
                                             disabled?
                                                                             18742      Erasure temporarily disabled
                                        Normal
                                                                                        Message display
Normal
                                                                         OK                        Subscanning grip
                                                                                 5.1.10, Fig. 1    home positioning
Normal
                                                                         OK                        Subscanning grip
                                                                                 5.2.12, Fig. 2    speed correction
                                                 END
                                                                                                                 FR6H1154.EPS
<I/O Locations>
FRONT
         Subscanning unit
         Z unit                                                                      FR6H1237.EPS
<I/O Table>
START
                              Logged
         12352 or 12355
            logged?
Not logged
                END
                                                               FR6H1338.EPS
START
Soft monitoring
                             Timeout [TZ34: within 15 sec] (Soft)
             MZ2 stop?
                                                                                                          Driving-shaft slow grip stop
                                                                                                          MZ2: OFF
            Stop
                                                                                                              Driving-shaft correction
                        MZ2: OFF (Hard)                                                           12353
                                                                                                              grip error
                                                                                                          Register reset
                        Timer stop
                                                                                                          Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]
                                NG
                                (±3% deviation)
        4.39 ≤ Timer ≤ 4.67
                                                                                                          Delay [TZ25: 0.1sec]
              OK
                                                                          Close (noise stop)
                                                                                               SZ2: Close?
                                                              Driving-shaft grip
                                                  12352
                                                              error stop                       Open
                                                                                                              Subscanning grip
                                                                                                  13355
                                                                                                              speed data update
Register reset
                  END
                                                                                                                           FR6H1352.EPS
START
Delay: 50ms
2 times or more
                                  A
                                                              FR6H1158.EPS
Delay: 20ms
                        Close
                        (HP position                                         5.2.14, Fig. 2     Sensor confirmation 2 (SA4)
                        OK)
Suction cup HP
                                             Suction cup movement               12326         Suction cup HP return failure
confirmation
                                             (Load suction → HP)
                                             MA1 [PA28: 164P]: Drive
                                                                                        Delay [TA47: 0.1sec]
                                       END
                                                                                                                        FR6H1159.EPS
<I/O Locations>
     Suction cup driving motor                  Cassette set unit                    Suction cup HP sensor
     MA1                                        A unit                               SA4
                                                                                       M
                                                                                                     Transport motor
                                                                                                     MB1
                                                                                                      Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                      C unit
                                                                                                     Transport motor
Subscanning unit                                                                                     MC3
Z unit
                                                                                       M
FR6H1238.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                        Type                                Function
           LEDCALL      CALL                        LED              Indicates that the machine is in "CALL" state.
           LEDOUT Processing complete               LED              Indicates that the processing has been completed.
           LED2         Progress 2                  LED              Indicates that the progress is "2".
           MA1          Suction cup driving motor Pulse motor        Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
           SA1          Cassette ejection sensor    PI (5mm)         Detects that the cassette has been ejected.
           SA4          Suction cup HP sensor       PI (5mm)         Detects that the suction cup is in its home position.
           MB1          IP transport motor          Pulse motor      Conveys the IP.
           MC3          IP transport motor          Pulse motor      Conveys the IP.
           CLA1         Cassette ejection clutch    Clutch           Power connection for actuating cassette ejection operation.
                                                                                                                             TR6H1073.EPS
START
                        Open
    S**: Close?
Close
        END
                                                          FR6H1118.EPS
<Sensor List>
            The sensors listed below are covered by “S**”.
START
                        Open
    S**: Close?
Close
        END
                                                             FR6H1119.EPS
<Sensor List>
                The sensors listed below are covered by “S**”.
START
   Close
   (IP found)                                   Open (No IP)
                                                Timeout [TB17: within 20 sec]
                               SB1: Close?
                                                                                           Load conveyance stop
                               Close                                                       MB1: OFF (Magnetization also OFF)
                          (IP found)                                                       MC3: OFF (Magnetization also OFF)
                                                                                                 Recovery after-erasure
                                                                                   10361
                                                                                                 conveyance failure
                           Close (IP found)
                           Timeout [TB11: within 20 sec]
         SB1: Open?
    Open
    (No IP)
                                                                      Load conveyance stop
                    Load conveyance stop
                                                                      MB1: OFF (Magnetization also OFF)
                    MB1: OFF
                                                                      MC3: OFF (Magnetization also OFF)
Delay: 50ms
                             IP load return
        5.2.11, Fig. 1       (Without cassette ejection)
              END
                                                                                                                          FR6H1171.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                                      M
                                                                                                    Transport motor
                                                                                                    MB1
                                                                                                    IP sensor
                                                                                                    SB1
                                                                                                    Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                    C unit
     Subscanning motor                       M
     MZ1
                                                                                      M
                                                                                                    Transport motor
                                                                                                    MC3
  Subscanning unit
  Z unit                                                                                                               FR6H1240.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                            Type                               Function
           SB1          Cassette inlet IP sensor     PI (19mm)                    Detects the presence of an IP.
           MB1          IP transport motor           Pulse motor                  Conveys the IP.
           MC3          IP transport motor           Pulse motor                  Conveys the IP.
           MZ1          Subscanning motor            FFM                          Conveys the IP.
                                                                                                                        TR6H1083.EPS
START
Delay: 50ms
                         END
                                                                FR6H1342.EPS
<I/O Locations>
         Suction cup
         driving motor                 Cassette set unit
         MA1                           A unit
FRONT FR6H1349.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                 Name                  Type                                      Function
            MA1         Suction cup driving motor   Pulse motor   Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
                                                                                                                    TR6H1097.EPS
                        B
                                         5.2.1, Fig. 1        Cassette IN detection
                               Retry
                                         5.2.3, Fig. 1        Feed conveyance
                               Retry
                                         5.2.4, Fig. 1        Side-positioning operation
Notified
                                   Not notified
                                                                                                      IP load return
                                                                                   5.2.11, Fig. 1
                                                                                                      (Without cassette ejection)
                                             END
                                                                                                                      FR6H1339.EPS
START
Lamp preheat ON
                    END
                                           FR6H1351.EPS
START
                                                                         1
                                 Open (Stopper retreat NG)
                                 Timeout [TZ42: within 2 sec]
                SZ4: Close?
             Close
          (Stopper                                                                 Within 5 times [NZ12]
            retreat                                             Retry?
    B
               OK)
                                                       6 times                                                        IP stopper retreat
                                                                                                           14341
                                                       or more                                                        retry
                                 Close
                                 Timeout [TZ54: within 10 sec]
                SZ5: Open?
Open
                        A
                                                                                                                                           FR6H1195.EPS
                             Open
                             Timeout [TZ53: within 1.8 sec]
           SZ5: Close?
                             Close
                             Timeout [TZ54: within 10 sec]
           SZ5: Open?
               END
                                                                                                    FR6H1196.EPS
<I/O Locations>
FRONT
         Subscanning unit
         Z unit                         IP stopper solenoid            IP stopper HP sensor
                                        SolZ1                          SZ4           FR6H1241.EPS
<I/O Table>
BLANK PAGE
START
                                           Subscanning                              IP stopper
                       5.1.10, Fig. 4                                  10341
                                           driven-shaft grip                        retreat failure          Delay [TZ44: 2sec]
                                           Subscanning
                       5.1.10, Fig. 8      driving-shaft grip                                            1
                                           Subscanning
                       5.1.10, Fig. 6      driven-shaft grip release
Those steps enclosed by a box are skipped for RU software A07 or later.
                            END
                                                                                                                         FR6H2028.EPS
<I/O Locations>
                                                                   M
       Dust removal motor
       MZ3
       Dust removal sensor
       SZ5
        Subscanning unit
        Z unit                                               IP stopper HP sensor
                                 IP stopper solenoid
                                 SolZ1                       SZ4                                                             FR6H1242.EPS
<I/O Table>
          Symbol                   Name                       Type                                   Function
           MZ2          Grip driving                    DC motor              Speed correction capability (equivalent to DPR).
            MZ3         Dust removal                    Brushless DC motor    Removes dust on the light-collecting guide and mirror.
                        Driving-side grip release HP
            SZ2                                         PI (5mm)              Detects that the driving side is in grip released mode.
                        sensor
                        Driven-side grip release HP
            SZ3                                         PI (5mm)              Detects that the driven side is in grip released mode.
                        sensor
            SZ4         Stopper HP sensor               PI (5mm)              Detects that the IP stopper is in its home position.
            SZ5         Dust removal HP sensor          PI (5mm)              Detects that the dust removal brush is in its home position.
            SolZ1       Stopper driving SOL             Power-down solenoid   Protrudes the stopper when turned ON.
            MA1         Suction cup driving motor       Pulse motor           Opens the rear cover of the cassette and moves the roller.
                                                                                                                                  TR6H1062.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-05                                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                           MD - 187
10.10.2000
02.20.2002 FM2887
           FM3328 (2)
                                                              MD - 188
BLANK PAGE
   Troubleshooting (MT)
                                                                                                                                               0.1
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                 Reason                  Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)         All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Corrections (FM3058)         All pages
          12/20/2001    03                Corrections (FM3277)         MT-1, 132–140, 194
          04/20/2002    06                Corrections (FM3386)         All pages
                                                                                                                                         ■ Flow of Troubleshooting
1.         Overview of Troubleshooting
                                                                                                                                                  The flow of RU troubleshooting greatly varies depending on whether the associated error log
                                                                                                                                                  exists.
1.1        Flow of Troubleshooting
                                                                                                                                                  When you start a troubleshooting procedure, be sure to confirm the error log.
                                                                                                                                                  ● When the error is logged
     Trouble occurred
                                                                                                                                                  Note the error code table, analysis flow, and check flow to identify the cause of the error.
                                                                                                                                                  ● When the error is not logged
 Checking the Error Log                                                                                                                           Note the check flow to identify the cause of the error.
                                                                                                                                         ■ Error classifications
                2. Errors preventing the RU from becoming ready                                                                                   RU errors can be roughly classified into the following five categories:
                                                                                                                                                  1. Errors causing the CL screen to display an error code
                                                                                                                                                      Mechanical, electrical, scanner, or software errors that cause the CL screen to display an error
                      “15. Bootup Failure Analysis Flow”                                                                                              code upon error detection
                3. Errors causing image abnormalities                                                                                             2. Errors preventing the RU from becoming ready
                                                                                                                                                      CL-to-RU communication errors that inhibit the RU from becoming ready
                5. Errors causing the inability to update the software or save data                                                               5. Errors causing the inability to upgrade the software or save data
                                                                                                                                                      Errors that cause a problem between the FTP server and CPU12A board due to an improper
                      “7. Troubleshooting the errors that cause the inability to update the software or back up machine
                      shipment control data”                                                                                                          FTP server setting, IP address setting, or RU name setting
                                                                                                                          FRMT0376.EPS
1.2          Analysis and Check Flow Marks                                                                                                        1.3      How to View "1.4 Troubleshooting with Error Log"
             In the Troubleshooting volume, troubleshooting procedures are described in the form of a flow.                                                Each page consists of two vertical columns lying side by side. The left-hand side describes the
             Various marks are used for flow simplification.                                                                                               "analysis procedure" and the right-hand side furnishes "detailed information".
                                                                                                                                                           When you read the Troubleshooting volume for the first time, you should read not only the left-hand
■ Marks Used in Flows                                                                                                                                      side but also the "detailed information" on the right-hand side to understand the background,
                                                                                                                                                           objective, and other details of the troubleshooting procedure.
                                                                                                                                                           When performing a troubleshooting procedure, follow the steps indicated in the left-hand "analysis
                                                      : Indicates an operation item.
                                                                                                                                                           procedure" column.
                                                        The operation description is given next to a circle.
                                                                                                                                                           The flow of troubleshooting of individual                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       This column furnishes detailed information,
                                              N                                                                                                            troubleshooting steps are described using                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       including the background and objective.
                                                      : Indicates that the flow of operation branches off                                                  illustrations. Refer to this column when you                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    When you read the Troubleshooting volume
                               Y                        in a specific direction depending on the check result.                                             merely confirm the outline and flow of                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          for the first time, you should read such
                                                        The     mark is positioned at the right and below this                                             troubleshooting.                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                detailed information in addition to the
                                                        mark to indicate the reference section.                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            left-hand illustrative instructions.
                                                      : Indicates the section you should refer to.
                                                        The section number and title are indicated to the right
                                                        of this mark. The reference section is variously                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                MT- 6
                                                                                                                                                                        1.4.3              Viewing the Error Code Table to Locate the Associated Analysis Flow                                                                                                                                                                                                                         ■ Error Code Table Description
                                                        described depending on whether it is within the same                                                                                                                Reference page or reference section number
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         The error code table lists error codes in ascending order to facilitate your error code search.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Each error code is furnished with an error name and a brief description of error occurrence
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         conditions. It is also provided with the information (page number or section number) that
                                                                                                                                                                              10300                    IP sensor logical inconsistency                                 having logical inconsistency for its IP sensor result is                                                                                                or
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                4
(When the reference section is within the same volume) ■ Viewing the Error Table to Locate the Reference Analysis Flow
(When the reference section is within another volume) Section number ● When a page number is indicated: See the page marked "MT-xx".
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Y
                                                                                                                                                                                  10302          Broken sensor detected                                                                                                    Check the error code table again
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 During initialization, the result of IP search detects the presence of an                                                     "2. Error Code Table"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 IP, but the backup memory information indicates that there is no IP in
                                                                                                                                                                                                 the machine. The backup memory has a record indicating that the IP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     1
                                                                                                                                                                                                 conveyance was performed before power recovery.                                                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Voltage on the CPU12A and                                Replace the power supply.
                                                                                                                    FRMT0415.EPS                                                  12302          IP location information logical failure                                                                                                          DRV12A board normal?                                          "Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Y                                          11.8 Power Supply"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 During initialization, the result of IP search indicates the presence of an                                                                                               "9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)"
                                                                                                                                                                                                 IP, but the backup memory information indicates that there is no IP in
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                                                 the machine. Because there is no result of clearing the CMOS, it is                                                                              CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  boards tested in M-Utility normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   and check if the error occurs        N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                 logically inconsistent.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Y         "8. Board Tests in M-Utility"          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                                                                                                                      FRONT                                                                                                                                       Error recurs?                                                   1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                     Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                B unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. SNS12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                IP sensor SC4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4. MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   FR6H2223.EPS
1.4        Troubleshooting with Error Log                                                                             ■ Purpose of Viewing the Error Log
                                                                                                                               When an error occurs, it generally causes two or more additional errors. The error code displayed
1.4.1 Viewing the Error Log                                                                                                    on the CL represents the last-encountered error. You must therefore view the error log to locate the
                                                                                                                               error code related to the encountered trouble before proceeding to perform troubleshooting.
           View the error log with M-Utility to obtain the information about the occurrence of an error indicated
           by an error code.
                                                                                                                      ■ Purpose of Exiting the CL Software
              START
                                                                                                                               If you start PC-MUTL while the CL software is running, the CL may give erratic on-screen indica-
                                                                                                                               tions or fail to operate normally. Therefore, exit the CL software before starting PC-MUTL.
               END
                                                                    FRMT0405.EPS
1.4.2 Determining the Error Code of the Encountered Trouble                                                                                 ■ Error Occurrence Time Recording in Error Log
                                                                                                                                                   When errors occur at RU startup, their occurrence time indications vary with the error occurrence
              (1) Group the errors that occurred.                                                                                                  timing.
              (2) Locate the error that is responsible for the encountered trouble (the error that occurred first).                                ● When errors occurred after "time data" was acquired from the CL
                    (Example)                                                                                                                      Determine the order of error occurrences in accordance with the "occurrence time" indications.
                    • The errors can be divided into Groups A and B because their error occurrence time differ by
                      14 minutes.                                                                                                                               Occurrence Occurrence
                                                                                                                                                   Error code      date       time
                    • The first error in Group A is "12302".
                                                                                                                                                       10300 2000.10.07 13:12:19 00257D tiphscan____
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Error code that occurred second
                                                                                                                                                            3D0004 ScnCmFnc.c 2817
■ When an error occurred after "time data" was acquired from the CL                                                                                    10302 2000.10.07 13:12:10 00258D tiphscan____
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Code of the error that occurred
                                                                                                                                                            3D0004 400000,00 00 00 609C 6098
                                                                                                                                                                                                       first. Perform troubleshooting
                                    Error codes displayed on the CL screen                                                                                                                             with this error code.          FR6H0406.EPS
                                                                   Error code that occurred last                                                   ● When errors occurred before "time data" was acquired from the CL
                                                                                                    Error code that                                The resulting occurrence date/time indications look like "0000.00.00 00.00.25". Note, however, that
A                                                                                                   occurred second
                                                                                                                                                   the time elapsed after power ON is indicated in the "seconds" position (underlined) of the "occur-
                                                                                                    Code of the error that occurred
                                                                                                    first. Perform troubleshooting                 rence time" field.
                                                                                                    with this error code.                          The error having the smallest "seconds" value occurred first.
B
                                                                                                                                                                Occurrence Occurrence
                                                                                                                                                   Error code      date       time
1.4.3 Viewing the Error Code Table to Locate the Associated Analysis Flow                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ■ Error Code Table Description
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The error code table lists error codes in ascending order to facilitate your error code search.
                                                          Reference page or reference section number
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Each error code is furnished with an error name and a brief description of error occurrence condi-
             Error
                                                Error Name                                                    Occurrence Condition
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Analysis Detail                                                                 tions. It is also provided with the information (page number or section number) that indicates the
             Code                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Flow    Code                                                                   most appropriate analysis flow you should refer to.
                                                                                                     During bootup, the remaining IP is ejected, but the sensor                                                                                             MT- 30
            10300                                                                                    having logical inconsistency for its IP sensor result is
                                     IP sensor logical inconsistency
                                                                                                     detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             or
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4
            Section number
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ● When a section number is indicated: See the page having a section number mark "x".
                                                                                                <Error Code Analysis Flow>                                                                                                                                                                                                                     REFERENCE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 MT- 30
                                                                                                                           ■ Analysis Flow
                4.           Error Code Analysis Flow (Mechanism)                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           The page number and section number are both marked at two locations to facilitate your
                10300, 10302, 12302
                                                                                                                                                         Check the error log in M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                   The indicated error is at the         N                   Check the error code table again for the error
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            reference search.
                                                                                                                                   beginning of the error log?                               at the beginning, and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                                     Y
                10302          Broken sensor detected                                                                                                    Check the error code table again
                                                                                                                                                                                                       [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                                                                                       1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                                         and troubleshoot.
                               During initialization, the result of IP search detects the presence of an                                                     "2. Error Code Table"
                                                                                                                                                                                                       2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                                                                                                                       3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                               IP, but the backup memory information indicates that there is no IP in
                               the machine. The backup memory has a record indicating that the IP
                                                                                                                                                                                   1
                               conveyance was performed before power recovery.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      N
                                                                                                                                                                                Voltage on the CPU12A and                                Replace the power supply.
                12302          IP location information logical failure                                                                                                          DRV12A board normal?                                          "Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                   Y                                          11.8 Power Supply"
                               During initialization, the result of IP search indicates the presence of an                                                                                               "9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                                         on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)"
                               IP, but the backup memory information indicates that there is no IP in
                               the machine. Because there is no result of clearing the CMOS, it is                                                                              CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 and check if the error occurs        N
                                                                                                                                                                                boards tested in M-Utility normal?                                                              1
                               logically inconsistent.                                                                                                                                                                           again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      N
                                    FRONT                                                                                                                                       Error recurs?                                                   1
                                                              Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                     Y
                                                              B unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        1. SNS12A
                                                              IP sensor SC4                                                                                                                             2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                        3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                        4. MTH12A
                                                  M
                                                          M
                                                      M
                                                                                 FR6H2223.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                [ 4. ]
                010-051-00
                10.15.2000 FM2887
                                                                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                                                                                           MT - 30
FR6H2516.EPS
END
           WARNING: 2
           • An error is logged, but the user is not notified.
           • Level of error where the function associated with the error is rendered unusable.
           • It is necessary to immediately troubleshoot and take remedial action.
           WARNING: 1
           • The user is notified of an error occurrence.
           • Errors that occur due to erroneous user operation (incorrect loading of the cassette or IP, etc.).
           • If this level of error occurred at the same time with another level of warning, it is necessary to
             troubleshoot and take remedial action.
           WARNING: 4
           • An error is logged, but the user is not notified.
           • Errors that occur when a retry operation is performed.
           • If the same error occurs frequently and if this level of error occurs at the same time with another
             level of warning, it is necessary to troubleshoot and take remedial action.
           WARNING: 3
           • An error is logged, but the user is not notified.
           • Errors that occur when servicing procedures are performed.
Error                                                                                                                                                                                 Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                     Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                   Flow
                                                       During bootup, the configuration file in the flash ROM on the CPU12A board is defective, so that installation is not
10026   Machine configuration error
                                                       automatically performed from the FTP server running on the CL.
                                                                                                                                                                                        6.1
                                                       When an attempt is made to initialize the image processing section of the CPU board during the machine initialization
10100   Image processing initialization error          routine, either of the errors ranging from 12101 to 12108 is detected.                                                            8
                                                       Because error, from 12101 to 12108, is detected three times or more, fatal error results.
                                                       During IP read processing, an attempt is made to activate the sub-CPU (image processing section) of the CPU board, but
10120   Image processing CPU sequence error            error, from 12121 or 12125, is detected.                                                                                          8
                                                       Because error, from 12101 to 12108, is detected three times or more, fatal error results.
                                                       During bootup, because the connector (CN1 on the PMT12A board, CNE1 on the scanning optics unit, CNE2 on the
                                                       scanning optics unit, CN1 on the SYN12A board, or CN1 on the LDD12A board) is disconnected, the laser (LDD), start-point
10230   Scanner functional error during bootup
                                                       detection (SYN), and photomultiplier (PMT) functions are disabled. Because the laser is not enabled, the leading-edge
                                                                                                                                                                                       MT-88
                                                       detection (SED) cannot be performed (detail code: D0F603). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is D0F403.
                                                       During bootup, because +15V is not supplied to the SCN12A board due to blow of the fuse (H11 on the MTH board) or +15V
10231   Scanner power supply error during bootup (1)   power supply error, most of the functions, except for the polygonal mirror (POL) and laser (LDD), are disabled (detail code:    MT-89
                                                       A0DF03). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is A0DD03.
                                                       During bootup, because the fuse (H12 on the SCN12A board) is blown, the photomultiplier (PMT) and start-point detection
10232   Scanner power supply error during bootup (2)
                                                       (SYN) functions are disabled (detail code: 809603). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 809403.
                                                                                                                                                                                       MT-90
                                                       During bootup, because the fuse (J11 on the MTH12A board) is blown or because -15V is not supplied to the SCN12A
10233   Scanner power supply error during bootup (3)   board, the photomultiplier (PMT), start-point detection (SYN), and laser (LDD) functions are disabled. Because the laser        MT-91
                                                       (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed (detail code: C1DD03).
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                         [2.]    MT-9
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                               MT-10
Error                                                                                                                                                                                Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                  Flow
                                                       • During bootup, because the fuse (J12 on the SCN12A board) or the fuse (H12 on the SCN12A board) is blown, ±15V is not
                                                       supplied to the SCN12A board, and the photomultiplier (PMT), start-point detection (SYN), laser (LDD), and SCN board
                                                       (PLL) functions are disabled. Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be
                                                       performed (detail code: C0DC03).
                                                       • During bootup, because -15V is not supplied to the SCN12A board due to blow of the fuse (J11 on the MTH12A board) or -
                                                       15V (SLOT4) power supply error, the photomultiplier (PMT), start-point detection (SYN), and laser (LDD) functions are
10234   Scanner power supply error during bootup (4)
                                                       disabled. Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed (detail code:
                                                                                                                                                                                       MT-92
                                                       C0D400).
                                                       • During bootup, because ±15V is not supplied, except for the laser (LDD), due to blow of the fuse (J11 on the MTH12A
                                                       board, or J12, H12, or H14 on the SCN board), the photomultiplier (PMT), start-point detection (SYN), and laser (LDD)
                                                       functions are disabled. Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed
                                                       (detail code: C0D603). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is C0D400.
                                                       • During bootup, because 24V is not supplied to the SCN12A board due to blow of the fuse (K11 on the MTH12A board) or
                                                       24V (SLOT5) power supply error, the polygonal mirror (POL) function is disabled (detail code: D01403).
10235   Scanner power supply error during bootup (5)   • During bootup, because the fuses (H14 and A22 on the SCN board) are blown or because 5V is not supplied to the                MT-93
                                                       SYN12A board and SED12A board, the leading-edge detection (SED) and start-point detection (SYN) functions are disabled
                                                       (detail code: C01403).
                                                       During bootup, because ±15V is not supplied to the SYN12A board, PMT12A board, and LDD12A board due to blow of the
                                                       fuses (J12 and H12 on the SCN board), the photomultiplier (PMT), start-point detection (SYN), and laser (LDD) functions are
10236   Scanner power supply error during bootup (6)
                                                       disabled. Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed (detail code:
                                                                                                                                                                                       MT-94
                                                       819603). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 819403.
                                                       For self-diagnostic during bootup, an SCN board diagnostic error associated with polygon error is detected. Because the
10244   Scanner control board error (4)
                                                       PLL on the SCN12A does not oscillate, a polygon sync signal cannot be detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                         -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                      [2.]     MT-10
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                     MT-11
Error                                                                                                                                                                                      Analysis
                          Error Name                                                                     Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                        Flow
                                                        During routine processing, error for the polygon lock signal (PONL, POKL) is detected so that the polygonal mirror function is
10261   Polygon stop/rotation error (1)                 disabled. The start-point detection (SYN) and leading-edge detection (SED) functions are also disabled (detail code:                MT-100
                                                        D03403).
                                                        During routine processing, the laser (LDD) and start-point detection (SYN) functions are disabled due to blow of the fuse
10271   Laser unlit error (1)
                                                        (H13 on the SCN board) or laser failure (detail code: 815403).
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-102
                                                        During bootup, because the signal from the start-point detection (SYN) is faulty, the SCN12A board does not operate
10281   Start-point detection error during bootup (1)
                                                        normally (detail code: 801C03).
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-95
                                                        For self-diagnostics prior to reading during routine processing, an SCN board diagnostic error (C05401 or C07403)
10283   Scanning optics unit board error (1)            associated with polygon error is detected. The laser is unlit due to a disconnected connector at the scanning optics unit, etc.,       -
                                                        so that an error related to the polygon error occurs, as well.
                                                        <Service Procedure>
                                                        This error occurs when the version of the M-Utility is checked or error log backup is executed during RU bootup.
10298   Before-reading scanner retry error              <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                               MT-96
                                                        During routine processing, because the scanner-related error is detected, the IP is returned to the cassette and the scanner
                                                        is initialized. The routine processing is retried again, but the scanner-related error recurs.
                                                        During bootup, the remaining IP is ejected, but sensors having physically inconsistent IP sensor results (the CLOSE state of
                                                        both SB1 and SC3, or the CLOSE state of SB1, SC3, and SC4) are detected.
10300   Sensor logical inconsistency
                                                        Alternatively, even though the cassette ejection is detected (the OPEN state of SA1), the cassette insertion is detected (the
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-55
                                                        CLOSE state of SA2) or the cassette hold status (the CLOSE state of SA3) is detected.
                                                        During bootup, the sensor is turned OFF after the timeout of the mechanical operation is detected, but the sensor does not
10301   Sensor error
                                                        transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-56
                                                        During bootup, the result of IP search detects the presence of an IP, but the backup memory information indicates that there
10302   Broken wire sensor detected                     is no IP in the machine. The backup memory has a record indicating that the IP conveyance was performed before power                 MT-55
                                                        recovery.
                                                        During bootup, the result of location information confirmation for IP search indicates the absence of an IP, but the backup
10303   IP initialization search error
                                                        memory information indicates the presence of an IP in the machine. System shutdown is selected via user intervention.
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-57
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]      MT-11
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                    MT-12
Error                                                                                                                                                                                     Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                      Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                       Flow
                                                        During bootup, the IP search detects the presence of an IP. The CLOSE state of the SB1, SC3, and SC4 is detected, and
10304   IP conveyance error during bootup (1)           the MB1 and MC3 are driven, but any of the sensors does not transition to OPEN. The backup memory has a record                      MT-57
                                                        indicating the presence of an IP in the machine.
                                                        During bootup, the IP search detects that there is an IP in the machine that is difficult to convey. The backup memory has a
10305   IP conveyance error during bootup (2)           record indicating the absence of an IP in the machine. IP conveyance is not performed before power-OFF. It is presumed              MT-57
                                                        that the backup memory has been cleared.
        IP positioning error at side-positioning conveyor During bootup, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to perform side-positioning operation for remaining IP processing,
10306   during bootup                                     but the SC3 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-59
                                                        During bootup, the MZ1, MC3, and MB1 are driven (counterclockwise) to measure the IP size for remaining IP processing,
        Length-measurement conveyance error during
10307   bootup
                                                        but the SC3 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. Alternatively, it transitions to CLOSE but not to     MT-59
                                                        OPEN.
                                                        During bootup or routine processing, because error (14315, 14316, 14317) is detected, retries (four times or more) are
10318   Suction cup HP operation error
                                                        performed, but error (fatal error) results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-60
                                                        During bootup or routine processing, because error (14331, 14332, 14333) is detected, retries (four times or more) are
10334   Side-positioning HP operation error
                                                        performed, but error (fatal error) results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-61
                                                        During bootup or routine processing, because error (14335, 14336, 14337) is detected, retries (four times or more) are
10338   Side-positioning grip HP operation error
                                                        performed, but error (fatal error) results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-62
                                                        During bootup, the SolZ1 is turned ON to protrude the stopper, but the SZ4 does not transition to OPEN within the specified
10340   IP stopper protrusion error
                                                        period of time. Retries (six times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-63
                                                        During bootup and shutdown processing, the SolZ1 is turned OFF to retreat the stopper, but the SZ4 does not transition to
10341   IP stopper retreat error
                                                        CLOSE within the specified period of time. Retries (six times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-63
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]     MT-12
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                             MT-13
Error                                                                                                                                                                              Analysis
                         Error Name                                                              Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                Flow
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driving shaft, but the SZ2 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period
10346   Driving shaft grip error
                                                 of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-64
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driven shaft, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified
10347   Driven shaft grip error
                                                 period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-66
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release both grips, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period
10348   Both grip release error
                                                 of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-64
                                                 <Service Procedure>
                                                 This error occurs when the version of the RU application software is updated from any version earlier than A04 to version
                                                 A05 or later, but the backup memory/error log/trace log is not initialized.
10349   Driven shaft grip release error
                                                 <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-66
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release the driven shaft grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to OPEN within the
                                                 specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to correct the speed, but the SZ2 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period of
10353   Driving shaft correction grip error
                                                 time.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-64
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ3 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period
10354   Initialization grip movement (1) error
                                                 of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-66
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE or the SZ3 does not
10355   Initialization grip movement (2) error
                                                 transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-64
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to perform ejection grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified
10356   Ejection grip error
                                                 period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-66
                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to perform no-load running, but the SZ3 does not transition to OPEN within the specified
10357   No-load running error
                                                 period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-66
                                                 During routine processing, the SB1 cannot detect the IP leading edge for after-erasure conveyance (the MB1 is driven
10360   After-erasure conveyance error           counterclockwise). The MB1 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform load conveyance, but the SB1 does not transition to              MT-76
                                                 CLOSE within the specified period of time (20 sec).
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                            [2.]   MT-13
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                             MT-14
Error                                                                                                                                                                              Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                Flow
                                                  During error handling, the SB1 cannot detect the IP leading edge. The MB1, MC1, and MZ1 are driven (counterclockwise)
10361   After-recovery-erasure conveyance error   for load conveyance, but the SB1 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time (20 sec). (The SB1 is in         MT-76
                                                  OPEN status.)
                                                  During routine processing, the MB1 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform load conveyance, but the SB1 does not transition
10370   Load positioning error
                                                  to OPEN within the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-68
                                                  During error handling, the MB1, MC1, and MZ1 are driven (counterclockwise) for load conveyance after the IP leading edge
10371   Recovery load positioning error
                                                  is detected by the SB1, but the SB1 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period of time (20 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-68
                                                  During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ5 does not transition to CLOSE
10390   Dust removal operation error (1)
                                                  within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-69
                                                  During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure the length of the hole
10391   Dust removal mechanism lock (1)           (x2) of the drive gear, but a mechanism lock results. Subsequently, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ5 does not            MT-69
                                                  transition from CLOSE to OPEN within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                  During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure the length of the hole
10392   Dust removal mechanism lock (2)           (x2) of the drive gear, but a mechanism lock results. Subsequently, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ3 does not            MT-69
                                                  transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                  During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform home positioning, but the
10393   Dust removal operation error (4)
                                                  SZ5 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-69
                                                  During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise), but two or more retries occur.
10394   Dust removal CCW drive error
                                                  However, driving in the clockwise direction is normal.
                                                                                                                                                                                     MT-71
10400 Network board error During bootup and routine processing, error is detected on the Ethernet section on the CPU12A board of the RU. 6.1
                                                  During bootup, when the SDRAM, or the main memory of the CPU12A board, is tested, error is detected. The warning is
10700   SDRAM test error
                                                  recorded and retries (up to two times) are performed, but error is detected again.
                                                                                                                                                                                       8
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                           [2.]   MT-14
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                            MT-15
Error                                                                                                                                                                             Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                  Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                               Flow
                                                     <Service Procedure>
                                                     This error occurs when the version of the RU application software is updated from any version earlier than A04 to version
10799   CPU bus error                                A05 or later, but the backup memory/error log/trace log is not initialized.                                                     8
                                                     <Occurrence Condition>
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, an unthinkable state is detected by the main CPU on the CPU12A board.
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, the driver used for conveyance-related software processing between the CPU12A
10900   Conveyance-related driver error
                                                     and SNS12A boards causes ERROR to be returned as a return value.
                                                                                                                                                                                     6.2
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, ERROR is returned as a return value for the common function used for conveyance-
10901   Conveyance-related common function error
                                                     related software processing between the CPU12A and SNS12A boards.
                                                                                                                                                                                     6.2
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, ERROR is returned as a return value for the standard function used for conveyance-
10902   Conveyance-related standard function error
                                                     related software processing between the CPU12A and SNS12A boards.
                                                                                                                                                                                     6.2
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, ERROR is returned as a return value for device OPEN used for conveyance-related
10903   Conveyance-related device OPEN error
                                                     software processing between the CPU12A and SNS12A boards.
                                                                                                                                                                                     6.2
10921 Watchdog error During bootup and routine processing, the watchdog timer on the CPU12A board times out. 8
10991 Device open error During bootup and routine processing, the device open error on the CPU12A board occurs. 8
                                                     Writing of the RU APPL software from the FTP server of the CL to the CPU12A board flash ROM of the RU is completed
11024   Machine application update
                                                     normally.
                                                                                                                                                                                      -
                                                     Writing of the RU configuration data from the FTP server of the CL to the CPU12A board flash ROM of the RU is completed
11025   Machine configuration update
                                                     normally.
                                                                                                                                                                                      -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                       [2.]   MT-15
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                          MT-16
Error                                                                                                                                                                           Analysis
                          Error Name                                                          Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                             Flow
                                             During bootup, error related to socket communication is detected. Socket communication cannot be performed normally due
11094   Socket error
                                             to software bugs.
                                                                                                                                                                                    -
11208 Laser drive current error During bootup and routine processing, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times the factory default value. MT-97
11272 Insufficient laser light intensity During bootup, laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) error is detected. MT-97
11273 Laser life warning During bootup and routine processing, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times the factory default value. MT-97
                                             During bootup, the IP search determines that there is no IP. However, the conveyance backup memory has a record
11303   IP initialization search error
                                             indicating the presence of an IP in the machine for routine processing.
                                                                                                                                                                                  MT-57
                                             Because the cassette is inserted into the RU while the CL is in "Unacceptable (cassette cannot be accepted)" condition, the
11309   Cassette setting error (3)           cassette is fed once and ejected without reading; as a result, a message notifying that reading has not be done is displayed           -
                                             on the CL.
                                             <User Operation>
                                             This error occurs when the cassette is inserted without being closely aligned to the reference plane or inserted aslant relative
                                             to the reference plane.
11310   Cassette setting error (1)
                                             <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                  MT-72
                                             During routine processing, the SA2 transitions to CLOSE, and after the SolA1 is turned OFF, the SA3 does not transition to
                                             OPEN. Retries (six times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                             <User Operation>
                                             This error occurs when the cassette is inserted without being closely aligned to the reference plane or inserted aslant relative
                                             to the reference plane. Alternatively, this error occurs when the cassette is not inserted all the way.
11311   Cassette setting error (2)
                                             <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                  MT-72
                                             During routine processing, the SA2 transitions to CLOSE, and after the SolA1 is turned ON, the cassette is moved, but the
                                             SA2 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. However, the SA1 is CLOSE.
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]      MT-16
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                        MT-17
Error                                                                                                                                                                         Analysis
                        Error Name                                                            Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                           Flow
                                              <User Operation>
                                              This error occurs when the hold pin does not lower due to the force exerted on the hold pin as the cassette is pulled in the
                                              cassette hold non-released condition.
11312   Cassette hold release error
                                              <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                MT-73
                                              During routine processing, the SolA1 is turned ON to release the cassette hold, but the SA3 does not transition to CLOSE
                                              within the specified period of time. Retries (six times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                              <User Operation>
                                              This error occurs when the cassette containing no IP is inserted.
                                              <Occurrence Condition>
11319   Feed IP suction error
                                              During routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) and the PA1 is turned ON to perform IP feed leak, but the
                                                                                                                                                                                MT-74
                                              SA5 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error
                                              results.
                                              During bootup and routine processing, the MA1 and MB1 are driven (clockwise) to feed the IP from the cassette, but the SA5
11320   Feed IP drop                          transitions to OPEN at the time when the IP is griped by the rollers. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error        MT-74
                                              results.
                                              During bootup and routine processing, the MB1 is driven (clockwise) to perform IP feed leak and conveyance, but the SB1
11321   Feed IP grip error                    does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error           MT-74
                                              results.
                                              During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to perform IP high-speed conveyance, but the SC3
11322   Feed conveyance error
                                              transitions to OPEN. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                MT-74
                                              During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to determine the IP size, but the SB1 transitions to
11323   Length-measurement conveyance error
                                              OPEN. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                MT-76
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]   MT-17
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                            MT-18
Error                                                                                                                                                                             Analysis
                          Error Name                                                               Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                               Flow
                                                  During routine processing, the SVA1 is turned ON and the PA1 is turned OFF to leak the IP after loading it into the cassette,
11325   Load leak error
                                                  but the SA5 does not transition to OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-77
                                                  During routine processing, the Solz1 is turned ON to protrude the IP stopper after IP feed leak, but the SZ4 transitions to
11340   IP stopper protrusion error
                                                  CLOSE. SZ4 checks are retried (two times or more), but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-63
                                                  During routine processing and U-Utility dust removal operation, the SOLZ1 is turned OFF to retreat the IP stopper, but the
11341   IP stopper retreat error
                                                  SZ4 transitions to OPEN. SZ4 checks are retried (six times or more), but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-63
                                                  During routine processing, the MZ1 is driven (clockwise) to perform read processing, but the SZ1 transitions to OPEN.
11342   Reading IP leading-edge detection error   Subsequently, the laser is turned OFF, and when IP conveyance is performed to isolate the error, the SC3 transitions to           MT-78
                                                  OPEN.
                                                  During routine processing, the MZ1 is driven (clockwise) to perform read processing, but the SZ1 transitions to OPEN.
11343   Subscanning conveyance error (1)          Subsequently, the laser is turned OFF, and when IP conveyance is performed to isolate the error, the SC3 transitions to           MT-78
                                                  CLOSE.
                                                  During routine processing, the SC3 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period of time before the end-of-image
11344   Subscanning conveyance error (2)
                                                  interrupt after reading is initiated.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-78
                                                  During routine processing, the end-of-image interrupt from the scanner board is not processed within the specified period of
11350   End-of-image timeout
                                                  time after reading is initiated.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-79
                                                  During routine processing, the MZ1, MC3, and MB1 are driven (counterclockwise) to convey the IP to the erasure unit after
11362   After-reading conveyance error
                                                  reading is completed, but the SC4 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-80
                                                  During routine processing, the MC3 and MB1 are driven (counterclockwise) to perform erasure conveyance of the IP after
11363   Erasure conveyance error
                                                  reading, but the SC4 does not transition to OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-81
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]   MT-18
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                     MT-19
Error                                                                                                                                                                                      Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                        Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                        Flow
                                                         During bootup and routine processing, the MB1 is driven (counterclockwise) to reload the IP due to the load IP drop retry
11371   Load IP drop
                                                         (14373) or load IP suction failure retry (14372), but the SB1 does not transition to OPEN within the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-82
                                                         During routine processing, the PA1 is turned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load the IP into the cassette,
11372   Load IP suction error                            but the SA5 transitions to OPEN within the specified period of time. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error          MT-82
                                                         results.
                                                         During routine processing, the PA1 is turned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load the IP into the cassette,
11373   Load IP drop                                     but the SA5 transitions to OPEN at the time when the IP is released. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error          MT-82
                                                         results.
11380 Maximum empty cassette setting During bootup, an attempt is made to eject (load) the remaining IP into the cassette, but the cassette has not been set. MT-83
11387 Recovery IP processing During bootup, the remaining IP that has not been erased is detected. MT-84
11400 Unread IP ejection (1) During routine processing, the IP is ejected, without being read, to the cassette for some reason on the CL side. -
11401 Unread IP ejection (2) During routine processing, the IP is ejected, without being read, to the cassette for some reason on the RU side. -
                                                         During routine processing, an attempt is made to retransmit the unsent image data from the RU to the CL after
11402   Retransmission retry failure cassette ejection
                                                         communication down processing with the CL, the CL rejects it, so that the image data is lost, and the cassette is ejected.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.1
                                                         <User Operation>
                                                         This error occurs when the user attempts to output a test image in M-Utility without barcode-based ID registration, while the
                                                         machine is used in the N-to-N connection setup. Alternatively, this error occurs when the DIP switch of the CPU12A board is
                                                         set to "no barcode".
11403   Barcode load request
                                                         <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                               -
                                                         The barcode cannot be read.
                                                         • The barcode attached on the IP is tarnished or soiled.
                                                         • The barcode reader is not working properly or the barcode reader installation position is improper.
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                            [2.]   MT-19
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                     MT-20
Error                                                                                                                                                                                      Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                      Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                        Flow
                                                        <User Operation>
                                                        This error occurs when the menu is not selected only in the N-to-N connection setup while a test image is outputted in M-
                                                        Utility.
11404   Patient information not registered
                                                        <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                               -
                                                        The patient information corresponding to the barcode attached on the IP has not been registered. Alternatively, the barcode
                                                        cannot be read because, for example, the barcode attached on the IP is tarnished or soiled.
                                                        An inquiry is made from the RU to the CL as to the image data transfer destination, but the transfer destination is not notified
11405   Patient information search error                from the CL.                                                                                                                           -
                                                        It is necessary to troubleshoot the CL.
        Thermistor failure detection (during erasure    During bootup, it is detected that temperature control of the erasure unit is disabled due to temperature thermistor (THB1)
11731   initialization)                                 error.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
        Thermistor status error detection (during       During bootup, the temperature thermistor (THB1) detects an abnormal range. Temperature control of the erasure unit is
11732   erasure initialization)                         disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
        Lamp unlit detection (during erasure            During bootup, the erasure lamps are turned on to check their lighting, but a single center lamp (socket L2) of the three
11737   initialization)                                 erasure lamps is unlit. Or, two or more erasure lamps are unlit.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
        Erasure unit temperature status inconsistency   During routine processing, error for the temperature states (LED: D15, D11, D10, D13) in the erasure unit is detected.
11752   (during IP processing)                          Temperature control of the erasure unit is disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]     MT-20
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                      MT-21
Error                                                                                                                                                                                       Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                          Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                         Flow
        Lamp unlit detection (during erasure idle           During machine idle state, in order to perform erasure temperature control, the erasure lamps are turned on to check their
11757   temperature control)                                lighting, but a single center lamp (socket L2) of the three erasure lamps is unlit. Or, two or more erasure lamps are unlit.
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.4
                                                            During IP erasure, the erasure lamps are turned on to check their lighting, but a single center lamp (socket L2) of the three
11767   Lamp unlit detection (during IP erasure lighting)
                                                            erasure lamps is unlit. Or, two or more erasure lamps are unlit.
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.4
11781 Thermistor failure detection (during idling) During idle state after machine bootup, error for the temperature thermistor (THB1) is detected. 6.4
        Erasure unit temperature status inconsistency       During bootup, error for the temperature states (LED: D15, D11, D10, D13) in the erasure unit is detected. Temperature
11782   (during idling)                                     control of the erasure unit is disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.4
11890 Power supply C31 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse C31 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
12026 Image transfer timeout During routine processing, the image data is not sent from the sub-CPU of the CPU12A board to the CL. (Timeout error) 6.1
12033 Barcode data reading error Because an attempt to read the barcode data on the CPU12A board, a retry is performed. 8
                                                            During bootup and routine processing, because the erasure lamps are turned on without preheating them, the erasure lamps
12035   Preheat warning during erasure lamp lighting
                                                            are not lit.
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.4
                                                            During bootup and routine processing, a timeout occurs for communication between the main CPU (CPU12A board) and
12036   Scanner communication timeout
                                                            scanner H8CPU (SCN12A board).
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.3
                                                            During bootup and routine processing, a checksum error occurs for communication between the main CPU (CPU12A board)
12037   Scanner communication checksum error
                                                            and scanner H8CPU (SCN12A board).
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.3
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]   MT-21
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                  MT-22
Error                                                                                                                                                                                   Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                     Flow
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, because an attempt to register the reset switch interrupt on the CPU12A board fails,
12040   Failure to register reset switch interrupt
                                                      the reset switch does not function.
                                                                                                                                                                                           8
                                                      During routine processing, because the data sent from the sub-CPU of the CPU12A board has an insufficient or excess
12063   Image processing CPU error during operation   number of pixels, the software performs processing to supplement or cut the insufficient or excess number of pixels in the           8
                                                      line direction.
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, an attempt to write to the backup memory (SRAM) fails. Or, a write to the backup
12070   Backup SRAM write error
                                                      SRAM is performed during backup memory test.
                                                                                                                                                                                           8
12071 Flash ROM write error An attempt to write the flash ROM on the CPU12A board fails. 8
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, the software executes an abnormal case. Although the process may be resumed as
12090   Software logic warning
                                                      is, its error log is generated.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, the FTP server cannot be accessed for communication from the RU to the CL. Or,
12092   FTP server access error
                                                      the FTP server may be accessed, but a connection cannot be established.
                                                                                                                                                                                           6.1
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, the FTP server cannot be accessed for communication from the RU to the CL. Or,
12093   FTP server file acquisition error
                                                      the FTP server may be accessed, but a file cannot be obtained.
                                                                                                                                                                                           6.1
                                                      <Software error>
                                                      If the software version is A06 and the operation mode indicated by the detailed error information is "IR", this event is logged
                                                      due to a software bug. In this instance, no remedial action needs to be taken.
12094   ACK timeout
                                                      <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                           6.1
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, a FTP server connection timeout error occurs for communication from the RU to the
                                                      CL.
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]    MT-22
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                MT-23
Error                                                                                                                                                                                 Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                   Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                   Flow
                                                      • A warning log indicating that dummy data was sent from the CPU12A board due to image data shortage.
12101   Image processing CPU data output shortage
                                                      • During routine processing, the image data sent from the SCN12A board to the CPU12A board is insufficient.
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.2
        Image frame clock timeout during routine      A timeout of the frame clock lock (information indicative of the beginning of the image data) from the SCN12A board is
12148   processing                                    detected by the sub-CPU. (30 seconds)
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.3
                                                      An error is detected for the pixel clock from the sub-CPU to the SCN12A board.
12149   Image processing pixel clock excess error     • The pixel clock that is larger than the parameter value is detected.                                                             6.3
                                                      • The pixel clock, which is part of image data, denotes the number of pixels per one line of the image data.
                                                      During routine processing, when the image data from the SCN12A board is processed, an insufficient number of pixels for a
12150   Image processing pixel clock shortage error
                                                      certain line is detected by the sub-CPU.
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.3
                                                      During routine processing, when the image data from the SCN12A board is processed, an excess number of lines is
12151   Image processing line clock excess error
                                                      detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.3
                                                      During routine processing, when the image data from the SCN12A board is processed, an insufficient number of lines is
12152   Image processing line clock shortage error    detected, or even when five seconds have passed after the trailing edge of a certain line clock, the trailing edge of its          6.3
                                                      subsequent line clock cannot be detected.
                                                      During routine processing, when an image processing command is accepted from the SCN12A board to the sub-CPU, the
12153   Image processing frame clock error
                                                      sub-CPU have already received the frame clock from the SCN.
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.3
12154 Image processing overrun error During routine processing, the main CPU loses some of the image data from the sub-CPU. 8
                                                      During routine processing, the sub-CPU completes its processing normally, but the number of pixels received by the main
12164   FIFO data count shortage error
                                                      CPU via the FIFO is insufficient.
                                                                                                                                                                                          8
                                                      During routine processing, the sub-CPU completes its processing normally, but the number of pixels received by the main
12165   FIFO data count excess error
                                                      CPU via FIFO is excessive.
                                                                                                                                                                                          8
12201 Start-point detection error During bootup and routine processing, error for the start-point detection signal (SSH, SSL) is detected. MT-95
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]   MT-23
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                      MT-24
Error                                                                                                                                                                       Analysis
                          Error Name                                                       Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                         Flow
12202   Leading-edge detection error       During bootup and routine processing, only error for the leading-edge detection signal (SED1, SED2L) is detected.                  MT-98
                                           For self-diagnostics prior to reading during bootup, an SCN board diagnostic error (no main-scan sync signal is generated)
12203   SCN sync signal error
                                           associated with polygon error occurs.
                                                                                                                                                                                -
                                           For self-diagnostics prior to reading during bootup, an SCN board diagnostic error (no polygon index signal is generated)
12204   Polygon index signal error
                                           associated with polygon error occurs.
                                                                                                                                                                                -
12211 PMT analog power supply error During bootup and routine processing, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is detected. MT-99
12212 Laser light intensity error During bootup and routine processing, only error for the laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) is detected. MT-97
12213 Polygon lock error During bootup and routine processing, only error for the polygon lock signal (POKL, PONL) is detected. MT-100
                                           During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A
12214   Polygon rotation error
                                           board.
                                                                                                                                                                              14.2
12215 PLL function error During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the PLL function on the SCN12A board. 14.2
                                                                                                                                                                              14.2
12216   Start-point interval error         During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the start-point interval function on the SCN12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                              14.3
12217 High-voltage power supply error During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH/L). MT-99
                                           During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the high-voltage command value diagnostics signal on the
12218   High-voltage command value error
                                           SCN12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                                8
12225 Reading status error During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the VSYNC signal on the SCN12A board. 8
12226 Operation line status error During bootup and routine processing, error is detected only for the SEDTM/FCLKTM signal on the SCN12A board. 8
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                           [2.]   MT-24
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                 MT-25
Error                                                                                                                                                                                  Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                 Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                    Flow
                                                  During routine processing, error is detected for the PLL function, polygon rotation function, start-point interval function on the     14.2
12241   Scanner control board error (1)
                                                  SCN12A board.                                                                                                                          14.3
                                                  During routine processing, because the PMT high-voltage value is not set correctly on the SCN12A board, error is detected
12242   Scanner control board error (2)
                                                  for the high-voltage command diagnostics.
                                                                                                                                                                                         14.5
                                                  During bootup self-diagnostics, error is detected for the start-point mask signal generated from the SCN12A board and the
12243   Scanner control board error (3)
                                                  index signal (PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror (POL).
                                                                                                                                                                                         14.3
                                                  During routine processing, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is detected (detail code:
12251   Photomultiplier control board error (1)
                                                  008200). Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 008000.
                                                                                                                                                                                         MT-99
12252 Photomultiplier control board error (2) During routine processing, only error for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH, HVOKL) is detected. MT-99
12255 Leading-edge detection error During bootup, only error for the leading-edge detection signal (SED1, SED2L) is detected. MT-98
                                                  During routine processing, IP conveyance overrun occurs due to mechanical error or SCN12A board control error, and only
12256   Leading-edge detection timing error
                                                  error for the SEDTM and FCLKTM signals on the SCN12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                        MT-101
                                                  • During routine processing, error for the signals (PONL, POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror (POL) and the start-point
                                                  interval function on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 003400).
12262   Polygon rotation error (2)
                                                  • During routine processing, error for the polygon lock signal (PONL, POKL) and error for the start-point interval function and
                                                                                                                                                                                        MT-100
                                                  polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 003400).
                                                  During routine processing, only error for the lock signal (POKL, PONL) from the polygonal mirror (POL) is detected (detail
12263   Polygon rotation error (3)
                                                  code: 002000). If error for the SEDTM or FCLKTM signal on the SCN12A board is detected, the detail code is 002003.
                                                                                                                                                                                        MT-100
                                                  During routine processing, error for the signals (PONL, POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror and the SEDTM signal on
                                                  the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 001002). Alternatively, error for the index signal (PINDXL) from the polygonal
12264   Polygonal rotation error (4)              mirror and the SEDTM and FCLKTM signals on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 0010030). Alternatively, error                  MT-100
                                                  for the signals (POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror and the SEDTM signal on the SCN12A board is detected (error
                                                  code: 001002).
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                            [2.]     MT-25
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                   MT-26
Error                                                                                                                                                                                    Analysis
                          Error Name                                                                   Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow
                                                      During routine processing, the laser light intensity is less than 50%, and the laser light intensity error signal (LD1OKL,
12272   Insufficient laser light intensity (1)        LD1OKH) is detected (detail code: 004000). Alternatively, the laser light intensity error signal (LD1OKL, LD1OKH) and laser          MT-97
                                                      drive current value (LDIF) error are detected (detail code: 014000).
12273 Laser life warning During bootup and routine processing, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times the factory default value. MT-97
                                                      During routine processing, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) function, and error for the PLL function and
                                                      polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 801C03). Alternatively, the disabled
12281   Start-point detection error (1)               state of the start-point detection (SYN) function, and error for the PLL function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail           MT-95
                                                      code: 800C03). Alternatively, during routine processing, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) function, and
                                                      error for the PLL function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 801401).
                                                      During bootup and routine processing, only error for the start-point interval function on the SCN12A board is detected (detail
12282   Start-point detection error (2)               code: 000400). Alternatively, error for the start-point interval function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A      14.3
                                                      board is detected (detail code: 001400).
                                                      During routine processing, error for the VSYNC signal on the SCN12A board is detected after IP reading is completed (detail
12291   Reading sequence error
                                                      code: 000002).
                                                                                                                                                                                             8
                                                      Reading is completed by any interrupt other than the leading-edge detection interrupt or end-of-screen interrupt. At the
12292   Reading sequence error during routine (2)
                                                      same time, an insufficient number of output lines and a too-early start of reading are detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                             -
                                                      For self-diagnostics prior to reading during routine processing, a combination of errors that should not have logically occurred
12299   Error for scanner, etc.
                                                      were generated.
                                                                                                                                                                                             -
                                                      During routine processing, the sensor is turned OFF after the timeout of the mechanical operation is detected, but the sensor
12301   Sensor error
                                                      does not transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-56
                                                      During bootup, the result of IP search indicates the presence of an IP, but the backup memory information indicates that
12302   IP location information logical failure
                                                      there is no IP in the machine. Because there is no result of clearing the CMOS, it is logically inconsistent.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-55
        IP movement error at scanner unit during      During bootup, the MB1, MC3, and MZ1 are driven (clockwise) for IP search, but the SC3 does not transition to OPEN within
12304   bootup                                        the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-57
        IP movement error at erasure conveyor/side-   During bootup, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) for IP search, but the SB1 or SC4 do not transition to CLOSE within
12305   positioning conveyor during bootup            the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-57
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]      MT-26
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                            MT-27
Error                                                                                                                                                                             Analysis
                          Error Name                                                             Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                               Flow
                                                <User Operation>
                                                This error occurs when the cassette is inserted aslant relative to the reference plane and then pulled out immediately.
12313   Cassette not detected                   <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                              MT-85
                                                During routine processing, while the SolA1 is tuned ON to hold the cassette, the cassette is pulled all the way out of the
                                                shutter, and SA1 transitions to OPEN.
12318 Suction cup HP return error During bootup and routine processing, SA4 does not transition to CLOSE for suction cup HP check. MT-60
                                                During routine processing, an attempt to read the barcode for feed conveyance fails. Retries (four times or more) are
12324   Barcode reading error
                                                performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-87
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the SVA1 is turned ON and the PA1 is turned OFF to perform IP feed leak, but the
12325   Feed leak error
                                                SA5 does not transition to OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-77
                                                During routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform suction cup home positioning after the cassette is
12326   HP return error during ejection
                                                ejected, but the SA4 does not transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-60
                                                During routine processing, the MC1 is driven (clockwise) to perform side-positioning home positioning, but the SC1 does not
12334   Side-positioning operation error
                                                transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-61
                                                During routine processing, the MC2 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform side-positioning grip home positioning, but the
12338   Side-positioning grip operation error
                                                SC2 does not transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-62
12345 FFM drive W.F. disorder During routine processing, wow-flutter error (irregular revolutions) of the FFM motor (MZ1) is detected. MT-86
                                                During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform driving-shaft slow grip after driven-shaft grip is completed, but the
12346   Driving shaft grip error
                                                SZ2 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-64
                                                During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driven shaft after side-positioning is completed, but the SZ3 does not
12347   Driven shaft grip error
                                                transition to CLOSE. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-66
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to release both grips, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE.
12348   Both grip release error
                                                Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-64
                                                During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to release the driven shaft slow grip after reading, but the SZ3 does not
12349   Driven shaft grip release error
                                                transition to OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                    MT-66
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]    MT-27
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                    MT-28
Error                                                                                                                                                                                     Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                     Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                       Flow
                                                       During bootup and routine processing, the grip time for the driving shaft grip deviates by ±3% relative to its specified value,
12352   Driving shaft grip error stop
                                                       but the SZ2 is CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                       During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform driving-shaft correction grip, but the SZ2 does not transition to
12353   Driving shaft correction grip error
                                                       OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-64
                                                       During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform driving-shaft slow grip and the SZ2 transitions from CLOSE to
12354   Driving shaft grip disorder
                                                       OPEN, but the grip time deviates by ±3% relative to its specified value.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                       During bootup and routine processing, because the grip time for the driving shaft grip deviates by ±6% relative to its
12355   Driving shaft grip malfunction
                                                       specified value, speed correction processing and operation check are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                       During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform ejection grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE. Retries (two
12356   Ejection grip error
                                                       times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                       During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform no-load running, but the SZ3 does not transition to
12357   No-load running error
                                                       OPEN. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                       During routine processing, the SB1 cannot detect the IP leading edge for after-erasure conveyance (the MB1 is driven
12360   After-erasure conveyance error                 counterclockwise). To perform load conveyance, the MB1 is driven (counterclockwise), but the SB1 does not transition to                -
                                                       CLOSE within the specified period of time (20 sec). It is logged, with the operation continued.
12388 IP with improper generation or type detected During routine processing, the IP of the type that is not set in the configuration is detected from the barcode data. -
                                                       During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5 does
12390   Dust removal operation error (1)
                                                       not transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-69
                                                       During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5 does
12391   Dust removal operation error (2)
                                                       not OPEN after its transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-69
                                                       During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5
12392   Dust removal operation error (3)
                                                       does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-69
                                                       During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5
12393   Dust removal operation error (4)
                                                       does not OPEN after its transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-69
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                            [2.]   MT-28
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                  MT-29
Error                                                                                                                                                                                   Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                        Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                     Flow
                                                         During shutdown processing, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5 does not
12394   Dust removal operation error (5)
                                                         transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                          MT-69
                                                         During bootup, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN
12395   Dust removal operation in low speed              to OPEN within the specified time (30 sec) in the low-speed operation mode (the actuator, from its large hole to smaller         MT-69
                                                         hole).
12401 Software initialization timeout The initialization of the RU software is not completed within the specified period of time. 8
12402 User password setup failure Password setup that is defined in the configuration fails. 8
12403 FTP server registration failure The IP address of the FTP server cannot be registered in the table that manages the OS. 6.1
                                                         An attempt to create a device for accessing the FTP server fails. Software automatic version update, log uploading, etc.
12404   Failure to create device for FTP server access
                                                         cannot be done.
                                                                                                                                                                                           6.1
                                                         <Servicing operation>
                                                         If the error is logged each time a normal process is performed, bit 4 of the S1 switch on the CPU12A board is set to OFF (to
12406   Barcode data error                               indicate that the RU does not have a barcode reader). In this instance, set bit 4 to ON.                                           8
                                                         <Occurrence Condition>
                                                         The data that is scanned by the barcode is inconsistent with the format (A********C: * denotes a numeral).
                                                         An image processing command is issued to the image processing unit (sub-CPU), but the status of the sub-CPU does not
12407   Status check error after SCPU command writing
                                                         become IDLE or BUSY.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
                                                         After a command is sent, the status of the image processing CPU is not busy. Image reading is not performed, and the IP is
12408   Image processing CPU status error
                                                         ejected.
                                                                                                                                                                                            8
12409 IP size error An IP of out-of-range size was set by the conveyance subsystem. -
                                                         During bootup, the configuration file in the flash ROM on the CPU12A board causes a checksum error. Because the machine
12410   Configuration checksum error
                                                         is rebooted with its default configuration setup, it is necessary to perform configuration user setting.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                       [2.]    MT-29
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                     MT-30
Error                                                                                                                                                                                      Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                          Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                        Flow
        Connection monitoring Com-Terminate                The communication disabled state between the CL and RU is detected. The communication connection is disconnected
12502   detection                                          once, and enters the connection wait state.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.1
12700 CPU board initial diagnostics test error The machine is booted up with the SW S5 setting on the CPU12A board in the ON state. -
12701 Bus error detection function error During bootup and routine processing, error is found for the bus error detection. 8
                                                           During bootup and routine processing, an interrupt is sent from the main CPU of the CPU12A board to the H8CPU of the
12702   SCN-H8 microprocessor interrupt test error
                                                           SCN12A board, but the interrupt is not completed normally.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.3
                                                           During bootup and routine processing, an interrupt is sent from the main CPU of the CPU12A board to the SNS12A board,
12703   Sensor board interrupt test error
                                                           but the interrupt is not completed normally.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.2
        Erasure cooling fan diagnostics error (during      During bootup, error for the FAN3 (erasure unit lamp house cooling fan) is detected, but only a warning is recorded, and fan
12735   erasure initialization)                            control continues as usual.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
        Single lamp unlit detection (during erasure        During bootup, because one of the three lamps is unlit, the machine is booted up in the mode where the erasure time is
12736   initialization)                                    extended.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
                                                           During bootup and routine processing, 12733 or 12753 occurs and the temperature of the erasure unit lamp reaches an
                                                           abnormal level, so that the no-erasure mode is temporarily entered.
12743   Erasure unit high-temperature error cancel
                                                           Subsequently, because the erasure lamp temperature drops below the specified level (erasure-enabled temperature), it
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
                                                           returns to the normal mode.
12753 Erasure unit high-temperature error During routine processing and idling, the temperature thermistor (THB1) detects high-temperature error. 6.4
        Single lamp unlit detection (during erasure idle   During idling, when the erasure lamps are turned on for erasure temperature control, a single lamp that is normally lit does
12756   temperature control)                               not turn on, so that it enters the erasure time extension mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
        Single lamp unlit detection (during IP erasure     During bootup and routine processing, when the erasure lamps are turned on during IP erasure, a single lamp is unlit, so that
12766   lighting)                                          it enters the erasure time extension mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                              6.4
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                        [2.]    MT-30
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                             MT-31
Error                                                                                                                                                                              Analysis
                        Error Name                                                               Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                Flow
                                                An interrupt is received such that the main CPU has accessed the self-reset register that is usually accessed during
12799   Self-reset procedure error
                                                shutdown processing, using improper procedure.
                                                                                                                                                                                       8
        Erasure unit safety thermostat TSWB1    During bootup and routine processing, because the erasure unit lamp housing reaches an abnormally high temperature, the
12800   operation                               safety thermostat TSWB1 is activated.
                                                                                                                                                                                       6.4
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses A21 on the MTH12A board, A22 on the SCN12A board, and
12810   Power supply A error
                                                A32, A33, A34, and A35 on the SNS12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                    10.1-10.6
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses A21 on the MTH12A board and A22 on the SCN12A board is
12811   Power supply A21 error
                                                detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                      10.4
12812 Power supply A22 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A22 on the SCN12A board is detected. 10.4
12813 Power supply A32 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A32 on the SNS12A board is detected. 10.5
12814 Power supply A33 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A33 on the SNS12A board is detected. 10.6
12815 Power supply A34 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A34 on the SNS12A board is detected. 10.6
12816 Power supply A35 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A35 on the SNS12A board is detected. 10.1
12817 Power supply A3 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses A32, A33, A34, and A35 on the SNS12A board is detected. 10.1-10.6
12818 Power supply A series detection error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse A21 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.4
                                                During bootup and routine processing, it is detected that a combination of errors for software monitoring is other than a
12819   Power supply A system error
                                                combination from 12810 to 12818.
                                                                                                                                                                                    10.1-10.6
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point B of SLOT2 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and           10.5
12820   Power supply BC error
                                                the blow of the fuses B11, B21, C11, and C21 on the MTH12A board is detected.                                                         10.7
12821 Power supply C error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses C11 and C21 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                             [2.]   MT-31
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                        MT-32
Error                                                                                                                                                                         Analysis
                        Error Name                                                             Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                           Flow
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point B of SLOT2 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and     10.5
12822   Power supply B error
                                                the blow of the fuses B11 and B21 on the MTH12A board is detected.                                                              10.7
12823 Power supply B11 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse B11 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
12824 Power supply B21 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse B21 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
12825 Power supply C11 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse C11 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
12826 Power supply C21 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse C21 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.5
12827 Power supply B series detection error During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point B of SLOT2 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted. 10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point B of SLOT2 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, or
                                                                                                                                                                                10.5
12828   Power supply BC system error            either of B11, B21, C11 or C21 on the MTH12A board is detected as defective, but a combination of errors for software
                                                                                                                                                                                10.7
                                                monitoring is other than a combination from 12820 to 12827.
                                                                                                                                                                                10.2
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point D of SLOT3 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and     10.3
12830   Power supply DE error
                                                the blow of the fuses D11, D21, D31, D41, E11, E21, E31, and E41 on the DRV12A board is detected.                               10.6
                                                                                                                                                                                10.7
                                                                                                                                                                                10.2
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point D of SLOT3 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and     10.3
12831   Power supply D error
                                                the blow of the fuses D11, D21, D31, and D41 on the DRV12A board is detected.                                                   10.6
                                                                                                                                                                                10.7
                                                                                                                                                                                10.2
12832   Power supply E error                    During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses E11, E21, E31, and E41 on the DRV12A board is detected.             10.3
                                                                                                                                                                                10.6
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                       [2.]    MT-32
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                        MT-33
Error                                                                                                                                                                         Analysis
                        Error Name                                                             Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                           Flow
12833   Power supply D11 error                  During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse D11 on the DRV12A board is detected.                                 10.2
12834 Power supply D21 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse D21 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12835 Power supply D31 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse D31 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12836 Power supply D41 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse D41 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.6
12837 Power supply E11 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse E11 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.2
12838 Power supply E21 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse E21 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.2
12839 Power supply E31 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse E31 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12840 Power supply E41 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse E41 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12841 Power supply D series detection error During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point D of SLOT3 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted. 10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the broken line detection circuit D or either D11, D21, D31, D41, E11, E21, E31, or       10.2
12842   Power supply DE system error            E41 is detected as abnormal, but a combination of errors for software monitoring is other than a combination from 12830 to      10.3
                                                12841.                                                                                                                          10.6
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point H of SLOT4 (+15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and     10.4
12850   Power supply H error
                                                the blow of the fuses H11 on the MTH12A and H12, H13, and H14 on the SCN12A is detected.                                        10.7
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                      [2.]     MT-33
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                             MT-34
Error                                                                                                                                                                              Analysis
                        Error Name                                                               Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                Flow
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses H11 on the MTH12A board and H12, H13, and H14 on the
12851   Power supply H11 error
                                                SCN12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.4
12852 Power supply H12 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse H12 on the SCN12A board is detected. 10.4
12853 Power supply H13 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse H13 on the SCN12A board is detected. 10.4
12854 Power supply H14 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse H14 on the SCN12A board is detected. 10.4
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point H of SLOT4 (+15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, or           10.4
12855   Power supply H series detection error
                                                the blow of the fuse H11 on the MTH12A board is detected.                                                                            10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, it is detected that a combination of error for software monitoring is other than a
12856   Power supply H system error
                                                combination from 12850 to 12855.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.4
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point J of SLOT4 (-15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and          10.4
12860   Power supply J error
                                                the blow of the fuses J11 on the MTH12A and J12 on the SCN12A board is detected.                                                     10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses J11 on the MTH12A board and J12 on the SCN12A board is
12861   Power supply J11 error
                                                detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.4
12862 Power supply J12 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse J12 on the SCN12A board is detected. 10.4
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point J of SLOT4 (-15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, or           10.4
12863   Power supply J series detection error
                                                the blow of the fuse J11 on the MTH12A board is detected.                                                                            10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, it is detected that a combination of errors for software monitoring is other than a
12864   Power supply J system error
                                                combination from 12860 to 12863.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.4
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                             [2.]   MT-34
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                             MT-35
Error                                                                                                                                                                              Analysis
                        Error Name                                                               Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                Flow
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point K of SLOT5 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and          10.4
12870   Power supply K error
                                                the blow of the fuse K11 on the MTH12A board is detected.                                                                            10.7
12871 Power supply K11 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse K11 on the MTH12A board is detected. 10.4
12872 Power supply K series detection error During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point K of SLOT5 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted. 10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point L of SLOT5 (+15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.3
12880   Power supply L error                    the error for the regulator L12 on the DRV12A board and the blow of the fuses L11, L21, and L31 on the DRV12A board are
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.7
                                                detected.
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the error for the regulator L12 on the DRV12A board and the blow of the fuse L11 on
12881   Power supply L11 error
                                                the DRV12A board are detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.3
12882 Power supply L12 error During bootup and routine processing, the error for the regulator L12 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12883 Power supply L21 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuses L21 and L31 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
12884 Power supply L31 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse L31 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.3
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point L of SLOT5 (+15V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, or           10.3
12885   Power supply L series detection error
                                                the blow of the fuse L11 or L21 on the DRV12A board is detected.                                                                     10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, it is detected that a combination of errors for software monitoring is other than a
12886   Power supply L system error
                                                combination from 12880 to 12885.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.7
                                                During bootup and routine processing, the voltage at point E of SLOT2 (+24V) on the power supply unit is not outputted, and
12891   Power supply C series detection error
                                                the blow of the fuse C11, C21, or C31 on the MTH12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                     10.7
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                             [2.]   MT-35
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                   MT-36
Error                                                                                                                                                                                    Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow
12892   Power supply D51 error                       During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse D51 on the DRV12A board is detected.                                       10.2
12893 Power supply E51 error During bootup and routine processing, the blow of the fuse E51 on the DRV12A board is detected. 10.2
12921 Image processing CPU status error During routine processing, a status error occurs between the main CPU and sub-CPU on the CPU12A board. 8
12922 FTP server detection error During bootup and routine processing, the FTP server cannot be detected for communication from the RU to the CL 6.1
12923 Application download error An attempt to download an application from the FTP server of the CL to the CPU12A board of the RU fails. 6.1
12960 Message format error A message that is not defined in the FRUP protocol is received for communication from the RU to the CL. 6.1
12961 ACK timeout A timeout in connection with the FTP server is detected for communication from the RU to the CL. 6.1
12970 Backup memory write warning During bootup and routine processing, an attempt to write to the backup memory of the CPU12A board fails. 8
13010 Utility command concurrent execution error Bootup by use of the production tool and bootup in M-Utility from the CL are performed concurrently. -
13011 Utility command parameter error An entry that is out of range that may be inputted in M-Utility is made. -
                                                     The content of the file in the FTP server is different from the content of the file (IPL data, APPL data) in the flash ROM on the
13020   File comparison error
                                                     CPU12A board of the RU.
                                                                                                                                                                                            6.1
13092 Software logic warning After power ON, the machine is in condition that is not set in software. 8
13200 High-voltage OFF during bootup During bootup, the photomultiplier (PMT) high voltage is OFF. 14.5
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]      MT-36
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                MT-37
Error                                                                                                                                                                 Analysis
                          Error Name                                                      Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                   Flow
13201   Start-point detection error     During M-Utility operation, only error for the start-point detection signal (SSH, SSL) is detected.                             MT-95
13202 Leading-edge detection error During M-Utility operation, only error for the leading-edge detection signal (SED1L, SED2L) is detected. MT-98
13203 Start-point mask signal error During M-Utility operation, only error for the start-point mask signal on the SCN12A board is detected. 8
13204 Polygon index signal error During M-Utility operation, only error for the polygon index signal on the SCN12A board is detected. 8
13208 Laser drive current error During M-Utility operation, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times the factory default value. MT-97
                                        During bootup and routine processing, the polygon OK signal is not detected within 6 seconds after turn-ON of the polygonal
13210   Polygon lock timeout
                                        mirror.
                                                                                                                                                                       MT-100
13211 PMT analog power supply error During M-Utility operation, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is detected. MT-99
13212 Laser light intensity error During M-Utility operation, only error for the laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) is detected. MT-97
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                     [2.]     MT-37
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                     MT-38
Error                                                                                                                                                                                      Analysis
                          Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                        Flow
13213   Polygon lock error                           During M-Utility operation, only error for the polygon signal (POKL, PONL) is detected.                                                   -
13214 Polygon rotation error During M-Utility operation, only error for the polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board is detected. -
13215 PLL function error During M-Utility operation, only error for the PLL function on the SCN12A board is detected. -
13216 Start-point interval error During M-Utility operation, only error for the start-point interval function on the SCN12A board is detected. -
13217 High-voltage power supply error During M-Utility operation, only error for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH, HVOKL) is detected. MT-99
                                                     During M-Utility operation, only error for the high-voltage command value diagnostics signal on the SCN12A board is
13218   High-voltage command value error
                                                     detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                               -
13225 Reading status error During M-Utility operation, only error for the VSYNC signal on the SCN12A board is detected. -
13226 Operation line status error During M-Utility operation, only error for the SEDTM/FCLKTMSED signal on the SCN12A board is detected. -
13227 Reading IP size error The IP of the size other than the input size is inserted for shading correction of the M-Utility, so that error is detected. -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                               [2.]   MT-38
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                  MT-39
Error                                                                                                                                                                                   Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                     Flow
                                                     • The start-point mask signal issued from the SCN12A board varies by 0.02%, peak to peak.
13240   Start-point mask signal warning
                                                     • The detection of 12241 error is done with 2% variations.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
                                                     • The FCLK signal issued from the SCN12A board varies by 0.05%, peak to peak.
13260   Main-scan interval warning
                                                     • The detection of 14261 or 14262 error is done with 0.2% variations.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
                                                     This error occurs when the surrounding temperature around the machine changes drastically.
                                                     Note that with software version A06 or earlier, even if this error occurs only once, it will be logged every time the machine is
                                                     booted, due to its software bug.
13270   LDIF MAX update                              To reset this error, execute "INITIALIZE" of "[8-1] BACKUP MEMORY" in M-Utility.                                                       -
                                                     During bootup self-diagnostic checks, it is detected that the LD drive current value varies by more than 5 mA. In order to
                                                     adjust the insufficient amount of light due to degraded LD (to maintain the same amount of light), it is necessary to vary the
                                                     LD drive current by more than 5 mA.
13289 Format adjustment calculation result error In M-Utility, when image format adjustments are performed, the adjustment result is out of normal range. -
13314 Cassette detection logic error During routine processing, the SA2 is CLOSE (the cassette is detected), but the SA1 is OPEN (the shutter is closed). MT-85
                                                     During cassette ejection, because the status of the sensor SA4 changes upon demagnetization of the motor that drives the
13326   HP return error during ejection
                                                     IP removal unit, home-positioning of the IP removal unit is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
                                                     This error may occur during bootup, as the belt of the subscanning unit is stiffened because the machine is not in use for a
                                                     long time (e.g., the power remains OFF since the pervious day in the wintertime).
13355   Subscanning grip speed data update
                                                     During bootup and routine processing, the grip time for the driving shaft grip deviates by ±3% relative to its specified value,
                                                                                                                                                                                          MT-64
                                                     and the SZ2 transitions to OPEN, so that speed correction processing is performed.
                                                     During bootup, when the conveyance-related backup memory information is checked, the result indicates that it has been
13386   Conveyance CMOS cleared
                                                     cleared.
                                                                                                                                                                                            -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                           [2.]    MT-39
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                           MT-40
Error                                                                                                                                                                            Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                              Flow
                                                    During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure the length of the hole
13391   Dust removal mechanism lock (1)
                                                    (x2) of the drive gear, but the SZ5 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                   MT-69
                                                    During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure the length of the hole
13392   Dust removal mechanism lock (2)
                                                    (x2) of the drive gear, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified period of time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                                                   MT-69
                                                    During bootup, SZ5 detects the transition from CLOSE to OPEN to CLOSE when the length of the hole (x2) of the drive gear
                                                    is measured, but the OPEN state cannot be detected.
13395   Dust removal mechanism lock (3)
                                                    Because the drive gear is engaged with the worm gear too tight, the locked condition occurs (MZ3 stops) before the dust
                                                                                                                                                                                   MT-69
                                                    removal operation is completed.
13405 Symbol table creation failure The table used to register the function to the OS on the CPU12A board cannot be created. 8
13411 Serviceman reading mode The erasure conveyance mode has been entered, or the erasure conveyance mode has been exited. -
13501 Connection monitoring Com-Break detection The communication between the CL and RU is disconnected. -
13502 Connection monitoring Com-Down detection Because no response is returned from the destination, the connection is disconnected once and connected again. -
13503 Network connection error Network connection is checked from the RU, but there is no response. -
13504 ping execution error In M-Utility, ping is executed, but an error results due to improper input value. -
13505 Image data retransmission The RU has retransmitted the image data to the CL -
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                      [2.]   MT-40
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                MT-41
Error                                                                                                                                                                                 Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                   Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                   Flow
                                                   The main CPU has read the image data of the specified size, but the sub-CPU (image processing CPU) does not become
13506   Image data count mismatch                  idle, so that the image data is not transmitted.                                                                                       -
                                                   The RU software automatically broke the connection with the RU and then retransmitted the image.
                                                   The CL was too late receiving the image data sent from the RU, so that the image was retransmitted from the RU.
13507   CL image data receive timeout              The network is overloaded, or a communication error occurs due to hardware failure of the network, thereby causing frequent            -
                                                   retries. It is therefore supposed that the receiving process of the CL is delayed.
                                                   <Software error>
                                                   When the software version is A07, this error may be detected under incorrect conditions. If no image abnormality exists
                                                   when software version A07 is used, no remedial action needs to be taken.
                                                   <Occurrence Condition>
13508   Erasure lamp confirmation warning
                                                   During bootup or during routine processing, the erasure lamp that is lit is turned off, before the software instructs the end of
                                                                                                                                                                                         6.4
                                                   erasure, while in the IP erasure mode.
                                                   The erasure of the IP that was processed at that time is incomplete, so that if an exposure is performed using that IP, images
                                                   are overlapped.
        IP loading before erasure initialization   Log indicating the IP processing under condition where, during bootup, the mechanical/scanner/electrical diagnostics are
13738   completion                                 completed, but initialization of the erasure unit is not completed.
                                                                                                                                                                                          -
13800 Backup SRAM test error An error is detected for the backup SRAM test in electrical utility. 8
13801 SDRAM test error An error is detected for the SDRAM test in electrical utility. 8
                                                   <Service Procedure>
                                                   This error occurs when a combination of main CPU APPL version of A05 or later and IPL version of A01 has been installed.
13802   Checksum error                             It also occurs when a combination of main CPU APPL version of A04 or earlier and IPL version of A02 has been installed.               8
                                                   <Occurrence Condition>
                                                   The data in the flash ROM (IPL or APPL portion) of the RU is corrupted.
13803 Flash ROM read/write error An error is detected for the read/write test of the flash ROM in the electrical utility. 8
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                        [2.]      MT-41
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                               MT-42
Error                                                                                                                                                                Analysis
                          Error Name                                                         Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                  Flow
                                        <Service Procedure>
                                        This error occurs when the version of the RU application software is updated from any version earlier than A04 to version
13804   CPU12A interrupt error          A05 or later, but the backup memory/error log/trace log is not initialized.                                                     8
                                        <Occurrence Condition>
                                        An error is detected for the CPU12A interrupt test in electrical utility.
13805 Network register error An error is detected for the network register check in electrical utility. 8
13806 SCN12A register test error An error is detected for the register read/write test on the SCN12A. 8
13807 SCN12A interrupt error An error is detected for the SCN12A interrupt test in electrical utility. 8
13808 SCN12A H8 communication error An error is detected for the communication test with H8 of the SCN12A in electrical utility. 8
13809 SND12A board register error An error is detected for the SND12A register test in electrical utility. 8
13810 Sensor test error An error is detected for the sensor test in electrical utility. 8
13811 Panel LED error An error is detected for the panel LED test in electrical utility. 8
13812 Solenoid error An error is detected for the solenoid test in electrical utility. 8
13813 Pulse motor error An error is detected for the pulse motor test in electrical utility. 8
13814 SND12A board interrupt error An error is detected for the SND12A interrupt test in electrical utility. 8
13815 INV12A register error An error is detected for the INV12A register check in electrical utility. 8
13816 Erasure lamp test error An error is detected for the erasure lamp test in electrical utility. 8
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                     [2.]   MT-42
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                MT-43
Error                                                                                                                                                                                 Analysis
                        Error Name                                                                        Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                   Flow
13817   Image processing CPU SDRAM test error         An error is detected for the image processing CPU SDRAM test in electrical utility.                                                8
13818 Image processing FIFO test error An error is detected for the image processing CPU FIFO test in electrical utility. 8
13819 Barcode communication error An error is detected for the barcode communication test in electrical utility. 8
13820 Barcode data read test error An error is detected for the barcode reading test in electrical utility. 8
13821 Power supply monitoring register error An error is detected for the power supply monitoring register check in electrical utility. 8
        Reset cancel error during image processing    During bootup, the reset state of the sub-CPU of the CPU12A board is canceled, but a timeout error occurs, still in the reset
14101   CPU initialization                            state.
                                                                                                                                                                                         8
        Timeout error during image processing CPU     During bootup, the reset state of the sub-CPU of the CPU12A board is canceled, but a timeout error occurs, still in the reset
14102   initialization                                state.
                                                                                                                                                                                         8
                                                      During bootup, the reset state of the sub-CPU of the CPU12A board is canceled, but a timeout error occurs in the control
        Control program area error during image
14103   processing CPU initialization
                                                      program area error state (image processing APPL checksum error is detected), while waiting for a predetermined period of           8
                                                      time until the status of the sub-CPU becomes idle.
                                                      During bootup, because the sub-CPU on the CPU12A board is booted normally, a test command for FIFO (memory for
        FIFO test error during image processing CPU
14104   initialization
                                                      transaction of image data from the sub-CPU) is sent to the sub-CPU to execute diagnostics, but an error is found in 32770          8
                                                      counts of data received by the main CPU.
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                       [2.]    MT-43
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                              MT-44
Error                                                                                                                                                                               Analysis
                       Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                 Flow
        Image memory test error during image         During bootup, because the sub-CPU on the CPU12A board is booted normally, an image memory test command is sent to
14105   processing CPU initialization                the sub-CPU to execute diagnostics, but an error results.
                                                                                                                                                                                       8
        SCN bus test error during image processing   During device initialization, the sub-CPU boots normally, but the sub-CPU detects an error as a result of performing an
14106   initialization (1)                           image data transfer test from the SCN12A board to the sub-CPU on the CPU12A board by use of the image data test path.
                                                                                                                                                                                       6.3
        SCN bus test error during image processing   During device initialization, the sub-CPU boots normally, but the sub-CPU detects an error as a result of performing an
14107   initialization (2)                           image data transfer test from the SCN12A board to the sub-CPU on the CPU12A board by use of the image data test path.
                                                                                                                                                                                       6.3
        Abort error during image processing CPU      During bootup, the sub-CPU that is in the reset state is reset-canceled by software, but the status of the sub-CPU times out
14108   initialization                               waiting for the idle state. Or, the status of the sub-CPU becomes uncontrollable.
                                                                                                                                                                                       8
                                                     During routine processing, in order to execute image processing, an image memory clear command, image processing
14122   Image processing CPU sequence error          command, image reoutput command, etc. are sent to the sub-CPU on the CPU12A board, but a sequence error is detected               6.3
                                                     by the main CPU.
                                                     During routine processing, because an IP is loaded, an image processing command or image reoutput command is sent to
14123   Image processing CPU parameter error         the image processing section to execute the processing, but the sub-CPU detects a parameter error. (The image processing          8
                                                     section detects an out-of-spec command.)
                                                     During routine processing, because an IP is loaded, an image processing command or image reoutput command is sent to
        Image processing CPU out-of-spec command
14124   error
                                                     the image processing section to execute the processing, but the sub-CPU detects a parameter error. (The image processing          8
                                                     section detects an out-of-spec command.)
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                        [2.]    MT-44
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                      MT-45
Error                                                                                                                                                                                       Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                       Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                         Flow
                                                        During routine processing, because an IP is loaded, an image processing command or image reoutput command is sent to
14125   Image processing CPU command reject error
                                                        the image processing section to execute the processing, but the sub-CPU reports the reject status.
                                                                                                                                                                                                8
14211 PMT analog power supply error during bootup During bootup and routine processing, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is detected. MT-99
                                                        During bootup, error is detected for the PLL function, polygon rotation function, and start-point interval function on the            14.2
14241   Scanner control board error during bootup (1)
                                                        SCN12A board.                                                                                                                         14.3
                                                        During bootup, because the PMT high-voltage value is not set correctly on the SCN12A board, error is detected for the high-
14242   Scanner control board error during bootup (2)
                                                        voltage command diagnostics.
                                                                                                                                                                                              14.5
        Photomultiplier control board error during      During bootup, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is detected (detail code: 008200).
14251   bootup (1)                                      Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 008000.
                                                                                                                                                                                              MT-99
                                                        During bootup, error for the polygon lock signal (PONL, POKL) is detected so that the polygonal mirror function is disabled.
14261   Polygon rotation error (1)
                                                        The start-point detection (SYN) and leading-edge detection (SED) are also disabled (detail code: D03403).
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-100
                                                        • During bootup, the laser (LDD) and start-point detection (SYN) functions are disabled due to blow of the fuse (H13 on the
                                                        SCN board) or laser failure (detail code: 815403).
                                                        • During bootup, the laser (LDD), start-point detection (SYN), and leading-edge detection (SED) functions are disabled due to
14271   Laser unlit error during bootup
                                                        blow of the fuse (H13 on the SCN board) or laser failure (detail code: C15403).
                                                                                                                                                                                             MT-102
                                                        • During bootup, error for the laser drive current value (LDIF) occurs and the start-point detection (SYN) and leading-edge
                                                        detection (SED) functions are disabled due to blow of the fuse (H13 on the SCN board) or laser failure (detail code: C04003).
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                             [2.]   MT-45
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                      MT-46
Error                                                                                                                                                                                       Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                       Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                         Flow
                                                         • During bootup, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) function, and error for the PLL function and polygon
                                                         rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 801C03). Alternatively, the disabled state of the
                                                         start-point detection (SYN) function and error for the PLL function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 800C03).
14281   Start-point detection error during bootup (1)    Alternatively, during routine processing, the disabled state of the start-point-detection (SYN) function, and error for the PLL      MT-95
                                                         function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 801401).
                                                         • During bootup, the start-point detection (SYN) function is disabled (detail code: 801402). Alternatively, the start-point
                                                         detection (SSH, SSL) cannot be performed (detail code: 800002).
                                                         During bootup, only error for the start-point interval function on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 000400).
14282   Start-point detection error during bootup (2)    Alternatively, error for the start-point interval function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board is            14.3
                                                         detected (detail code: 001400).
                                                         During bootup, the laser (LDD), start-point detection (SYN), and leading-edge detection (SED) functions are disabled due to
14283   Scanning optics unit board error During bootup
                                                         laser failure or disconnected connector (detail code: C05401).
                                                                                                                                                                                              MT-97
                                                         <Service Procedure>
                                                         This error occurs when the version of the M-Utility is checked or error log backup is executed during RU bootup.
14295   Scanner send/receive error                       <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                                6.3
                                                         During bootup, routine processing, or maintenance utility, control communication is conducted between the CPU12A board
                                                         and SCN12A board, but scanner unit error is detected, so that control communication is not completed normally.
                                                         During bootup, routine processing, or maintenance utility, communication between the CPU12A board and SCN12A board
14296   Scanner transmission sum check error
                                                         can be established, but sum check error from the SCN12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                               6.3
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                            [2.]   MT-46
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                   MT-47
Error                                                                                                                                                                                    Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                    Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow
                                                      During bootup, routine processing, or maintenance utility, communication between the CPU12A board and SCN12A board
14297   Scanner receive size error
                                                      can be established, but data size error from the SCN12A board is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                                            6.3
                                                      During routine processing, because the scanner-related error is detected, the IP is returned to the cassette and the scanner
14298   Before-reading scanner retry error
                                                      is initialized.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-96
                                                      For self-diagnostics prior to reading during routine processing, a combination of errors that should not have logically occurred
14299   Error for scanner, etc.
                                                      were generated.
                                                                                                                                                                                             -
                                                      <User Operation>
                                                      This error occurs when the cassette is inserted without being closely aligned to the reference plane or inserted aslant relative
                                                      to the reference plane.
14310   Cassette hold failure retry
                                                      <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-72
                                                      During routine processing, the SA2 transitions to CLOSE, and after the SolA1 is turned OFF, the SA3 transitions to CLOSE,
                                                      so that retries (within five times) are performed.
                                                      <User Operation>
                                                      This error occurs when the cassette is pulled in the cassette hold non-released condition.
14312   Cassette hold release failure retry           <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                               MT-72
                                                      During routine processing, the SolA1 is turned ON to release the cassette hold, but the SA3 does not transition to CLOSE
                                                      within the specified period of time, so that retries (within five times) are performed.
        Suction cup HP detection preparation          During bootup or routine processing, the MA1 is driven (clockwise), but the SA4 does not transition to CLOSE within the
14315   positioning retry                             specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-60
        Suction cup HP detection preparation return   During bootup or routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise), but the SA4 does not transition to OPEN within
14316   retry                                         the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-60
                                                      During bootup or routine processing, the MA1 is driven (one-pulse driving) for home positioning, but the SA4 does not
14317   Suction cup HP detection retry
                                                      transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-60
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]      MT-47
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                   MT-48
Error                                                                                                                                                                                    Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                      Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow
                                                         <User Operation>
                                                         This error occurs when the cassette containing no IP is inserted.
14319   Feed IP suction failure retry                    <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                            MT-74
                                                         During routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) and the PA1 is turned ON to perform IP feed leak, but the
                                                         SA5 transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                         During bootup and routine processing, the MA1 and MB1 are driven (clockwise) to feed the IP from the cassette, but the SA5
14320   Feed IP drop retry
                                                         transitions to OPEN at the time when the IP is gripped by the rollers, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-74
                                                         During bootup and routine processing, the MB1 is driven (clockwise) to perform IP feed leak and conveyance, but the SB1
14321   Feed IP grip failure retry
                                                         transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-74
                                                         During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to perform IP high-speed conveyance, but the SC3
14322   Feed conveyance retry
                                                         transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-74
                                                         During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to determine the IP size, but the SB1 transitions to
14323   Length-measurement conveyance retry
                                                         OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-76
                                                         During routine processing, because an attempt to read the barcode for feed conveyance fails, retries (within three times) are
14324   Barcode reading retry
                                                         performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-87
                                                         During bootup or routine processing, the MC1 is driven (one-pulse driving) to perform home positioning, but the SC1 does
14333   Side-positioning HP detection retry
                                                         not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                           MT-61
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                        [2.]     MT-48
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                                    MT-49
Error                                                                                                                                                                                     Analysis
                         Error Name                                                                       Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                                       Flow
        Side-positioning grip HP detection preparation
14336   return retry
                                                         During bootup or routine processing, the MC2 is driven (clockwise), but the SC2 does not transition to OPEN.                       MT-62
                                                         During bootup or routine processing, the MC2 is driven (one-pulse driving) to perform home positioning, but the SC2 does
14337   Side-positioning grip HP detection retry
                                                         not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-62
                                                         During bootup or routine processing, the SolZ1 is turned ON to protrude the stopper, but the SZ4 does not transition to
14340   IP stopper protrusion retry
                                                         OPEN, so that retries (within five times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-63
                                                         During bootup, routine processing, U-Utility dust removal operation, and shutdown processing, the SolZ1 is turned OFF to
14341   IP stopper retreat retry
                                                         retreat the stopper, but the SZ4 does not transition to CLOSE, so that retries (within 5 times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-63
                                                         During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driving shaft, but the SZ2 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN, so that a
14346   Driving shaft grip error
                                                         retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-64
                                                         During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driven shaft, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE,
14347   Driven shaft grip error
                                                         so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                         During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to release both grips, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE, so
14348   Both grip release error
                                                         that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-64
                                                         During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release the driven shaft grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to OPEN, so that a retry
14349   Driven shaft grip release error
                                                         (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-66
                                                         During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ2 does not transition to OPEN, so that a retry (within one
14354   Initialization grip movement (1) error
                                                         time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-64
                                                         During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE or the SZ3 does not
14355   Initialization grip movement (2) error
                                                         transition to CLOSE, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            MT-64
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                           [2.]   MT-49
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                      MT-50
Error                                                                                                                                                                       Analysis
                         Error Name                                                         Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                         Flow
                                            During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform ejection grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE,
14356   Ejection grip error
                                            so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                              MT-66
                                            During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform no-load running, but the SZ3 does not transition to
14357   No-load running error
                                            OPEN, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                              MT-66
                                            During routine processing, the PA1 is tuned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load the IP into the cassette, but
14372   Load IP suction failure retry
                                            the SA5 transitions to OPEN within the specified period of time, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                              MT-82
                                            During routine processing, the PA1 is turned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load the IP into the cassette,
14373   Load IP drop retry
                                            but the SA5 transitions to OPEN at the time when the IP is released, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                              MT-82
                                            Because 11731, 11732, 11737, 11751, 11757, or 11767 occurs so that temperature control is disabled, the mode shifts to
18740   Inerasable cassette ejection
                                            the no-erasure mode with a message displayed. The IP that is read while in the no-erasure mode is not erased.
                                                                                                                                                                                -
                                            Because 12736, 12756, or 12766 occurs so that a single lamp is unlit, the mode shifts to the erasure time extension mode
18741   Incomplete erasure                  where the erasure time is extended twice. The IP that is read while in the erasure time extension mode is erased with the          6.4
                                            extended erasure time.
                                            12733 or 12753 occurs, and the temperature sensor (TSB1) detects an abnormal level of temperature.
18742   Erasure temporarily disabled mode   • The mode temporarily shifts to the no-erasure mode.                                                                               -
                                            • The IP that is read while in the no-erasure mode is not erased.
19030 Driver registration error A driver cannot be registered to the OS on the CPU12A board. 8
19031 Driver unregistered During bootup, a device is created without registering its driver on the CPU12A board. 8
19032 Device creation error During bootup and routine processing, an OS system call fails. 8
                                            During bootup and routine processing, a FPMC driver error status is detected for the communication from the SNS12A board
19034   FPMC error
                                            to the CPU12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                               6.2
19038 Image processing CPU status error During bootup and routine processing, the main CPU detects an error in the status of the sub-CPU. 8
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                          [2.]   MT-50
   2. Error Code Table                                                                                                                                                       MT-51
Error                                                                                                                                                                        Analysis
                         Error Name                                                      Occurrence Condition
Code                                                                                                                                                                          Flow
                                      When an attempt is made to operate a motor or the like during bootup or routine processing, the specified device cannot be
19039   Device open error
                                      opened.
                                                                                                                                                                                8
19080 OS system call error (1) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19081 OS system call error (2) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19082 OS system call error (3) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19083 OS system call error (4) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19084 OS system call error (5) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19085 OS system call error (6) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19086 OS system call error (7) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19087 OS system call error (8) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19088 OS system call error (9) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19089 OS system call error (10) During bootup or maintenance utility bootup, an OS system call fails. 8
19090 Software logic error An abnormal case that is unthinkable for the RU software is encountered. 8
19091 Error returned by driver A return signal of the driver called by the application is an error. The detail of the error is notified within the driver software. 8
19094 Socket error A network connection between the RU and CL is established. Various types of error occur for the socket communication. 6.1
  010-051-06
  04.20.2002 FM3386                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                              [2.]    MT-51
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 MT - 52
                                                                                                                                           RU operation status
                                                                                                                                        Display            S (Start)                      B (Busy)                    I (Idle)
                                                                                                                                       Meaning      An error occurred            An error occurred           An error occurred while
                                                                                                                                                    immediately after startup    during IP conveyance        the RU is in idle state.
                                                                                                                                                    of the RU.                   or during IP
                                                                                                                                                                                 processing.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 TR6H2543.EPS
TR6H2544.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                         REFERENCE
             • T00: Conveyance-related log                                                                                                                         If there is no sub-error code, the sub-error code field displays “– – – – –”.
               For the conveyance-related log, the IP size, type (IP type), IP generation information, and
               barcode information are displayed.                                                                                                                  • T02: Configuration-related log
                                         IP generation
                                                                                                                                                                       For the configuration-related log, the configuration error file name, error occurrence source line
                                         information                                                                                                                   number, and detail data are displayed.
  14"x14"        1414 or 3535               **        BCR reading error        Not available           --------    No barcode was found.
  14"x17"        1417 or 3543               —         No BCR
  Unread         --------
  --------       The size could
                 not be read.
TR6H2545.EPS
3.2        Detail Codes for Scanner Errors                                                                            ■ Meaning of Six-Digit Detail Code
                                                                                                                               To each bit of a six-digit detail code is assigned an object to be checked during error check, so that
           Scanner errors are detected by checking a plurality of scanner I/O states and finding a combination                 a bit value of “1” indicates that the object to checked is in error.
           of defects and/or failures.
                                                                                                                               Six digits of detail code
           Each I/O status at the time of error occurrence can be identified by checking the detail code in the
           error log.                                                                                                              1     2   3    4        5       6        A        0          D           F        0              3
           The detail code is displayed in six hexadecimal digits, located in the error log as shown below.
                                                                                                                                       NO.       Object to be checked              Signal source                              Value of bit
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Hexadecimal
           Error code                                                                                                                    1   Start-point detection sensor       SYN12A board                              1     2       3      4
             12256 2000.10.07 13:12:19 00257D tiphscan____                                                                               2   Leading-edge detection sensor      SED12A board                    0         0     0       0      0
                                                                                                                                   1
                  3D0004 ScnCmFnc.c 2817                                                                                                 3   Start-point mask signal            SCN12A board                    1         0     0       0      1
             12255 2000.10.07 13:12:10 00258D tiphscan____
                                                                                                                                         4   Polygon index                      POL (polygon)                   2         0     0       1      0
                  3D0004 400000,00 00 00 609C 6098
                                                                                                                                         1                     –                         –                      3         0     0       1      1
                    Detail code
                                                                                                                                         2                     –                         –                      4         0     1       0      0
                                                  FR6H2521.EPS                                                                     2
                                                                                                                                         3                     –                         –                      5         0     1       0      1
                                                                                                                                         4   LD drive current                   LDD12A board                    6         0     1       1      0
                                                                                                                                         1   PMT analog power supply            PMT12A board                    7         0     1       1      1
                                                                                                                                         2   Laser light intensity error        LDD12A board                    8         1     0       0      0
                                                                                                                                   3
                                                                                                                                         3   Polygon lock                       POL (polygon)                   9         1     0       0      1
                                                                                                                                         4   Polygon rpm                        SCN12A board                    A         1     0       1      0
                                                                                                                                         1   PLL function                       SCN12A board                    B         1     0       1      1
                                                                                                                                         2   Start-point period                 SYN12A board                    C         1     1       0      0
                                                                                                                                   4
                                                                                                                                         3   High-voltage power supply          PMT12A board                    D         1     1       0      1
                                                                                                                                         2                     –                         –
                                                                                                                                   5
                                                                                                                                         3                     –                         –
                                                                                                                                         4                     –                         –
                                                                                                                                         1                     –                         –
                                                                                                                                         2                     –                         –
                                                                                                                                   6
                                                                                                                                         3   Reading status error               SCN12A board
                                                                                                                                         4   Operation line status error        SCN12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                             TR6H2024.EPS
                                                                                                                      ■ Analysis Flow
4.         Error Code Analysis Flow (Mechanism)
                                                                                                                                             Check the error log in M-Utility.
During bootup, the remaining IP is ejected, but sensors having physically inconsistent IP sensor “1.2 How to Understand Error Log”
           results (the CLOSE state of both SB1 and SC3, or the CLOSE state of SB1, SC3, and SC4) are                  Power supply error                    N
           detected. Alternatively, even though the cassette ejection is detected (the OPEN state of SA1), the         (12810-12893) occurs?
           cassette insertion is detected (the CLOSE state of SA2) or the cassette hold status (the CLOSE                                Y
           state of SA3) is detected.                                                                                                                                                      [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                             Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                             and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
10302 Broken wire sensor detected                                                                                                                “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           During bootup, the result of IP search detects the presence of an IP, but the backup memory
           information indicates that there is no IP in the machine. The backup memory has a record
           indicating that the IP conveyance was performed before power recovery.                                                                                      1
                                          IP sensor SC4                                                                                                             Sensors SB1, SC3, and SC4             N                                 Replace the sensor.
                                                                                                                                                                    normal?                                                                     “Service Parts List Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                       Y         “11. Checking the Sensors”
                                          Side-positioning conveyor                                                                                                                                       N
                                                                                                                                                                    Error recurs?                                                   1
                                          C unit
                                                                                                                                                                                       Y
                                                                                                                                                                                           Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                                                                                                                                            1. SNS12A
                                                                                                                                                                                            2. DRV12A
    IP sensor SC3
                                                                                                                                                                                            3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                            4. MTH12A
FR6H2223.EPS
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                           Y
                                                                                                                                                                                            [Preparation procedures]
                                                         Suction cup HP sensor                                                                Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                    Cassette set unit
                                                                                                                                              and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                                    A unit               SA4
                                                               IP sensor                                                                          “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
        Cassette ejection sensor                               SB1
                            SA1      M                              Barcode reader
                                                                                                                                                                        1
                                                                  M
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                     Voltage on the CPU12A and                                             Replace the power supply.
                          Hold sensor                                 Transport motor                                                                                DRV12A board normal?                                                      “Check, Replacement, and
                                 SA3                                  MB1                                                                                                                                                                      Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                        Y         “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                           Cassette IN sensor                                                                                                                                                     on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”         11.8 Power Supply”
                                         SA2                                                                                                                                                                                               Replace the sensor.
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                     Each sensor normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               “Service Parts List Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                        Y         “11. Checking the Sensors”                   and “Check, Replacement,
                                         FRONT                        Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                                                         and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                      B unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N          Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                     CPU12A, and SNS12A boards                                                             N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      and check if the error occurs
                                                                                                                                                                     tested in M-Utility normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   1
                                                                                                                                                                                        Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Y
                                                                                                                                                                                              “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                      Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                      C unit                                                                                         Error recurs after M-Utility          N                                   “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                     backup memory initialization?                    END                      and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                             M                                                                                                                                                         Y                                                       “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                 M                                                                                                                                            “Maintenance Utility Volume
                                                                                                                                                                                              3. [8] BACKUP MEMORY”
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                     Error recurs?                                     1
                                                          M                                                                                                                             Y
                                                                  M
                                                              M                                                                                                                             Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                                                                                                                                             1. SNS12A
                                                                                                                                                                                             2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                             3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                             4. MTH12A
       Subscanning unit
       Z unit                                                                                                                                                                                   “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                         FR6H2205.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                “11.7 MTH12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   FR6H2419.EPS
                                                                                                                                                          1
                                                        Side-positioning conveyor                                                                                                            N
                                                                                                                                                       Voltage on the CPU12A and                                             Replace the power supply.
                                                        C unit                                                                                         DRV12A board normal?                                                      “Check, Replacement, and
    Subscanning motor                                                                                                                                                                                                            Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                          Y         “9.1 Checking the Voltage
    MZ1                                                                                                                                                                             on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”         11.8 Power Supply”
                         M
                                     M                                                                                                                CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                                                        and check if the error occurs
                                                                                                                                                      boards tested in M-Utility normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                        again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     1
                                                                                                                                                                          Y         “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”        Y
                                                        Transport motor                                                                                                                                                      Replace the error-causing board.
                                            M           MC3                                                                                                                                                                      “Check, Replacement,
                                                    M                                                                                                                                                                            and Adjustment Volume”
                                                M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.6 DRV12A Board"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                            IP sensor
      Subscanning unit                                                                                                                                 Sensors SB1, SC3, and SC4             N                               Replace the sensor.
                                            SC3                            FR6H2222.EPS                                                                normal?
      Z unit                                                                                                                                                                                                                     “Service Parts List Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                “Maintenance Utility Volume
                                                                                                                                                                                3. [8] BACKUP MEMORY”
                                                                                                                                                                                             N
                                                                                                                                                       Error recurs?                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                          Y
12318 Suction cup HP return error “1.2 How to Understand Error Log”
           During bootup and routine processing, SA4 does not transition to CLOSE for suction cup HP                 Power supply error                    N
           check.                                                                                                    (12810-12893) occurs?
                                                                                                                                       Y
12326 HP return error during ejection                                                                                                                                                    [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                           Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
           During routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform suction cup home                                     and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
           positioning after the cassette is ejected, but the SA4 does not transition to CLOSE.                                                “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           During bootup or routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise), but the SA4 does not                                                                                                         Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                  CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N                                                          N
           transition to OPEN within the specified period of time.                                                                                                boards tested in M-Utility normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   and check if the error occurs
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   again.
           During bootup or routine processing, the MA1 is driven (one-pulse driving) for home positioning,                                                                                                                               Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              “Check, Replacement, and
           but the SA4 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.                                                                                                                                                                                Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              “11.2 CPU12A Board”
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                                                                                                                               “11.6 DRV12A Board"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              “11.5 SNS12A Board”
           During routine processing, the MC1 is driven (clockwise) to perform side-positioning home                Power supply error                    N
           positioning, but the SC1 does not transition to CLOSE.                                                   (12810-12893) occurs?
                                                                                                                                      Y
14331 Side-positioning HP detection preparation positioning retry                                                                                                                       [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                          Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
           During bootup or routine processing, the MC1 is driven (clockwise), but the SC1 does not transition                            and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
           to CLOSE.                                                                                                                          “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                                                                                                                       Y
14335 Side-positioning grip HP detection preparation positioning retry
                                                                                                                                                                                         [Preparation procedures]
           During bootup or routine processing, the MC2 is driven (counterclockwise), but the SC2 does not                                 Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                           and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
           transition to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                               “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           does not transition to OPEN, so that retries (within five times) are performed.                                                                                                                                                “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “11.2 CPU12A Board”
14341 IP stopper retreat retry                                                                                                                                                                                                            “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “11.5 SNS12A Board”
           During bootup, routine processing, U-Utility dust removal operation, and shutdown processing, the
           SolZ1 is turned OFF to retreat the stopper, but the SZ4 does not transition to CLOSE, so that                                                                                                N                             Replace the sensor SZ4.
                                                                                                                                                                  Sensors SZ4 normal?
           retries (within 5 times) are performed.                                                                                                                                                                                        “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                     Y         “11.3 Checking SZ2, SZ3,                   07D REF.13”
                                                                                                                                                                                               SZ4, and SZ5”
■ I/O Locations
                                                                                                                                                                                                        N                             Replace the solenoid SolZ1.
                                                                                                                                                                  Solenoid SolZ1 normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “Check, Replacement, and
                    FRONT                                                                                                                                                            Y         “13. Checking the Actuators”               Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          10.4 Solenoid (SolZ1)”
                            M                                                                                                                                     Error recurs?
                                                                                                                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1
                                           M
                                                                                                                                                                                     Y
    Subscanning unit                                          IP stopper HP sensor                                                                                                       Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                              SZ4                                                                                                                         1. SNS12A
    Z unit
                                                                                                                                                                                          2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                          3. CPU12A
                                                              IP stopper solenoid                                                                                                         4. MTH12A
                                                              SolZ1
                                                                              FR6H2204.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                             “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                             “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                             “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                             “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                             “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                               FR6H2425.EPS
10346, 10348, 10353, 10355, 12346, 12348, 12353, 13355,                                                               14348 Both grip release error
                                                                                                                               During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to release both grips, but the SZ2 does
14346, 14348, 14354, 14355                                                                                                     not transition to CLOSE, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
10346 Driving shaft grip error                                                                                        14354 Initialization grip movement (1) error
           During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driving shaft, but the SZ2 does not transition to OPEN                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ2 does not transition to OPEN,
           within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.                  so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
10348 Both grip release error                                                                                         14355 Initialization grip movement (2) error
           During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release both grips, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE                    During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ2 does not transition to CLOSE
           within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.                  or the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                     Y
                                                                                                                                                       [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                         Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                         and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                             “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
            Subscanning unit
            Z unit                                  FR6H2427.EPS                                                                   1
10347, 10349, 10354, 10356, 10357, 12347, 12349, 12352,                                                                 12355 Driving shaft grip malfunction
                                                                                                                                 During bootup and routine processing, because the grip time for the driving shaft grip deviates by
12354, 12355, 12356, 12357, 14347, 14349, 14356, 14357                                                                           ±6% relative to its specified value, speed correction processing and operation check are
                                                                                                                                 performed.
10347 Driven shaft grip error                                                                                           12356 Ejection grip error
           During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driven shaft, but the SZ3 does not transition to CLOSE                   During routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform ejection grip, but the SZ3 does not
           within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.                    transition to CLOSE. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
10349 Driven shaft grip release error
                                                                                                                        12357 No-load running error
           <Service Procedure>
                                                                                                                                 During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to perform no-load running, but the SZ3
           This error occurs when the version of the RU application software is updated from any version
                                                                                                                                 does not transition to OPEN. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results.
           earlier than A04 to version A05 or later, but the backup memory/error log/trace log is not initialized.
           <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                       14347 Driven shaft grip error
           During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release the driven shaft grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to                 During bootup and routine processing, the MZ2 is driven to grip the driven shaft, but the SZ3 does
           OPEN within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error                        not transition to CLOSE, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
           results.
                                                                                                                        14349 Driven shaft grip release error
10354 Initialization grip movement (1) error
                                                                                                                                 During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to release the driven shaft grip, but the SZ3 does not transition to
           During bootup, the MZ2 is driven to check the grip state, but the SZ3 does not transition to OPEN                     OPEN, so that a retry (within one time) is performed.
           within the specified period of time. Retries (two times or more) are performed, but error results
                                                                                                 Y
                                                                                                                                                   [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                     Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                     and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                         “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           Subscanning unit
           Z unit                               FR6H2432.EPS
                                                                                                                               1
                                                                                                                                                                     1
                                                                M
                                                                     Transport motor                                                                              Voltage on the CPU12A and            N                              Replace the power supply.
                                                                     MB1                                                                                          DRV12A board normal?                                                    “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                     Y         “9.1 Checking the Voltage                  and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                               on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”       11.8 Power Supply”
                                       IP sensor
                                            SB1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                  CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N                   and check if the error occurs      N
                                   FRONT                                                                                                                          boards tested in M-Utility normal?             again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               1
                                                                    Erasure conveyor                                                                                                 Y         “8. Board Tests                    Y
                                                                    B unit                                                                                                                     in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                          IP sensor                                                                                                                                                       “Check, Replacement,
                                                                          SC4                                                                                                                                                             and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                    Side-positioning conveyor                                                                                                          N                              Replace the sensor SB1.
                                                                                                                                                                  Sensors SB1 normal?
                                                                    C unit                                                                                                                                                                 “Service Parts List Volume:
   Subscanning motor                                                                                                                                                                 Y         “11.1 Checking SA1, SA2, SA3,               04B REF.25”
                                                                                                                                                                                               SA4, SA5, and SB1”
   MZ1
                         M                                                                                                                                        Motor MB1 normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                       N                              Replace the motor MB1.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “Check, Replacement,
                                           M                                                                                                                                         Y                                                    and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                               “12.1 Checking MA1 and MB1”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          6.10 Motor (MB1)”
10390, 10391, 10392, 10393, 12390, 12391, 12392, 12393,                                                              12394 Dust removal operation error (5)
                                                                                                                               During shutdown processing, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but
12394, 12395, 13391, 13392, 13395                                                                                              the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
10390 Dust removal operation error (1)                                                                               12395 Dust removal operation in low speed
            During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ5 does                 During bootup, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal operation, but the SZ5 does
            not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time.                                                       not transition from CLOSE to OPEN within the specified time (30 sec) in the low-speed operation
                                                                                                                               mode (from the large actuator hole to the small hole).
10391 Dust removal mechanism lock (1)
                                                                                                                     13391 Dust removal mechanism lock (1)
            During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure
            the length of the hole (x2) of the drive gear, but a mechanism lock results.                                       During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure
                                                                                                                               the length of the hole (x2) of the drive gear, but the SZ5 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN
            Subsequently, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ5 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN
                                                                                                                               within the specified period of time.
            within the specified period of time.
                                                                                                                     13392 Dust removal mechanism lock (2)
10392 Dust removal mechanism lock (2)
                                                                                                                               During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure
            During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to measure
                                                                                                                               the length of the hole (x2) of the drive gear, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE
            the length of the hole (x2) of the drive gear, but a mechanism lock results.
                                                                                                                               within the specified period of time.
            Subsequently, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise), but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE
            within the specified period of time.                                                                     13395 Dust removal mechanism lock (3)
                                                                                                                               During bootup, SZ5 detects the transition from CLOSE to OPEN to CLOSE when the length of the
10393 Dust removal operation error (4)
                                                                                                                               hole (x2) of the drive gear is measured, but the OPEN state cannot be detected.
            During bootup or U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform
                                                                                                                               Because the drive gear is engaged with the worm gear too tight, the locked condition occurs (MZ3
            home positioning, but the SZ5 does not transition from CLOSE to OPEN within the specified period
                                                                                                                               stops) before the dust removal operation is completed.
            of time.
                                                                                                                     ■ I/O Locations
12390 Dust removal operation error (1)
            During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal                                           FRONT
            operation, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                                               Dust removal motor
12391 Dust removal operation error (2)                                                                                                                                         MZ3
            During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (clockwise) to perform dust removal                                                                     Dust removal sensor
                                                                                                                                            M                                  SZ5
            operation, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE within the specified time (30 sec).
                                                                                                                                                             M
12392 Dust removal operation error (3)
                                                                                                                                                                                    Sensor                         Drive gear
            During U-Utility dust removal operation, the MZ3 is driven (counterclockwise) to perform dust                                                                            (SZ5)
            removal operation, but the SZ5 does not transition from OPEN to CLOSE.
010-051-06
010-051-06                                                                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                             [4.]            MT - 69
04.20.2002 FM3386
           FM3386 (1)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    MT - 70
■ Analysis Flow
                                                        A
                                                                                                                           FR6H2490.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                    Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                                                                                                                                     1. SNS12A
                                                                                                                                                                                     2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                     3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                     4. MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                                                       “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                       “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                       “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                       “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                       “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                          FR6H2491.EPS
10394
                                                                                                                                                                                        A
           FRONT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                        Dust removal motor                                                                              CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N                                                       N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       and check if the error occurs
                                                                        MZ3                                                                                             boards tested in M-Utility normal?             again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1
                                                                        Dust removal sensor
                            M
                                                M
                                                                        SZ5                                                                                                                 Y        “8. Board Tests                     Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                     in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.6 DRV12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 “11.5 SNS12A Board”
     Subscanning unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                              N                              Replace the sensor SZ5.
     Z unit                                                                                                                                                             Sensor SZ5 normal?
                                                                                  FR6H2444.EPS                                                                                                                                                    “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                            Y                                                     and Adjustment Volume:
■ Analysis Flow                                                                                                                                                                                      "11.3 Checking SZ2, SZ3,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  10.8 Sensor (SZ5)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                     SZ4, and SZ5”
                            Check the error log in M-Utility.                                                                                                                                                 N                              Replace the motor MZ3.
                                                                                                                                                                        Motor MZ3 CCW operation
                                                                                                                                                                        normal?                                                                   “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  and Adjustment Volume:
     The indicated error is at the          N                   Check the error code table again for the error                                                                              Y        “12.3 Checking MZ2 and MZ3”                  10.7 Motor (MZ3)”
     beginning of the error log?                                at the beginning, and troubleshoot.
           This error occurs when the cassette is pulled in the cassette hold non-released condition.                                                                                                      N                             Replace the sensor SA3.
                                                                                                                                                                     Sensor SA3 normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             “Service Parts List Volume:
           <Occurrence Condition>                                                                                                                                                       Y         “11.1 Checking SA1, SA2, SA3,              03C REF.6”
                                                                                                                                                                                                  SA4, SA5, and SB1”
           During routine processing, the SolA1 is turned ON to release the cassette hold, but the SA3 does
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
           not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time, so that retries (within five times) are                                                      Solenoid SolA1 normal?                                              Replace the solenoid SolA1.
           performed.                                                                                                                                                                   Y         “13. Checking the Actuators”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             5.5 Solenoid (SolA1)”
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                                                      Error recurs?
                                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       1
                                     Cassette set unit                                                                                                                                  Y
                                     A unit
           During routine processing, the SolA1 is turned ON to release the cassette hold, but the SA3 does          Power supply error                    N
           not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time. Retries (six times or more) are per-         (12810-12893) occurs?
           formed, but error results.                                                                                                  Y
                                                                                                                                                                                         [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                           Check the error code table again
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                            and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                                                                         1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                                                                         2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                                                               “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                     Cassette set unit
                                     A unit                                                                                                                          1
11319, 11320, 11321, 11322, 14319, 14320, 14321, 14322 ■ I/O Locations
           <User Operation>
           This error occurs when the cassette containing no IP is inserted.
           <Occurrence Condition>
           During routine processing, the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) and the PA1 is turned ON to
           perform IP feed leak, but the SA5 transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are                                                                                              Transport motor
                                                                                                                                                                                    M                   MC3
           performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                             M
                                                                                                                                                                                        M
14320 Feed IP drop retry
           During bootup and routine processing, the MA1 and MB1 are driven (clockwise) to feed the IP from
           the cassette, but the SA5 transitions to OPEN at the time when the IP is gripped by the rollers, so
           that a retry (within one time) is performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                            IP sensor
                                                                                                                                                                                            SC3
14321 Feed IP grip failure retry                                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H2448.EPS
           During bootup and routine processing, the MB1 is driven (clockwise) to perform IP feed leak and
           conveyance, but the SB1 transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
■ Analysis Flow A
                                                              Voltage on the CPU12A and             N                              Replace the power supply.                                                N                          Replace the sensor SC3.
                                                              DRV12A board normal?
                                                                                                                                                                      Sensor SC3 normal?
                                                                                                                                       “Check, Replacement,                                                                                “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                  Y                                                    and Adjustment Volume:                             Y        “11.2 Checking SC1, SC2, SC3,           05D REF.8”
                                                                                            “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                            on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”       11.8 Power Supply”                                          and SC4”
           conveyance, but the SB1 does not transition to CLOSE within the specified period of time (20 sec).                         Y                                           “2. Error Code Table”
                                                                                                                                            “1.2 How to Understand Error Log”
           During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to determine the IP size, but                                                          1
           the SB1 transitions to OPEN. Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error results.
                                                                                                                                                                 Voltage on the CPU12A and            N                              Replace the power supply.
14323 Length-measurement conveyance retry                                                                                                                        DRV12A board normal?                                                    “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         and Adjustment Volume:
           During routine processing, the MB1 and MC3 are driven (clockwise) to determine the IP size, but                                                                          Y         “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                                              on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”
           the SB1 transitions to OPEN, so that retries (within three times) are performed.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                 CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N                                                      N
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                                                  boards tested in M-Utility normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                and check if the error occurs
                                                                                                                                                                                                                again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                    Y         “8. Board Tests
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Y
                                                                                                                                                                                              in M-Utility”
                                    M                                                                                                                                                                                                Replace the error-causing board.
                                         Transport motor                                                                                                                                                                                 “Check, Replacement,
                                         MB1                                                                                                                                                                                             and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.6 DRV12A Board”
          IP sensor                                                                                                                                                                                                                      “11.5 SNS12A Board”
               SB1
                                                                                                                                                                                                       N                             Replace the sensor SB1.
                                                                                                                                                                 Sensor SB1 normal?
     FRONT                                                                                                                                                                                                                               “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                    Y         “11.1 Checking SA1, SA2, SA3,              04B REF.25”
                                        Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                                      SA4, SA5, and SB1”
                                        B unit                                                                                                                                                         N                             Replace the motor MB1.
                                                                                                                                                                 Motor MB1 normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                    Y         “12.1 Checking MA1 and MB1”                and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         6.10 Motor (MB1)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                       N
                                                                                                                                                                 Motor MC3 normal?                                                   Replace the motor MC3.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement,
                                        Side-positioning conveyor                                                                                                                   Y         "12.2 Checking MC1, MC2,                   and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                              and MC3”                                   7.8 Motor (MC3)”
                                        C unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                       N
                                                                                                                                                                 Error recurs?                                     1
                                                                                                                                                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                     Y
                                                                                                                                                                                       [Preparation procedures]
   Subscanning motor                                                                                                                     Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
   MZ1                                                                                                                                   and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                          M                                                                                                                  “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                           M
                                                                                                                                                                   1
                                                                                                                                              Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                [Preparation procedures]
                                                                       M                                                                          Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                                  and troubleshoot.
                                                                                Transport motor                                                                                                 2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                                                                      “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                                                                MB1
     FRONT
                                                                                                                                                                 1
                                       Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                                            N                 Replace the power supply.
                                       B unit                                                                                                                 Voltage on the CPU12A and
                                                                                                                                                              DRV12A board normal?                                       “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Volume: 11.8 Power Supply”
                                       IP sensor                                                                                                                                 Y         “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                       SC4                                                                                                                                                 on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”
           During routine processing, the PA1 is turned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load                              Y
           the IP into the cassette, but the SA5 transitions to OPEN within the specified period of time.                                    Check the error code table again
                                                                                                                                                                                           [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                                                                           1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
           Retries (four times or more) are performed, but error results.                                                                    and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                                                                                                                                                 “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           During routine processing, the PA1 is tuned ON and the MA1 is driven (counterclockwise) to load                                                          CPU12A, DRV12A, and SNS12A N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   and check if the error occurs
           the IP into the cassette, but the SA5 transitions to OPEN within the specified period of time, so that                                                   boards tested in M-Utility normal?             again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1
           retries (within three times) are performed.                                                                                                                                 Y         “8. Board Tests
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                 in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                 and SB1”
                                    Cassette set unit                                                                                                                                                    N                 Replace the sensor SA5.
                                    A unit                                                                                                                          Sensors SA5 normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               “Check, Replacement,
      Suction cup drive motor MA1                                                                                                                                                      Y         “11.1 Checking SA1,           and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                      Suction pump                                                                                                                                             5.8 Suction Sensor (SA5)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                 SA2, SA3, SA4, SA5,
                                    M                                 PA1                                                                                                                        and SB1”
                                                                                                                                                                                                         N                 Replace the motor MA1.
                                                                                                                                                                    Motor MA1 normal?
                                                                        Suction sensor                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement, and
                                                                                                                                                                                       Y         “12.1 Checking MA1            Adjustment Volume:
                                                                        SA5
                                                                 M                                                                                                                               and MB1”                      5.11 Motor (MA1)”
       Subscanning unit
                                                                                                                                                                                             Replace the boards in the order named.
       Z unit
                                                                                                                                                                                              1. SNS12A
                                                                                          FR6H2205.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                              2. DRV12A
                                                                                                                                                                                              3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                              4. MTH12A
■ I/O Locations Y
                                                                                                                                         Y
                                M                                                                                                                                                          [Preparation procedures]
                                                  M                                                                                          Check the error code table again              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
   Subscanning motor                                                                                                                         and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
   MZ1                                                                                                                                           “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
           During routine processing, because an attempt to read the barcode for feed conveyance fails,                   Power supply error                    N
           retries (within three times) are performed.                                                                    (12810-12893) occurs?
                                                                                                                                            Y
■ I/O Locations                                                                                                                                 Check the error code table again
                                                                                                                                                                                              [Preparation procedures]
                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Secure space for servicing the machine.
                                                                                                                                                and troubleshoot.                             2. Remove the covers.
                                   Cassette set unit     Suction cup HP sensor                                                                      “2. Error Code Table”                     3. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
                                   A unit                SA4
                                                               IP sensor
                                                               SB1
                                                                                                                                                                          1
       Cassette ejection sensor
                           SA1      M
                                                                      Barcode reader                                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                                                                                       Voltage on the CPU12A board                                             Replace the power supply.
                                                                                                                                                                       normal?                                                                     “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y                                                        Volume: 11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                  M                                                                                                                                 “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                                    on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”
                         Hold sensor
                                                                           Transport motor                                                                             CPU12A and SNS12A boards,                      Reseat the error-causing board
                                SA3                                                                                                                                    as well as barcode, tested
                                                                                                                                                                                                            N         and check if the error occurs          N
                                                                           MB1
                                                                                                                                                                       in M-Utility normal?                           again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1
                          Cassette IN sensor
                                        SA2                                                                                                                                               Y         “8. Board Tests                        Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                    in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    “Maintenance Utility
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Volume:                                         “Check, Replacement,
                                        FRONT                           Erasure conveyor                                                                                                                                                            and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                    [4-6] BARCODE TEST”
                                                                        B unit                                                                                                                                                                      “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               Replace the barcode reader.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   04B REF.11”
                                                                                                                                                                                                            N
                                                                                                                                                                       IP type normal?                                                         Replace the IP.
                                                                        Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                        C unit
                                                                                                                                                                       IP barcode free from scratch,        N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               Replace the IP.
                                                                                                                                                                       soil, or peeling?
                            M
                                                M                                                                                                                                         Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                            N
                                                                                                                                                                       Error recurs?                                                   1
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                          M                                                                                                                                   Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                  M                                                                                                                            1. Barcode reader
                                                              M                                                                                                                                2. SNS12A
                                                                                                                                                                                               3. CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                                               4. MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                  “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                  04B REF.11”
      Subscanning unit                                                                                                                                                                            “Check, Replacement,
      Z unit                                                                               FR6H2487.EPS                                                                                           and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                  “11.5 SNS12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                  “11.2 CPU12A Board”                                                   FR6H2486.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                  “11.7 MTH12A Board”
                                                                                                                   ■ Analysis Flow
5.         Error Code Analysis Flow (Scanner)
                                                                                                                                        Check the error log in M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                        Check the error code table again
■ Error Occurrence Conditions                                                                                                           and troubleshoot.                     1
                                                                                                                                            “2. Error Code Table”
10230 Scanner functional error during bootup                                                                                                                                TP2 voltage on the SCN12A           N               Replace the power supply.
                                                                                                                                                                            board normal?                                            “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
           During bootup, because the connector (CN1 on the PMT12A board, CNE1 on the scanning optics                                                                                                                                Volume: 11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                                             Y
           unit, CNE2 on the scanning optics unit, CN1 on the SYN12A board, or CN1 on the LDD12A board)                                                                                            “9.1 Checking the Voltage
           is disconnected, the laser (LDD), start-point detection (SYN), and photomultiplier (PMT) functions                                                                                      on the Board Test Pins
                                                                                                                                                                                                   (Connectors)”
           are disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                            CPU12A and SCN12A boards            N         Reseat the error-causing board        N
           Because the laser is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed (detail                                                                   tested in M-Utility normal?                   and check if the error occurs                   1
           code: D0F603).                                                                                                                                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                   “8. Board Tests                           Y
           Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is D0F403.                                                                                                                                  in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Replace the error-causing
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     “Check, Replacement, and
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Adjustment Volume"
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                N
                                                                                                                                                                            Connectors connected?                               Restore              “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                N
                                                                                                                                                                            Error recurs?                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                             Y
                                                                                                                                 Y                                         1
10232 Scanner power supply error during bootup (2)                                                                                   Check the error code table again
                                                                                                                                     and troubleshoot.                   TP2 voltage on the SCN12A           N                                Replace the power supply.
           During bootup, because the fuse (H12 on the SCN12A board) is blown, the photomultiplier (PMT)                                 “2. Error Code Table”
                                                                                                                                                                         board normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
           and start-point detection (SYN) functions are disabled (detail code: 809603).                                                                                                  Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Volume: 11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                                               “9.1 Checking the Voltage
           Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 809403.                                                                                                                              on the Board Test Pins
                                                                                                                                                                                               (Connectors)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                             N
                                                                                                                                                                         Error recurs?                                                1
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                         CPU12A and SCN12A boards            N         and check if the error occurs        N
                                                                                                                                                                         tested in M-Utility normal?                   again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       1
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                               “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”                  Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                             N                                Replace the PMT12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                         Photomultiplier (PMT) normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y         “14.5 Checking the Light-Collecting           Volume: 9.2 PMT12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Unit (PMT)”
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                             N                                Replace the SED12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                         Leading-edge detection (SED)
                                                                                                                                                                         normal?                                                                  “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  07C REF.7”
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y         “14.4 Checking the Leading-Edge
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sensor (SED)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 N
                                                                                                                                                                            Error recurs?                                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                                              Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                            CPU12A and SCN12A boards             N         and check if the error occurs           N
                                                                                                                                                                            tested in M-Utility normal?                    again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                              Y                                                  Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                   “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”                     Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 N                                   Replace the PMT12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                            Photomultiplier (PMT) normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment
                                                                                                                                                                                             Y         “14.5 Checking the Light-Collecting               Volume: 9.2 PMT12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Unit (PMT)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 N                                   Replace the SED12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                            Leading-edge detection (SED)
                                                                                                                                                                            normal?                                                                      “Service Parts List Volume: 07C REF.7”
             Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed                                                                                                        N
                                                                                                                                                                            Error recurs?                                   1
             (detail code: C0D400).                                                                                                                                                           Y
           • During bootup, because ±15V is not supplied, except for the laser (LDD), due to blow of the fuse                                                                                                              Reseat the error-causing board
             (J11 on the MTH12A board, or J12, H12, or H14 on the SCN board), the photomultiplier (PMT),                                                                    CPU12A and SCN12A boards             N         and check if the error occurs         N
                                                                                                                                                                            tested in M-Utility normal?                    again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1
             start-point detection (SYN), and laser (LDD) functions are disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                              Y                                                Y
             Because the laser (LDD) is not enabled, the leading-edge detection (SED) cannot be performed                                                                                          “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”                   Replace the error-causing board.
             (detail code: C0D603).                                                                                                                                                                                                                    “Check, Replacement, and
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Adjustment Volume”
             Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is C0D400.                                                                                                                                                                                     “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        "11.3 SCN12A Board”
             start-point detection (SYN) functions are disabled (detail code: C01403).                                                                                   Fuse K11 on the MTH12A board        N                 Replace the fuse.
                                                                                                                                                                         and fuses H14 and A22 on the
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                         SCN12A board normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   12. Fuse Replacement and Fuse Locations”
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                               “10.4 Scanner-Related Fuses”
                                                                                                                                                                                                             N
                                                                                                                                                                         Error recurs?                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                          Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                N
                                                                                                                                                                           Error recurs?                                   1
                                                                                                                                                                                             Y
           function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 800C03).                                                                                                                                             N                                 Replace the scanning optics unit.
                                                                                                                                                                                 Start-point detection (SYN) normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              “Check, Replacement,
           Alternatively, during routine processing, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) func-                                                                                  Y        “14.3 Checking the Start-Point                     and Adjustment Volume:
           tion, and error for the PLL function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board                                                                                                Sensor (SYN)”                                      8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
           are detected (detail code: 801401).                                                                                                                                                                          N
                                                                                                                                                                                 Error recurs?                                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                                                  Y
13201 Start-point detection error
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Reseat the boards in the order named,
           During M-Utility operation, only error for the start-point detection signal (SSH, SSL) is detected.                                                                                        and if the error is detected, replace the board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                       1. SCN12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                                       2. Scanning optics unit
14281 Start-point detection error during bootup (1)                                                                                                                                                    3. CPU12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                                       4. MTH12A board
           • During bootup, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) function, and error for the
             PLL function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail                                                                                                 “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
             code: 801C03).                                                                                                                                                                                “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                           “8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
             Alternatively, the disabled state of the start-point detection (SYN) function and error for the PLL                                                                                           “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                           “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                              FR6H2470.EPS
             function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code: 800C03). Alternatively, during routine
             processing, the disabled state of the start-point-detection (SYN) function, and error for the PLL
             function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected (detail code:
             801401).
           • During bootup, the start-point detection (SYN) function is disabled (detail code: 801402). Alterna-
             tively, the start-point detection (SSH, SSL) cannot be performed (detail code: 800002).
           <Occurrence Condition>
                                                                                                                                                              1
           During routine processing, because the scanner-related error is detected, the IP is returned to the
           cassette and the scanner is initialized. The routine processing is retried again, but the scanner-
                                                                                                                                                         Other software exited before RU         N
           related error recurs.                                                                                                                         startup?                                                Exit the other software.
                                                                                                                                                                              Y
14298 Before-reading scanner retry error                                                                                                                                            “Maintenance Utility Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                    2.1.3 VER: Procedures for Checking the Software Version of the RU
           During routine processing, because the scanner-related error is detected, the IP is returned to the                                                                      (Implemented with RU Software Version of A07 or Later, or PCMUTL 1.2
           cassette and the scanner is initialized.                                                                                                                                 or Later)”
                                                                                                                                                                                                 N
                                                                                                                                                         Error recurs?                                      1
                                                                                                                                                                              Y
11208, 11272, 11273, 12212, 12272, 12273, 13208, 13212, ■ Analysis Flow
           During bootup and routine processing, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times                                 Check the error code table
           the factory default value.                                                                                                        again and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                                 “2. Error Code Table”
11272 Insufficient laser light intensity
           During bootup, laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) error is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                 1
                                                                                                                                                            TP2 voltage on the SCN12A               N                 Replace the power supply.
11273 Laser life warning                                                                                                                                    board normal?                                                 “Check, Replacement,
           During bootup and routine processing, the laser drive current value (LDIF) is more than 1.4 times                                                                     Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          and Adjustment Volume:
           the factory default value.                                                                                                                                                                                     11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                                      “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                      on the Board Test Pins
                                                                                                                                                                                      (Connectors)”
12212 Laser intensity error                                                                                                                                                                         N
           During bootup and routine processing, only error for the laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) is
                                                                                                                                                            Error recurs?                                      1
           detected.                                                                                                                                                             Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                    N
13212 Laser light intensity error                                                                                                                           Error recurs?                                      1
           During M-Utility operation, only error for the laser OK signal (LD1OKH, LD1OKL) is detected.                                                                          Y
14283 Scanning optics unit board error during bootup                                                                                                                                 Reseat the boards in the order named,
                                                                                                                                                                                     and if the error is detected, replace the board.
           During bootup, the laser (LDD), start-point detection (SYN), and leading-edge detection (SED)                                                                             1. SCN12A board
           functions are disabled due to laser failure or disconnected connector (detail code: C05401).                                                                              2. Scanning optics unit
                                                                                                                                                                                     3. CPU12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                     4. MTH12A board
12211, 12217, 12251, 12252, 13211, 13217, 14211, 14251 ■ Analysis Flow
           During bootup and routine processing, only error for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH/                                                                                       “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                                                                                                                                   on the Board Test Pins
           L) is detected.                                                                                                                                                                         (Connectors)”
           Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 008000.                                                                                                                                                                                 Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      “Check, Replacement, and
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Adjustment Volume”
12252 Photomultiplier control board error (2)                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      “11.3 SCN12A Board”
           During routine processing, only error for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH, HVOKL) is
           detected.                                                                                                                                                         Photomultiplier (PMT) normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 N                                Replace the Photomultiplier.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                             Y         “14.5 Checking the Light-                      and Adjustment Volume:
13211 PMT analog power supply error                                                                                                                                                                    Collecting Unit (PMT)”                         9.2 PMT12A Board”
           During M-Utility operation, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH,                                                                                                               N
           +15VOKL) is detected.
                                                                                                                                                                             Error recurs?                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                              Y
13217 High-voltage power supply error                                                                                                                                                             Reseat the boards in the order named,
                                                                                                                                                                                                  and if the error is detected, replace the board.
           During M-Utility operation, only error for the high-voltage power supply signal (HVOKH, HVOKL) is                                                                                       1. PMT12A board
           detected.                                                                                                                                                                               2. SCN12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                                   3. CPU12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                                   4. MTH12A board
14211 PMT analog power supply error during bootup
                                                                                                                                                                                                      “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
           During bootup, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH, +15VOKL) is de-                                                                                                 “9.2 PMT12A Board”
           tected.                                                                                                                                                                                    “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                      “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                      “11.7 MTH12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      FR6H2474.EPS
14251 Photomultiplier control board error during bootup (1)
           During routine processing, only error for the PMT analog power supply signal (+15VOKH,
           +15VOKL) is detected (detail code: 008200).
           Note that if the HV is OFF, the detail code is 008000.
           During bootup and routine processing, only error for the polygon lock signal (POKL, PONL) is                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Reseat the error-causing board
                                                                                                                                                                              CPU12A and SCN12A boards                      and check if the error occurs          N
           detected.                                                                                                                                                          tested in M-Utility normal?                   again.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               1
                                                                                                                                                                                              Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Y
12262 Polygon rotation error (2)                                                                                                                                                                    “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Replace the error-causing board.
           • During routine processing, error for the signals (PONL, POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror                                                                                                                                             “Check, Replacement,
             (POL) and the start-point interval function on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code:                                                                                                                                                   and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “11.2 CPU12A Board”
             003400).                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    “11.3 SCN12A Board”
           • During routine processing, error for the polygon lock signal (PONL, POKL) and error for the start-                                                                                                   N                                  Replace the scanning optics unit.
             point interval function and polygon rotation detection function on the SCN12A board are detected                                                                 Polygonal mirror (POL) normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement,
             (detail code: 003400).                                                                                                                                                           Y         “14.2 Checking the Polygonal Mirror”             and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  N
12263 Polygon rotation error (3)                                                                                                                                              Error recurs?                                                  1
           During routine processing, only error for the lock signal (POKL, PONL) from the polygonal mirror                                                                                    Y
           (POL) is detected (detail code: 002000).
                                                                                                                                                                                                   Reseat the boards in the order named,
           If error for the SEDTM or FCLKTM signal on the SCN12A board is detected, the detail code is                                                                                             and if the error is detected, replace the board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. SCN12A board
           002003.                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Scanning optics unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. CPU12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                                    4. MTH12A board
12264 Polygonal rotation error (4)
                                                                                                                                                                                                       “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
           During routine processing, error for the signals (PONL, POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror                                                                                             “11.3 SCN12A Board”
           and the SEDTM signal on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 001002).                                                                                                                 “8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                                                       “11.2 CPU12A Board”
           Alternatively, error for the index signal (PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror and the SEDTM and                                                                                              “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                             FR6H2475.EPS
           FCLKTM signals on the SCN12A board is detected (detail code: 0010030).
           Alternatively, error for the signals (POKL, PINDXL) from the polygonal mirror and the SEDTM
           signal on the SCN12A board is detected (error code: 001002).
           During routine processing, IP conveyance overrun occurs due to mechanical error or SCN12A                            Y
           board control error, and only error for the SEDTM and FCLKTM signals on the SCN12A board is
                                                                                                                                    Check the error code table
           detected.                                                                                                                again and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                        “2. Error Code Table”
                                                                                                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                                                   Error recurs?                                      1
                                                                                                                                                                        Y
                                                                                                                                                                            Reseat the boards in the order named,
                                                                                                                                                                            and if the error is detected, replace the board.
                                                                                                                                                                             1. SCN12A board
                                                                                                                                                                             2. Scanning optics unit
                                                                                                                                                                             3. CPU12A board
                                                                                                                                                                             4. MTH12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                “8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                                “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                                  FR6H2476.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    N
                                                                                                                                                                               Leading-edge detection (SED)                                           Replace the SED12A board.
                                                                                                                                                                               normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          “Service Parts List Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                Y         “14.4 Checking the Leading-Edge                 07C REF.7”
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sensor (SED)”
6.         Error Code Analysis Flow (Electrical)                                                                                                       6.2          Error Code Analysis Flow between the SNS12A Board and
                                                                                                                                                                    CPU12A Board
6.1        Error Code Analysis Flow between the CPU12A Board and CL                                                                                                              Check the error log
                                                                                                                                                                                 in M-Utility.
                          Check the error log
                          in M-Utility.                                                                                                                      1
      1                                                                                                                                                 Booted up normally?
                                                                                                                                                                                                N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 If not, troubleshoot as appropriate.
                                         N                                                                                                                                   Y
 Booted up normally?                                                      If not, troubleshoot as appropriate.                                                                     “15.1 RU Bootup Failure”
                          Replace the boards in the order named                                                                                                                  Replace the boards in the order named
                           1. CPU12A board                                             END                                                                                        1. CPU12A board
                           2. CNN12A board                                                                                                                                        2. SCN12A board
                           4. MTH12A board                                                                                                                                        4. MTH12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                     “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                              “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”                                                                                                            “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                              “11.2 CPU12A Board”                                                                                                                                    “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                              “11.10 CNN12A Board”                                                                                                                                   “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                                                              FR6H2158.EPS
                              “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                                                               FR6H2157.EPS
6.3         Error Code Analysis Flow between the SCN12A Board and
            CPU12A Board
                         Check the error log
                         in M-Utility.
      1
                                        N
 Booted up normally?                                                     If not, troubleshoot as appropriate.
                     Y
                           “15.1 RU Bootup Failure”
                                        N                                If not, troubleshoot as appropriate.
 LED on the CPU12A board normal?
                                                                              “15.2 Checking the LED on the CPU12A Board”
                     Y
                           “15.2 Checking the LED
                           on the CPU12A Board”
6.4        Error Code Analysis Flow between the Erasure Unit and                                                      ■ Analysis Flow
           INV12B Board                                                                                                        After checking the LED display on the INV12B board, analysis should be performed by using the
                                                                                                                               analysis flow that corresponds to the resulting LED display.
                                                                                                                               ● INV12B LED display - ON: LED14, LED15
11731, 11751, 11781                                                                                                                                          OFF: LED16, LED17, LED18
■ Error Occurrence Conditions                                                                                                             Check the error log
                                                                                                                                          in M-Utility.
11731 Thermistor failure detection (during erasure initialization)
                                                                                                                                                       N
           During bootup, it is detected that temperature control of the erasure unit does not function due to          Error 12820 logged?
           temperature thermistor (THB1) error.
                                                                                                                                      Y
                                                                                                                                          Replace the power supply.
11751 Thermistor failure detection (during IP processing)                                                                                    “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                             and Adjustment Volume:
           During routine processing, error for the temperature thermistor (THB1) is detected.                                               11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                                           N
11781 Thermistor failure detection (during idling)                                                                                                         Error 12823 logged?
During idling after machine bootup, error for the temperature thermistor (THB1) is detected. Y
           ● INV12B LED display - ON: LED14, LED15, LED16                                                                        ● INV12B LED display - ON: LED14, LED15, LED17, LED18
                                       OFF: LED17, LED18                                                                                                        OFF: LED16
11732 Thermistor status error detection (during erasure initialization)                                                          Harness between SNS12A       N
                                                                                                                                 and INV12B normal?                             Replace the harness.
           During bootup, the temperature thermistor (THB1) detects an abnormal range. Temperature control
           of the erasure unit does not function.                                                                                             Y
■ Error Occurrence Conditions ● INV12B LED display - ON: LED14, LED15, LED16, LED17, LED18
                                                                                                                                                          N
                                                                                                                                                              Disconnect CN14 and measure
                                                                                                                                                              the resistance value between
                                                                                                                                                              the thermistor pins.
                                                                                                                                                      END
                                                                                                                                                                                                             FR6H2555.EPS
12735
■ Error Occurrence Conditions
■ Analysis Flow
START
                                                                                                                                        END
                                                                                                                                                                                               FR6H2557.EPS
12800
■ Error Occurrence Conditions
■ Analysis Flow
START
           This chapter summarizes troubleshooting procedures for failure to update software versions or
           failure to back up machine shipment control data.
           Troubleshooting should be performed in accordance with the checking procedures described in
           each section.
■ Troubleshooting Procedure
           ◆ NOTE ◆
                                                                                                                                                                                                        FR6H3321.EPS
           Troubleshooting should be performed in accordance with the following procedures. If not, the
           trouble may not be analyzed.
                                                                                                                                        REFERENCE
                                                                                                                                    Digits for XXX in TTL=”XXX” vary depending on the environment in which the command is
                                                                                                                                    executed.
7.2        Checking the FTP Server                                                                                  ■ Checking If the FTP Server can be Accessed on the CL
                                                                                                                                 (1) Exit the CL software.
           The method for checking the FTP server differs depending on the version of the PC-MUTL used.                          (2) Using Explorer, check the name of the folder where the RU data reside on the Local Disk,
           Thus, check the version of the PC-MUTL before performing the procedures described below.                                  and verify that it matches RU NAME.
               REFERENCE
           Each version of the PC-MUTL corresponds to each version of the RU software, as follows.                                  (Folder path) C:\Program Files\FujiFilm\FCR\CR-IR346\SYSTEM\ru0
           • RU software version A01 to A04: PC-MUTL version 1.0
           • RU software version A05 to A06: PC-MUTL version 1.1
           • RU software version A07 or later: PC-MUTL version 1.2                                                                  If the folder name is not matched, correct RU NAME.
                                                                                                                                         “15.6 Checking RU NAME”
7.2.1 PC-MUTL 1.1 or Earlier
FRMT0431.EPS
              (4) Click the [FTP] button.                                                                             7.3      Checking the Setting of the FTP Server
              (5) Make sure that the results of access to the FTP server on the CL and the results of access to
                  the FTP server from the RU are displayed.
                                                                                                                      7.3.1 Checking IIS
                    ● Results of access to the FTP server on the CL
                                                                                                                               Unless IIS (“Internet Information Service”) is installed, the FTP server cannot be used.
                                                                                                                               Make sure that IIS has been installed on the CL that is used as the FTP server.
FRMT0441.EPS
(3) Make sure that “IIS (Internet Information Service” has been installed in “Administrative Tools”.
FR6H3329.EPS
FR6H0446.EPS
              (6) If either of them is not displayed, perform the procedures described in “7.3 Checking the
                  Setting of the FTP Server,” “7.4 Checking the IP Address of the FTP Server,” and “15.6
                  Checking RU NAME.”
7.3.2 Checking the Operating Status of the FTP Server                                                                              7.4      Checking the IP Address of the FTP Server
              (1) Exit the CL software.                                                                                                     To establish the connection between the RU and CL, RU NAME of the RU, CL, and FTP server
              (2) Double-click “Administrative Tools” in “Control Panel”.                                                                   must be matched.
                                                                                                                                            If they are not matched, change the IP address as appropriate.
                                                                                                                                                  “CL Service Manual, Installation (IN-B)”
                                                                                                                                                (3) Double-click            .
                                                                              FRMT0444.EPS
(4) Make sure that “Default FTP Site” has been started (i.e., “Stopped” is not displayed). ➮ The “Control Panel” window opens.
FRMT0438.EPS
(5) If “Stopped” is displayed, select [Start] from the [Action] menu. (5) Double-click .
              (8) Make sure that the IP address of the FTP server matches “FTP-SERVER IP ADDRESS” that
                  is set in the RU.
                    If they are not matched, set the IP addresses of the RU and CL as appropriate.
                        “15.3 Checking the IP Addres”
172.16.1.35
FRMT0447.EPS
                                                                                                                                 (6) Make sure that the IP address of “FTP-SERVER IP ADDRESS” matches the IP address of
                                                                                                                                     the FTP server.
                                                                                                                                     If they are not matched, set the IP addresses of the RU and CL as appropriate.
                                                                                                                                          “15.3 Checking the IP Addres”
                                                                                                                                                 SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
                                Remove the front cover
                                                                                                                                              For [*], enter the menu number for the board to be tested.
                                and lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                                        CPU12A: 2
                                                                                                                                                        SCN12A: 3
      Turn OFF the high-voltage switch.                                                                                                                 INV12A: 4
                                                                                                                                                        SND12A: 5
                                                                                                                                                        SUB CPU: 6
                                Power ON.
                                                                                                                                          [GOOD indication]
                                                                                                                                                 RESULT: OK
                                                                                                                                          [NG indication]
                                                                                                                                                 RESULT: XXXXX
                                                                                                                                                  [2] Checking the Voltage on the CPU12A Board Test Pin (TP1)
9.         Checking the Voltage
       WARNING
                                                                                                                                                                                                   CPU12A board
       To avoid possible electric shock hazard from high voltage, observe the following precautions.
       • Do not touch the power supply terminals.
       • When making voltage measurements, do not touch the probe (metal portion) of a tester.
START
                        Power OFF
                                                                                                                                                                   CN6         CN5        S1 TP1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  S2
                        Remove the front cover
                        and lower light protect plate.
 Test pin voltage on each            N                    Voltage on the power supply    N                Replace the power
 board normal?                                            unit normal?                                    supply unit.
                                                                                         N
                                                                                                          Replace the fuse.
                                                          Fuse on each board normal?
                                                                                                              “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                              and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                          Y
                                                                               “10.7 Board Check              12. Fuse Replacement
                                                                               Pin Fuses”                     and Fuse Locations”
[3] Checking the Voltage on the INV12B Board Test Pin (TP4) [4] Checking the Voltage on the SCN12A Board Test Pin (TP2)
              CN14
                           D1 D3 D5 D13 D16 D15                         CN5
                                                             TP4    1
                           D12 D7 D8 D11 D18                              GND
FRONT
                                                                    2    +24V(C)
              CN2
                                                                                       : GND                                                                  TP2
              CN3                                                                                                                                  CN1                            CN5         CN4       S1
                                                                                                                                                                       CN2 CN3
                                                                                                                                                                                                         F
            Test pin TP4     Voltage                                                                                                                                                                     R
                                                   Reference voltage                                                                                                                                     O
                                                                                                                                                                                 +24V(K)                 N
              TP4 1-2         +24V Should be within a range from +23.5 to 25.0 V.                                                                                                   +15V(H)              T
                                                                                      FR6H2503.EPS
                                                                                                                                              TP2                  6    5    4
                                                                                                                                                                                    -15V(J)
3 2 1 : GND
GND
[5] Checking the Voltage on the DRV12A Board Test Pin (TP3)
DRV12A board
                                         TP3
                                   CN3                  CN7        CN5
                    CN2 CN8                                                CN6     CN4
               F
               R                                             +24V(D)
               O           TP3                                  +15V(L)
               N                           6        5    4
               T                                                +5V(D)
+5V
3 2 1 : GND
GND
9.2 Checking the Voltage on the Power Supply Unit [2] Connector Locations
START
                                                                                                                                                                                   MTH12A board
                                Power OFF
Power ON.
                                            N                                                                                   Connector
             Voltage on the power
                                                               Replace the power supply unit.                                   CN2 (DRV12A)
             supply unit normal?
                                                                    “Check, Replacement,
                            Y                                       and Adjustment Volume:
                                    [2], [3]                        11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                    DRV12A board
                        END                                                                                                                                                                        FR6H2481.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                      A11
                           END                                                                                                                                       FUSE3
                                                                                                                                                                                      A35   A34
                                                                                                                                                                                      F1    F2
                                                                                                                                                                                         A33      A32
                                                                                                                                                                                         F3       F4
                    Fuse
                                                 FR6H2143.EPS
                                                                                                      A
                                                                                                                    CNA1
           Power supply unit                                                                                          1 +5VSA1     +5VSA1    1
                                                                                                                                                 SA1
                                                                                                                      2 SINSA1H    SINSA1H   2
            α 400     A1                 MTH12A   CPU12A                                                              3 GND        GND       3
                           1 +5                                                                                       4 +5VSA2
                +5V        2 +5V-GND                                                                                  5 SINSA2H
                                        CN9 5AT                                                                                    +5VSA2    1
                                                                                                                      6 GND                      SA2
                                       1                                                                                           SINSA2H   2
                      A2                    A31                                                                       7 +5VSA3
                           1 +5V       3                                                                                           GND       3
                                                  SNS12A   CN4                                                        8 SINSA3H
     TB1        +5V        2 +5V-GND   2                    1   +5VSA1                                                9 GND
            1                          4          0.5A      2   SINSA1H                                                            +5VSA3    1
                                                                                                                                                 SA3
            2                                     A35       3   GND                                                                SINSA3H   2
            3                                               4   +5VSA2                                                             GND       3
                                                            5   SINSA2H
            AC IN                                                                                                   CNA2
                                                            6   GND
            85–265V                                                                                                   1 +5VSA4     +5VSA4    1
                                                            7   +5VSA3                                                                           SA4
                                                                SINSA3H                                               2 SINSA4H    SINSA4H   2
                                                            8
                                                                GND                                                   3 GND        GND       3
                                                            9
                                                                +5VSA4                                                4 N.C
                                                           10
                                                                SINSA4H                                               5 SINSA5H
                                                           11                                                                      SINSA5H   1   SA5
                                                                GND                                                   6 GND
                                                           12                                                                      GND       2
                                                           13   NC(+5VSA5)
                                                           14   SINSA5H
                                                                GND                                                 CNB1
                                                           15
                                                                +5VSB1                                                1 +5VSB1     +5VSB1    1
                                                           16                                                                                    SB1
                                                                SINSB1H                                               2 SINSB1H    SINSB1H   2
                                                           17
                                                                GND                                                   3 GND        GND       3
                                                           18
                                                           19   +5VSC1
                                                           20   SINSC1H
                                                           21   GND
                                                           22   +5VSC2
                                                           23   SINSC2H
                                                           24   GND
                                                           25   +5VSC4
                                                                SINSC4H                                                            +5VSC1    1
                                                           26                                                                                    SC1
                                                                GND                                                                SINSC1H   2
                                                           27
                                                                +5VSC3                                              CNC1           GND       3
                                                           28
                                                           29   SINSC3H                                               1 +5VSC1
                                                           30   GND                                                   2 SINSC1H    +5VSC2    1
                                                                             CNZ1                                                                SC2
                                                           31   +5VSZ2                                                3 GND        SINSC2H   2
                                                           32   SINSZ2H         1 +5VSZ2    +5VSZ2    1               4 +5VSC2     GND       3
                                                                                                          SZ2
                                                           33   GND             2 SINSZ2H   SINSZ2H   2               5 SINSC2H
                                                           34   +5VSZ3          3 GND       GND       3               6 GND        +5VSC4    1
                                                           35   SINSZ3H         4 +5VSZ3                              7 +5VSC4                   SC4
                                                                                                                                   SINSC4H   2
                                                           36   GND             5 SINSZ3H   +5VSZ3    1               8 SINSC4H
                                                                                                          SZ3                      GND       3
                                                           37   +5VSZ5          6 GND       SINSZ3H   2               9 GND
                                                           38   SINSZ5H         7 +5VSZ4    GND       3               10 +5VSC3
                                                           39   GND             8 SINSZ4H                             11 SINSC3H   +5VSC3    1
                                                           40   +5V OK          9 GND                                 12 GND                     SC3
                                                                                            +5VSZ4    1                            SINSC3H   2
                                                                               10 +5VSZ5                  SZ4                      GND
                                                                                            SINSZ4H   2                                      3
                                                           46 +5VSZ4           11 SINSZ5H
                                                                               12 GND       GND       3
                                                           47 SINSZ4H
                                                           48 GND              13
                                                           49                               +5VSZ5    1
                                                                                                          SZ5
                                                           50 N.C             22            SINSZ5H   2
                                                                                            GND       3             Check point: Pins linked to the fuse
                                                                                                                                 of CN4 on the SNS12A board
B FR6H2144.EPS
                                                                                                                                      DRV12A board
[1] Analysis Flow
START
                Fuse
                                                     FR6H2143.EPS
                                                                         CNMB1
                                          DRV12A
                                                                            1 RED   MC1A
                                                            CN3             4 BLU   MC1B
                                                             1   MA1A       2 BLK   +24V
                                                             7   MA1B       5 WHT   +24V    MB1
                                                             2   +24V       3 YEL   MC1AL
      AC IN                                  D11
      85–265V                                                8   +24V       6 ORG   MC1BL
TB1
      1                                                      3   MA1AL
              D                                                  MA1BL
      2                                                      9
                    1
      3 +24V                                                 4   MB1A
                    2
                                                            10   MB1B
                                 CN2                         5   +24V
                                             D51
                          +24V   1                          11   +24V
                          PGND   2                           6   MB1AL
                          +24V   3                          12   MB1BL
                          PGND   4
                                 5                                       CNC10       CNMC1
               E                 6
                    1                                                       1           1 RED   MC1A
                                 7                                          7           4 BLU   MC1B
          +24V      2            8                                          2           2 BLK   +24V
                                                            CN5             8           5 WHT   +24V     MC1
                                                             1   MC1A
                                                                            3           3 YEL   MC1AL
                                                             7   MC1B
                                             3AT
                                                                 +24V       9           6 ORG   MC1BL
                                                             2
                                             E11                            4
                                                             8   +24V
                                                                 MC1AL     10        CNMC2
                                                             3
                                                                            5           1 RED   MC2A
                                                             9   MC1BL
                                                                 MC2A      11           4 BLU   MC2B
                                                             4
                                                                            6           2 BLK   +24V
                                                            10   MC2B
                                             3AT
                                                             5   +24V      12           5 WHT   +24V     MC2
                                             E51                                        3 YEL   MC2AL
                                                            11   +24V
                                                                 MC2AL                  6 ORG   MC2BL
                                                             6
                                                            12   MC2BL
                                                            CN4                      CNMC3
                                                            1    MC3A                   1 RED   MC3A
                                                            4    MC3B                   4 BLU   MC3B
                                             3AT
                                                            2    +24V                   2 BLK   +24V
                                             E21
                                                            5    +24V                   5 WHT   +24V     MC3
                                                            3    MC3AL                  3 YEL   MC3AL
                                                            6    MC3BL                  6 ORG   MC3BL
Check point: Pins linked to the fuses of CN3, CN4, and CN5 on the DRV12A board
                                                                                                          FR6H2146.EPS
                                                                                                                                        DRV12A board
[1] Analysis Flow
START
                     Fuse
                                               FR6H2143.EPS
SNS12A
                                                                                         CNSOLA1
                                          DRV12A
                                                                                            1          RED
                                                                                            3          YEL
                                                            CN8                                        BLK SOLA1
                                                                 PGND                       2
                                                            1
                                                      L12        +5V                        4
                                                            2
      AC IN
                                                            3    PGND
TB1   85–265V
                                                            4    +15V
      1                                      L11                                          CNPA1
              D
      2             1                                                                        1         RED
      3 +24V        2                                                                        3         BLK
                                                                                             2               PA1
               E                 CN2                        CN7                    NC        4
                    1     +24V   1                          1    +24V
           +24V     2     PGND   2           3AT            6    +24VH
                                             D21
                          +24V   3                          2    NC                      CNSVA1
                          PGND   4                          7    +24VL                      1          RED
                          +15V   5           2A             3    +24VPA1                    2          BLK   SVA1
               L          PGND   6           D31            8    PGND
                    1            7                          4    +24VSVA1
           +15V     2            8                          9    PGND                    CNCLA1
                                             2A             5    +24VCLA1                   1          RED
                                             E41
                                                            10   PGND                       2          BLK   CLA1
                                                                                                          CNMZ2
                                                                                               MZ2+15V       1  RED
                                                                                               PGND          2  BLK     MZ2
                                                                                 CNZ11
                                                                                   1
                                                                                   4
                                                                                   2
                                                                                   5
                                                                                   3
                                                                                   6                      CNMZ3
                                                            CN6                                MZ3+15V1      1  RED
                                             2A             1    MZ2+15V                       MZ3+15V2      2  BLK     MZ3
                                             L21
                                                            5    PGND
                                             3AT            2    MZ3+15V1
                                             L31
                                                            6    MZ3+15V2       CNSOLZ1
                                                            3    +24V              1         RED
                                             E31
                                                            7    +24VH             3         YEL
                                                            4    NC                2         BLK SOLZ1
                                                            8    +24VL             4
FR6H2148.EPS
                                                                                                                               MTH12A board
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                               B11             A41
                                                                                                                                                              FUSE5           FUSE4
               START                                                                                                                                 C11
                                                                                                                                                    FUSE7
                                                                                                                                                                       B21
                                                                                                                                                                      FUSE6
      Fuse to be checked            N               Replace the fuse.                                                                            C31      C21
      normal?                                                                                                                                  FUSE12    FUSE8
                                                          “Check, Replacement,
                    Y           [2], [4]                  and Adjustment Volume:
                                                          12. Fuse Replacement
                                                          and Fuse Locations”                                                                                A31               J11
     Load protected by fuse         N                                                                                                                       FUSE1            FUSE10
                                                    Restore the load.
     normal?
                                                          “14. Checking the Scanner I/O”
                                                                                                                                                                      K11              H11
                    Y           [3], [5]
                                                                                                                                                                    FUSE11            FUSE9
                                                                                                                                                             A21
                                                                                                                                                            FUSE2
                END
SCN12A board
                Fuse
                                           FR6H2143.EPS
CN-2 CN-5
B FR6H2511.EPS
10.5 Erasure Lamp and Cooling Fan Fuses [4] Fuse Locations
                                                                                                                             MTH12A board
[1] Analysis Flow                                                                                                                                             B11             A41
                                                                                                                                                             FUSE5           FUSE4
                                                                                                                                                    C11
                START                                                                                                                              FUSE7
                                                                                                                                                                      B21
                                                                                                                                                                     FUSE6
       Fuse to be checked            N               Replace the fuse.                                                                          C31     C21
       normal?                                                                                                                                FUSE12   FUSE8
                                                           “Check, Replacement,
                       Y         [2], [4]                  and Adjustment Volume:
                                                           12. Fuse Replacement
                                                                                                                                                            A31               J11
                                                           and Fuse Locations”
                                                                                                                                                           FUSE1            FUSE10
      Load protected by fuse         N               Restore the load.
      normal?
                                                           “13.3 Checking the Lamps/Fans”                                                                            K11              H11
                       Y         [3], [5]                                                                                                                          FUSE11            FUSE9
                                                                                                                                                            A21
                                                                                                                                                           FUSE2
END
SNS12A board
                                                                                                                                                                          A35    A34
                                                                                                                                                                          F1     F2
                                                                                                                                                                                   A
                                                                                                               For board operation: INV12A
                                                        MTH12A                                                            INV12A
                                                                                           CPU12A                                       CN11
                                                                                                                                                 1 L1-1
CNG12                                                                                                                                            6 L1-2
    1                                                                  4AT                                                                       2
    2           Power supply unit                                      B11                                                                       7
                                                                                                                                                      NC
                                                                                                                                                 3 L2-1
                α 400                    1   +5                        4AT
                             A1   +5V                                                                                                            8 L2-2
                                         2   +5V-GND                   B21
                                                                                                                                                 4
          TB1      AC IN                                    CN9                                     C                                            9    NC           L1-1                L2-1              L3-1
                 1 85–265V                              1                                                                                                               1                   1                 1
                                         1   +5V                              CN7                   CNG11                  CN1                   5 L3-1            L1-2   LAMP 1       L2-2   LAMP 2     L3-2   LAMP 3
                 2                                      3                                                                                                               2                   2                 2
                             A2   +5V        +5V-GND                                 1 +24V RED        1                   1                    10 L3-2
                 3                       2              2                                                                                                          L1-3                L2-3              L3-3
                                                                                     5 GND BLK             5               5                                            1                   1                 1
                                                        4                                                                                                          L1-4                L2-4              L3-4
                                                                                     2 +24V RED            2               2                                            2                   2                 2
                                                                                                                                        CN12
                                         1   +24V                                    6 GND BLK             6               6                     1 L1-3 WHT
                             B    +24V   2   +24V-GND    CN8          4AT            3 +24V RED            3               3                     4 L1-4 WHT
                                                                      C11                                                                                                                                             INV12B
                                                        1                            7 GND BLK             7               7                     2 L2-3 WHT
                                                        6                            4 +24V RED            4               4                     5 L2-4 WHT                                                              CN5   CN3
                                         1 +24V         2
                                                                      3AT                                                                                                                               +5V              1           1 +24V RED
                                                                      C21            8 GND BLK             8               8                     3 L3-3 WHT
                                         2   +24V-GND                                                                                                                                                   LAMP STB1        2           2 GND BLK      FAN3
                         C        +24V                  7                                                                                        6 L3-4 WHT
                                                                                                                                                                                                        LAMP STB2        3
                                                        3
                                                                      3AT
                                                                              CN11                                                       CN4                                                            LAMP STB3        4
                                                        8             C31
                                                                                     1 +24V RED                                                  1 +24V RED                                             LAMP ON1         5
                                                        4
                                                                                     2 GND BLK      FAN1                                             GND BLK         FAN4
                                                                                                                                                 2                                                      LAMP ON2         6
                                                        9
                                                                                                                                                                                                        LAMP ON3         7
                                                        5
                                                                                                                                                                                                        LDSNC-1          8
                                                        10                    CN12
                                                                                     1 +24V RED                                                                                                         LDSNC-2          9
                                                                                                                                         CN6
                                                                                     2    GND BLK   FAN2                                         1 +24V_GND                                             LDSNC-3          10
                                                                                                                                                 2 +24V_GND                                             +5V_GND          11
                                                                                                                                                 3 +24V                                                 +24V_TSW         12
                                                                      5AT
                                                                      A31                                                                        4 +24V_GND
                                                                                                                                                                                   B                    FANG4H           13
                                                                                                                                                 5 +24V                                                 FANG4L           14
                                                                                                                                                   FUOPEN3                                              FUOPEN1          15
                                                                                                                                                 7 FUOPEN2                                              FUOPEN2          16
                                                                  SNS12A                                                                         8 FUOPEN1                                              FUOPEN3          17
                                                                                                                                                                                                        +24V             18
                                                                              CN6                                                                9 FANG4L
                                                                                     1 +5VINV                                                   10 FANG4H                                               +24V_GND         19
                                                                      1.5AT          2 STBL 1L                                                                                                          +24V             20
                                                                                                                                                11 +24V_TSW
                                                                       A32
                                                                                     3 ONL 1L                                                   12 +5V_GND                                              +24V_GND         21
                                                                                     4 FAN3ONL                                                  13 LDSNC-3                                              +24V_GND         22
                                                                                     5 FAN4ONL                                                  14 LDSNC-2
                                                                                     6 LAMPREOH                                                 15 LDSNC-1                                                               CN2
                                                                                     7 LDSN1H                                                   16 LAMP ON3
                                                                                                                                                                                                           +5VINV        1
                                                                                     8 LDSN2H                                                   17 LAMP ON2
                                                                                                                                                                                                          STBL1L         2
                                                                                     9 LDSN3H                                                   18 LAMP ON1
                                                                                                                                                                                                              ONL1L      3
                                                                                     10 FAN3REOH                                                19 LAMP STB3                                             FAN3ONL         4
                                                                                     11 FAN3ERRH                                                20 LAMP STB2                                             FAN4ONL         5
                                                                                     12 FAN4ERRH                                                21 LAMP STB1                                           LAMPREQH          6
                                                                                     13 THB1ERRH                                                22 +5V
                                                                                                                                                                                                         LDSN1H          7
                                                                                     14 HTMPERRH                                                                                                          LDSN2H         8
                                                                                     15 TSWB1ERRH                                                                                                         LDSN3H         9
                                                                                     16 GND                                                                                                             FAN3REQH         10
                                                                                     17 STBL2L                                                                                                          FAN3ERRH         11
                                                                                     18 ONL2L                                                                                                           FAN4ERRH         12
                                                                                     19 STBL3L                                                                                                          THB1ERRH         13
                                                                                     20 ONL3L                                                                                                          HTMPERRH          14
                                                                                     21                                                                                                                TSWB1ERRH         15
                                                                                     22                                                                                                                        GND       16
                                                                                     23                                                                                                                   STBL2L         17
                                                                                     24                                                                                                                    ONL2L         18
                                                                                     25                                                                                                                   STBL3L         19
                                                                                     26                                                                                                                       ONL3L      20
D FR6H2512.EPS
                                                                                                                                      MTH12A board
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                                     B11             A41
                                                                                                                                                                    FUSE5           FUSE4
                START                                                                                                                                      C11
                                                                                                                                                          FUSE7
                                                                                                                                                                             B21
                                     N                                                                                                                                      FUSE6
      Fuse to be checked                            Replace the fuse.                                                                                  C31     C21
      normal?
                                                          “Check, Replacement,                                                                       FUSE12   FUSE8
                      Y         [2], [4]                  and Adjustment Volume:
                                                           12. Fuse Replacement
                                                          and Fuse Locations”                                                                                      A31               J11
      Load protected by fuse         N              Restore the load.
                                                                                                                                                                  FUSE1            FUSE10
      normal?
                                                          “13.2. Checking the Barcode Reader”
                      Y         [3], [5]                                                                                                                                    K11              H11
                                                                                                                                                                          FUSE11            FUSE9
                                                                                                                                                                   A21
                                                                                                                                                                  FUSE2
                    END
SNS12A board
                                                                                                                                                                                   A35      A34
                                                                                                                                                                                   F1       F2
                Fuse
                                           FR6H2143.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                      A33      A32
                                                                                                                                                                                      F3       F4
                                                                   CN6
                                                                   1
                                                                                                         CNBCR1
                                                                                                   RTS    1       (CTS)    BLU
                                                    1AT                                            GND    2       GND      PUR
                                                    A34            21   TXD                         NC    3       NC
                                                                   22   RST                    +5VBCR     4       +5VBCR   RED                    BCR
                                                                   23   (CTS)                      RXD    5       TXD      GRN
                    D
                         1                                         24   RXD                         NC    6       NC
             +24V        2                                         25   GND                       (CTS)   7       RTS      GRAY
                                                                   26   +5VBCR                     TXD    8       RXD      WHT
                                                CN2               DRV12A
                                                1
                                                2           3AT
                                                            D41
                                                8
                                                                                                                                              FR6H2513.EPS
[2] TP3 24V/15V Error on the DRV12A Board (D41 on the DRV12A Board)                                                                                                                     SCN12A
                                                                                                                 α 400                A1
           Replace the DRV12A board.                                                                                                        1 +5
                                                                                                                               +5V          2 +5V-GND
                    “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume: 11.6 DRV12A Board”                                                                                  CN9
                                                                                                                                      A2                        1
                                                                                                                 AC IN                      1 +5V               3         C21
                                                                                                        TB1      85–265V       +5V          2 +5V-GND           2
[3] TP2 15V/-15V/24V Error on the SCN12A Board (H11, J11, K11 on the MTH12A Board)                                                                              4
                                                                                                                 1
                    “10.4 Scanner-Related Fuses”                                                                                      B
                                                                                                                 2                          1 +24V                                         +15V
                                                                                                                 3             +24V         2 +24V-GND                                                    TP2
                                                                                                                                                                  CN8                      -15V
                                                                                                                                                                 1                         +24V
[4] TP1 5V Error on the CPU12A Board (A11 on the MTH12A Board)                                                                        C                          6
                                                                                                                                            1 +24V
                                                                                                                                                                 2
                    “10.4 Scanner-Related Fuses”                                                                               +24V         2 +24V-GND
                                                                                                                                                                 7
                                                                                                                                      H                          3   H11                SNS12A
                                                                                                                                            1 +15V               8
                                                                                                                               +15V         2 +15V-GND           4    J11
                                                                                                                                                                 9
                                                                                                                                      J                          5
                                                                                                                                            1 -15V                   K11
                                                                                                                                                                10
                                                                                                                               -15V         2 -15V-GND
                                                                                                                                      K
                                                                                                                                            1 +24V
                                                                                                                               +24V         2 +24-GND
                                                                                                                                      L
                                                                                                                                            1 +15V
                                                                                                                               +15V         2 +15V-GND                                  DRV12A
                                                                                                                                      E                                                CN2
                                                                                                                                            1 +24V                                    1
                                                                                                                               +24V         2 +24V-GND                                2
                                                                                                                                                                                           +24V
                                                                                                                                                                                      3 D41
                                                                                                                                      D                                               4
                                                                                                                                            1 +24V                                                        TP3
                                                                                                                                                                                      5    +15V
                                                                                                                               +24V         2 +24V-GND
                                                                                                                                                                                      6
: Regulator FR6H2528.EPS
                                                                                                                                    ● SA4
                                                      SA2      Monitors the cassette IN detection.         CLOSE      OPEN
                SNS12A board                                                                                                                     (1) Type in [6][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] to execute “HOME POSITION” for “IP
                                                                                                                                                     FEED/LOAD (MA1, MB1)”.
                                                      SA3      Monitors the cassette hold detection.       CLOSE      OPEN                       (2) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                                 (3) Perform the procedures described in [2] to execute sensor monitoring.
                                                      SA4      Monitors the suction cup HP detection.      CLOSE      OPEN                       (4) Verify that the status of SA4 is CLOSE.
                                                                                                                                                 (5) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                                 (6) Type in [6][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive MA1 until SA4
                                                      SA5      Monitors the suction detection.             CLOSE      OPEN
                                                                                                                                                     becomes OPEN.
                                                                                                                                                 (7) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                      SB1      Monitors the cassette inlet IP detection.   CLOSE      OPEN                       (8) Perform the procedures described in [2] to execute sensor monitoring.
                                                                                                                                                 (9) Verify that the status of SA4 is OPEN.
                                                                                                                     TR6H2004.EPS
                                                                                                                                                (10) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
[4] ON/OFF of Each Sensor                                                                                                                       (11) Type in [6][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] to execute “HOME POSITION” for “IP
                                                                                                                                                     FEED/LOAD (MA1, MB1)”.
● SA1 and SA2
                                                                                                                                                (12) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
              (1) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive SolA1.
              (2) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
              (3) Perform the procedures described in [2] to executing sensor monitoring.
              (4) Insert a cassette into the cassette set unit and then pull it out.
              (5) Verify that the status of SA1 and SA2 changes.
              (6) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
              (7) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [2][ENT] to stop SolA1.
              (8) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
49 FR6H2406.EPS
11.2 Checking SC1, SC2, SC3, and SC4                                                                                     [2] Monitoring the Sensor in M-Utility
                                                                                                                               ◆ NOTE ◆
[1] Analysis Flow                                                                                                              If “Confirm” is clicked upon occurrence of a fatal error, the sensor status indicates CLOSE: X. Thus,
                                                                                                                               check the sensor status before clicking “Confirm”.
          START
                                                                                                                                      (1) Start the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                      (2) Type in [6][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [3][ENT] to check the sensor status.
 Repeat sensor monitoring N   SNS12A board LED             N   Reseat the SNS12A/   Y                                                 (3) Perform the procedures described in [4] to turn ON/OFF the sensor, and verify that the on-
 five times in M-Utility.     lighting status normal?          CPU12A board and                                                           screen sensor status indication changes accordingly.
 The result normal?                                            check if the error   If the error recurs, replace
               Y                            Y        [3]                                                                                  An on-screen display example is shown below where the status of the SC1, SC2, SC3, and
                                                               occurs again.        the boards in the order named.
                       [2]                                                                                                                SC4 sensors has changed.
                                                                                      1. SNS12A board replacement
                                                                                      2. CPU12A board replacement
 1                                                                                    3. MTH12A board replacement                              MU>SNS>3
                                                                                                                                               Open:o/Close:x
            END
                                                           N                                                                                   SSSSSSSSSSSSSSLLL
      Return to the error     Cable normal?                             Repair or replace.                                                     AAAAABCCCCZZZZDDD
      code analysis flow.                    Y                                                                                                 12345112342345SSS
                                                    [5]
                                                                                                                                                             NNN
                              Repeat SNS12A board
                                                                                                                                                             123
                              LED lighting status checks N
                              five times to check if the                                                                                        ooxxxoxxooxoxoxxx
                              error recurs.
                                                                                                                                                xxxxxoooxxxoxoxxx
                                            Y
                                                                                                                                                                 The status of SC1, SC2, SC3, and SC4 has changed.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         FRMT0418.EPS
                                                 Replace the sensor.
                                                                                                FRMT0407.EPS
1 2
3 1
12
11
                                                                                                                                                                                       SC4
                                                                                                                                                                                                  CN9 (MTH12A)         CN4 (SNS12A)
                                                                                                                                                                SC1
                                                                                                                                                                                       SC2                             2
                                                                                                                                                                                              4
                                                                                                                                                                                   SC3                                 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    50
                                                                                                                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                                                                                 CN9                     CNC1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          49
                                                                                                                                                  CN4
                                                                                                                                                            T
                                                                                                                                                         ON
                                                                                                                                                       FR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FR6H2408.EPS
11.3 Checking SZ2, SZ3, SZ4, and SZ5                                                                                     [2] Monitoring the Sensor in M-Utility
                                                                                                                               ◆ NOTE ◆
[1] Analysis Flow                                                                                                              If “Confirm” is clicked upon occurrence of a fatal error, the sensor status indicates CLOSE: X. Thus,
                                                                                                                               check the sensor status before clicking “Confirm”.
            END                                                                                                                                 SSSSSSSSSSSSSSLLL
                                                           N                                                                                    AAAAABCCCCZZZZDDD
      Return to the error     Cable normal?                             Repair or replace.
      code analysis flow.                                                                                                                       12345112342345SSS
                                             Y
                                                    [5]                                                                                                       NNN
                                                                                                                                                              123
                              Repeat SNS12A board
                              LED lighting status checks   N
                                                                                                                                                ooxxxoxxooxoxoxxx
                              five times to check if the
                              error recurs.                                                                                                     xxxxxoooxxoxoxxxx
                                            Y
                                                                                                                                                                      The status of SZ2, SZ3, SZ4 and SZ5 has changed.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         FRMT0419.EPS
[3] Checking the LED Lighting Status                                                                                                    [4] ON/OFF of Each Sensor
              (1) Remove the lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                        ● SZ2 and SZ3
              (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
              (3) Turn ON/OFF the relevant sensor in accordance with the procedures described in [4] and                                         (1) Type in [6][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [1][ENT] to execute “HOME POSITION” for “SUB
                  verify that the LED on the SNS12A board changes its indication accordingly.                                                        READING GRIP DRIVE (MZ2)”.
                                                                                                                                                 (2) Make sure that “RESULT: OK” appears.
                                                                                                                                        ● SZ4
                                                SZ2      Monitors the driving-side grip release HP detection.   CLOSE     OPEN
                                                                                                                                                 (1) Perform the procedures described in [2] to execute sensor monitoring, and check the status
                                                                                                                                                     of SZ4.
                                                SZ3      Monitors the driven-side grip release HP detection.    CLOSE     OPEN                   (2) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
        SNS12A board                                                                                                                             (3) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive the IP stopper solenoid (SOLZ1).
                                                SZ4      Monitors the IP stopper HP detection.                  CLOSE     OPEN                       Verify that the status of SZ4 changes.
                                                                                                                                                 (4) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                                 (5) Perform the procedures described in [2] to execute sensor monitoring.
                                                SZ5      Monitors the dust removal HP detection.                CLOSE     OPEN
                                                                                                                                                 (6) Compare the status of SZ4 against the status at step (1) above to verify that the status has
                                                                                                                         TR6H2005.EPS
                                                                                                                                                     changed.
                                                                                                                                                 (7) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                                 (8) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] to stop the IP stopper solenoid.
                                                                                                                                                 (9) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                        ● SZ5
                                                                                                                                                 (1) Type in [6][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [7][ENT] → [1][ENT] to execute “HOME POSITION” for
                                                                                                                                                     “SCANNER CLEANING (MZ3)”.
                                                                                                                                                 (2) Make sure that “RESULT: OK” appears.
                                                                                                                                                 (3) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
                    2. Check for shorts between each of the pins and GND           → 2Ω or greater.
                                                                                                                                   ● Connector Pin Numbers
                    3. Check for shorts between each of the pins                   → 2Ω or greater.
                    4. Check for continuity of each of the pins                    → 1Ω or less.                                                                                                 SZ2~5
CN9 (MTH12A)
                                                                                                                                                                   SZ3
                                                                                                                                               SZ2
                                                                                                                                                                                            4
                                                                                                                                               SZ5
                                                                                                                                                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                             CNZ1                                     CN4 (SNS12A)
                                                                                                                                                                              CN9
                                                                                                                                                                                             2                                    2
                                                                                                                                                                                     CNZ1    1                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 50
                                                                                                                                                                             SZ4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           22
                                                                                                                                                         CN4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  21                                    49
                                                                                                                                                              NT
                                                                                                                                                          FRO
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         FR6H2407.EPS
                                                            N
                               Cable normal?                            Repair or replace.
                                             Y
                                                    [5]
[3] Checking the LED Lighting Status                                                                                                           [4] Measuring the Motor Resistance Value
              (1) Remove the lower light protect plate.                                                                                                (1) Power OFF the machine.
              (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.                                                                                (2) Remove the covers to gain access to the motor.
              (3) Start the M-Utility.                                                                                                                 (3) Measure the winding resistance of the motor.
              (4) Perform the procedures described in [2] to drive the relevant motor, and verify the LED                                                 Check the connector pin numbers by way of cable colors, and make sure that the winding
                  lighting status.                                                                                                                        resistance value of the motor is held within its reference levels.
                                         Location   I/O No.                  Monitoring description                    LED ON OFF                         ● Terminal numbers and locations
                                                                                                                                                                            Latch
                                                     MA1      Monitors the suction cup driving motor control signal.    Drive       Stop                                                       Terminal No.      Motor cable color
                                                                                                                                                                6       5    4                       1                 Red
                      DRV12A board                   MB1      Monitors the IP transport motor control signal.           Drive       Stop                        3       2     1                      2                Black
                                                                                                                                                                            FRMT0433.EPS             3                Yellow
                                                                                                                                TR6H2010.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                     4                Blue
              (5) Type in [2][ENT] to stop the motor, and verify the LED lighting status.                                                                                                            5                White
                                                                                                                                                                                                     6               Orange
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               TR6H2551.EPS
FR6H2032.EPS
12.2 Checking MC1, MC2, and MC3 [2] Checking Motor Operation in M-Utility
[3] Checking the LED Lighting Status                                                                                                    [4] Measuring the Motor Resistance Value
              (1) Remove the lower light protect plate.                                                                                            (1) Power OFF the machine.
              (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.                                                                            (2) Remove the covers to gain access to the motor.
              (3) Start the M-Utility.                                                                                                             (3) Measure the winding resistance of the motor.
              (4) Perform the procedures described in [2] to drive the relevant motor, and verify the LED                                             Check the connector pin numbers by way of cable colors, and make sure that the winding
                  lighting status.                                                                                                                    resistance value of the motor is held within its reference levels.
                                         Location   I/O No.                 Monitoring description                  LED ON OFF                        ● Terminal numbers and locations
                                                                                                                                                                        Latch
                                                     MC1      Monitors the side-positioning motor control signal.    Drive   Stop                                                          Terminal No.      Motor cable color
                                                                                                                                                            6       5     4                      1                 Red
                    DRV12A board                     MC2      Monitors the grip release motor control signal.        Drive   Stop                           3       2     1                      2                Black
                                                                                                                                                                        FRMT0433.EPS             3                Yellow
                                                     MC3      Monitors the IP transport motor control signal.        Drive   Stop                                                                4                Blue
                                                                                                                         TR6H2009.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                                                 5                White
                                                                                                                                                                                                 6               Orange
              (5) As the motor automatically stops 30 seconds later, verify the LED lighting status.                                                                                                                       TR6H2551.EPS
● Winding resistance value of the motor (common to MC1, MC2, and MC3)
● Block Diagram
                                                                                                                                                                         CN2 (DRV12A)
      Power supply unit                                                                                                                                 MC1
                                                                                                                                             MC3                        8
      α 400                       MTH12A            CPU12A
                                                                        A              B                                                   CNC10
                                                                                                                                                              MC2
                                                                                                                                                                        4
                                                                            CNC10          CNMC1
                                                                               1              1 RED    MC1A                                                                                5
      AC IN
                                                                                                                                                                                     1
                                                    SNS12A                     7              4 BLU    MC1B
TB1   85–265V                                                                  2              2 BLK    +24V
      1
              E                                                                8              5 WHT    +24V     MC1
      2             1                                                          3              3 YEL    MC1AL                         CN2                                    CN4 (DRV12A),
      3 +24V        2                                                          9              6 ORN    MC1BL                               CN5                              CNMC1,2,3
                                                                               4                                                             CN4
                                 CN2       DRV12A            CN5              10           CNMC2
                          +24V   1          3AT               1 MC1A           5
                                                                                                                                                                    4
                                            E11                                               1 RED    MC1A
                          PGND   2                            7 MC1B          11              4 BLU    MC1B
                          +24V   3                            2 +24V           6              2 BLK    +24V                                    O   NT               1
                                 4                            8 +24V          12              5 WHT             MC2                          FR                                        6
                                                                                                       +24V
                                 5                            3 MC1AL                         3 YEL    MC1AL
                                 6                            9 MC1BL                                                                                                            3
                                            3AT                                               6 ORN    MC1BL
                                 7                            4 MC2A                                                                                                                 FR6H2411.EPS
                                            E51
                                 8                           10 MC2B
                                                              5 +24V
                                                             11 +24V
                                                              6 MC2AL
                                                             12 MC2BL
                                                             CN4                           CNMC3
                                            3AT              1 MC3A                           1 RED    MC1A
                                            E21
                                                             4 MC3B                           4 BLU    MC1B
                                                             2 +24V                           2 BLK    +24V
                                                             5 +24V                           5 WHT    +24V     MC3
                                                             3 MC3AL                          3 YEL    MC1AL
                                                             6 MC3BL                          6 ORN    MC1BL
FR6H2031.EPS
12.3 Checking MZ2 and MZ3 [2] Checking Motor Operation in M-Utility
                                                                   N
                                  Cable normal?                               Repair or replace.
                                                Y
                                                       [5]
MZ2 Monitors the grip release motor drive signal. Drive Stop
DRV12A board MZ3 Monitors dust removal motor drive signal. Drive Stop
TR6H2008.EPS
                              +15V   5
                              PGND   6                            8
                                     7
                    L                8
                        1
               +15V     2
FR6H2030.EPS
12.4 Checking MZ1 (FFM Motor)                                                                                            [2] Checking the LED Lighting Status
                                                                                                                                  (1) Remove the lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                  (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                  (3) Start the M-Utility.
           START                                                                                                                  (4) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [9][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive “MZ1
                                                                                                                                      (FFM)” at “READING SPEED”.
                                                                                                                                  (5) Make sure that the LED is illuminated.
  Activate the motor to be    N   Fuse on L11 of the           N            Replace the fuse.
  checked. M-Utility              DRV12A board normal?                         "Check, Replacement, and                                                        Location   I/O No.             Monitoring description            LED ON OFF
  indication and DRV12A                                                        Adjustment Volume:
  board LED lighting                           Y                               12. Fuse Replacement and
                                                      “10.2 Motor-Related
  normal?                                                                      Fuse Locations”
                                                      Fuses”                                                                                                              FFM       Monitors the FFM motor drive signal.         Drive       Stop
                    Y
                        [2]                                    N
  1                               Cable normal?                             Repair or replace.                                                                                                                                           TR6H2022.EPS
                                                                                                                                           DRV12A board
                                               Y
                                                      [3]
            END
      Return to the error
      code analysis flow.         Reseat the DRV12A/           N
                                  CPU12A board and check              1                                                           (6) Hit [2][ENT] to stop the motor.
                                  if the error occurs again.
                                                                                                                                  (7) Make sure that the LED turns OFF, with “RESULT: OK” displayed.
                                               Y
                    2. Check for shorts between each of the pins and GND                   → 2Ω or greater.                                                                                       1
                    3. Check for shorts between each of the pins                           → 2Ω or greater.                                                                                                            8
                                                                                                                                                                                                               4
                    4. Check for continuity of each of the pins                            → 1Ω or less.
21 FR6H2413.EPS
           END                The resistance value of             N                                                                                  (2) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [5][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive the suction pump
                              the actuator normal?                           Repair or replace.
                                                                                                                                                         (PA1).
                                             Y            [4]                                                                                            By listening to its driving sound, verify that the pump is operating.
                                                                                                                                                     (3) Type in [2][ENT] to stop the suction pump (PA1).
                                                                                                                                                     (4) Hit [0][ENT].
                                                                N
                                                                                                                                                     (5) Make sure that “RESULT: OK” appears.
                              Cable normal?                                  Repair or replace.
                                             Y            [5]
                                                                                                                                                     (6) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utility.
              (2) Type in [6][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [1][ENT] to drive the IP stopper solenoid (SOLZ1).
                    By listening to its driving sound, verify that the solenoid is operating.                                                                           SVA1      Monitors the IP leak valve drive signal.                 Drive      Stop
              (3) Type in [2][ENT] to stop the IP stopper solenoid (SOLZ1).
              (4) Hit [0][ENT].
                                                                                                                                                                        CLA1      Monitors the clutch drive signal.                        Drive      Stop
              (5) Make sure that “RESULT: OK” appears.
              (6) Navigate the menu to return to the initial screen of the M-Utilit
                                                                                                                                                                        SolZ1     Monitors the stopper driving solenoid control signal.    Drive      Stop
TR6H2007.EPS
                                                                                                                                                       Latch
                    ● Terminal numbers and locations                                                                                                                  Terminal No.       Actuator cable color
                                   Latch                                                                                                     3       4                     1                    Red
                                                       Terminal No.       Actuator cable color
                                                                                                                                                                           2               Not connected
                         3       4                                                                                                            1       2
                                                              1                  Red
                                                                                                                                                    FRMT0442.EPS           3                    Black
                         1        2                           2             Not connected
                                                                                                                                                                           4               Not connected
                                FRMT0442.EPS                  3                 Yellow                                                                                                                   TR6H2557.EPS
                                                              4                  Black
                                                                                                                                        ● Resistance value of the actuator (common to SOLA1 and SOLZ1)
                                                                                          TR6H2554.EPS
                                                                                                                                                                 Reference
                    ● Resistance value of the actuator (common to SOLA1 and SOLZ1)                                                       Measurement position resistance value
                                                                                            CNPA1
                                                                                                      RED
                                                                                                                                             CN2                                CNSolA1,
           AC IN                                                                               1
                                                                                               3      BLK                                           CN7                         CNPA1,
     TB1   85–265V
           1                                                                                   2             PA1                                      CN6                       CNSolZ1,
                   D                  CN2          DRV12A            CN7
           2                                        3AT                               NC       4
                         1     +24V   1                              1 +24V
           3 +24V                                   D21
                         2     PGND   2                              6 +24VH                                                                                  T
                               +24V   3                              2 NC                  CNSVA1                                                           ON              4
                     E                                                                                                                                 FR
                               PGND   4                              7 +24VL                  1       RED
                         1                                                                            BLK SVA1
                                                    2A               3 +24VPA1                2
                +24V     2
                                                    D31
                                                                                                                                                                            2
                                      8                              8 PGND                                                                                                                  3
                                                                     4 +24VSVA1                                                                                                          1                           FR6H2409.EPS
                                                                     9 PGND                CNCLA1
                                                    2A               5 +24VCLA1               1       RED
                                                    E41
                                                                     10 PGND                  2       BLK CLA1
                                                                     CN6
                                                                     1
                                                                                           CNSOLZ1
                                                                     3   +24V                 1       RED
                                                    E31
                                                                     7   +24VH                3       YEL
                                                                     4   NC                   2       BLK SolZ1
                                                                     8   +24VL                4
FR6H2029.EPS
                                N                                                                                         Replace the power                           (6) Check to see if the LED on the SCN12A board is normal.
   Laser ON operation               TP2 voltage on the              N       Voltage on the power supply      N
                                                                                                                          supply unit.
   normal in M-Utility?             SCN12A board normal?                    unit normal?                                                                          [GOOD indication]
                                                                                                                              “Check, Replacement,
                 Y
                          [2]
                                                    Y
                                                            “9.1 Checking the Voltage
                                                                                            Y
                                                                                                   “9.2 Checking the          and Adjustment Volume:                   ◆ NOTE ◆
 1                                                          on the Board Test Pins                 Voltage on the Power       11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                       Because the “HVOK” LED indication varies depending on the position of the HV switch, check
                                                            (Connectors)”                          Supply Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                       the position of the HV switch.
             END                                                                                                                                                          • High-voltage switch in the ON position  → LED ON
        Return to error code
                                                                                                                                                                          • High-voltage switch in the OFF position → LED OFF
                                                        Power OFF
        analysis flow
                                                                                                                                                                                                              POLLOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ON
LD11DLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     PMTD1G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     POLON
                                                    Y
ZLCLK
LD10N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             LD20N
                                                                                                                                                                         LD10K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                 HVOK
                                                                                                                                                                                                       PCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                        FCLK
                                                            [3]                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Blinking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SOH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SOS
                                                                    N                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             OFF
                                    Error recurs?                             1
                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Controller front view
                                    SCN12A and CPU12A
                                                                    N
                                    boards tested in M-Utility                                  Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              S1
                                    normal?                                                         “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         HVON
                                                                                                    and Adjustment Volume”                                                                                                                  CN5
                                                    Y                                               “11.3 SCN12A Board”                                                                 CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                CN4           S1
                                                            “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”
                                                                                                    “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         SCN12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             FR6H2039.EPS
                                                                    N
                                    Error recurs?                             1
                                                    Y                                                                                                             [NG indication]
                                                                                                                                                                            All other than GOOD indication.
                                                        Replace the scanning optics unit.
                                                            “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume:
                                                            8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”                                              FR6H2103.EPS
                                                MTH12A         CPU12A
                                                                                                                                                                      CNE1        4
                                                                                A                       Scanning optics unit
                                                                                                                                                                                               1
      Power supply unit
                                                               SCN12A                                          LDD12A
      α400              A1                                                 CN1             CNE1
                                                                                                                                                                      CN9
                                                    5A        1.5A                                             CN1
                             1 +5                                        1 +15AS          1 +15AS
                 +5V                                H11       H13                                              1                                           CN8
                             2 +5V-GND                                   2 AG             2 AG
                                              CN9                        3 +15AS          3 +15AS              2
                        A2                1
                                                                         4 AG             4 AG
      AC IN                  1 +5V        3                                                                                                 CN1
                                                                         5 +15AS          5 +15AS
TB1   85-265V    +5V         2 +5V-GND    2
                                                                         6 AG             6 AG
      1                                   4
                        B                                                7 +15AS          7 +15AS
      2                      1 +24V                                      8 AG             8 AG
      3                                             5A        1.5A
                 +24V        2 +24V-GND     CN8                          9 -15AS          9 -15AS
                                                    J11       J12                                                                                      T
                                           1                             10 AG            10 AG                                                     ON
                        C                  6                             11 -15AS         11 -15AS                                                FR
                             1 +24V                                      12 AG            12 AG
                                           2
                 +24V        2 +24V-GND                                  13 LD1IDH        13 LD1IDH
                                           7                                                                  19
                        H                  3                             14 LD1IDL        14 LD1IDL           20                            SCN12A-CN1                            CNE1
                             1 +15V        8                             15               15 LD1ONH
                                                                              NC
                 +15V        2 +15V-GND    4                             16               16 LD1ONL
                                           9                             17 LD1ONH        17 LD1OKH                                     2
                        J                  5                             18 LD1ONL        18 LD1OKL                                                                          20
                             1 -15V                                      19               19 LDIFH
                                          10                                  NC
                 -15V        2 -15V-GND                                  20               20 LDIFL                                     1
                                                                         21 LD1OKH                                                                                     40    19
                        K                                                   LD1OKL
                             1 +24V                                      22
                 +24V        2 +24-GND                                   23 LDIFH
                                                                         24 LDIFL
                                                                                                                                                                                                       2
                                                                         40                                                                                      39                                1
                                                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H2403.EPS
Error detection signal: LD1IDH, LD1IDL, LD1ONH, LD1ONL, LD1OKH, LD1OKL FR6H2023.EPS
14.2 Checking the Polygonal Mirror (POL)                                                                                                                  [2] Checking Laser ON in M-Utility
                                                                                                                                                                       (1) Remove the front cover and lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                                                       (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                                       (3) Start the M-Utility.
           START                                                                                                                                                       (4) Type in [5][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] to turn ON the laser.
                                                                                                                                                                       (5) Check the result for “RESULT: ”.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                POLLOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ON
LD11DLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        PMTD1G
                                    boards tested in M-Utility                                   Replace the error-causing board.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        POLON
                                                                                                                                                                                                 ZLCLK
LD10N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                LD20N
                                                                                                                                                                           LD10K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                   HVOK
                                                                                                     “Check, Replacement,
                                                                                                                                                                                                         PCLK
                                    normal?
                                                                                                                                                                                          FCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Blinking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 SOH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           SOS
                                                                                                     and Adjustment Volume”
                                                    Y                                                “11.3 SCN12A Board”                                                                                                                                                                                              OFF
                                                             “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”           “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            HVON
                                                        Replace the scanning optics unit.                                           FR6H2130.EPS                                                                                               CN5
                                                            “Check, Replacement, and                                                                                                      CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                 CN4           S1
                                                            Adjustment Volume:                                                                                                                                             SCN12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 FR6H2040.EPS
                                                            8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                   [NG indication]
                                                                                                                                                                           All other than GOOD indication.
                                                                                                       CN1
                                                                                                                                                                                       1
           Power supply unit                                                                           8
                                                                                              NC       7                                               CN9             SCN12A-CN3
            α400              A1                      MTH12A       CPU12A                  PIDXL       6
                                   1 +5                                                    GND-P       5                                         CN8
                       +5V         2 +5V-GND                                               PONL
                                                     CN9                                               4                                                       1
                                                                                           POKL        3
                              A2                 1
                                                                                           GND-P       2
            AC IN                  1 +5V         3                                                                                     CN3
                       +5V         2 +5V-GND     2                                         +24PS       1
     TB1    85-265V                                                                                                                                                           6
            1                                    4
                              B                                    SCN12A                                                                                              CNE2
            2                      1 +24V
            3                      2 +24V-GND                                                                                                T
                       +24V                       CN8                                                                                     ON
                                                 1                                                                                      FR
                              C
                                   1 +24V
                                                 6
                                                 2
                                                                                  A                                                                            1
                       +24V        2 +24V-GND
                                                 7
                              H                  3                                                                                                                            6
                                   1 +15V        8                          CN3            CNE2                                                                                   FR6H2405.EPS
14.3 Checking the Start-Point Sensor (SYN)                                                                                                                [2] Checking Laser ON in M-Utility
                                                                                                                                                                       (1) Remove the front cover and lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                                                       (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                                       (3) Start the M-Utility.
            START                                                                                                                                                      (4) Type in [5][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] to turn ON the laser.
                                                                                                                                                                       (5) Check the result for “RESULT: ”.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                POLLOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           ON
LD11DLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       PMTD1G
                                                                     N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       POLON
                                                                               1
ZLCLK
LD10N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               LD20N
                                                                                                                                                                           LD10K
                                     Error recurs?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                   HVOK
                                                                                                                                                                                                         PCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                          FCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           Blinking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SOH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          SOS
                                                     Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           OFF
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           HVON
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              CN5
                                                                     N                                                                                                                    CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                CN4           S1
                                     Error recurs?                             1                                                                                                                                           SCN12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      FR6H2044.EPS
                                                     Y
● Block Diagram
                                                                                                                                                                          4
      Power supply unit
                                                                                                                                                                                  1
       α400                A1                      MTH12A          CPU12A                                                                               CN1
                                1 +5                                                                                                                               CN9
                    +5V         2 +5V-GND                                                                                                                                SYN12A-CN1
                           A2                1
                                                 CN9
                                                       5A
                                                       A21
                                                                                                      A
                                1 +5V        3                                                                                                               CN8
       AC IN
TB1    85–265V      +5V         2 +5V-GND    2
       1                                     4                                                            Scanning optics unit                 CN1                       1
                           B                                       SCN12A
       2                        1 +24V
       3            +24V        2 +24V-GND    CN8      5A           1.5A             CN1                         SYN12A
                                             1         H11          H12          1
                           C                 6                                                                   CN1                                                                  10
                                1 +24V                                                           +15VAS                                                  T
                                                                                      +15VAS
                                2 +24V-GND
                                             2                                   25                             10                                     ON                SCN12A-CN1
                    +24V
                                             7                                   26   AG         AG             9                                    FR
                                                                    1.5A              +5VAS      +5VAS
                           H                 3                                   27                             8
                                1 +15V       8
                                                                    H14
                                                                                 28   AG         AG             7
                                                                                                                                                                         2
                                                       5A           1.5A              -15VAS
                    +15V        2 +15V-GND   4                                   29              -15AVS         6
                                                       J11          J12
                                             9                                   30   AG         AG             5
                           J                 5                                   31   +5VDS      +5VDS          4                                                        1
                                1 -15V                              1.5A              GND        DG
                                                                                                                                                                                                     40
                                             10                     A22          32                             3
                    -15V        2 -15V-GND
                                                                                 33   SSL        SSL            2
                           K                                                     34   SSH        SSH            1
                                1 +24V
                    +24V        2 +24-GND                                        40     NC
                                                                                                                                                                                       39
                                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H2401.EPS
14.4 Checking the Leading-Edge Sensor (SZ1)                                                                                                          [2] Checking Laser ON in M-Utility
                                                                                                                                                                  (1) Remove the front cover and lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                                                  (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                                  (3) Start the M-Utility.
           START
                                                                                                                                                                  (4) Type in [5][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] to turn ON the laser.
                                                                                                                                                                  (5) Check the result for “RESULT: ”.
                                                                                                                                                                      “RESULT: OK”                                   → The troubleshooting procedure is completed.
                                                                                                                                                                      “RESULT: XXXXX” → See the error code table to perform troubleshooting as appropriate.
                                                                                                         N          Replace the power
 Laser ON operation normal N   TP2 voltage on the              N       Voltage on the power supply                                                                (6) Check to see if the LED on the SCN12A board is normal.
 in M-Utility?                 SCN12A board normal?                    unit normal?                                 supply unit.
                Y                              Y                                        Y
                                                                                                                         “Check, Replacement,                 [GOOD indication]
                                                                                                                         and Adjustment Volume:
                    [2]                                “9.1 Checking the Voltage               “9.2 Checking the
                                                       on the Board Test Pins                  Voltage on the
                                                                                                                         11.8 Power Supply”                        ◆ NOTE ◆
  1                                                    (Connectors)”                           Power Supply Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                   Because the “HVOK” LED indication varies depending on the position of the HV switch, check
                                                                                                                                                                   the position of the HV switch.
            END                                                                                                                                                       • High-voltage switch in the ON position  → LED ON
                                                   Power OFF                                                                                                          • High-voltage switch in the OFF position → LED OFF
                                                               N                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Check unnecessary
                               Cable normal?                                      Restore the cable.
                                                                                                                                                                                                           POLLOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                ON
LD11DLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  PMTD1G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  POLON
                                               Y
ZLCLK
LD10N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          LD20N
                                                                                                                                                                      LD10K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                              HVOK
                                                                                                                                                                                                    PCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                     FCLK
                                                        [3]                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Blinking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           SOH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     SOS
                                                               N                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                OFF
                               Error recurs?                                1
                                               Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                           Controller front view
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      HVON
                                                                                                and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         CN5
                                                                                                “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                               Y                                                                                                                                     CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                CN4           S1
                                                        “8. Board Tests in M-Utility”           “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SCN12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H2043.EPS
                                                               N
                               Error recurs?                                1
                                               Y
                                                                                                                                                              [NG indication]
                                                                                                                                                                      All other than GOOD indication.
                                                   If the error recurs, replace the scanning
                                                   optics unit.
                                                       “Check, Replacement,
                                                       and Adjustment Volume:
                                                       8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
FR6H2131.EPS
                             K
                                  1 +24V
                      +24V        2 +24-GND
14.5 Checking the Light-Collecting Unit (PMT)                                                                                                               [2] Checking the Light-Collecting Unit in M-Utility
                                                                                                                                                                     (1) Remove the front cover and lower light protect plate.
                                                                                                                                                                     (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A board.
[1] Analysis Flow
                                                                                                                                                                     (3) Start the M-Utility.
           START                                                                                                                                                     (4) Type in [5][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] to turn ON the laser.
                                                                                                                                                                     (5) Check the result for “RESULT: ”.
   Laser ON operation           N                                  N                                         N           Replace the power                               “RESULT: OK”                                   → The troubleshooting procedure is completed.
                                    TP2 voltage on the                      Voltage on the power supply
                                                                                                                         supply unit.
   normal in M-Utility?             SCN12A board normal?                    unit normal?                                                                                 “RESULT: XXXXX” → See the error code table to perform troubleshooting as appropriate.
                                                                                                                             “Check, Replacement,
                 Y                                  Y                                       Y                                and Adjustment Volume:                  (6) Check to see if the LED on the SCN12A board is normal.
                          [2]                               “9.1 Checking the Voltage               “9.2 Checking the
 1                                                          on the Board Test Pins                  Voltage on the
                                                                                                                             11.8 Power Supply”
                                                                                                                                                                   [GOOD indication]
                                                            (Connectors)”                           Power Supply Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                      ◆ NOTE ◆
             END
                                                                                                                                                                      Because the “HVOK” LED indication varies depending on the position of the HV switch, check
       Return to error code                             Power OFF
       analysis flow
                                                                                                                                                                      the position of the HV switch.
                                                                                                                                                                         • High-voltage switch in the ON position  → LED ON
                                    Fuses H12 and J12 on the       N                Replace the fuse.                                                                    • High-voltage switch in the OFF position → LED OFF
                                    SCN12A board normal?                                “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                        12.2 SCN12A Board Fuses”
                                                    Y
                                                            “10.4 Scanner-Related Fuses”                                                                                                                                                                                     Polygon ON
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Quasi-reading LED ON
                                                                   N                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Quasi-reading PMT
                                    Cable normal?                                   Restore the cable.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Data issuance
                                                    Y
                                                             [3]                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Check unnecessary
                                                                                                                                                                                                              POLLOCK
                                                                   N                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                ON
LD11DLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     PMTD1G
                                    Error recurs?                             1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     POLON
                                                                                                                                                                                               ZLCLK
LD10N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             LD20N
                                                                                                                                                                         LD10K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                 HVOK
                                                                                                                                                                                                       PCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                        FCLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Blinking
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SOH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SOS
                                                    Y
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    OFF
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         HVON
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            CN5
                                                                   N
                                    Error recurs?                             1                                                                                                         CN1              CN6            CN2 CN3                                CN4           S1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         SCN12A
                                                    Y                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FR6H2041.EPS
CN5 CN2
                                                                                                                   Photomultiplier
  Error detection signal: HVOKH, HVOKL, +15VOKH, 15VOKL, VIONH, VIONL                                                      FR6H2024.EPS
15.2 Checking the LED on the CPU12A Board [2] LED Check
 TP1 voltage on the CPU12A board        N         Voltage on the power supply unit     N               Replace the power                                                Handle                                                                                                             Handle
 normal?                                          normal?                                              supply unit.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    100/10 (green)               Sub CPU LED                       Main CPU LED
                                                                                                                                                                                FDPOL (green)
                                                                                                           “Check, Replacement,
                    Y                                                 Y                                                                                                                         RX (green)     TX (green)
                                                                                                           and Adjustment Volume:
                           “9.1 Checking the Voltage                       “9.2 Checking the Voltage       11.8 Power Supply”
                           on the Board Test Pins (Connectors)”            on the Power Supply Unit”                                                                                    Meanings of Ethernet operation LED illumination                                     Meaning of CPU operation LED illumination
                                                                                                                                                          LINK                   COL            FDPOL              RX                TX              100/10                Main CPU LED              Sub CPU LED
                                                  Fuse A11, A41 on the MTH12A          N             Replace the fuse.                               Link established    Collision occurred   In operation   Packet receiving   Packet sending Connected at 100Mbps   Indicate operating status Indicate operating status
                                                  board normal?                                          “Check, Replacement,
      1                                                                                                  and Adjustment Volume:                                                                                                                                                                                   FR6H2526.EPS
                                                                      Y
                                                                                                         12. Fuse Replacement and Fuse Locations”
                                                                           “10.7 Board Check Pin Fuses”                                              [3] LED Indication
                                                                          Replace the boards in the order named.                                                 [GOOD indication]
                                                                           1. CPU12A
                                                                           2. MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                                                  Ethernet operation LED
                                                                            “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                                            “11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                            “11.7 MTH12A Board”                                                                                                                                                                   CPU operation LED
                                        N                                              N                                                                                  Lit
 Main CPU LED normal?                            Reseat the CPU12A board and                     1
                                                 check if the error occurs again.
                    Y
                          [2]                                         Y
                                                                          Replace the CPU12A board.
                                                                              “Check, Replacement,
                                                                              and Adjustment Volume:                                                                                                                                              Sub CPU LED                              Main CPU LED
                                                                              11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                        N                                              N                                                                                                                                                                                                           FR6H2524.EPS
 Ethernet LED normal?                            Cable connection normal?                              Repair or replace.
                    Y                                                 Y                                                                                          [NG indication]
                          [3]
                                                                          Replace the boards in the order named.
                                                                           1. CPU12A                                                                              • When the network cable is not connected
                                                                           2. CNN12A
                                                                                                                                                                                  Ethernet operation LED
                                                                            “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”                                                                                                                                           CPU operation LED
                                                                            “11.2 CPU12A Board”                                                                         Unlit
                                                                            “11.10 CNN12A Board”
                                        N
 Error recurs?                                                    1
                    Y
15.3 Checking the IP Address                                                                              [2] Checking Ping with RU Network Cable Disconnected
                                                                                                                   [GOOD indication]
15.4 Initializing and Setting the AP Ad dress of CL/RU                                                                                    (3) Make sure that the IP address of the RU is at its default, and then start the M-Utility.
                                                                                                                                              If it is not at its default, enter the default value, and then start the M-Utility.
           To set the IP addresses of the CL and RU, first initialize their IP addresses before changing the
                                                                                                                                                                                      #1 [Check] RU IP ADDR
           user settings of the RU and CL in the order named.
           CAUTIONS
           Make sure that devices that are set as shown below are not connected over the same network:
              (1) Make sure that devices that are set as shown below are not connected over the same
                  network:
                    • Device where ‘ru0’ is used as the RU host name                                                                      (4) Double-click              on the desktop.
                    • Device where the IP address is used by its default setting
                    ➮ If any such device is connected over the same network, disconnect that device from the                                  ➮ The “My Computer” window opens.
                      same network by powering it OFF or unplugging its I/F cable.
              (2) Turn OFF and then back ON the power switch of the RU, and, at the same time, hold down                                  (5) Double-click                  .
                  the erasure process switch until the erasure process indicator blinks (once).
                                                                                                                                              ➮ The “Control Panel” window opens.
                                                                                            [Press] Erasure
                                                                                            process switch                                (7) Double-click              .
                                                                                    Blink
                                                                                                          FR6H2542.EPS
              (8) Click                    .
                    ➮ The “Local Area Connection Properties” window opens.
FR6H2548.EPS
            (12) Click                 .
                    ➮ You are returned to the “Local Area Connection Properties” window.
            (13) Click                 .
                    ➮ The system returns to the desktop screen.
                    REFERENCE
               When a window appears prompting you to restart the system, click [Yes].
               Once the OS has started, the CL-AP will start up automatically.
            (14) Click on             and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute has
                    passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
            (15) Change the IP addresses of the CL and RU to the user settings.
                        “CL Service Manual, Installation (IN-B)”
               CAUTION
               To change the IP address to the user setting, be sure to change the IP address of the RU first.
               If the IP address of the CL is changed first, connection cannot be established between the CL
               and RU.
15.5 Action to be Taken When the RU Application Software is                                                                           (2) Set the IP address of the CL to “172.16.1.20” (default value).
                                                                                                                                              “15.4 Initializing and Setting the AP Address of CL/RU”
     Damaged
                                                                                                                                      (3) Exit the CL software.
           Below are described the procedures for updating the RU application software when the RU                                    (4) Set the IP address of the RU to its default.
           application software is damaged.
                                                                                                                                                                       #1 [Set] RU IP ADDR “172.16.1.10”
           CAUTIONS
           • Do not power OFF the RU and CL during RU application update. If power is turned OFF during
             update, the machine will no longer boot up.
           • When the M-Utility can be started (can be logged in), the procedures described in this section
             should not be performed.
             If the procedures are inadvertently performed under condition where the M-Utility can be started,
             the CPU12A board should be replaced with a new one.
           • Make sure that there is no machine that has been set up as described below, connected over the
             same network.
             If such a machine is connected over the same network, disconnect it from the network by
             powering it OFF or unplugging its I/F cable.                                                                                                                                               FR6H4D75.EPS
             Unless such a machine is disconnected, the application and configuration data of that machine                            (5) [Struggle] → [Rescue APPL via Network (Soft Update)]
             will be automatically updated as well when the application of the RU is updated.
               REFERENCE
           By performing “soft up date”, the application software and configuration data of the FTP server are
           overwritten, and the software and data so changed are written into the FLASH ROM.
FR6H4D28.EPS
              (7) Make sure that "Write OK" appears.                                                                                                  (11) Using TEMPORARY SETTING of SOFTWARE UTILITY, change the following items to
                                                                                                                                                           the user settings that have been noted before the procedure.
                                                                                                   [Press] Erasure
                                                                                                   process switch
                                                                                           Blink
                                                                                                                  FR6H4D77.EPS
              (9) Set the IP address of the RU to its default, and click on the [PING] button.                                                                         #1 [Type/ENT]
                    Referring to the DOS prompt window displayed, make sure that the result is 100%
                    successful.
            (10) Click on the [MUTL] button.                                                                                                                                                     #3 [Check] Ensure that they have been
                                                                                                                                                                        #2 [Type/ENT]                       changed to the default values.
                                                                        (9) #1 Enter the default IP address
FR6H4D76.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute “PING”,                                                                                                                      FR6H4D09.EPS
               before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has not been
               connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
            (12) Turn OFF the power switch of the RU and then back ON.                                                         15.5.2 Procedure to be Taken When Version 1.1 or Earlier of PC-MUTL is Used
               ◆ NOTE ◆
                                                                                                                                            (1) Make sure that there is no machine that has been set up as described below, connected over
               Unless the power switch of the RU is turned OFF and then back ON, the user settings will not                                     the same network.
               become effective.
                                                                                                                                                • Machine that uses ru0 as the RU host name.
(13) Set the IP address of the CL to the user setup value. • Machine that uses the IP address by its default.
                         “CL Service Manual, Installation (IN-B)”                                                                               ➮ If such a machine is connected, isolate it from the network by powering it OFF or
                                                                                                                                                  disconnecting its I/F cable.
            (14) Click on                   and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.                                (2) Set the IP address of the CL to “172.16.1.20” (default value).
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.                                                                                     “15.4 Initializing and Setting the AP Address of CL/RU”
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute has                                   (3) Start “Command Prompt” from the [Start] menu.
                    passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
                    Boot up the CL.
            (15) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen, and
                 reboot the RU from the CL screen, and the RU boots up.
                    When it is rebooted, all the panel indicators are illuminated, with an audible alarm generated.                                                                                                           [Click]
                        RU panel                            CL screen
                      (CALL lamp)
                                                              ID
#1 [Check]
FR6H4D08.EPS
              (7) Type in “softupdate”.                                                                                               (13) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen, and
                    All the panel indicators on the RU are illuminated for about two minutes (with no audible                              reboot the RU from the CL screen, and the RU boots up.
                    alarm).                                                                                                                When it is rebooted, all the panel indicators are illuminated, with an audible alarm generated.
                                                                                FR6H2567.EPS
                                                                                                                                                 RU panel                              CL screen
                                                                                                                                               (CALL lamp)
                    REFERENCES                                                                                                                                                          ID
               • By performing “soft update”, the application software and the configuration data of default
                 values are written into the flash ROM. (Step (7))                                                                                                       #1 [Check]
               • Once the configuration data is overwritten, the IP address of the RU is changed to the user
                 setting. Thus, it is necessary to change the IP address of the CL to the user setting. (Steps
                 (10 and 11))
[Type] FR6H3097.EPS
                                                                  (5) [Type]
                                                                                                                                              [11025]      [11025] RU: CONFIGURATION UPDATE. Reboot the RU.                          #1 [Check]
                                                          (6) [Type] cr-ir346
                                                  (7) [Type]                                                                                              Alarm stop                                                   REBOOT        #2 [Click]
              (9) Turn OFF the power switch of the RU and then back ON.                                                                              RU panel                          CL screen
            (10) Using TEMPORARY SETTING of SOFTWARE UTILITY, change the IP address to the user                                                (Cassette loading lamp)
                 setting.                                                                                                                                                               ID
                        “ Check, Replacement and Adjustment Volume, 11.2 Replacing the CPU12A Board, [4]
                        Change the memory on the CPU12A board to the user settings”
            (11) Set the IP address of the CL to the user setup value.
                        “CL Service Manual, Installation (IN-B)”
                                                                                                                                                        Illuminated
            (12) Click on             and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
RU:
RU:
Illuminated FR6H3096.EPS
           For RU NAME, the names described in “15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory”, “15.6.2 RU NAME of                                   (1) Exit the CL software.
           CL Configuration”, and “Folder Name of FTP Server” must be all identical.                                               (2) Start the IIP Service Utility.
                                                                                                                                   (3) Click [Setup Configuration Item].
15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory                                                                                                        (4) Check the setting of “NETWORK CONFIG”.
                                                                           ru0
                                                   ru0
                                                                                                                                   (5) Check the setting of “CONNECTING EQUIPMENT”.
                                                                                                                                       Make sure that all the RU’s connected have been set.
FRMT3340.EPS
              (5) If any of the names described in “15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory”, “15.6.2 RU NAME of CL
                  Configuration”, and “Folder Name of FTP Server” is different, perform the procedures
                  described in “15.6.4 Correcting RU NAME” to make all the names identical.
              (6) If any of the names described in “15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory”, “15.6.2 RU NAME of CL         15.6.4 Correcting RU NAME
                  Configuration”, and “Folder Name of FTP Server” is different, perform the procedures
                  described in “15.6.4 Correcting RU NAME” to make all the names identical.                              If any of the names described in “15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory”, “15.6.2 RU NAME of CL
                                                                                                                         Configuration”, and “Folder Name of FTP Server” is different, perform the procedures described in
15.6.3 Folder Name of FTP Server                                                                                         “15.6.4 Correcting RU NAME” to make all the names identical.
              (1) Exit the CL software.                                                                         ■ To Change RU NAME for 15.6.1 and 15.6.3
              (2) Using Explorer, check the folder name of the RU in the SYSTEM folder.                                       REFERENCE
                                                                                                                         If version 1.2 or later of PC-MUTL is used, RU NAME may be changed by using the RENAME
                                                                                                                         function of PC-MUTL, instead of the procedures described below.
                                                                                                                               “Maintenance Utility Volume, 2.1.5 RENAME: Changing RU NAME”
              (3) If any of the names described in “15.6.1 RU NAME on RU Memory”, “15.6.2 RU NAME of CL
                  Configuration”, and “Folder Name of FTP Server” is different, perform the procedures de-
                  scribed in “15.6.4 Correcting RU NAME” to make all the names identical.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      F
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      R
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      O
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      T
Subscanning unit
FRONT
                                                                                   Guide plate
                                                                                                                                                                         Guide
Rubber roller
Rubber roller
                                                                 Acrylic
                                                                 filter
Rubber roller
Roller
                                                                  Roller
          Antistatic
          brush                                                                                                                                                         Unit: mm
                                                               Unit: mm                                                View from front
                       View from front
                                                                                                                                                      IP edge
                                                                                                                                         (reference side for IP conveyance)
                                                       IP edge                                                                                                                      FR6H2535.EPS
■ Subscanning Unit
                                                                                              Rubber roller
Antistatic brush
                     Roller
                                                                                                 F
                                                                                                 R
                                                                                                 O
                                                                                                 N
                                                                                                 T
                                                                                             Unit: mm
                              View from top
                                                                              IP edge
                                                                 (reference side for IP conveyance)
                                                                                               FR6H2536.EPS
16.2 Troubleshooting Based on Scratches or Streaks on the IP Back                                                     ■ Cassette Set Unit
     Face (Black)
                                                Top
                                                                                    Erasure
                                                                                    conveyor
                                                                                                                                            Suction cup
Lid-opening bracket
                                                                                    Side-positioning
            Front
                                                                                    conveyor
                                                                                                                                                                                                     F
                                                                                                                                                                                                     R
                                                                                                                                                                                                     O
                                                                                                                                                                                                     N
                                                                                                                                                                                                     T
       Subscanning unit                                                                                                                            View from top                           Unit: mm
                                                                M
                                                                                                                                                                                IP edge
                                                                                                                                                                   (reference side for IP conveyance)
                                                                                                                                                                                             FR6H2538.EPS
FRONT
                                                                                                                                                                       Guide
                                                                   Rubber roller
                                                                    Plastic roller
                                                                Guide                                                                                             Rubber roller
Rubber roller
Guide Guide
Guide
                                                                                                                                                                  Rubber roller
                                                                                             Antistatic brush
                                                                                                  (front side)
                                                                   Rubber roller
Antistatic brush
FR6H2540.EPS
■ Subscanning Unit
Rubber roller
Guide plate
Guide
                                                                              F
                                                                              R
                                                                              O
                                                                              N
                                                                              T
                                Guide
                                                                             Unit: mm
                                                      IP edge
                                        (reference side for IP conveyance)
                     View from top                                            FR6H2541.EPS
                                                               Quasi-data output from the             N                         Reseat the SCN12A board and          N                                  XX3XX error occurs?                    N               Replace the CPU12A board.
                                                               SCN12A board normal?                                             check if the error occurs again.                1                                                                                   “Check, Replacement, and
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             Y
                                                                                   Y                                                              Y                                                                                                                 Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                             “Maintenance Utility Volume:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                                             [5-12-3] SCN12A INPUT”                                                                                                              Check the error code table
                                                                                                                                                      Replace the boards in the order named.                                     and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                                                       1. SCN12A                                                                      “Error Code Table”
                                                                                                                                                       2. MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                       3. CPU12A
                                                                                N
                                      Horizontal streaks recur?                                               1
                                                         Y Replace the parts in the order named.         “Check, Replacement, and Adjustment Volume”
                                                            1. Scanning optics unit                      “8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 FR6H2154.EPS
                                                            2. SCN12A                                    “11.3 SCN12A Board”
                                             Quasi-data output from the             N                    Reseat the SCN12A board and             N                                                                N          Replace the CPU12A board.
                                             SCN12A board normal?                                        check if the error occurs again.               1                  XX3XX error occurs?
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                “Check, Replacement,
                                                                Y          “Maintenance Utility Volume:                   Y Replace the boards                                             Y                                    and Adjustment Volume:
                                                                                                                                                        “Check, Replacement, and                                                11.2 CPU12A Board”
                                                                           [5-12-3] SCN12A INPUT”                           in the order named.         Adjustment Volume”
                                                                                                                              1. SCN12A                 “11.3 SCN12A Board”                    Check the error code table
                                                                                                                              2. MTH12A                 “11.7 MTH12A Board”                    and troubleshoot.
                                                                                                                              3. CPU12A                 “11.2 CPU12A Board”                        “Error Code Table”
                                             Quasi-data output from the             N                                         Replace the light-collecting unit.          Reseat the PMT12A and               N
                                             LED lighting on the PMT12A                                                           “Check, Replacement,                    SCN12A boards and check if                  1
                                             board normal?                                                                        and Adjustment Volume:                  the error occurs again.
                                                                Y          “Maintenance Utility Volume:                           9.1 Light-Collecting Unit”                              Y
                                                                           [5-12-1] LIGHT”
[Phenomenon]
           The bootup sequences of the CL and RU are completed normally; however, after a cassette is
           inserted under condition where reading operation is possible, the IP comes to a halt before its
           reading is initiated.
           This phenomenon is characterized by the following.
● The M-Utility of the RU cannot be started from the CL. Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                                                              ✼
           ● The IP halts at a location before its reading is initiated.                                                                      The IP halts prior to
                     “IP halt location”                                                                                                       the reading start position.
                                                                                                                                          M
           ● When the RU is powered OFF and then back ON, the IP is ejected and it starts up normally.
                                                                                                                     Subscanning unit
           ● When the barcode reader test is performed in the M-Utility, “RESULT: OK” appears.
[Cause]                                                                                                                           FRONT
           Large numbers of interrupts from the barcode reader are issued to the CPU12A board, so that the
           processing freezes and does not proceed any further.
                                                                                                                                                     FRMT0448.EPS
[Action]
           Replace the barcode reader.
13.1 Procedures for Updating the Version of the PC-MUTL Software .................. MC-246
13.2 Version Update Procedures for PC-MUTL Version 1.2 or Later .................... MC-250
13.3 Version Update Procedures for PC-MUTL Version 1.1 or Earlier .................. MC-256
13.4 Procedures for Updating MAIN CPU (OS) Version ......................................... MC-267
14. Procedures for Restoring the Application Software in the Flash ROM ................. MC-270
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                   Reason                        Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)                 All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Support for software version A05     MC–2–4, 6, 8, 21, 32, 33,
                                          (FM3058)                             59.1–59.4, 63, 122, 134, 138,
                                                                               139, 150, 151, 151.1–151.4,
                                                                               152–157, 164, 165.1–165.4, 178,
                                                                               186–251
          12/20/2001    03                Changes in the procedures (FM3277)   MC–1, 6, 186, 187, 194–199,
                                                                               203–211, 241, 243, 245, 252–259
          02/20/2002    05                Support for software version A07     MC–1, 132, 133, 151, 151.2, 163,
                                          (FM3328)                             165, 165.1, 165.2, 178, 179,
                                                                               186–189, 194–281
           WARNING
           To avoid electric shock hazards, power OFF the machine before performing the procedures.
           WARNING/CAUTION
           Observe the warnings and cautions described in the “Safety Precautions.”
           CAUTIONS
           • When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to
             ground your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may
             cause damage to electronic parts on the board.
           • Do not remove the cover of the scanning optics unit.
           • Never remove the red-painted screws.
           ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
           Some of the illustrations in this volume contain check/adjustment and half-punch indicators
           as needed.
           For removal and reinstallation, perform the procedures as instructed by such indicators.
           ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
           • Never remove the rubber belt of the subscanning unit, except for its replacement.
Rubber belt
FR6H4104.EPS
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           The TP screw used to secure the ground wire is similar in shape to a DT screw.
           When attaching the screw, check its shape to avoid confusing it with a wrong one.
DT screw TP screw
FR6H4105.EPS
2. Table of Contents
     5. Cassette Set Unit   5. Removing and Reinstalling the Cassette Set Unit MC-20
                              5.1 Shelf Cover Assembly                           MC-20
                              5.2 Shutter                                        MC-22
                              5.3 Cassette Set Unit                              MC-24
                              5.4 Wrong-Insertion Prevention Bracket Assembly    MC-26
                              5.5 Solenoid (SolA1)                               MC-28
                              5.6 Hold Pin                                       MC-30
                              5.7 Inch/Metric Changeover Guide                   MC-32
                              5.8 Suction Sensor (SA5)                           MC-34
                              5.9 Suction Cup                                    MC-36
                              5.10 IP Removal Arm                                MC-40
                              5.11 Motor (MA1)                                   MC-42
                              5.12 Roller                                        MC-44
                              5.13 Guide Plate                                   MC-48
                              5.14 Stopper                                       MC-50
                              5.15 Actuator (Cassette IN Detection)              MC-52
                              5.16 Sensor (SA2)                                  MC-54
                              5.17 Roller Assembly                               MC-56
                              5.18 Movable Guide Assembly                        MC-58
                              5.19 Sensor (SA3)                                  MC-59.1
                                                                                         FR6H4101.EPS
FR6H4102.EPS
     12. Fuses              12. Replacing the Fuses and Fuse Locations           MC-234
                               12.1 MTH12A Board Fuses                            MC-236
                               12.2 SCN12A Board Fuses                            MC-237
                               12.3 SNS12A Board Fuses                            MC-238
                               12.4 DRV12A Board Fuses                            MC-239
FR6H4103.EPS
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4350.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                                  #3
                                  [Remove] T4x8 (x4)
                                          Left-hand side cover
                                                                       Top cover
                                                                                             Upper rear cover
                                                                                  #6
                                                                                  [Loosen] T4x12 (x4)           #7
                                                                                                                [Remove] DT3x6 (x4)
                                                                                            X
                #3
[Remove] T4x6 (x4)
                         #4
         [Remove] T4x6 (x6)
                                                                                                        #2
                    Upper light                                                                         [Remove] T4x12 (x6)
                       protect
                         plate
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4B51.EPS
               CAUTION
               When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to
               ground your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may
               cause damage to electric parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
                                    INV12B board
                                                                                          #3
                                                                                          [Remove] BR3x6 (x4)
                                 CN5
                    CN14
                                                                             Light protect
                                  INV12A board                                       plate #1
                                         FRONT                             [Remove] T4x6 (x2)
                                                                                             FR6H4B05.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4B52.EPS
               CAUTION
               When servicing the inverter assembly, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
               your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause
               damage to electric parts on the board mounted in the inverter assembly.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
Inverter assembly
                                                                                                 #3
                                                                                                 [Remove] DT3x6
                                       INV12B board
CN14
                        CN2     #2
                                [Disconnect] Connector
                        CN3
                                     INV12A board
                                             FRONT
                                                                                                         FR6H4B01.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4B53.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the inverter assembly.
                     “4.2 Inverter Assembly”
                                                  #1
                                                  [Unclamp] Clamp
Fan
Label
                                     #2
                            [Disconnect]                               #4
                          Connector CN4                                [Remove] S3x35 (x2)
                            #3
                            [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)                           Inverter assembly
FR6H4B03.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the fan, make sure that the label of the fan is oriented as shown in the
               illustration above.
FR6H4B55.EPS
               CAUTION
               When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to
               ground your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may
               cause damage to electric parts on the board mounted in the inverter assembly.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the fan (FAN4).
                      “4.3 Fan (FAN4)”
INV12B
                                         Bracket
                               #1
                      [Disconnect]
                    Connector CN6
                               INV12A board
                                                                           #3
                                                                           [Remove] BR3x6 (x4)
                                                                                     FR6H4B04.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedure
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4B54.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the inverter assembly.
                        “4.2 Inverter Assembly”
              (2) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Upper light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
Fan
Label
Guard
FR6H4B02.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the fan, make sure that the label of the fan is oriented as shown in the
               illustration above.
FR6H4442.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the shelf cover assembly.
                                                                                                         #1
                                                                                                         [Disconnect]
                                                                                                         Connector
                                                                                                         CNLED2
                 #2
[Remove] DT3x6 (x4)
                                                                           #1
                                                                          [Disconnect] Connector CNSA1
■ Exploded View
                                                         BR3x6 (x5)
BR3x6 (x7)
Name plate
                                                                  LED12A
             Base
                                                              Key top      Cover
Name plate
Name plate
                                                                                    FR6H4466.EPS
                                                           PS3x8 (x4)
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
5.2 Shutter
FR6H4469.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the shelf cover assembly.
                        “5.1 Shelf Cover Assembly”
              (2) Remove the shutter.
                                                                                 #1
                                         #2
                                                                                 [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                         [Remove]
                                         Hook
Shelf cover
                                                            #3
                                               [Remove] Shutter
                                                                                   PUSH
                                                                                            FR6H4424.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the sensor (SA1) and shutter do not interfere with each other.
                              Sensor (SA1)
Shutter FR6H4425.EPS
FR6H4443.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the shelf cover assembly.
                       “5.1 Shelf Cover Assembly”
              (2) Disconnect the connectors.
         DETAIL A
        Cassette set unit
                                                                     FRONT
                                                    #1
                                                    [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                                    #2
                                                                    [Disconnect]
                                                                    Connector CNCLA1
                                                                    #2
                                                                    [Disconnect]
                                                                    Connector CNSOLA1
                                     #2                     #1 [Unclamp] Clamp
                                     [Disconnect]
                                     Connector CNPA1 #2
                                   #2                   [Disconnect] Connector CNA10
                                   [Disconnect] Connector CNSVA1
                            A
                                                               Cassette set unit
                                                                                       #3
                                                                                       [Disconnect] Connector CNA2
                                                                                       #3
                                                                                       [Disconnect] Connector CNA4
                                                                                       #3
                                                                                       [Disconnect] Connector CNA1
FR6H4429.EPS
                                                                                               #1
                                                                                               [Remove] BR4x8 (x4)
                                                                                                   #2
                                                                                                   [Remove] BR4x8
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                When installing the cassette set unit, align the cassette set unit against the positioning
                bracket to position it as appropriate, and then tighten the screws in reverse order of
                removal.
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                    MC - 25
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                        MC - 26
FR6H4464.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the cassette set unit.
                        “5.3 Cassette Set Unit”
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                To remove the wrong-insertion prevention bracket assembly, access it from behind the
                cassette set unit.
                          (2)                                                  (3)
                          [Remove] DT3x6 (BLK)                                 [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
Bracket
                                                     Compression
                                                       coil spring
                                  Cover
                                                                                    Wrong-insertion prevention
                                                                                    bracket assembly
                                                                       T
                                                                     ON
                                                                 FR        T
                                                                           O
                                                                           P
FR6H4434.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                                   Wrong-insertion
                                                   prevention bracket
    Plain bearing                                            Guide
                                                                BR3x6
                                  Shaft
                                Plain bearing                FR6H4467.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4462.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the cassette set unit.
                      “5.3 Cassette Set Unit”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the solenoid (SolA1), access it from behind the cassette set unit.
Solenoid (SolA1)
                                                 #2
                                          [Remove]
                                         BR3x6 (x2)
                                 #1
                    [Unclamp] Clamp
                        T
                        O
                        P
                                       #2
           [Disconnect] Connector CNSOLA1
FR6H4432.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4463.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the solenoid (SolA1).
                     “5.5 Solenoid (SolA1)”
                                                           #1
                               [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                                                         #3
                                                                         [Remove] Hold pin
                                        Solenoid arm
                                                   #2
                                       [Remove] DT3x6
                           T
                           O
                           P
FR6H4433.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
010-051-00
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                   MC - 31
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                                MC - 32
FR6H4455.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Move the IP removal arm to its home position before performing the procedures.
                                                         IP removal arm
                                                                      Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4411.EPS
                                                                                                  #1
                                                                         Inch/metric changeover   [Remove] BR3x6
                                                                                          guide
                                                                                                      #2
                                                                                                      [Remove]
                                                                                                      BR3x6
                                                                                                          Stopper
                                                                                                  I
                                                                                                      M
FR6H4446.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
       • The changeover guide mounting location differs depending on whether the inch or metric
         setting is used. Install the inch/metric changeover guide as instructed in the illustration below
         according to the setting selected.
                                                  I
                                                        M
I M I M
FR6H4415.EPS
S1
CPU12A board
ON 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
OFF
FR6H4465.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                To remove the FASTON terminal, push the shaded portion of the terminal illustrated
                below to detach it.
                                                               Push
                                                                   FR6H0001.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                  MC - 34
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                     MC - 35
               (2) Remove the suction sensor (SA5).
                                                                      #1               #4
                                                                      [Remove] Hose    [Disconnect]
                                                                                       Connector SA5-2
                                                                                        #3
                                                                                        [Disconnect]
                                                                                        Connector SA5-1
                                                                 #2
                                                          [Remove]
                                                       A2.6x16 (x2)
                                                                                      Suction
                                                                                      sensor (SA5)
                                                               T
                                                          ON
                                                     FR
             T
           ON
         FR
                                                                                                         FR6H4416.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                 ◆ NOTE ◆
                 To attach the FASTON terminal, insert it all the way to secure it in place.
FR6H4453.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing or removing the suction cup assembly, perform the procedures while
               supporting the IP removal arm by hand.
               If you try to perform the procedures without supporting the IP removal arm, the IP removal
               arm may be bent.
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Move the IP removal arm to its IP suction position before performing the procedures.
                                                      IP removal arm
                                                                       Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4407.EPS
                                  #2
                           [Remove]
                          DT3x6 (x2)
                            PUSH
                        #1 [Remove] Lid-opening bracket
FR6H4408.EPS
                  Packing                                                       #3
                                                                                [Remove] Suction cup
                    T
                 RON
                F                                                                                      #2
                                                            Pipe joint                                 [Remove]
                                                                                                       Retainer
                                                           Packing
FR6H4410.EPS
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                While keeping the pipe joint in place by use of a wrench or the like, remove the suction
                cup with a Phillips screwdriver.
                                                                  Pipe joint
Suction cup
Retaining screw
Wrench FR6H4409.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                    For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4454.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the suction cup assembly.
                      “5.9 Suction Cup”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Move the IP removal arm to its home position before performing the procedures.
                                                    IP removal arm
                                                                 Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4411.EPS
Support plate
               #1
     [Remove] Arm
                         #2
        [Remove] DT3x6 (x4)
                                                                                           #1
                                                                                           [Remove] Arm
                                                                                               FR6H4436.EPS
IP removal arm
                    #1
[Remove] Plain bearing
                 Bearing
                                                                                  #1
                                                                                  [Remove] Plain bearing
Bearing
FR6H4412.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4451.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                            “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
               (2) Remove the motor (MA1).
Motor (MA1)
                                                                            Spur gear
                                                                              #5
                                                                              [Remove] E4
                                                                                            #4
                                                                                            [Remove] BR4x12 (x2)
                                #1             FRONT
                   [Unclamp] Clamp                                                          #3
                                #2                                                          [Remove] DT3x6 (x3)
                       [Disconnect]
                  Connector CNMA1
Bracket
                       #1
                [Unclamp]                                                CHECK
                   Clamp                                                                                  FR6H4401.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual                      MC - 42
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                     MC - 43
■ Reinstallation Procedures
        ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
        When attaching the bracket, make sure that the pawl of the bracket is engaged into the U-
        shaped notch of the solenoid clutch.
FRONT
Pawl
Bracket
                                                                                        Solenoid
                                                                                        clutch
                                                                                    U-shaped
                                                                                    notch
FR6H4403.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
            • Make sure that the pawl of the bracket is engaged into the U-shaped notch of the solenoid
              clutch.
            • Make sure that the motor (MA1) is installed in its correct orientation.
                                                 Motor (MA1)
Cable
                                                        FRONT
                                                         FR6H4438.EPS
5.12 Roller
FR6H4452.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the solenoid clutch.
                                                                                            #1
                                                                                            [Unclamp] Clamp
Gear
Solenoid clutch
                                                                               #1                 #3
                                                                               [Unclamp] Clamp    [Loosen] WP3x5 (x2)
                                                                      #2
                                                                      [Disconnect] Connector CNCLA1
FR6H4404.EPS
                                                                                 #2
                                                                                 [Remove]
                                                                                 Extension coil spring
                                                                                 L = 116 mm
                                                                               Gear assembly
                                                                                Bearing
                                                                                   Gear
Bracket
                                                                                             #1
        DETAIL A                                                                             [Remove]
                                                                                             DT3x6 (x3)
                                                                            CHECK
                                                   #3
                                                   [Remove]
                                                   Leaf spring
                                           #4
                                   [Remove]
                        Extension coil spring
                                L = 104 mm
                                                                                               FR6H4405.EPS
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When removing the roller, make sure that the edges of the side plates do not interfere
               with the roller.
Edge
Roller
                                                                                     Housing (small)
                                                                                            [Remove]
                                                                                       Housing (large)
                                                                                                    FR6H4406.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs differ in size depending on where they are attached. Use care
                not to confuse their locations..
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the pawl of the bracket is engaged into the U-shaped notch of the
                  solenoid clutch.
FRONT
Pawl
Bracket
                                                                                    Solenoid
                                                                                    clutch
                                                                                U-shaped
                                                                                notch
FR6H4403.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               MC - 47
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                            MC - 48
FR6H4459.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
                    REFERENCE
               When only the guide plate (large) is to be removed, the motor (MA1) need not be
               removed.
                                                    IP removal arm
                                                                 Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4411.EPS
                              #2
       [Remove] DT3x6 (BLK) (x4)
                     #1
              [Remove]
       DT3x6 (BLK) (x2)
                    CHECK
                      Guide plate (large)
                                             CHECK
                                                                                           FR6H4427.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                    For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                    • Make sure that the guide plate is not lifted.
Guide plate
FR6H4444.EPS
5.14 Stopper
FR6H4456.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Move the IP removal arm to its IP suction position before performing the procedures.
                                                     IP removal arm
                                                                      Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4407.EPS
Support plate
                                                                        #2
                       #2                                               [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
      [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)                                               Stopper (right)
Stopper (left)
                                                                                              #1
                                                                                              [Remove] DT3x6 (x4)
FR6H4418.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4457.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the shelf cover assembly.
                      “5.1 Shelf Cover Assembly”
              (2) Remove the guide plate (large).
                      “5.13 Guide Plate”
              (3) Remove the stopper (right).
                      “5.14 Stopper”
              (4) Remove the actuator.
                                                             Actuator     [Remove]
                                                                           Actuator
FR6H4420.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               The actuator should be installed properly.
                    OK                                      NG
                        Actuator
                                                                        Actuator
FR6H4421.EPS
FR6H4461.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the cassette set unit.
                      “5.3 Cassette Set Unit”
              (2) Remove the actuator (cassette IN detection).
                      “5.15 Actuator (Cassette IN Detection)
              (3) Attach the support plate.
Support plate
                                                                                     #2
                                                                                     [Secure]
                                                                                     DT3x6 (x4)
FR6H4437.EPS
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • To remove the sensor (SA2), access it from behind the cassette set unit.
               • Move the IP removal arm to its home position before performing the procedures.
                                                IP removal arm
                                                             Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H4411.EPS
                                                                                 T
                                                                               ON
                                                                             FR    T
                                                                                   O
                                                                                   P
                                                        #2
                                                        [Remove]
                                                        Sensor (SA2)
                                                          T
                                   #1                   ON
                                                      FR
                          [Disconnect]
                     Connector CNSA2
                                                                                            FR6H4430.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4458.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the roller assembly.
                     Roller assembly
                                    PUSH
                                                                        Support plate
                                                  #2
                            [Remove] Roller assembly
                                                                                          #1
                                                                                         [Remove]
                                                                                         DT3x6 (x4)
FR6H4422.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4460.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the guide plate.
                     “5.13 Guide Plate”
              (2) Remove the roller assembly.
                     “5.17 Roller Assembly”
              (3) Remove the movable guide assembly.
                                                                          #1              #2
                                                                          [Remove]        [Remove]
                                Roller assembly
                                                                          Roller          DT3x6 (x2)
                                                 PUSH                     assembly (x2)
                                                                                          Movable
                                                                                          guide
                                                                                          assembly
FR6H4428.EPS
■ Exploded View
BR3x6
Guide
BR3x6
                                       Plain          Stopper
                                       bearing
Bracket
                                                                       Shaft
                                                                               Plain bearing
                                                         Bracket
                                             DT3x6
Bracket
FR6H4468.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4471.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the guide.
                                                                          #3
                                                           #2             [Remove] Guide
                                                           [Remove] Arm
                                               #1
                    [Remove] Tension coil spring                                FR6H4472.EPS
                                                          #2
                                                      [Raise]
                                                      Bracket
                                                                                     #1
                                                                                #3   [Disconnect]
                                                                         [Remove]    Connector
                                                                      Sensor (SA3)
FR6H4473.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4567.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the cassette set unit.
                      “5.3 Cassette Set Unit”
              (2) Remove the rear cover.
                      “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (3) Remove the lamp assembly.
                      “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (4) Remove the duct box.
                      “6.7 Duct box”
                                  #1
                                  [Disconnect]
                                  Connector
                                  CNBCR
                                                                                                 #1
                                                                                                 [Disconnect]
                                                                                                 Connector CNMB1
                                    #1
                           [Disconnect]
                        Connector CNB1
FR6H4529.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               When installing the erasure conveyor, align it against the positioning bracket.
                                                                                      Erasure conveyor
                    Positioning bracket
                                                                                             FR6H4530.EPS
FR6H4551.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               The lamp assembly is mounted along with rail.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
INV12B board
CN14
                                                                                (3) #3
                                                                                [Disconnect]
                                                                                Connector
                                                                                     INV12A board
                                                                                               FRONT
                                                                      ONT
                                                                   FR
                                                                              (3) #4
                                                                              [Remove] BR3x6
                                                                                                Light protect
                                                                                                plate
                                                                                                 (3) #1
                               Yellow filter
                                                                                                 [Remove]
                                                                                                 T4x8 (x2)
                              Lamp assembly                                                      (2)
                                                                                                 [Remove]
                                                                                                 BR4x8
                                                                     Box
FR6H4501.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                                                         Socket
                                                    Holder plate
                                                                                                                      Filter
             Bushing
                                                                                                                     Socket
                                                                                                          DT3x6
                                                                                                          (x2)
Holder plate
010-051-00
010-051-00                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                          MC - 64
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                      MC - 65
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4555.EPS
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                To remove the FASTON terminal, push the shaded portion of the terminal illustrated
                below to detach it.
                                                             Push
                                                                FR6H0001.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp assembly.
                        “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
                                                             (2)
                                             [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                   Filter
                (3) #3     Thermal switch
    [Remove] T3x6 (x2)       (TSWB1)
                                                                                                            (2)
                                                                                            [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                             T
                                                          ON
                                                       FR
                                                                                                  Holder plate
                                   (3) #2
             (3) #1                [Remove] FASTON terminal
             [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                               TSWB1-1 cable (red)
                                                            Thermal switch
                                                            (TSWB1)
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                To attach the FASTON terminal, insert it all the way to secure it in place.
6.4 Lamp
FR6H4552.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp assembly.
                        “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (2) Remove the lamps.
Holder plate
                                                                                               T
                                                                                            ON
                                                                                         FR
                   #1
  [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                              Yellow filter
                                                                                     #3
                                                                                     [Remove] Lamp
                                                                  #2
                                                      [Remove] Filter
                                                                                                     Holder plate
                                                                                               #1
                                                                              [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)               FR6H4540.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • After installing the filter, wipe the filter with a moistened cloth.
               • To install the filter, put the filter under the rib of the lamp assembly.
Lamp assembly
                               Rib                                                   T
                                                                                   ON
                                                                                 FR
FR6H4541.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
            • Reset the erasure lamp lightening time.
                              INSTALL                        RESET
                                                              PREVIOUS VERSION       VERSION UP SINCE 2000         10    10
All IP SIZES 16
ERASURE LAMP
                                                                                                                 (3) #2 [Click]
                                                                                                                              FR6H4568.EPS
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4553.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp.
                      “6.4 Lamp”
              (2) Remove the bracket.
                                                                                        Lamp socket
                                                                                        (right-hand side) cable
                            #1
               [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                   Bracket                #3
                                                             [Unclamp] Clamp
                              #2
                             [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                    T
                                                                                 ON
                                                                               FR
                                                                                                     FR6H4502.EPS
Lamp assembly
                                              L1
                                              L2
                  (3) #1
                                              L3
        [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                                                        ONT
                        CHECK                                                        FR
                        Lamp socket                                                           (4) #1
                    (right-hand side)                                                         [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                                                L1
                                                                                L2
                                                                                L3
                                                                                                       (4) #2
                                                                                                       [Remove]
                                                                 CHECK                                 BR3x6 (x3)
                                                                Lamp socket
                                                             (left-hand side)                            FR6H4503.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the lamp sockets, they should be installed in place as illustrated below.
Lamp assembly
                                              L1
                                              L2
                                              L3
                                                                                                     T
                                                                                                ON
                        Lamp socket                                                        FR
                    (right-hand side)
                                                                               L1
                                                                               L2
                                                                               L3
                                                                   Lamp socket
                                                                (left-hand side)             FR6H4534.EPS
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • After installing the filter, wipe the filter with a moistened cloth.
               • To install the filter, put the filter under the rib of the lamp assembly.
Lamp assembly
                                        Rib                                                     T
                                                                                              ON
                                                                                            FR
FR6H4541.EPS
                     REFERENCE
               Cable route
                                  Lamp socket (left-hand side) cable
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the lamp sockets are installed in their proper position.
6.6 Thermistor
FR6H4554.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp.
                         “6.4 Lamp”
              (2) Remove the bracket.
Thermistor cable
                                 #1
                    [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                                                 #3
                                                          Bracket
                                                                                 [Unclamp] Clamp
                                  #2
                                  [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                            ONT
                                                                                         FR                     FR6H4505.EPS
Thermistor
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4556.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
                                                                                  [Remove]
                                     T
                                  ON                                              DT3x6 (x2)
                                FR           Stepped DT
                                                                       Duct box
                                                                                        FR6H4509.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4557.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the cleaning roller assembly.
                                                                                      [Remove] BR4x8
                                                                                                   FR6H4510.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                                   #3
                                                   [Remove] Spur gear
              Anti-static material   Bearing           #4
                                                       [Remove] E6
                                                    Plain bearing
                 #1
     [Remove] DT3x6
Cleaning roller
Bracket
                                      DT3x6 (x3)
                           #2
               [Remove] DT3x6
                                                                                                       #4
                                                            Bracket                                    [Remove] E6
Plain bearing
                                                                                        Box
                                                                                                       FR6H4533.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4558.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the cassette set unit.
                      “5.3 Cassette Set Unit”
              (2) Remove the lamp assembly.
                      “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (3) Remove the cleaning roller assembly.
                      “6.8 Cleaning Roller Assembly”
                                                                                   #2
                                                                       [Loosen/Secure]
                                                                                DT3x6
                                                                                     #1
                                                                                     [Remove]
                                                                                     Spur gear
                                                                                          #3
                                                                         [Remove] Timing belt
FR6H4511.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the timing belt is mounted in its proper position.
Timing belt
                           FRONT
                                       FR6H4550.EPS
FR6H4563.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp assembly.
                      “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (2) Remove the rear cover.
                      “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (3) Loosen the belt tension.
                      “6.9 Timing Belt”
              (4) Remove the reflection bracket.
                                CHECK                                                    (5) #4
                                                                                         [Remove] BR4x8 (x2)
                                                            (5) #5                                Bracket
                                                            [Remove]
                             Motor (MB1)                    E4
                                            (5) #2
                   (4)                      [Disconnect] Connector CNMB1
   [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)                                                                                 FR6H4524.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the motor (MB1) is mounted in its proper position.
Motor (MB1)
                                Cable
                               FRONT
FR6H4531.EPS
                                                                 Rubber roller B
                                                                 Rubber roller A
FRONT
FR6H4542.EPS
FR6H4559.EPS
                    REFERENCE
                To remove the rubber roller B, the rubber roller A should be removed first.
                The rubber roller B cannot be removed alone.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the timing belt.
                        “6.9 Timing Belt”
              (2) Remove the rubber roller A.
                           #1
                           [Remove] Extension coil spring
                           L = 90 mm
                 #3
  [Remove] Housing Bearing
                                                                                            #1
                                                                                            [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                                                                            L = 102 mm
                           Rubber roller A
                                                                     Bearing          #2
                                                                                      [Remove] Spur gear
                                                                                      #3
                                                                                      [Remove] Housing
                                     T
                                  RON
                                 F
                                                                                                            FR6H4512.EPS
                                           #1
                                           [Remove] E6
                                            Timing belt pulley
Bearing
                                      #3
                        [Remove] Housing
                                                                                   Bearing #3
                                                                                           [Remove] Housing
                                                                                            #2
                                                                                            [Remove]
                                                Rubber roller B                             Spur gear
                                                      O  NT
                                                   FR                                              FR6H4536.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs and rubber rollers differ in size depending on where they are
                attached. Use care not to confuse their locations.
010-051-00
010-051-00                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       MC - 87
10.10.2000 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                           MC - 88
Rubber roller D
Rubber roller C
                                                              FRONT
                                                                                       FR6H4543.EPS
FR6H4560.EPS
                    REFERENCE
                To remove the rubber roller D, the rubber roller C should be removed first.
                The rubber roller D cannot be removed alone.
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the timing belt.
                        “6.9 Timing Belt”
               (2) Remove the rubber roller C.
                                #1
                                [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                L = 90 mm
                       #3
         [Remove] Housing
                      Bearing
                                                                                                         #1
                                                                              [Remove] Extension coil spring
                              Rubber roller C                                                  L = 102 mm
                                                                                                  #2
                                                                                                  [Remove] Spur gear
                                                                                               #3
                                              T                                                [Remove] Housing
                                           ON
                                       FR                                                   Bearing            FR6H4515.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                 MC - 88
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                  MC - 89
               (3) Remove the rubber roller D.
                           #1             Gear
                  [Remove] E6
                                 #2
                        [Remove] E6
                 Timing belt pulley
                                #3 Bearing
                  [Remove] Housing
                                                                                        Bearing
                                                                                          #5
                                                                                          [Remove] Housing
                                      Rubber roller D                                    #4
                                                                                         [Remove]
                                                                                         Spur gear
                                                O NT
                                             FR
                                                                                                     FR6H4537.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs and rubber rollers differ in size depending on where they are
                attached. Use care not to confuse their locations.
010-051-00
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                            MC - 89
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                      MC - 90
                                                                               Rubber roller F
                                                        Rubber roller E
                                                                   FRONT
                                                                                       FR6H4544.EPS
FR6H4561.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               To remove the rubber roller F, the rubber roller E should be removed first.
               The rubber roller F cannot be removed alone.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp assembly.
                      “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (2) Remove the duct box.
                      “6.7 Duct Box”
              (3) Loosen the timing belt.
                      “6.9 Timing Belt”
              (4) Remove the rear cover.
                      “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
                                                                        (6)
                                               Guide roller assembly    [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                    #1
                    [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                   Reflection bracket
                                                                                       FR6H4513.EPS
                              #3
                [Remove] Housing
                                            Bearing
                            #2
             [Remove] Spur gear
                                       #1
           [Remove] Extension coil spring
                             L = 90 mm
Bearing
                                                                                                #3
                                                      Rubber roller E             [Remove] Housing
                                                                                                    #1
                                                                        [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                                                                         L = 103 mm
FR6H4518.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                     MC - 92
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                 MC - 93
              (8) Remove the rubber roller F.
                    #1
                    [Remove] Spur gear
                         #2
           [Remove] Housing
                        Bearing
                                                                                                 #4
                                                                                                 [Remove]
                                                                                                 Housing
                                                                                           #3
                                                                                   [Remove] E6      FR6H4538.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs and rubber rollers differ in size depending on where they are
                attached. Use care not to confuse their locations.
                                                                               Rubber roller G
                                                                               Rubber roller H
                                                              FRONT
                                                                                     FR6H4545.EPS
FR6H4562.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               To remove the rubber roller H, the rubber roller G should be removed first.
               The rubber roller H cannot be removed alone.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the lamp assembly.
                      “6.2 Lamp Assembly”
              (2) Remove the duct box.
                      “6.7 Duct Box”
              (3) Loosen the timing belt.
                      “6.9 Timing Belt”
              (4) Remove the rear cover.
                      “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
Reflection bracket
                                                                                            (5)
                                                                                            [Remove]
                                                                                            DT3x6 (x2)
                                                          (6) #1
                                                          [Remove] DT3x6
Rail
                                                         (6) #2
                                                         [Remove]
                                                         DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                   FR6H4520.EPS
                         #2
         [Remove] Spur gear
                                 Bearing
                      #1
              [Remove]
   Extension coil spring
            L = 79 mm
                            #3
              [Remove] Housing
                                                                                      Bearing
                                                                                                #3
                                       Rubber roller G
                                                                                                [Remove] Housing
                                                                                       #1
                                                           [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                                                             L = 93 mm                   FR6H4521.EPS
                          #1
                          [Remove]
                          Spur gear
                              #2 Bearing
                        [Remove]
                         Housing
                                                                                              #3
                                           Rubber roller H
                                                                                 Bearing      [Remove]
                                                                                              E6
                                                                                    #4
                                                                      [Remove] Housing
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs and rubber rollers differ in size depending on where they are
                attached. Use care not to confuse their locations.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the anti-static brush is brought into contact with the roller.
Roller
                                                      Anti-static brush
                                                             FR6H4522.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                          MC - 97
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                      MC - 98
                                                                FRONT
                                                                                      FR6H4547.EPS
FR6H4564.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the rubber rollers A and B.
                      “6.11 Rubber Rollers A and B”
              (2) Remove the guides A and B.
Guide A
Guide A
FR6H4525.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               The guides A and B differ in shape.
               When attaching them, use care not to confuse their locations.
6.16 Guide C
                                                                ■ Guide Locations
Guide C
                                                                        FRONT
                                                                                    FR6H4548.EPS
FR6H4565.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the guide C.
                                                                                                             T
                                                                                                        ON
                                                                                                   FR
                                #2
         [Remove] DT3x6 (BLK) (x2)
Guide C
                                                                        #1
                                                       [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                                 FR6H4526.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               The guide roller assembly should be installed as illustrated below.
Half punch
                                                                  FRONT
                                                                 FR6H4527.EPS
6.17 Guide D
                                                               ■ Guide Locations
                                                                                Guide D
                                                                FRONT
                                                                                FR6H4549.EPS
FR6H4566.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                     • Front cover
                     • Right- and left-hand side covers
                     • Top cover
                     • Rear cover
                         “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the guide D.
                                                                                                    T
                                                                                                  ON
                                                                                                FR
                    #1
                    [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                            Reflection bracket
                                                                Guide D                           FR6H4528.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4651.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Rear cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
DETAIL A DETAIL B
                                                                 #2
                                                                 [Remove]
                                                   #2            BR4x8 (x2)
                                                   [Remove]
                                                   BR4x8 (x2)
                                             #1
                                             [Disconnect]
                                             Connector CNC1
                                                                              #1
                                                                              [Disconnect] Connector CNMC3
                                                                         #1
                                                                         [Disconnect] Connector CNC10
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4552.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                         “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the timing belt.
                        #1
                        [Remove] Extension coil spring
CHECK
                                                                                #2
                                                                                [Shift] Arm assembly
                                                    #3
                                                    [Remove] Timing belt                               FR6H4602.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
           • Check the mounting position of the timing belt.
Timing belt
FRONT
FR6H4603.EPS
FR6H4653.EPS
FR6H4604.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the timing belt.
                        “7.2 Timing Belt”
Cam A Cam B
                        Grip release
                      cam assembly
                        #2                                         Cam B
                                                           E4
                        [Remove] E4
                                                   Bearing
CHECK Cam A
                                                                         CHECK
              #1                                                       Grip release cam assembly
              [Remove] E5        E4
                              Bearing             Spacer        #3                                           FR6H4605.EPS
                                                                [Remove] E4
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               The cams differ in shape depending on where they are attached. When attaching the
               cams, use care not to confuse their locations.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the cams are attached correctly.
                    Narrow     Wide
                                                                                      Cam B
                    Cam A
                                                                                              Grip release cam
Wide
                                                                                                   Narrow
                                                                                                      FR6H4606.EPS
FR6H4654.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                        “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the bracket.
Gear (small)
Gear (large)
Bracket FR6H4607.EPS
Cam A Cam B
                                                                                                   Grip release
                                                                      Cam A                        cam assembly
                                                                           E4                         #2
                                                                            Bearing                   [Remove] E4
CHECK
                                                                              Spacer
                                                   CHECK
                                                                                 Bearing
                                                                                              Cam B
                                       Grip release cam assembly                       E4
                                                                   #3                                  #1
                                                                   [Remove] E4                         [Remove] Gear
                                                                                                            FR6H4608.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               The cams differ in shape depending on where they are attached. When attaching the
               cams, use care not to confuse their locations.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the cams are attached correctly.
                                                                                           Wide    Narrow
              Cam A
Wide
Narrow
FR6H4609.EPS
FR6H4655.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the grip mechanism (left-hand side).
                          “7.3 Grip Mechanism (Left-Hand Side)”
               (2) Remove the grip mechanism (right-hand side)
                          “7.4 Grip Mechanism (Right-Hand Side)”
               (3) Remove the upper grip roller (long) and upper grip roller (short).
                                                     DETAIL A               #1
                                                                            [Remove] Extension coil spring
                                                                            L = 160 mm (x2)
                                                                                Timing belt pulley
                                                                                   Spacer
                                                                                     Ball bearing (small)
                                                                                                     Housing
                                                       #2
                                                       [Remove] E4 (x2)
                                                                                                      Ball bearing (mid)
                                                                    Spacer
                                    CHECK
                   A                                         Ball bearing (large)
010-051-00
010-051-00                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                MC - 112
10.10.2000 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                     MC - 113
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               The upper grip rollers differ in length depending on where they are attached. When
               attaching the upper grip rollers, use care not to confuse their locations.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Check the attachment locations of the upper grip rollers.
               • Make sure that the upper grip roller (short) is fitted into the notch of the arm.
Arm
FR6H4611.EPS
FR6H4656.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the grip mechanism (left-hand side).
                       “7.3 Grip Mechanism (Left-Hand Side)”
              (2) Remove the grip mechanism (right-hand side)
                       “7.4 Grip Mechanism (Right-Hand Side)”
              (3) Remove the shock absorber-attached roller.
                                                                     #1
                                      DETAIL A                       [Remove] Extension coil spring (L = 116 mm)
                                                                            #1
                                                                            [Remove] Extension coil spring (L = 160 mm)
                                                                               Timing belt pulley
                                                                                   Spacer
                                         #2
                                                                                                    Housing
                                         [Remove] E4 (x2)
                                                                                                    Ball bearing (mid)
                                            Ball bearing (small)
                                                              Spacer
                                                                                                     Housing
                                                                                                           Ball bearing (large)
                              CHECK
                                                         Ball bearing (small)
Spacer
                                                                       #1
                                                                       [Remove] Extension coil spring (x2)
                                                                       (L = 160 mm)                                 #2
                                                                                                                    [Remove] E4 (x2)
FR6H4613.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                  MC - 115
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                           MC - 116
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                The lower-stage guides should be removed in accordance with their removal direction.
Bracket
                        (5) #2
                        [Remove] DT3x6 (BLK) (x3)
                (5) #1
                [Remove] DT3x6 (BLK)
              Lower-stage guide
                         (small)
                 Lower-stage guide
                 removal direction
CHECK
FR6H4614.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil springs and lower grip rollers differ in length depending on where they
                are attached. When attaching the extension coil springs and lower grip rollers, use care
                not to confuse their locations.
                ◆ NOTE ◆
                When attaching the shock absorber-attached roller, ensure that the notch of the discharge
                bracket assembly is fitted into the slit.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Check the attachment locations of the lower grip rollers.
                • Make sure that the latch of the lower-stage guide is locked to the bracket.
FR6H4657.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                            “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the motor (MC2).
                        #3
                        [Remove]
                        BR4x8 (x3)
                                                                                                                  T
                                                                                                                 N
                                                                                                                O
                                                                                                              FR
Spur gear
                                                                               #2
                        #4
                                                                               [Disconnect] Connector CNMC2
                        [Remove] E4                          #1
                             Motor (MC2)                     [Unclamp] Clamp                              FR6H4616.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4658.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
                (1) Remove the timing belt.
                        “7.2 Timing Belt”
                (2) Remove the motor (MC3).
                                                                             #2
                                                                             [Disconnect] Connector CNMC3
                                                                             #3
                                                                             [Remove] BR4x8 (x4)
                                                  #1
                                                  [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                              Motor (MC3)
                                                                                                     FR6H4617.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                 For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4659.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the motor (MC2).
                       “7.7 Motor (MC2)”
              (2) Remove the motor (MC3).
                       “7.8 Motor (MC3)”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the latch driver, manually rotate the gear until the latches of the latch assembly
               are positioned inside the side plate of the machine.
Latch
               Latch driver
                       [Rotate] Gear
                              Latch assembly
                                                              FR6H4618.EPS
                                                 Side plate
DETAIL B DETAIL A
FRONT FRONT
            #6                                                                          #6
            [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)                                                         [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                        Latch driver
                                                                                                  A
                                                                                #5
                                                                                [Disconnect]
                                                                                Connector CNC10
                                       #1
                                       [Unclamp]
             #2                        Clamp                 #4
             [Disconnect]                                    [Unclamp] Clamp
             Connector SC1
                                                                  Connector bracket
                                                                                          #3
                                                                         [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                      FR6H4619.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                                             Bearing
                                                                   Roller                          DETAIL B
                                                                            Bearing
                                        Roller
                                                                                 Shaft
                                                                                                                              0
                                      Bearing                Bearing
                                                                  Shaft
                                      Latch
C 2-DT3x6(BLK)
                                                                      Arm                                             Bearing
                                                                                                                          Compression
                                        A                              Spur gear         Bearing                          coil spring
                                                                                                                                   Bearing
                                                                                      Compression
                    E6 (x2)                                                             coil spring Bearing
                    Bearing                                                                              E6
                                                                DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                                                  E6
                                                                        Spur gear
                                                      Clamp
                                                                                 E4
                                                                                 Spur gear
DETAIL A Clamp
Bracket
                    Bushing
                                                                                                                                  DT3x6
                                                                                                                            Photo sensor
                              Clamp              Frame
FR6H4629.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
              (1) While manually rotating the gear in the direction of the arrow, attach the latch
                  assembly.
                                                                                                     T
                                                                                                 ON
                                                                                             FR
                              Latch driver
                                                     #1                              Latch
                                          [Rotate] Gear
Latch assembly
Shaft
                     Latch assembly
                    (right-hand side)                                               Latch
                                                                                                    T
                                                                                                ON
                                                                                            FR
                                         Latch driver
                                                             #2
                                                  [Rotate] Gear
Latch assembly
                                                          Shaft
                      Latch assembly
                     (right-hand side)
                            Latch driver
                                                                                                O NT
                                                                                             FR
                                                   #3
                                        [Rotate] Gear
                                                Latch assembly
                                                                                             FR6H4620.EPS
(2) Press the latch driver to the half punch and snap it into place.
FR6H4660.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the latch driver.
                        “7.9 Latch Driver
                    REFERENCE
               To remove the latch assembly, slide the latch assembly in the direction of the arrow as
               illustrated below to facilitate access to the E-rings that retain the shaft.
                                  E-ring
                    F
                    R
                    O
                    N
                    T
                                                                             Latch driver
                                     #1
                              [Remove]                                                     #3
                                E6 (x4)                                                    [Remove] B3x6
Bracket
Latch driver
Latch assembly
Bearing
Latch driver
                                                                                    #2
                                                                                    [Pullout] Shaft assembly
                    #4
[Remove] Latch assembly
FR6H4624.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4661EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the grip mechanism (right-hand side).
                           “7.4 Grip Mechanism (Right-Hand Side)”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the latch assembly (right-hand side), manually rotate the gear in the direction
               of the arrow to shift the shafts of the latch driver away from the latch assembly (right-hand
               side).
Shaft
                     Latch assembly
                    (right-hand side)
                                                                                          T
                                                                                      ON
                                                                                    FR
                                        Latch driver
[Rotate] Gear
FR6H4630.EPS
                                                                                            #3
                                                                                            [Remove] E4
                                                                                          Latch
                                                                                                    CHECK
                                                                                                        #2
                                                                                                        [Remove]
                                                                                                        Extension coil
                                                                                                        spring
Shaft
Bracket
Latch assembly
                                                                                            #1
                                                                                            [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                              FR6H4625.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                The extension coil spring should be attached properly.
                 Latch assembly
                                                                         Bracket                              Bracket
                                                            OK                                       NG
                                                                                                                 FR6H4626.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the extension coil spring is attached correctly.
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                      MC - 127
10.10.2000 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                 MC - 128
FR6H4662.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                        “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor
              (2) Remove the movable guide.
                                                                        CHECK
                                                                                Movable guide
                                                                                                #2
                                                                                                [Remove]
                                                                                                BR3x6 (x2)
                             #1
                     [Remove]
          Extension coil spring
FR6H4627.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the lower grip roller is fitted into the notch of the arm.
Arm
FR6H4611.EPS
FR6H4663.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the upper grip roller.
                        “7.5 Upper Grip Roller”
              (2) Remove the movable guide.
                        “7.12 Movable Guide”
              (3) Remove the upper-stage guide.
Upper-stage guide
                      [Remove]
                    DT3x6 (BLK)
Upper-stage guide
FR6H4628.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4751.EPS
       WARNING
       The scanning optics unit should not be removed or installed by other than a service engineer
       who has been trained to do so.
       CAUTIONS
       • When servicing the scanning optics unit, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
         your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause
         damage to electronic parts on the board.
       • The procedures for removing and reinstalling the scanning optics unit differ depending on the
         version (VER:) of that unit. Before performing the procedures, check the revision of the
         scanning optics unit.
       ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
       Do not remove the top cover of the scanning optics unit.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
       ◆ NOTES ◆
       • The TP screw used to secure the ground wire for mounting the scanning optics unit of
         VER: F or earlier is similar in shape to a DT screw.
         When attaching the screw, check its shape to avoid confusing it with a wrong one.
DT screw TP screw
FR6H4105.EPS
                                                                         #3
                                                                         [Remove] BR4x12 (x4)
                                                                                                Skip this step for the
                                                                                                scanning optics unit of VER:
                                                                         CHECK                  G or later.
                                                                                                             #2
                                                                                                             [Remove] TP4x6
Top cover
Ground wire
                                                                                                      #1
                                                                                        #1            [Disconnect] Connector
                                                                    [Disconnect] Connector            CNE1
                                                                                      CN1
                                  ONT
                               FR                                                                                     FR6H4701.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the scanning optics unit, press the positioning brackets of the scanning
               optics unit against the frame of the subscanning unit to secure it in place.
                                                                                             Scanning optics
                                                                                                  unit
                                                                                   F
                                                                                   R          Positioning brackets
                                                                                   O
                                                                                   N          and knob
                                                                                   T
                                    T
                                  ON
                                FR
                                                                                                               FR6H4703.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When the scanning optics unit is replaced with a new one, it is necessary to install the
               machine-specific data bundled therewith.
               Take the following steps to install the machine-specific data.
                                         CANCEL                     OK                 (3) #3
                                                                                       [Click]
                                                                    OK                 (3) #4
                                                                                       [Click]                             FR6H4704.EPS
FR6H4850.EPS
        CAUTION
        Never touch the light-receiving face of the light-collecting unit even when you are wearing
        gloves.
        ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
        When servicing the light-collecting unit, wear gloves.
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Top light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
010-051-00
010-051-00                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                  MC - 136
10.10.2000 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                       MC - 137
               (2) Disconnect the connectors.
               (3) Remove the after-reading conveyor cover.
                                                                         (2)
                                                                                                Light-collecting unit
                                                [Disconnect] Connector PMT1
Spacer
        (3) #2
        [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                            (3) #1
                                                                               [Remove] BR3x8 (x2)
FR6H4806.EPS
Light-collecting unit
                    #2
                    [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                               B
         DETAIL A
DETAIL B
FR6H4801.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the light-collecting unit, mount it along the rail.
               When screwing down the light-collecting unit, secure it in place while pushing it in the
               direction of the arrow as illustrated below.
                                                  #4                   PMT12A board
                                           [Connect]
                                     Connector PMT2
                                                    #4                Light-collecting unit
                              [Connect] Connector PMT1
Light-collecting unit
                                           A
                                              Rail
                #3
                [Secure]
                BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                         B
                                                                                                 Peep hole
       DETAIL A
        #2
        [Secure] BR3x10                              HHS Label No.2
CHECK
FRONT
DETAIL B
FR6H4802.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
              (1) While looking into the peep hole, verify that the φ4 mm hole is visible.
                           HHS Label
                           No.2
                                                                    Peep hole
                                                                    φ4 mm hole
                                                                                     FR6H4807.EPS
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When the light-collecting unit is replaced with a new one, it is necessary to install the
               machine-specific data bundled therewith.
               Take the following steps to install the machine-specific data.
                                         CANCEL                    OK                    (4) #3
                                                                                         [Click]
                                                                   OK                    (4) #4
                                                                                         [Click]                             FR6H4808.EPS
FR6H4851.EPS
        CAUTION
        When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
        your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
        to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
               (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Top light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
               (2) Remove the PMT12A board together with the shield material.
                                                              #1
                                                              [Disconnect] Connector PMT2
                                                                        #2
                                                                        [Disconnect] BR3x6 (x3)
                                             #1                          Shield material
                                    [Disconnect]                       PMT12A board               Light-collecting
                                 Connector PMT1                                                   guide assembly
                                                         CHECK
FR6H4803.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                          MC - 142
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                MC - 143
              (3) Remove the PMT12A board.
PMT12A board
Shield material
FR6H4804.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the PMT12A board, together with the shield material, to the light-
               collecting guide assembly, ensure that the socket of the PMT12A board is parallel to the
               connector portion of the light-collecting guide assembly.
                                                                                                    Parallel
                                                                        Socket
                                                                                              Light-collecting
                                                                                              guide assembly
FR6H4805.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the light-collecting guide assembly is parallel to the socket of the
                  PMT12A board.
FR6H4963.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                       “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the light-collecting unit.
                       “9.1 Light-Collecting Unit”
              (3) Install the after-reading conveyor cover.
               CAUTION
               When removing or installing the subscanning unit, exercise due care about your posture
               to avoid lower-back pain.
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               When lifting up the subscanning unit, grasp the locations illustrated below.
                                                                                              HHS Label
                                                                                              No.2
                                  Subscanning unit
               Grasp this.            HHS Label No.2
Grasp this.
                               #2
              [Remove] BR4x8 (x3)                                                            #1
                                                                                             [Disconnect]
                                                                                             Connector CNZ10
                                                                                                  #1
                                                                                                  [Disconnect]
                                                                                                  Connector
                                                                                                  CNSOLZ1
                        HHS Label No.2
                                                                                                   #1
                                     Positioning pin                                               [Disconnect]
                                                                                                   Connector CNZ11
                                                                                            #3
                DETAIL B             #5                                                     [Disconnect]
                    [Remove] BR4x8 (x2)                                                     Connector CNE3
                                                                                             #3
                                                                                             Disconnect]
                                                                                             Connector CNE1
                             #4
                             [Remove]                                                       #3
                             BR4x8 (x2)                                                     [Disconnect]
                                                                                            Connector CN1
                                                                                            #3
                                                                                            [Disconnect]
                                                                                            Connector CNZ1
                                #4
               [Remove] BR4x8 (x2)                                               HHS Label No.2
                                                                                                  A
                                HHS Label No.2
                             Subscanning unit
                                                                                             HHS Label No.2
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                While aligning the subscanning against the positioning pins, secure it in place.
FR6H4951.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Left-hand side cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the Kapton® belt.
                                                                            #1
                                                                           [Remove] Extension coil spring
Kapton® belt
                                                  #2
                                      [Shift] Bracket
                                                                                    CHECK
                                                                                              FR6H4901.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
               • The Kapton® belt should be mounted with its date indicating side up, so that the arrow
                 mark faces the side plate.
               • After mounting the Kapton® belt, manually rotate the flywheel to verify that the Kapton®
                 belt does not come off.
                                                Side plate
                                                                        5
                                                       0     9
                                                    03           Rotation mark
                                               00
                                                        Date
                             Kapton® belt
                                                                        FR6H4902.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the Kapton® belt has been mounted in a proper orientation.
                • Manually rotate the flywheel to verify that the Kapton® belt does not come off.
10.3 Flywheel
FR6H4952.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the Kapton® belt.
                         “10.2 Kapton® Belt”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Insert an Allen wrench into the hole of the driving shaft to secure the shaft in place, and
               then remove the nut.
Driving shaft
                    HHS Label
                         No.2
Allen wrench
Flywheel
                                                                                                        #1
                                                                                                        [Remove] Na20
FR6H4903.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • Use care not to damage the surface in contact with the Kapton® belt.
               • Before reinstalling the flywheel, clean the Kapton® belt contacting surface with ethanol.
Flywheel
                [Clean] Ethanol
                Contact surface
                                                            FR6H4935.EPS
FR6H4959.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                     “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the flywheel.
                     “10.3 Flywheel”
              (3) Remove the solenoid assembly.
                HHS Label
                     No.2
                                                                                                 (4) #4
                                                                                                 [Remove]
                                                                                                 BR3x6 (x2)
Shaft
                                                                   (4) #3                         (4) #1
                                                                [Remove]                          [Remove] Clamp
                                                                  Washer
                                                                      Solenoid
                                                                          (4) #2
                                                                    [Disconnect]
                                                                     Connector
                                                                          Solenoid
                                                                         assembly
                                                                                        (3) #1
                                                                                  [Disconnect]
   CHECK                                                                            Connector
                                                   (3) #2
                                                   [Remove]
                    Solenoid assembly              DT3x6 (x2)                                            FR6H4919.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                             Bracket
                                   Bushing                    BR3x6 (x2)
BR3x6 (x2)
                    Solenoid
                                                                                 Arm
                                                                                             BR3x6 (x2)
                                              Extension
                                                coil spring                     Spacer
                                        Washer
                                                                   Arm
                        Shaft
                                                                                      FR6H4940.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • When installing the solenoid assembly, raise the stoppers to gain access to the threaded
                 holes.
Push
Stopper
               • Make sure that the tip of the arm extends through the guide, and push the bracket of the
                 solenoid assembly against the bump to screw it down.
                                                                                                 Bracket
Bump
Guide FR6H4976.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the actuator of the solenoid assembly blocks the light path of the
                  sensor (SZ4).
                                          HHS Label
                                          No.2
                                                                 Actuator
Sensor (SZ4)
FR6H4937.EPS
                • Measure the resistance value at the connector terminal of the solenoid to verify that
                  the measured resistance value is correct.
                              HHS Label
                                   No.2
                                                                                      4    3
                                                                                               Hi
                                                                                           1
                                                                                Lo
                                                                                          Terminal       Resistance
                                                                                  Hi 1 (Red)-3 (Yellow) 13.5–16.5Ω
                                                                                  Lo 1 (Red)-4 (Black) 127–156Ω
FR6H4970.EPS
FR6H4964.EPS
               CAUTIONS
               • When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to
                 ground your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may
                 cause damage to electronic parts on the board.
               • When removing or installing the motor (MZ1), do not use any magnet screwdriver.
               • Do not touch the magnet portion of the motor (MZ1).
Motor (MZ1)
                    REFERENCE
               The screws that retain the motor (MZ1) have different lengths depending on the version of
               the light-collecting guide assembly.
               Light-collecting guide assembly 606Y0055 (#20669 or earlier): BR3x6 (x5)
               Light-collecting guide assembly 606Y0055A (#20670 or later): BR3x10 (x5)
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the subscanning unit.
                       “10.1 Subscanning Unit”
              (2) Remove the Kapton® belt.
                       “10.2 Kapton® Belt”
#1 [Disconnect] Connectors
                                                                                Connector
                                                                                CN2
                                                                                 Connector
                                                                                 CN1
Subscanning unit
Cover
                                                                             Motor (MZ1)
                                                                                                             #2
                                                                                           [Remove] BR3x6 (x5)/
                                                                                                    BR3x10 (x5)
FR6H4931.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the motor (MZ1), loosely tighten the five screws and then securely tighten
               them in order illustrated below.
Motor (MZ1)
                                   #1                          #2
                [Secure] BR3x6/BR3x10                          [Secure] BR3x6/BR3x10
                                                               #4
                                                               [Secure] BR3x6/BR3x10
                                   #3
                [Secure] BR3x6/BR3x10
                                                               #5
                                                               [Secure] BR3x6/BR3x10
                                                                           FR6H4932.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                    If the motor is replaced, perform the following check procedures.
                    • DIP switch setting
                    • Preparation for output image (exposure)
                    • Subscan length check
                                           Motor (MZ1)
                    Example of DIP
                    switch setting                                  ON
                                                                     1     2    3   4     5   6
OFF
FR6H4933.EPS
Cassette
Steel rule
FR6H4965.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               If the IP cannot be exposed at 1 mR, it should be exposed at 1 mR, with reference to the
               following exposure conditions.
               Note, however, that those conditions are for standard IP setup reference.
                           Distance:    1.8 m
                           Voltage:     80 kV
                           Amperage:    50 mA
                           Time:        0.013 sec
Measure
Formula: Length (theoretical value) of the steel rule on the film = Length of the steel rule x reduction factor
Formula: Allowable value of the subscan length = Length of the steel rule (theoretical value) x specified value (±0.6%)
              (4) Measure the length of the steel rule (actual measurement) of the calipers on the output
                  film, and verify that it is within the allowable value calculated.
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               If the subscan length is beyond the allowable value, make subscan length adjustments
               (i.e., change the DIP switch setting), as appropriate.
F value
FR6H4967.EPS
FR6H4962.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the scanning optics unit.
                     “8.1 Scanning Optics Unit”
              (2) Remove the sensor bracket.
                                                                 #2                        #2
                                                        [Disconnect]                       [Disconnect]
                                                  Connector CNSZ2                          Connector CNSZ3
                                                             #2
                                                   [Disconnect]
                                              Connector CNMZ2
                                                            #1
                                               [Unclamp] Clamp
                                                                           #2
                                                                           [Disconnect] Connector CNMZ3
Sensor bracket
                                                                       Bearing
                                                                                                   #3
                                                                                                   [Remove] Spring
                                                                                           #4
                                                                                           [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
FR6H4926.EPS
CHECK
                                                           [Remove]
                                                           DT3x6 (x2)
FR6H4927.EPS
                                                               #2
                                                               [Unclamp] Clamp
Cam Shaft
                              #5
                       [Remove]                                                            #1
       Hexagon-headed screw (3B)             Motor (MZ2)
                                                                                           [Remove] BR3x6 (BLK) (x2)
                                                       #4
                                      [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
Cover FR6H4936.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                    For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
                    REFERENCE
                The threaded holes for mounting the motor (MZ2) assembly are adjacent to the threaded
                holes for mounting the sensor bracket.
                With reference to the illustration below, install the motor (MZ2) assembly and sensor
                bracket as appropriate.
FR6H4938.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                 • Make sure that the bearing for the driving-shaft grip release arm is brought into contact
                   with the outer periphery of the cam A and B.
                                                                               Cam B
                                                                                             Bearing
                                                               Bearing
                                                                                    Driving-shaft
                                                                                grip release arm
                                                                                                        FRONT
                                                                          Driven-shaft
                                                                          grip release arm
FR6H4909.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                     MC - 160
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                MC - 161
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4653.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the flywheel.
                      “10.3 Flywheel”
              (2) Remove the motor (MZ3).
Motor (MZ3)
                           #1
                  [Disconnect]                                                            #2
             Connector CNMZ3                                                              [Remove]
                                                                                          BR3x6 (x2)
FR6H4904.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
              (1) Apply Molykote to the worm gear.
                    When mounting the MZ3, use Molykote as indicated below.
                    • Made by Dow Corning
                    • Type
                             JPN/USA            Molykote (EM30L GREASE)
                             Europe             Molykote (PG30L GREASE)
[Apply] Molykote
                                      Worm gear
                                                      FR6H4D63.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               When mounting the MZ3, apply a grain size of Molykote to the worm gear. Otherwise, an
               error (13395) might occur.
FR6H4954.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the motor (MZ3) assembly.
                                                                                                       HHS Label
                                                                                                       No.2
                                      #3
                                      [Remove]
                                      BR3x6                                                      CHECK
         #1              #1
         [Disconnect]    [Disconnect]
         Connector CNMZ3 Connector CNMZ3                                 Spacer
Gear (large)
                                                                                             #2
                                                                              Gear           [Remove] BR3x12
                                                                              (small)
FR6H4942.EPS
FR6H4907.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When installing the motor assembly, ensure that the housing of the motor assembly is
               located between the flange of the bearing and the side plate.
                                            Flange
                                                                     Gear
               Light-collecting
                          shaft
                                                    E-ring
                                              Bearing
                        Side plate
                                          Housing
                                                                 FR6H4906.EPS
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               Refer to the illustration below when mounting the gear (large) and gear (small).
FRONT
Pinionless section
[Apply] Molykote
                                      Worm gear
                                                      FR6H4D63.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               When mounting the MZ3, apply a grain size of Molykote to the worm gear. Otherwise, an
               error (13395) might occur.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
              (1) Check the engagement between the gear (large) and the worm gear of the motor
                  (MZ3).
                    GOOD: There should be some backlash (about 0.3 mm).
                    NG:      There is no backlash (the gear (large) and the worm gear of the motor (MZ3)
                             move).
                    If the engagement between the gears is inappropriate, loosen the screws (BR3x6 (x2))
                    that retain the motor (MZ3). and adjust the engagement as appropriate.
0.3 mm approx.
FRONT
Gear (large)
FR6H4971.EPS
              (2) Power ON the CL/RU, and verify that a dust removal operation failure or dust removal
                  function lock error does not occur.
FR6H4960.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Top light protect plate
                    • Left-hand side cover
                    • Right-hand side cover
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the flywheel.
                        “10.3 Flywheel”
              (3) Remove the after-reading conveyor cover.
                                                                               HHS Label
                                                                               No.2
Spacer
                           After-reading
                           conveyor cover
Spacer
         #2
         [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                #1
                                                                               [Remove] DT3x8 (x2)
FR6H4921.EPS
                             #1
     [Remove] Spring L = 20 mm
                           CHECK
                    #2
        [Remove] DT3x6
                                       Arm
                                                                                 HHS Label
                                                                                 No.2
Bearing
Bearing
FR6H4922.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                                       Shaft
                  BR3x6 (x2)
                        Bracket              Fork
BR3x6 Fork
CHECK
BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                         Arm
                                                        CHECK            BR3x6
                                                                                 FR6H4943.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                    For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                 • Make sure that the bearing for the driving-shaft grip release arm is brought into contact
                   with the outer periphery of the cam A.
                              HHS Label
                              No.2                                               Cam B
                                                                                                 Bearing
                                                               Bearing
Cam A
                                                                                     Driving shaft
                                                                                 grip release arm
                                                                                                      FRONT
                                                                         Driven shaft grip release arm
FR6H4939.EPS
                ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                When the fork for the driving-shaft grip release arm is removed and then reinstalled, make
                sure that there is no gap between the bracket and fork.
                                                  Bracket                 Bracket
                                                                                         Fork
                                                              Fork
GOOD NG
Bracket Fork
Fork
Bracket FR6H4946.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                        MC - 168
10.10.2000 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                MC - 169
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4955.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                         “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the driven-shaft grip release arm.
DETAIL A
                                                                                 Driven-shaft
                                                                            grip release arm
                                                                                                          #1
                                                                                                   [Remove]
                                                                            Extension coil spring L = 20 mm
                                       Bearing
                                                                       CHECK
                                                           A
                        Driven-shaft
                   grip release arm
                                                                                          Bearing
                                                                                                 #2
                             HHS Label No.2                                               [Remove]
                                                                                         B4x12 (x2)
FR6H4908.EPS
■ Exploded View
                         E3
             Bearing
                                                 Shaft
               Arm
                       BR3x6
                                                                 Fork
                                                                                  Arm
                        CHECK
                                                                                   BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                        BR3x6
CHECK FR6H4944.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                    For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                • Make sure that the bearing for the driving-shaft grip release arm is brought into contact
                  with the outer periphery of the cam B.
                                                                                          Cam B
                                                                                                          Bearing
                                                                        Bearing
                                                                                               Driving-shaft
                                                                                           grip release arm
                                                                                                               FRONT
                                                                                  Driven-shaft
                                                                                  grip release arm
FR6H4909.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When the fork for the driven-shaft grip release arm is removed and then reinstalled, make
               sure that there is no gap between the arm and fork.
Arm Arm
Fork Fork
                                            GOOD                        NG
                    Arm
Fork
Arm
Fork FR6H4947.EPS
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4961.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the light-collecting unit.
                        “8.1 Light-Collecting Unit”
              (2) Remove the flywheel.
                        “10.3 Flywheel”
              (3) Remove the driving-shaft grip roller (upper).
                                                                                     HHS Label
                                                                                          No.2
Hook
Hook
             [Remove]
             Extension coil spring                              Driving-shaft grip
             L = 39 mm                                          roller (upper)
                                                                                                           [Remove]
                                                                                                 Extension coil spring
                                                                                                          L = 50 mm
FR6H4924.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                   Shaft
                PG3x4 (3B)            Bearing
                                            Shaft
Rubber roller
                                                                      Bearing
                                                                            Shaft   PG3x4 (3B)
                                                                                      FR6H4945.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
                • The extension coil springs differ in size depending on where they are attached. Use
                  care not to confuse their locations.
                • To install the hook, snap it securely into the groove of the side plate.
                   Hook
                                            Groove of side plate
FR6H4925.EPS
FR6H4956.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor.
                          “7.1 Side-Positioning Conveyor”
              (2) Remove the driven-shaft grip roller (upper).
                                                                                #1
                                                                                [Loosen] B3x6 (x2)
                                                          Antistatic material
                                                          assembly
Hook Hook
                                                                                                     #2
                   #2                                      Driven-shaft                              [Remove]
                   [Remove]                          grip roller (upper)                             Extension coil spring
                   Extension coil spring                                                             L = 39 mm
                   L = 50 mm
FR6H4910.EPS
■ Exploded View
                                        Shaft
                        PG3x4 (3B)         Bearing
                                                 Shaft
Rubber roller
                                                                        Bearing
                                                                              Shaft   PG3x4 (3B)
                                                                                        FR6H4945.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
                ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
                • The extension coil springs differ in size depending on where they are attached. Use
                  care not to confuse their locations.
                • To install the hook, snap it securely into the groove of the side plate.
                    Hook
                                             Groove of side plate
FR6H4925.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                  MC - 175
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                   MC - 176
FR6H4957.EPS
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               When handling the light-collecting mirror, pay attention to the following points.
               • Wear gloves.
                 However, never touch the reflection surface of the light-collecting mirror even when you
                 are wearing the gloves.
               • Wear a mask so that saliva does not come into contact with the light-collecting mirror.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the flywheel.
                          “10.3 Flywheel”
              (2) Remove the driven-shaft grip roller (upper).
                          “10.12 Driven-Shaft Grip Roller (Upper)”
                     REFERENCE
               When removing the light-collecting mirror, rotate the guide A in the direction of the arrow
               as illustrated below to facilitate access to the screw that retains the light-collecting mirror.
Guide A
FR6H4912.EPS
                        HHS Label
                        No.2                                     HHS Label
                                                                 No.2
                                                                                         Spacer
                                                                                            Gear (large)
                                       #1
                                       [Remove]
                                       Spring
Gear (small)
                                                                                    #2
                                                                       [Remove] BR3x12
                                                    HHS Label
                                                         No.2
        #3
        [Remove] V3x6 (BLK) (x2)
                    Light-collecting
                              mirror
FR6H4913.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               Refer to the illustration below when mounting the gear (large) and gear (small).
FRONT
Pinionless section
[Apply] Molykote
                                      Worm gear
                                                      FR6H4D63.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               When mounting the MZ3, apply a grain size of Molykote to the worm gear. Otherwise, an
               error (13395) might occur.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
              (1) Verify that the D-shaped cut surface of the light-collecting shaft and the gear (large)
                  and gear (small) are mounted in their correct orientation.
              (2) Check the engagement between the gear (large) and the worm gear of the motor
                  (MZ3).
                    GOOD: There should be some backlash (about 0.3 mm).
                    NG:    There is no backlash (the gear (large) and the worm gear of the motor (MZ3)
                           move).
                    If the engagement between the gears is inappropriate, loosen the screws (BR3x6 (x2))
                    that retain the motor (MZ3). and adjust the engagement as appropriate.
0.3 mm approx.
FRONT
Gear (large)
FR6H4971.EPS
              (3) Power ON the CL/RU, and verify that a dust removal operation failure or dust removal
                  function lock error does not occur.
FR6H4958.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the light-collecting mirror.
                      “10.13 Light-Collecting Mirror”
              (2) Remove the light-collecting shaft.
                                            Guide
                                                    #2
                                                    [Remove]
                                                    E4
CHECK
                                                                                    Bearing
                                                                                            #1
                                                                                       [Remove]
                                                                                            E4
                                                Light-collecting
                                                shaft
                    #3
                    [Remove]
                    V3x4 (BLK) (x3)
                     Cleaning brush
                                                                                                   FR6H4916.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
               Install the guide in the orientation illustrated below.
FRONT
Guide
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
                     • Make sure that the guide is mounted in its correct orientation.
FR6H4A56.EPS
               WARNING
               To avoid electric shock hazards, turn OFF the breaker of the machine and unplug the
               power cable from the outlet before performing the procedures.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Unplug the cables.
                    • Power cable
                    • I/F cable
                                   #2
                    [Unplug] I/F cable
                                                          #1
                                                          [Unplug] Power cable
                                                                                             FR6H4A12.EPS
                      Support plate
                    (board retainer)
                     [Unclamp]
                    Clamp (x2)
                                 Controller
                                           #2
                          [Remove] BR4x8 (x3)
                                                                                                         FR6H4A13.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■Check/Adjustment Procedures
               • Make sure that the connectors are connected to their correct locations.
FR6H4A51.EPS
       CAUTIONS
       • When the manganese lithium battery is completely drained, replace the board as a whole.
       • Return the old board replaced to the Service Parts Center (manufacturer’s factory).
       • Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or
         equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Dispose of used batteries according to
         the manufacturer’s instructions.
       • When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
         your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause dam
         age to electronic parts on the board.
       • When replacing the CPU12A board, do not power OFF the CL/RU unless otherwise instructed
         in this manual.
       • Make sure that devices that are set as shown below are not connected over the same
         network:
         If any device of such specifications is connected over the same network, disconnect that
         device from the same network by powering it OFF or unplugging its I/F cable.
         Unless such a device is disconnected, the application and configuration data of that device
         will be automatically updated as well when the application of the RU is updated.
START
[2] Check the software version and back up HISTORY LOG Create Backup floppy disk.
  When the default setup values have been set              When other than the default setup values
  for the IP address/NET MASK of the CL                    have been set for the IP address/NET MASK
                                                           of the CL
[4] Change the memory on the CPU12A board to the user settings
              END
                                                                                                   FR6H4A64.EPS
Press.
              (3) Select [Run...] from the Start menu of Windows, and type
                  [“C:\ProgramFiles\FujiFilm\FCR\Tool\cr346uty.exe”] to open the MAINTENANCE
                  UTILITY, and display the EDIT CONFIGURATION window.
Windows Update
                                           Programs
                                           Favorites
                                           Documents
                                           Settings
                                           Search
                                           Help
                                           Log Off Administrator...
                                                                                 #1
                                                                                 [Click]
                                           Shut Down...
                                           Run...
Run ?
FR6H4A65.EPS
EXECUTE EXECUTE
ROUTE 0 0 0 0
EQUIPMENT CODE A
CANCEL SET
                                                        CANCEL                      OK                (3) #3
                                                                                                      [Click]
                                                                                    OK                (3) #4
                                                                                                      [Click]                    FR6H4972.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Lower light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the support plate (board retainer).
                        “11.1 Controller”
              (3) Remove the CPU12A board.
Rail
CN6
                                   #1
                    [Unplug] LAN cable
                                                                            #2
                                                                            [Remove] CPU12A board
                                                                                               FR6H4A02.EPS
CN1 CN2
BT1
                                                                                      J4
                                                                                                   S3
                               CN6       CN5              TP1
                                                    S1
                                                                                           S2
                                  ON
                                   1     2      3   4     5   6   7    8
                                                                                  Remote         Local
                                  OFF
               S1 settings
                                                                                                               Default
                    bit                    Description                       ON             OFF
                                                                                                           (factory preset)
               S2 settings
                                         Description                       Remote          Local               Default
                    Interlink with CL                                         —              —               Local (fixed)
                                                                                                                       FR6H4A03.EPS
■Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ NOTE ◆
       When installing the CPU12A board, mount it along the rail.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedure
           • Make sure that the connector is connected to its correct location.
Front view
DRV12A board
SNS12A board
SCN12A board
CN6
FR6H4A34.EPS
FR6H4D10.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute
               “PING”, before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has
               not been connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
              (5) Using TEMPORARY SETTING of SOFTWARE UTILITY, change the following items to
                  the user settings that have been noted before the procedure.
#1 [Type/ENT]
FR6H4D09.EPS
           REFERENCE
       Each version of the PC-MUTL corresponds to each version of the RU software, as follows.
       • RU software version A01 to A04: PC-MUTL version 1.0
       • RF software version A05 to A06: PC-MUTL version 1.1
       • RF software version A07 or later: PC-MUTL version 1.2
Version 1.2
FR6H4D11.EPS
Version 1.1
FR6H4D12.EPS
       CAUTION
       Do not power OFF the RU while the software is being installed.
       If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so that the
       RU will no longer boot up.
FR6H4D13.EPS
RU NAME
HISTORY.LOG
FR6H4D14.EPS
RESULT: OK
FR6H4D15.EPS
[Checkpoints]
                    (a) RU NAME            – Make sure that RU NAME is the one that has been set.
                    (b) HISTORY.LOG        – Make sure that the capacity is not zero bytes.
                    (c) RESULT: OK         – Make sure that “OK” is displayed.
                    REFERENCE
               If any of the three checkpoints (a), (b), and (c) results in “NG”, verify the IP address and
               RU NAME.
                    “Installation (IN-B), Appendix 2, Section 8” in CL Service Manual
               CAUTION
               Do not power OFF the RU while the software is being installed.
               If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so that
               the RU will no longer boot up.
                    Click on          and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute
                    has passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
                    REFERENCE
               If the RU is powered ON before booting up the CL, the “reboot” screen will not appear.
          RU panel                              CL screen
        (CALL lamp)
                                                  ID
#1 [Check]
         [11024]    [11024] RU: APPLICATION SOFTWARE UPDATE. Reboot the RU.            #1 [Check]
                                                                         REBOOT        #2 [Click]
                                                                                              FR6H4973.EPS
              (8) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen,
                  and restart the RU from the CL screen.
                    When it is restarted, all the indicators on the panel are illuminated, and an audible
                    alarm is generated.
          RU panel                              CL screen
        (CALL lamp)
                                                 ID
#1 [Check]
FR6H4D21EPS
RU software version
FR6H4D22.EPS
FR6H4D70.EPS
FR6H4D71.EPS
FR6H4D72.EPS
FR6H4D73.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               Even when “Clear Backup Memory Data” is executed, ISC LOG of TRACE LOGS is not
               cleared.
                    REFERENCE
               To quit the CL software, hold down the <SHIFT> key and choose “Shut Down” from the
               “FUJI FILM” menu.
OFF
FR6H4D20.EPS
       CAUTION
       Do not power OFF the RU while the software is being installed.
       If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so that the
       RU will no longer boot up.
       ◆ NOTES ◆
       • If the software versions are identical between the flash ROM of the CPU12A board and the
         HDD of the CL, step (2) for installing the application software is not performed.
       • If the contents are identical between the flash ROM of the CPU12A board and the HDD of the
         CL, step (6) for installing the configuration data is not performed.
Click on and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    REFERENCE
               If the RU is powered ON before booting up the CL, the “reboot” screen will not appear.
                    REFERENCE
               When the RU is powered OFF and then back ON, the installation of the application
               software and configuration data from the CL is initiated.
               At this time, all the indicators on the panel of the RU are illuminated, and an audible alarm
               is generated.
FR6H4D04.EPS
              (4) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11024] displayed on the CL screen,
                  and restart the RU from the CL screen.
                    When it is restarted, the RU is power OFF and then back ON with all indicators on the
                    panel illuminated, and an audible alarm (three short beeps) is generated.
          RU panel                               CL screen
        (CALL lamp)
                                                   ID
#1 [Check]
         [11024]     [11024] RU: APPLICATION SOFTWARE UPDATE. Reboot the RU.               #1 [Check]
                                                                           REBOOT          #2 [Click]
                                                                                                  FR6H4973.EPS
              (5) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen,
                  and restart the RU from the CL screen.
                    When it is restarted, all the indicators on the panel are illuminated, and an audible
                    alarm is generated.
          RU panel                                CL screen
        (CALL lamp)
                                                   ID
#1 [Check]
Press.
               (8) Select [Run...] from the Start menu of Windows, and type
                   [“C:\ProgramFiles\FujiFilm\FCR\Tool\cr346uty.exe”] to open the MAINTENANCE
                   UTILITY, and start M-Utility.
Windows Update
Programs (P)
Favorites (A)
Documents (D)
Settings (S)
Search (C)
Help (H)
                                          Run...
                                                                               #1
                                                                               [Click]
                                         Log Off Administrator (L)...
Run ?
FR6H4982.EPS
EXECUTE EXECUTE
                       C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                                        _
                        [Ru0] login : cr ir346                   #6 [Type/ENT]
                        Password :                               #7 [Type/ENT]
                                                                       _
                                                                    [cr ir346]
#8 [Type/ENT]           -> mutl
                        0. QUIT
                        1. LOG
                        2. VERSION
                        3. TEST
                        4. ELECTORICAL UTILITY
                        5. SCANNER UTILITY
                        6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                        7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                        8. BACKUP MEMORY
                        9. HV OFF
                        >
FR6H4983.EPS
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                     0. QUIT
                     1. LOG
                     2. VERSION
                     3. TEST
                     4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                     5. SCANNER UTILITY
                     6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                     7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                     8. BACKUP MEMORY
                     9. HV OFF
                     > 2         #2 [Type/ENT]
                     0. QUIT
                     1. DISPLAY VERSION
                     2. DETAIL
                     VER > 1         #3 [Type/ENT]
                                                                          Version of CR-IR346RU
                     Software Resouce Version
                                                                          application
                     MAIN CPU IPL      : Z45N5436001A01
                     MAIN CPU APPL     : Z45N5436002A03
                     SUB CPU IPL       : Z45N5436103A01
                     SUB CPU APPL      : Z45N5436103B02
                     SUB CPU APPL      : Z45N5436202A00
                     Hardware Type<VER_REC>
                     CPU12A            : 00       [02.00]
                     SNS12A            : 00       [00]
                     DRV12A            : 00
                     SCN12A            : 00       [00]
                                                                                           FR6H4984.EPS
                     0. QUIT
                     1. INITIALIZE
                     BMEM > 1         #2 [Type/ENT]
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                    0. QUIT
                    1. LOG
                    2. VERSION
                    3. TEST
                    4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                    5. SCANNER UTILITY
                    6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                    7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                    8. BACKUP MEMORY INITIALIZE
                    9. HV OFF
                    > 1          #1 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. ERROR LOG
                    2. TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > 1          #2 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. DISPLAY
                    2. SAVE TO FTP-SERV
                    3. CLEAR
                    LOG > ELG > 3         #3 [Type/ENT]
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                    0. QUIT
                    1. ERROR LOG
                    2. TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > 2          #1 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. DISPLAY
                    2. SAVE ALL TRACE LOGS TO FTP-SERV
                    3. CLEAR ALL TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > TRC > 3          #2 [Type/ENT]
                                                   CANCEL                   OK                 (3) #3
                                                                                               [Click]
                                                                            OK                 (3) #4
                                                                                               [Click]                  FR6H4975.EPS
                                                   CANCEL                     OK                 (3) #3
                                                                                                 [Click]
                                                                              OK                 (3) #4
                                                                                                 [Click]                           FR6H4A38.EPS
                    Click on        and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
              (2) Output the image exposed at 1 mR.
               ◆ CHECKS ◆
               • There should be no offensive noise or odor.
               • There should be no IP jam.
               • The IP should be free from any scratch or damage after reading.
               If anything abnormal is found, see [Troubleshooting Volume].
              (4) Restore the RU/CL that has been disconnected from the network to its connected state
                  (i.e., power it ON or connect its I/F cable).
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4A52.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Lower light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the support plate (board retainer).
                        “11.1 Controller”
              (3) Disconnect the SNS12A board connectors.
SNS12A board
CN6
CN4
CN5
[Disconnect] Connectors
FR6H4A05.EPS
Rail
                                          CN1
                                                  CN6
                                                   CN2
                                                      CN3
                                                        CN5
                                                              CN4
                                        #1
                    [Disconnect] Connectors
                                                    #2
                                 [Remove] SCN12A board
                                                                                  FR6H4A07.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆NOTE ◆
       When installing the SCN12A board, mount it along the rail.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedure
           • Make sure that the connectors are connected to their correct locations.
Front view
FR6H4A35.EPS
FR6H4A53.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
           REFERENCE
       The SNS12A board and DRV12A board are screwed together, and installed as the DRV12A-1
       board to the machine.
■ Removal Procedure
              (1) Remove the covers.
                    • Front cover
                    • Lower light protect plate
                        “3.1 Removing and Reinstalling the Covers”
              (2) Remove the support plate (board retainer).
                        “11.1 Controller”
                                                                                  #2
                                                                                  [Remove] DRV12A-1 board
                                                            CN2
                                                              CN8
                                                                 CN3
                                                     CN6                  CN7
                                                                                CN5
                                 #1                                                   CN6
             [Disconnect] Connectors                                                     CN4
                                                                    CN4
CN5
                                         #1
                     [Disconnect] Connectors
FR6H4A09.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ NOTE ◆
       When installing the DRV12A-1 board, mount it along the rail.
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
           • Make sure that the connectors are connected to their correct locations.
FR6H4A36.EPS
FR6H4A54.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the DRV12A-1 board.
                     “11.4 DRV12A-1 Board”
              (2) Remove the SNS12A board.
DRV12A board
SNS12A board
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4A55.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the DRV12A-1 board.
                     “11.4 DRV12A-1 Board”
              (2) Remove the DRV12A board.
DRV12A board
                                                                                         [Remove]
                                                                                         B3x6 (x6)
SNS12A board
FR6H4A11.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4A57.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                       “11.1 Controller”
              (2) Remove the boards.
                    • CPU12A board
                    • SCN12A board
                    • DRV12A-1 board
                       “11.2 CPU12A Board”, “11.3 SCN12A Board”, “11.4 DRV12A-1 Board”
              (3) Disconnect the connectors.
                                                                             #2
                                                                             [Disconnect] Connectors
                                                                                                       MTH12A board
                                                                             CN1
                                                                                   CN7
                    #1
      [Unclamp] Clamps
                                                                                                 CN8
                                                                                                    CN10
                                                                                                       CN9
                                                                                                         CN12
                                                                                     #2
                                                                            [Disconnect]
                                                                             Connectors
FR6H4A29.EPS
MTH12A board
Bracket
                          #2
         [Remove] BR3x8 (x2)
                                #1
                    [Remove] BR3x6
Bracket
                                                                                            #1
                                                                                [Remove] BR3x6
                                                                                                  #2
                                                                                 [Remove] BR3x8 (x2)
                                                                                                             FR6H4A30.EPS
MTH12A board
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4A58.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                         “11.1 Controller”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               The TP screw used to secure the ground wire is similar in shape to a DT screw.
               When attaching the screw, check its shape to avoid confusing it with a wrong one.
DT screw TP screw
FR6H4105.EPS
                                                     #1
                                       [Unclamp] Clamps
MTH12A board
                                                                                  CN8
                                                                                         CN9
CN2
                    #3
                    [Remove]                                                                       #1
                    TP3x6         #4                                                               [Unclamp] Clamps
                                  [Disconnect]
                                                                                     #2
                                  Connector
                                                                                     [Disconnect] Connector
                                                                          DRV12A board
                                                                                                          FR6H4A15.EPS
               CAUTION
               The cable connected to the power supply (marked by CAUTION in the illustration below)
               should not be detached.
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the FASTON terminal, push the shaded portion of the terminal illustrated
               below to detach it.
                                                            Push
                                                               FR6H0001.EPS
  DETAIL A
  #1                           Power supply
  [Remove]
  FASTON terminal
                                                A                             Power supply
                                                                                                   CAUTION
                        N L
                                                                                                       SW4
                                                                                                      W4
                                                                                                 Bracket
                                                                                                     #2
                                                                                    [Remove] BR3x8 (x2)
FR6H4A17.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
       Connect the FASTON terminal to its correct location.
FR6H4A59.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                      “11.1 Controller”
              (2) Remove the reset switch.
                                                                                 #2      CN10
                                                              [Disconnect] Connector
                                    #3
                        [Remove] BR3x6                                                      #1
                                               Bracket
                                                                                            [Remove] Clamp
Reset switch
                                                                    Anti-vibration
                                                                #5
                                                                [Remove] Nut
                                                          #4
                                                          [Remove] Switch cover
                                                                                                      FR6H4A18.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
FR6H4A60.EPS
       CAUTION
       When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
       your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause damage
       to electronic parts on the board.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                      “11.1 Controller”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the CNN12A board, take the following steps in the illustration below.
                             CNN12A
                             board
FR6H4A19.EPS
                                                                   #2
                                                                   [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
CNN12A board
CN1
CN2
                                                        #1
                                                        [Unplug] LAN cable CN2
FR6H4A20.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
       The CNN12A board should be installed in the orientation as illustrated below.
CNN12A board
                                       CN1
                                 CN2
FR6H4A33.EPS
FR6H4A61.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                      “11.1 Controller”
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the FASTON terminal, push the shaded portion of the terminal illustrated
               below to detach it.
                                                                Push
                                                                   FR6H0001.EPS
                                                                         PUSH
                                                                                #2
                                                                                [Remove]
              #1 [Remove] FAST-ON terminal                                      Power supply socket
PUSH
                    L cable
                    (black)
                        FG cable
                         (green) N cable
                                  (white)
FR6H4A22.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
           For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
11.12 Breaker
FR6H4A62.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                         “11.1 Controller
              (2) Remove the bracket.
                                                           #2
                                                           [Disconnect] Connector
                      #3                                         #2
               [Remove]                                          [Disconnect] Connector
              BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                #1
                                                                [Unclamp] Clamp
Bracket
                         Controller
                                                                                          FR6H4A23.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               To remove the FASTON terminal, push the shaded portion of the terminal illustrated
               below to detach it.
                                                                 Push
                                                                    FR6H0001.EPS
                    DETAIL A
                    #1 [Remove] FASTON terminal                                    Breaker
PUSH
                                  #2
                                  [Remove] Breaker
                        PUSH
                                                                                                              FR6H4A25.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       WARNING
       Before installing the breaker, put the breaker switch in the OFF position.
GOOD NG
Breaker Breaker
       CAUTION
       The breaker should be mounted in its correct orientation.
                                                                            T
                                                                            O
                                                                            P
Breaker
FR6H4A26.EPS
■ Check/Adjustment Procedures
           • Make sure that the breaker is installed in its OFF position.
           • Make sure that the breaker is mounted in its correct orientation.
BLANK PAGE
FR6H4A63.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the controller.
                      “11.1 Controller”
              (2) Remove the fan (FAN1).
                                                                                     #2
                                                                                     [Disconnect] Connector
                                                                                              #1
                                                                                              [Remove] Clamp
CN12
Label
Fan (FAN1)
Cover
                                                                                                      #3
                                                                                     [Remove] B3x35 (x2)       FR6H4A28.EPS
                            #3
                            [Remove] B3x35 (x2)
                    Cover                                                #2
                                         Fan (FAN2)                      [Disconnect] Connector
                                                        #1
                                            [Remove] Clamp
CN11
Label
FR6H4A27.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
       ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
       When installing the fan, orient its label as shown in the illustration.
                                LE
                                2A
                                                               LE   T
                                                               2A
                                LE
                                2A
FR6H4C13.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               The fuse (1A-5A) installed prior to shipment and a new replacement fuse (1A-5A) may
               have different silk-screened marks.
                                LE                            LE
                                2A                             2A
FR6H4C14.EPS
■ List of Fuses
       CAUTIONS
       • When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ground
         your body. If your body is not grounded, static electricity built on your body may cause
         damage to electronic parts on the board.
       • When replacing the fuse, check the type and rating (A) of the fuse to be replaced, and replace
         it with a fuse of the same type.
         At the same time, check the rating (A) silk-screened on the board as well.
       • To replace the fuse, use tweezers and exercise care not to damage the rib of the fuse holder.
Tweezer
[Pullout] Fuse
Fuse box
                       Board
                    Fuse holder latch
                                                           FR6H4301.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the MTH12A board.
                          “11.7 MTH12A Board”
              (2) Replace the fuse.
                          “■ Fuse Replacement Procedures”
■ Fuse Locations
                      MTH12A board
                                                     FUSE5         FUSE4
                                           FUSE7
                                                            FUSE6
                                      FUSE12     FUSE8
FUSE1 FUSE10
FUSE11 FUSE9
FUSE2
                                                   FUSE3
                                                                      FUSER6H4C03.EPS
FR6H4C03.EPS
■ Fuse Information
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the SCN12A board.
                       “11.3 SCN12A Board”
              (2) Replace the fuse.
                       “■ Fuse Replacement Procedures”
■ Fuse Locations
                    SCN12A board
F5 F6 F7 F10 F8
FR6H4C02.EPS
■ Fuse Information
                Board indications              Type               Rating (A)   Fuse number ✼
                F5                  Slow blow (T)                    1.5            A22
                F6                  Slow blow (T)                    1.5            H14
                F7                  Slow blow (T)                    1.5            H12
                F8                  Slow blow (T)                    1.5            H13
                F10                 Slow blow (T)                    1.5            J12
              ✼ Fuse number: Number indicated in the fuse block diagram.
                                                                                         Tbl_MC215_LB.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the SNS12A board.
                          “11.5 SNS12A Board”
              (2) Replace the fuse.
                          “■ Fuse Replacement Procedures”
■ Fuse Locations
SNS12A board
F1 F3 F2 F4
FR6H4C04.EPS
■ Fuse Information
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the DRV12A board.
                       “11.6 DRV12A Board”
              (2) Replace the fuse.
                       “■ Fuse Replacement Procedures”
■ Fuse Locations
DRV12A board
                                                                                  F13
                                                                     F10 F9 F14
                                   F4 F7                              F6 F12 F3
                                             F11 F1                                     F2
F5
FR6H4C05.EPS
■ Fuse Information
               Board indications             Type                Rating (A)        Fuse number ✼
                F1                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  D11
                F2                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  E21
                F3                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  E11
                F4                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  D41
                F5                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  E31
                F6                  Slow blow (T)                     3                  D21
                F7                  Slow blow (T)                     2                  L11
                F9                  Normal blow                       2                  E41
                F10                 Normal blow                       2                  D31
                F11                 Slow blow (T)                     3                  D51
                F12                 Slow blow (T)                     3                  E51
                F13                 Normal blow                       2                  L21
                F14                 Slow blow (T)                     3                  L31
             ✼ Fuse number: Number indicated in the fuse block diagram.
                                                                                                   Tbl_MC217_LB.EPS
■ Reinstallation Procedures
               For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
                                  CD-R
           Install to the CL
                                          Install
                                   CL        Memory (FTP)
START
                    Update the version of the CR-IR346RU                     • For PC-MUTL version 1.2 or later,
                                                                               “13.2 Version Update Procedures
                    application software
                                                                               for PC-MUTL Version 1.2 or Later”
                                                                             • For PC-MUTL version 1.1 or earlier,
                                                                               “13.3 Version Update Procedures
                                                                               for PC-MUTL Version 1.1 or Earlier”
               END
                                                                                                         FR6H4D53.EPS
       ◆ NOTES ◆
       • For combinations other than above, “13802 checksum error” occurs.
       • If the version of the MAIN CPU IPL (OS) is A01, a connection failure between the RU and CL
         may occur, so that its version should be updated to A02.
                     #1
                 [Click]
              UNINSTALL
                                                                 #2
                                                                 [Click]
                                                                 Next      FR6H4978.EPS
                                  #3
                                  [Click]
                                  Remove
                                   #4
                                   [Click]
                                   Finish       FR6H4979.EPS
                                                               #1
                                                               [Click]
                                                               INSTALL
                                                             #2
                                                             [Click]
                                                             Next
                                                             #3
                                                             [Click]
                                                             Install
                                                                      FR6H4980.EPS
                                  #4
                                  [Click]
                                  Finish
                                        #5
                                        [Click]
                                        EXIT
                                            FR6H4981.EPS
       CAUTIONS
       • If the RU indicated in “LIST OF EXISTING RU” is not connected, or if an error occurs during
         version update, the FTP server will be version-updated but the flash ROM will not.
       • Do not power OFF the CL/RU during version update. If power is turned OFF during version
         update, the machine will no longer boot up.
       • Before performing the install procedures, quit all the applications running on the CL.
       • If the RU application software is to be updated all at once from any version earlier than A04 to
         version A05 or later, be sure to initialize the backup memory/error log/trace log. If they are not
         initialized, an error may occur during operation of the RU.
       • In an N-to-N connection setup, if PREVIOUS VERSION/VERSION UP is executed, the RU
         software will be sequentially downdated for the RUs connected, one after another. It takes
         about one and one-half minutes for a single unit.
         Do not power OFF the CL and RUs until the installation is completed for all the RUs. After the
         installation, be sure to check the software versions for all the RUs to verify that the version
         downdate has been completed.
         Example: In a two-unit connection setup, if ru2 and ru1 have been registered in order named
                     in “LIST OF EXISTING RU”, then installation is performed for ru2 and ru1 in that
                     order named.
                    CR-IR346CL
Straight cable
Switching hub
Network
                                    Straight cable
                                    ru1                              ru2
                    CR-IR346RU                       CR-IR346RU
FR6H3200.EPS
       • Before performing the version update procedures described below, make sure that the version
         of the PC-MUTL is 1.2 or later.
FR6H4D57.EPS
RU NAME
HISTORY.LOG
FR6H4D59.EPS
RESULT: OK
FR6H4D60.EPS
FR6H4D61.EPS
FR6H4D64.EPS
FR6H4D65.EPS
FR6H4D66.EPS
FR6H4D67.EPS
FR6H4D70.EPS
FR6H4D71.EPS
FR6H4D72.EPS
FR6H4D73.EPS
FR6H4D27.EPS
RU software version
FR6H4D62.EPS
            (19) Click on           and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
            (20) Output an image exposed at 1 mR.
               ◆ CHECKS ◆
               • There should be no offensive noise or odor.
               • There should be no IP jam.
               • The IP should be free from any scratch or damage after reading.
               If anything abnormal is found, see “Troubleshooting Volume”.
            (22) Reconnect the RU/CL that were disconnected from the network (i.e., power them ON
                 or connect their I/F cables).
       CAUTIONS
       • Do not power OFF the CL/RU during version update. If it is powered OFF during version
         update, the machine will not boot up.
       • Before performing the install procedures, quit all the applications running on the CL.
       • If the RU application software is to be updated all at once from any version earlier than A04 to
         version A05 or later, be sure to initialize the backup memory/error log/trace log. If they are not
         initialized, an error may occur during operation of the RU.
MAINTENANCE UTL
START #1 [Click]
EXECUTE EXECUTE
CANCEL OK #4 [Click]
FR6H4D02.EPS
A04 #5 [Select/Click]
CANCEL OK #6 [Click]
CANCEL OK #7 [Click]
                                                            OK                     #8 [Click]
                                                                                                    FR6H4D03.EPS
               CAUTION
               Do not power OFF the CL/RU during version update.
               If it is powered OFF during version update, the machine will not boot up.
                    REFERENCE
               When the RU is powered OFF and then back ON, the installation from the CL starts.
               At this time, all the indicators on the panel of the RU are illuminated, and an audible alarm
               is generated.
FR6H4D04.EPS
              (5) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11024] displayed on the CL screen,
                  and restart the RU from the CL screen.
                    When it is restarted, the RU is power OFF and then back ON with all indicators on the
                    panel illuminated, and an audible alarm (three short beeps) is generated.
                RU panel                             CL screen
              (CALL lamp)
                                                       ID
#1 [Check]
               [11024]    [11024] RU: APPLICATION SOFTWARE UPDATE. Reboot the RU.            #1 [Check]
                                                                                REBOOT       #2 [Click]
FR6H4D05.EPS
                RU panel                                CL screen
              (CALL lamp)
                                                         ID
#1 [Check]
                                                    Install completed
                      RF panel                          CL screen
                (Cassette loading lamp)
                                                         ID
Illuminated
RU:
RU:
Illuminated FR6H4D06.EPS
Press.
              (9) Select [Run...] from the Start menu of Windows, and type
                  [“C:\ProgramFiles\FujiFilm\FCR\Tool\cr346uty.exe”] to open the MAINTENANCE
                  UTILITY, and start M-Utility.
Windows Update
Programs (P)
Favorites (A)
Documents (D)
Settings (S)
Search (C)
Help (H)
                                                Run...
                                                                                    #1
                                                                                    [Click]
                                               Log Off Administrator (L)...
Run ?
FR6H4982.EPS
EXECUTE EXECUTE
                       C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                                        _
                        [Ru0] login : cr ir346                   #6 [Type/ENT]
                        Password :                               #7 [Type/ENT]
                                                                       _
                                                                    [cr ir346]
#8 [Type/ENT]           -> mutl
                        0. QUIT
                        1. LOG
                        2. VERSION
                        3. TEST
                        4. ELECTORICAL UTILITY
                        5. SCANNER UTILITY
                        6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                        7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                        8. BACKUP MEMORY
                        9. HV OFF
                        >
FR6H4983.EPS
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                     0. QUIT
                     1. LOG
                     2. VERSION
                     3. TEST
                     4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                     5. SCANNER UTILITY
                     6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                     7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                     8. BACKUP MEMORY
                     9. HV OFF
                     > 2         #2 [Type/ENT]
                     0. QUIT
                     1. DISPLAY VERSION
                     2. DETAIL
                     VER > 1         #3 [Type/ENT]
                                                                          Version of CR-IR346RU
                     Software Resouce Version
                                                                          application
                     MAIN CPU IPL      : Z45N5436001A01
                     MAIN CPU APPL     : Z45N5436002A03
                     SUB CPU IPL       : Z45N5436103A01
                     SUB CPU APPL      : Z45N5436103B02
                     SUB CPU APPL      : Z45N5436202A00
                     Hardware Type<VER_REC>
                     CPU12A            : 00      [02.00]
                     SNS12A            : 00      [00]
                     DRV12A            : 00
                     SCN12A            : 00      [00]
                                                                                           FR6H4984.EPS
                     0. QUIT
                     1. INITIALIZE
                     BMEM > 1         #2 [Type/ENT]
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                    0. QUIT
                    1. LOG
                    2. VERSION
                    3. TEST
                    4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                    5. SCANNER UTILITY
                    6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                    7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                    8. BACKUP MEMORY INITIALIZE
                    9. HV OFF
                    > 1          #1 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. ERROR LOG
                    2. TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > 1          #2 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. DISPLAY
                    2. SAVE TO FTP-SERV
                    3. CLEAR
                    LOG > ELG > 3         #3 [Type/ENT]
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                    0. QUIT
                    1. ERROR LOG
                    2. TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > 2          #1 [Type/ENT]
                    0. QUIT
                    1. DISPLAY
                    2. SAVE ALL TRACE LOGS TO FTP-SERV
                    3. CLEAR ALL TRACE LOGS
                    LOG > TRC > 3          #2 [Type/ENT]
            (15) Click on           and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
            (16) Output the image exposed at 1 mR.
               ◆ CHECKS ◆
               • There should be no offensive noise or odor.
               • There should be no IP jam.
               • The IP should be free from any scratch or damage after reading.
               If anything abnormal is found, see [Troubleshooting Volume].
            (18) Restore the RU/CL that has been disconnected from the network to its connected state
                 (i.e., power it ON or connect its I/F cable).
       CAUTION
       Do not power OFF the RU while data is being written into the flash ROM of the CPU12A board.
       If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM will be corrupted, so that it is necessary
       to replace the CPU12A board with a new one.
(7) Click
FR6H4D30.EPS
          ===============MAIN_IPL_UPDATE.BAT================
          This is a batch program to upgrade the MAIN_IPL software of RU.
          At first, automatically check the version of the RU's application.            (8) Press the ENT key.
          --- Are you ready? (Escape character is [CTRL]+C) ----
          Press any key to continue ..
          Wait for a while....
          0.QUIT
          1.LOG
          2.VERSION
          3.TEST
          4.ELECTRICAL
          5.SCANNER
          6.MECHANICAL
          7.SOFTWARE UTILITY
          8.BACKUP MEMORY
          >2
          0.QUIT
          1.DISPLAY VERSION
          2.DETAIL
          >2
          0.QUIT
          1.LOAD SOFTWARE FROM FTP-SERV
          2.LOAD CONFIGURATION FROM FTP-SERV
          3.COMPARE SOFTWARE WITH FTP-SERV
          VER>DTL>LDSFT>1
          0.QUIT
          1.MAIN CPU IPL
          2.MAIN CPU APPL
          3.MAIN CPU FT
          4.SUB CPU IPL                                                               REFERENCE
          5.SUB CPU APPL                                                              A "beep" sounds while the flash
          VER>DTL>LDSFT>3                                                             ROM is being written
             ARE YOU SURE ?                                                           (for about 20 seconds).
          1.YES 2.NO(DEFAULT=2) : 1
          WAIT FOR A WHILE. IT TAKES FROM 3 TO 180 SECONDS.
          NEVER TURN OFF THE RU UNTIL "RESULT" IS INDICATED !!!
          RESULT : OK
                                                                                                     FR6H4D31.EPS
          0.QUIT
          1.MAIN CPU IPL
          2.MAIN CPU APPL
          3.MAIN CPU FT
          4.SUB CPU IPL
          5.SUB CPU APPL
          VER>DTL>LDSFT>3
            ARE YOU SURE ?
          1.YES 2.NO(DEFAULT=2) : 1
          WAIT FOR A WHILE. IT TAKES FROM 3 TO 180 SECONDS.             REFERENCE
          NEVER TURN OFF THE RU UNTIL "RESULT" IS INDICATED !!!         A "beep" sounds while the flash
          RESULT : OK                                                   ROM is being written
                                                                        (for about 20 seconds).
          0.QUIT
          1.MAIN CPU IPL
          2.MAIN CPU APPL
          3.MAIN CPU FT
          4.SUB CPU IPL                                                  (11) Check "OK".
          5.SUB CPU APPL
          VER>DTL>LDSFT>0
          VER>DETAIL> Press any key to continue ...                      (12) Press the ENT key.
                                                                                            FR6H4D32.EPS
           CAUTIONS
           • Do not power OFF the RU and CL during RU application update. If power is turned OFF
             during update, the machine will no longer boot up.
           • When the M-Utility can be started (can be logged in), the procedures described in this
             section should not be performed.
             If the procedures are inadvertently performed under condition where the M-Utility can be
             started, the CPU12A board should be replaced with a new one.
           • Make sure that there is no machine that has been set up as described below, connected
             over the same network.
             If such a machine is connected over the same network, disconnect it from the network by
             powering it OFF or unplugging its I/F cable.
             Unless such a machine is disconnected, the application and configuration data of that
             machine will be automatically updated as well when the application of the RU is updated.
               REFERENCE
           By performing “soft update”, the application software and the configuration data of default
           values are written into the flash ROM.
FR6H4D75.EPS
FR6H4D28.EPS
              (6) After verifying that the RU where soft update is to be performed has been booted, click
                  on the [EXECUTE] button.
FR6H4D74.EPS
FR6H3339.EPS
              (8) Turn OFF and then back ON the power switch of the RU, and, at the same time, hold
                  down the erasure process switch until the erasure process indicator blinks.
                                                                                          [Press] Erasure
                                                                                          process switch
                                                                                  Blink
                                                                                                        FR6H4D77.EPS
FR6H4D76.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute
               “PING”, before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has
               not been connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
#1 [Type/ENT]
FR6H4D09.EPS
            (14) Click on             and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute
                    has passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
                    Boot up the CL.
                        RU panel                           CL screen
                      (CALL lamp)
                                                             ID
#1 [Check]
[Click]
FR6H4D08.EPS
FR6H2567.EPS
                    REFERENCE
               By performing “soft update”, the application software and the configuration data of default
               values are written into the flash ROM.
[Type] FR6H3097.EPS
                                                                    (5) [Type]
                                                            (6) [Type] cr-ir346
                                                    (7) [Type]
                                                                                              [Press] Erasure
                                                                                              process switch
                                                                                      Blink
                                                                                                               FR6H4D77.EPS
FR6H4D78.EPS
       ◆ NOTE ◆
       In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute “PING”,
       before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has not been
       connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
#1 [Type/ENT]
FR6H4D09.EPS
            (16) Click on             and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute
                    has passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
            (17) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen,
                 and reboot the RU from the CL screen, and the RU boots up.
                    When it is rebooted, all the panel indicators are illuminated, with an audible alarm
                    generated.
              RU panel                             CL screen
            (CALL lamp)
                                                    ID
#1 [Check]
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                  Reason                           Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)                   All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Revisions associated with release of   All pages
                                          version A05 (FM3058)
          02/20/2002    05                Revisions associated with release of   All pages
                                          version A07 (FM3328)
       CAUTIONS
       • The M-Utility must be activated after routine conveyance is completed.
       • After exiting the M-Utility, be sure to reboot the machine. If the machine is not rebooted, the
         operation of routine conveyance may not be performed normally.
       • Before starting the M-Utility, quit all the application software programs
         running on the CL.
(3) Press the [Windows] key to open the Start menu of Windows.
Press
              (4) Select [Run...] from the Start menu of Windows, and type
                  [“C:\ProgramFiles\FujiFilm\FCR\Tool\cr346uty.exe”] to open the MAINTENANCE
                  UTILITY.
Windows Update
Programs (P)
Favorites (A)
Documents (D)
Settings (S)
Search (C)
Help (H)
                        Run (R)...
                                                                     #1
                                                                     [Click]
                        LogRun
                            Off Administrator...                                                        ?
FR6H3075.EPS
           REFERENCE
       Each version of the PC-MUTL corresponds to each version of the RU software, as follows.
       • RU software version A01 to A04: PC-MUTL version 1.0
       • RU software version A05 to A06: PC-MUTL version 1.1
       • RU software version A07 or later: PC-MUTL version 1.2
                                              Version 1.0
                          CR-IR346RU MAINTENANCE UTILITY
                          EACH RU SETTING
                           CONNECTION TEST
                             RU NAME       ru0                   LIST OF EXISTING RU
                                                                                                       NEW
                                                                 RU NAME        IP ADDRESS
                             RU IP ADDR       172 16    1 10     ru0            172.16.1.10        #1[Click]
                       #2[Click]            MUTL       PING
EXECUTE EXECUTE
FR6H3086.EPS
Version 1.1
                                                                                               #1[Click]
                    #2[Click]
FR6H3087.EPS
Version 1.2
                                                                                  #1[Click]
     #2[Click]
FR6H3097.EPS
                                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                                                        _
                                     RU [ru0] login : cr ir346    #3 [Type/ENT]
                                     Password :                   #4 [Type/ENT]
                                                                        _
                                                                     [cr ir346]
                    #5 [Type/ENT]    -> mutl
                                     0. QUIT
                                     1. LOG
                                     2. VERSION
                                     3. TEST
                                     4. ELECTORICAL UTILITY
                                     5. SCANNER UTILITY
                                     6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                                     7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                                     8. BACKUP MEMORY
                                     9. HV OFF
                                     >
FR6H3076.EPS
           REFERENCES
       • In the field of “RU[ru0] login:”, “cr-ir346” should be entered within 15 seconds. If 15 seconds
         have elapsed, the system returns to the “RU MAINTENANCE UTILITY” window.
       • After having entered the “RU[ru0] login:” field, enter “Password:” within 15 seconds. If 15
         seconds have passed, the system returns to the MAINTENANCE UTILITY window.
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe                           [Click]
                                       _
                     RU[ru0] login : cr ir346
                    Password :
-> mutl
                    0. QUIT
                    1. LOG
                    2. VERSION
                    3. TEST
                    4. ELECTORICAL UTILITY
                    5. SCANNER UTILITY
                    6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                    7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                    8. BACKUP MEMORY
                    9. HV OFF
                    >
FR6H3077.EPS
          [ 0 ] QUIT
          [ 1 ] LOG
                    [ 0 ] QUIT
                    [ 1 ] ERROR LOG             [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] DISPLAY                  [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                               [ 1 ] ALL                [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                                        [ 1 ] FATAL
                                                                                                        [ 2 ] WANING
                                                                                                        [ 3 ] BOTH
                                                                               [ 2 ] SUMMARY            [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 2 ] SAVE TO FTP-SERV                                  [ 1 ] FATAL
                                                [ 3 ] CLEAR                                             [ 2 ] WARNING
                                                                                                        [ 3 ] BOTH
                    [ 2 ] TRACE LOGS            [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] DISPLAY                   [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                [ 1 ] NETWORK LOG
                                                                                [ 2 ] IP HANDLING LOG
                                                                                [ 3 ] SED LOG                   [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                [ 4 ] ISC LOG                   [ 1 ] MFC
                                                                                [ 5 ] OPERATION LOG             [ 2 ] IPH
          [ 2 ] VERSION
                                                [ 2 ] SAVE ALL TRACE LOGS TO FTP-SERV.                          [ 3 ] UTL
                    [ 0 ] QUIT                  [ 3 ] CLEAR ALL TRACE LOGS                                      [ 4 ] COM
                    [ 1 ] DISPLAY VERSION
                    [ 2 ] DETAIL                [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] LOAD SOFTWARE            [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                      FROM FTP-SERV.           [ 1 ] MAIN CPU IPL
                                                                               [ 2 ] MAIN CPU APPL
                                                                               [ 3 ] SUB CPU IPL
                                                                               [ 4 ] SUB CPU APPL
                                                [ 2 ] LOAD              [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                      CONFIGURATION
          [ 3 ] TEST                                  FROM FTP-SERV.
                                                                        [ 1 ] ALL(IRSET, IRSTATUS, NETMASK,
                                                                                  ROUTE)
                    [ 0 ] QUIT                  [ 3 ] COMPARE SOFTWARE WITH FTP-SERV
                    [ 1 ] ROUTINE               [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] READING & ERASURE
                                                [ 2 ] PRIMARY ERASURE
                                                [ 3 ] SECONDARY ERASURE
                                                [ 4 ] MONITOR READING & ERASURE
                    [ 2 ] AUTO MODE             [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] READING & ERASURE
                                                [ 2 ] PRIMARY ERASURE
                                                [ 3 ] SECONDARY ERASURE
                    [ 3 ] SCANNER CLEANING
                    [ 4 ] NETWORK               [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                [ 1 ] PING(AUTO)
                                                [ 2 ] PING(MANUAL)
                                                [ 3 ] DISPLAY                   [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                      FTP-SERV                  [ 1 ] ~cr-ir346/
                                                                                [ 2 ] ~cr-ir346/SYSTEM
                                                                                [ 3 ] ~cr-ir346/SYSTEM/COMMON
    A1
                                                                                [ 4 ] ~cr-ir346/SYSTEM/[RuName]/CONFIG
                                                                                [ 5 ] ~cr-ir346/SYSTEM/[RuName]/MACHINE
                                                                                                                      FR6H3013.EPS
A1
              [ 4 ] ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                     [ 0 ] QUIT
                     [ 1 ] AUTO MODE          [ 0 ] QUIT
                                              [ 1 ] ALL
                                              [ 2 ] CPU12A
                                              [ 3 ] SCN12A
                                              [ 4 ] INV12A
                                              [ 5 ] SND12A
                                              [ 6 ] SUB CPU
                     [ 2 ] BOARD TEST         [ 0 ] QUIT
                                              [ 1 ] CPU12A           [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                     [ 1 ] BACKUP MEMORY TEST
                                                                     [ 2 ] SDRAM TEST
                                                                     [ 3 ] MAIN IPL CHECK SUM TEST
                                                                     [ 4 ] MAIN APPL CHECK SUM TEST
                                                                     [ 5 ] MAIN APPL ROM R/W TEST
                                                                     [ 6 ] INTERRUPT TEST
                                                                     [ 7 ] REGISTER(ETH) TEST
                                              [ 2 ] SCN12A           [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                     [ 1 ] REGISTER TEST
                                                                     [ 2 ] INTERRUPT TEST
                                                                     [ 3 ] H8 COMMUNICATION TEST
                                              [ 3 ] SND12A           [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                     [ 1 ] REGISTER TEST
                                                                     [ 2 ] SENSOR TEST
                                                                     [ 3 ] LED TEST
                                                                     [ 4 ] SOLENOID TEST
                                                                     [ 5 ] PULSEMOTOR TEST
                                                                     [ 6 ] INTERRUPT TEST
                                              [ 4 ] INV12A           [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                     [ 1 ] REGISTER TEST
                                                                     [ 2 ] LAMP TEST
A2
                    [ 5 ] SCANNER UTILITY
                           [ 0 ] QUIT
                           [ 1 ] INITIALIZE
                           [ 2 ] POLYGON            [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                    [ 1 ] OFF
                                                    [ 2 ] ON
                           [ 3 ] LASER              [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                    [ 1 ] OFF
                                                    [ 2 ] ON
[ 5 ] HV STATUS
                           [ 6 ] HV ON/OFF          [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                    [ 1 ] OFF
                                                    [ 2 ] ON
[ 7 ] HV DATA
                           [ 9 ] SHADING/           [ 0 ] QUIT
                                 SENSITIVITY
                                                    [ 1 ] SHADING/POLYGON CORRECTION
[ 2 ] CALCULATION [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                    [ 1 ] SHADING, POLYGON
                                                                                          AND SENSITIVITY
                                                                                    [ 2 ] SHADING AND
                                                                                          POLYGON
[ 3 ] POLYGON ONLY
[ 4 ] SENSITIVITY ONLY
[ 3 ] SENSITIVITY DATA
[ 4 ] HV DATA
[ 5 ] PMT DATA
          A3          B1
                                                                                                   FR6H3015.EPS
A3 B1
                [ 10 ] DATA MANAGEMENT
                             [ 0 ] QUIT
[ 3 ] SENSITIVITY DATA(SCN_ISEN.DAT)
                                                                    [ 4 ] FORMAT DATA
                                                                          (SCN_IFMT.DAT & SCN_OFMT.DAT)
[ 5 ] LD INITIAL DATA(SCN_LDIF.DAT)
[ 1 ] LIGHT A05–
[ 1 ] PARAMETER [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                 [ 5 ] SLEW UP TIME.
                [ 2 ] ACTUATOR                 [ 0 ] QUIT                        [ 6 ] SLEW DOWN TIME.
 A4        B2
                                                                                                           FR6H3016.EPS
    A4        B2
                    [ 3 ] SENSOR              [ 0 ] QUIT
                                              [ 1 ] MONITOR
                                              [ 2 ] MONITOR ALL
                                              [ 3 ] REAL-TIME MONITOR ALL
                    [ 4 ] UNIT                [ 0 ] QUIT
                                              [ 1 ] IP FEED/LOAD(MA1,MB1)         [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] HOME POSITION
                                                                                  [ 2 ] FEED
                                                                                  [ 3 ] LOAD
                                              [ 2 ] SIDE-POSITIONING GRIP(MC2)    [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] HOME POSITION
                                              [ 3 ] SIDE-POSITIONING(MC1)         [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] HOME POSITION
                                              [ 4 ] SUB READING GRIP DRIVE(MZ2)   [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] HOME POSITION
                                              [ 5 ] SUB READING DRIVE(MZ1)        [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] DRIVE
                                              [ 6 ] TRANSFER MOTOR UNLIMITED
                                                    DRIVE (MB1, MC3)
                                              [ 7 ] SCANNER CLEANING (MZ3)        [ 0 ] QUIT
                                                                                  [ 1 ] HOME POSITION
           [ 7 ] SOFTWARE UTILITY                                                 [ 2 ] LOCK(ref. service manual)
[ 0 ] QUIT
                    [ 1 ] DISPLAY             [ 0 ] QUIT
                          CONFIGURATION       [ 1 ] IRSET.CFG
                                              [ 2 ] IRSTATUS.CFG
                                              [ 3 ] NETMASK
                                              [ 4 ] ROUTE
                    [ 2 ] TEMPORARY SETTING
                                              [ 0 ] QUIT
                                              [ 1 ] READER UNIT NAME
                                              [ 2 ] READER UNIT IP ADDR
                                              [ 3 ] HOST(CL) IP ADDR
                                              [ 4 ] INFO-HOST IP ADDR
                                              [ 5 ] FTP-SERV IP ADDR
                                              [ 6 ] NETMASK
                                              [ 7 ] ROUTE(GATEWAY)
           [ 9 ] HV ON / HV OFF
                                                                                                        FR6H3017.EPS
EXECUTE EXECUTE
FR6H3098.EPS
FR6H3321.EPS
           [GOOD indication]
                    If messages shown below appear, the result is normal.
                    REFERENCE
               Digits for XXX in TTL=”XXX” vary depending on the environment in which the command is
               executed.
           [NG indication]
                    Other than the above.
FR6H3322.EPS
RU software version
FR6H3099.EPS
FR6H3323.EPS
RU NAME
HISTORY.LOG
FR6H3329.EPS
RESULT: OK
FR6H3330.EPS
RUNAME
HISTORY.LOG
FR6H3202.EPS
RESULT: OK
FR6H3203.EPS
FR6H3138.EPS
FR6H3140.EPS
                    A DOS prompt appears, and after a while, all the panel indicators on the RU blink four
                    times, with an audible alarm generated.
FR6H3142.EPS
                    This process will end after about one minute has passed, and the PC-MUTL window
                    appears.
                    CAUTION
                    Never power OFF the RU until the RENAME process ends completely (i.e., until the
                    PC-MUTL window appears).
RUNAME
HISTORY.LOG
FR6H3202.EPS
RESULT: OK
FR6H3203.EPS
2.1.6 Errors That May Occur during RENAME and Their Probable Causes
       ● RU is not connected
           If the RU has not been powered ON or if no network connection has been established with
           the RU, the following error message appears.
           In that case, check the network connection, and then power ON the RU.
FR6H3148.EPS
                                                    FR6H3342.EPS
                                                                                          FR6H3343.EPS
2.2        INSTALL
           This function installs the RU software contained in the CD-ROM.
               REFERENCE
           The timing of writing into the flash ROM of the RU differs depending on the software version.
           • RU software version A06 (PC-MUTL 1.1) or earlier
              → Written only into the FTP server of the CL.
           • RF software version A07 (PC-MUTL 1.2) or later
              → Written both into the FTP server of the CL and into the flash ROM of the RU.
           It should be noted that with RU software version A06, the RU software is written, upon power
           ON of the RU, into its flash ROM by auto update function.
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           Be sure to execute “PING” to the RU to be installed to ensure that a network connection has
           been established.
           Although RU software may be installed to the CL without a network connection established,
           the backup memory of the RU will not be overwritten, so that a connection with the RU
           cannot be established.
          RU                                              CL
                                                                                                CD-ROM
               Flash ROM                                       RU message file
                    Basic part
                    RU OS
RU-specific data
SDRAM
FR6H3008.EPS
           CAUTIONS
           • In an N-to-N connection setup, perform the procedures described in “Procedures for
             Installing the RU Software: Second Unit (RU Software Version A07 or Later)” after
             completing the procedures described in this section.
           • Before starting installation, be sure to execute “PING” to ensure that the RU has been
             connected. If the RU has not been connected, the RU software cannot be installed.
           • In an N-to-N connection setup, make sure that the software versions of the RUs connected
             are the same. If different versions of the RU software are installed, the operation of the CL
             and RU cannot be guaranteed.
               REFERENCE
           Because the value displayed in each setup item differs depending on the PC-MUTL version,
           set it up again as needed.
                  PC-MUTL 1.1 (A06) or earlier : The default value is displayed.
                  PC-MUTL 1.2 (A07) or later : The value that is currently set is displayed.
(1) In “RU NAME” of the PC-MUTL, type in the name of the RU to be installed.
FR6H3160.EPS
              (2) In “RU IP ADDR” of the PC-MUTL, type in the IP address of the RU that has been
                  taken note of before starting the procedures described in “2.7 UNINSTALL, ■
                  Uninstalling the RU software”.
              (3) Click on the [PING] button.
                     Referring to the DOS prompt window displayed, verify that the result is 100%
                     successful.
FR6H3162.EPS
FR6H3117.EPS
FR6H3118.EPS
FR6H3164.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    Do not power OFF the RU while the software is being installed.
                    If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so
                    that the RU will no longer boot up.
                    After about two minutes have passed, a dialog box appears notifying that the
                    installation has been completed.
              (9) Click on the [OK] button.
FR6H3119.EPS
                    The PC-MUTL window appears back on screen, where the RU installed is displayed in
                    “LIST OF EXISTING RU”.
           CAUTIONS
           • Installation of the RU software for the second and subsequent units should be performed
             following the installation for the first unit.
           • Before starting installation, be sure to execute “PING” to ensure that the RU has been
             connected. If the RU has not been connected, the RU software cannot be installed.
FR6H3331.EPS
FR6H3325.EPS
RU software version
FR6H3124.EPS
(5) In an N-to-N connection setup, perform steps (3) and (4) for all the RUs installed.
■ Errors That May Occur during Install and Their Probable Causes
       ● RU is not connected
           If the RU has not been powered ON or if no network connection has been established with
           the RU, the following error message appears.
           In that case, check the network connection, and then power ON the RU.
                                                                                    FR6H3121.EPS
                                           FR6H3120.EP
                                                    FR6H3342.EPS
                                                                                           FR6H3343.EPS
                         When it is clicked, the erasure lamp                  When it is clicked, the range "A", as well
                         lighting time and date are cleared.                   as the erasure lamp lighting time
                                                                               and date, is cleared.             FR6H3005.EPS
           ● IP processing counter
                 Indicates the number of IPs that have undergone routine reading, primary erasure, and
                 secondary erasure, on an IP size-by-size basis.
           ● IP reading counter
                 Indicates the number of IP reading operations performed for routine reading and primary
                 erasure.
           ● Warning counter
                 Indicates the number of events that have not been processed due to occurrence of error
                 (warning level).
                    REFERENCE
                 Values in the fields displayed on the “EDIT HISTORY” window represent cumulative
                 values starting from the count start date or the date when the values are cleared
                 (“SINCE” date).
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           While the flash ROM of the RU is being updated, the panel indicators on the RU are lit,
           during which the RU should not be powered OFF.
           If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so that the
           RU will no longer boot up.
              REFERENCE
           The display of the EDIT CONFIGURATION window differs depending on the software
           version.
CANCEL SET
                                                        telnet-connectable IP address
                                                        telnet-connectable net mask
FR6H3089.EPS
FR6H3104.EPS
Identification code
FR6H3081.EPS
           ● Erasure mode
               An erasure mode that is selectable by the erasure mode SW of the RU is set.
               Example) When “ERASE1, ERASE2” is set:
                            By pressing the erasure mode SW, either primary erasure or secondary
                            erasure may be selected.
               ◆ NOTES ◆
               • If type 5 IP is processed with “IP barcode availability or type” set to “6” (default), erasure
                 failure will occur.
               • When “IP barcode availability or type” is set to “5, 6”, type 6 IP takes as much erasure
                 time as type 5 IP, so that the resulting processing time for type 6 IP becomes longer
                 than specified.
           ● telnet-connectable IP address
                The IP address that permits a connection with the RU via telnet is set.
                When it is set to “0.0.0.0”, a connection can be established regardless of the IP address.
               REFERENCE
           The RU software auto update feature is intended to automatically update the RU software
           and configuration files by overwriting the contents of the FTP server.
           This feature permits the RU software to be automatically updated by updating, from a remote
           site, the files residing on the FTP server.
2.5        BACKUP
           This function copies the configuration information and error log data from the RU to the FTP
           server, and from the FTP server to a floppy diskette (FD).
          RU                                               CL
               Flash ROM                                         RU message file
                    Basic part
                    RU OS
           ● “ERROR LOG”:
               Log data is backed up.
           ● “CONFIGURATION”:
               Configuration data is backed up.
           ● “TRACE LOG”:
               Trace log data (design analysis information) is backed up.
           ● “HISTORY LOG”:
               History data (processing counter and erasure lamp lighting time) is backed up.
FR6H3325.EPS
Click
FR6H3205.EPS
or
FR6H3206.EPS
                    The backup starts, and when it is completed, the following dialog box appears.
              (8) Click on the [OK] button, and take out the floppy diskette.
FR6H3207.EPS
2.5.3 Errors That May Occur during BACKUP and Their Probable Causes
       ● RU is not connected
           If the RU has not been powered ON or if no network connection has been established with
           the RU, the following error message appears.
           In that case, check the network connection, and then power ON the RU.
FR6H3158.EPS FR6H3208.EPS
2.6        RESTORE
           This function installs the configuration information and machine-specific data from the floppy
           diskette (FD) into the RU-specific data area of the FTP server and copies it from the FTP
           server to the flash ROM of the RU.
          RU                                                CL
               Flash ROM                                         RU message file
                    Basic part
                    RU OS
           ● “CONFIGURATION”:
               Configuration data is restored.
           ● “HISTORY LOG”:
               History data (processing counter and erasure lamp lighting time) is restored.
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           When “SCN ALL DATA”, “SCN LIGHT COLLECTING DATA”, or “SCN OPTICAL DATA” is
           restored, the flash ROM of the RU is accessed, so that the RU should not be powered OFF
           during that time.
           If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so that the
           RU will no longer boot up.
FR6H3327.EPS
FR6H3332.EPS
                    A dialog box appears to prompt you to insert the floppy diskette that contains the data
                    to be resorted.
FR6H3333.EPS
2.6.3 Errors That May Occur during RESTORE and Their Probable Causes
       ● RU is not connected
           If the RU has not been powered ON or if no network connection has been established with
           the RU, the following error message appears.
           In that case, check the network connection, and then power ON the RU.
FR6H3158.EPS FR6H3208.EPS
2.7        UNINSTALL
           This function removes the RU software from the FTP server.
           Once the removal is completed, the “LIST OF EXISTING RU” list box and “RU IP ADDR”
           become empty.
           ◆ NOTES ◆
           • In an N-to-N connection setup, if UNINSTALL is executed, the software and configuration
             data for all the RUs will be deleted from the FTP server.
           • Be sure to execute INSTALL after UNINSTALL has been performed.
           CAUTIONS
           • Before executing UNINSTALL, be sure to take note of the IP addresses (user settings) of
             the RU, CL, and FTP server.
             Once UNINSTALL is executed, all the user settings are lost.
           • For the RU connected to the CL, back up the following files.
             Those files must be resorted after installation.
             - CONFIGURATION
             - HISTORY LOG
             - SCN ALL DATA
           For multiple RUs, it is necessary to identify which file belongs to which RU.
FR6H3130.EPS
              (4) Click on the [PING] button. Referring to the DOS prompt window displayed, verify that
                  the result is 100% successful.
                    CAUTION
                    If the software is to be updated from any version earlier than A04 to version A05 or
                    later, be sure to clear the backup memory data. If it is not cleared, a software error will
                    occur, so that the RU will hang up.
FR6H3334.EPS
CR-IR346CL
Straight cable
Switching hub
Network
                                      Straight cable
                                      ru1                              ru2
                      CR-IR346RU                       CR-IR346RU
FR6H3200.EPS
           • If the name of the RU is changed by using the [RENAME] button, PREVIOUS VERSION
             can no longer be executed.
       CAUTIONS
       • In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be downdated to the previous version,
         be sure to execute “ping”, before downdating, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If
         the RU has not been connected, the RU software cannot be downdated.
       • If the software is to be updated from any version earlier than A04 to version A05 or later, be
         sure to clear the backup memory data. If it is not cleared, a software error will occur, so that
         the RU will hang up.
              “2.13 Clear Backup Data, ■ Procedures for Clear Backup Data”
FR6H3328.EPS
FR6H3196.EPS
FR6H3194.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    While the version downdate is being executed, do not power OFF the RU.
                    If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so
                    that the RU will no longer boot up.
       CAUTIONS
       • In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute “ping”,
         before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has not been
         connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
       • If the software is to be updated from any version earlier than A04 to version A05 or later, be
         sure to clear the backup memory data. If it is not cleared, a software error will occur, so that
         the RU will hang up.
              “2.13 Clear Backup Data, ■ Procedures for Clear Backup Data”
          REFERENCE
       For software version update to A07 in an N-to-N connection setup, sequentially perform version
       update on the RUs registered in “LIST OF EXISTING RU”, one after another.
FR6H3336.EPS
FR6H3170.EPS
FR6H3172.EPS
FR6H3174.EPS
FR6H3176.EPS
FR6H3178.EPS
       CAUTIONS
       • In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute “PING”,
         before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has not been
         connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
       • If the software is to be updated from any version earlier than A04 to version A05 or later, be
         sure to clear the backup memory data. If it is not cleared, a software error will occur, so that
         the RU will hang up.
              “2.13 Clear Backup Data, ■ Procedures for Clear Backup Data”
FR6H3325.EPS
FR6H3186.EPS
FR6H3188.EPS
FR6H3190.EPS
FR6H3192.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    While the version update is being executed, do not power OFF the RU.
                    If power is turned OFF, the contents of the flash ROM of the RU will be corrupted, so
                    that the RU will no longer boot up.
FR6H3337.EPS
RU software version
FR6H3338.EPS
              (5) In an N-to-N connection setup, perform steps (3) and (4) for all the RUs where the
                  version update has been executed.
       ● RU is not connected
           If the RU has not been powered ON or if no network connection has been established with
           the RU, the following error message appears.
           In that case, check the network connection, and then power ON the RU.
FR6H3180.EPS FR6H3182.EPS
                                                    FR6H3342.EPS
                                                                                          FR6H3343.EPS
2.9        ERROR DB
           This function enables you to check error names and occurrence conditions by referring to
           the error log data of the RU. It also allows for adding memos to error messages and viewing
           the detail information and analysis flows.
           CAUTIONS
           • Do not install software programs, such as Adobe Acrobat Reader 4.0, on the PC that is
             used as the CL or FTP server. If such programs are installed, the CL or FTP server may
             not function normally.
           • It is a new feature added to software version A05 or later.
FR6H3210.EPS
Error code
FR6H3212.EPS
           8
                                                                                             10
7 11
9 12
                                                                              13           14
                                                                                   FR6H3091.EPS
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           To view the most up-to-the-minute error log, it is necessary to click on the “UPDATE” button
           and close the window once, and then open it again.
           ● 1 “SELECT” button
               A error log file to be viewed is selected.
           ● 2 “FATAL button
               Of the error log files, only FATAL errors are displayed.
           ● 3 “WARNING” button
               Of the error log files, only WARNING errors are displayed.
           ● 4 “BOTH” button
               Both “FATAL and “WARNING” errors windows are displayed.
           ● 5 “UPDATE”
               The latest error log data is copied from the CPU12A board of the RU to the FTP server of
               the CL.
           ● 14 “SAVE” button
               The contents of “Memo.” and “Author” are saved. To delete them, erase them by use of
               the Delete key and press the “SAVE” button again.
           CAUTION
           It is a new feature added to software version A05 or later.
                                                                                               5
      3
FR6H3092.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               Never use this button because it is reserved for future use.
           ● 4 “Scale” button
               The display scale for the time base (horizontal axis) is changed.
           ● 5 “Scroll” button
               The display range for the time base is shifted horizontally.
By clicking on the band (A) in the phase chart, the timing chart for that phase is displayed.
                                9               A            B              A-B            10
                                                                                   FR6H3093.EPS
           ● 5 “Scale” button
               The display scale for the time base (horizontal axis) is changed.
           ● 6 “Scroll” button
               The display range for the time base is shifted horizontally.
           ● 9 “Scroll” button
               When the number of I/Os exceeds 15, the display area is shifted vertically.
               Note that when the “CLEAR” button is clicked, the values in the A, B, and A-B fields are all
               cleared.
FR6H2558.eps
           CAUTIONS
           • The serviceman’s PC should run on Windows 2000 or NT.
           • It is a new feature added to software version A05 or later.
■ Procedure
              (1) Put the CD bundled with the RU into the serviceman’s PC.
                    The install start window opens.
[Click]
FR6H2553.EPS
FR6H2554.EPS
[FCR] → [ERROR-DB.exe]
FR6H2555.EPS
FR6H2556.EPS
           ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
           If the ERROR-DB windows does not open but an error is indicated, perform the procedures
           set forth below.
■ Error Indication
FR6H2557.EPS
Start the Explorer, double-click the batch file (Toolreg.batl), and restart the PC.
                    (114Y5436002A05) :\ETC\BATCH\TOOLREG.BAT
                    [Start] → [Explorer] → [114Y5436002A05] → [ETC] → [BATCH] → [TOOLREG.BAT]
FR6H2558.EPS
       CAUTION
       If the software is to be updated from any version earlier than A04 to version A05 or later, be
       sure to clear the backup memory data. If it is not cleared, a software error will occur, so that the
       RU will hang up.
FR6H3132.EPS
FR6H3134.EPS
FR6H3136.EPS
           CAUTIONS
           • Do not power OFF the RU and CL during RU application update. If power is turned OFF
             during update, the machine will no longer boot up.
           • When the M-Utility can be started (can be logged in), the procedures described in this
             section should not be performed.
             If the procedures are inadvertently performed under condition where the M-Utility can be
             started, the CPU12A board should be replaced with a new one.
           • Make sure that there is no machine that has been set up as described below, connected
             over the same network.
             If such a machine is connected over the same network, disconnect it from the network by
             powering it OFF or unplugging its I/F cable.
             Unless such a machine is disconnected, the application and configuration data of that
             machine will be automatically updated as well when the application of the RU is updated.
               REFERENCE
           By performing “soft update”, the application software and the configuration data of default
           values are written into the flash ROM.
FR6H4D75.EPS
FR6H4D28.EPS
              (6) After verifying that the RU where soft update is to be performed has been booted, click
                  on the [EXECUTE] button.
FR6H4D74.EPS
FR6H3339.EPS
              (8) Turn OFF and then back ON the power switch of the RU, and, at the same time, hold
                  down the erasure process switch until the erasure process indicator blinks.
                                                                                          [Press] Erasure
                                                                                          process switch
                                                                                  Blink
                                                                                                        FR6H4D77.EPS
FR6H4D76.EPS
               ◆ NOTE ◆
               In an N-to-N connection setup, if the RU software is to be updated, be sure to execute
               “PING”, before version update, to ensure that the RU has been connected. If the RU has
               not been connected, the RU software cannot be updated.
#1 [Type/ENT]
FR6H4D09.EPS
            (14) Click on                  and then sequentially choose “Programs”, “Fuji Film”, and “FCR”.
                    ➮ The CL-AP starts up in about one minutes.
                    A RU boot-up message appears on the monitor of the CL, and after about one minute
                    has passed, the RU becomes ready for operation.
                    Boot up the CL.
            (15) Verify that the RU call lamp is illuminated, with [11025] displayed on the CL screen,
                 and reboot the RU from the CL screen, and the RU boots up.
                    When it is rebooted, all the panel indicators are illuminated, with an audible alarm
                    generated.
                       RU panel                            CL screen
                     (CALL lamp)
                                                             ID
#1 [Check]
3. Details of M-Utility
[1] LOG
           Displays the error log or trace log or saves the error log or trace log stored in the RU’s CPU
           memory into the CL’s FTP server. Note that the trace log is for design analysis use.
           Displays the contents of the error log or saves the error log stored in the RU’s CPU memory
           into the CL’s FTP server.
[1-1-1] DISPLAY
LOG>ELG>DSP>ALL> 1
LOG>ELG>DSP>SML> 3
           [1] FATAL:      Displays the number of logged error events at levels 0 and 9 after grouping
                           them according to error codes.
           [2] WARNING: Displays the number of logged error events at levels 1, 2, 3 and 4 after
                        grouping them according to error codes.
           [3] BOTH:       Displays the total number of logged error events after grouping them accord-
                           ing to error codes.
Saves the error log stored in the RU’s CPU memory into the CL’s FTP server.
■ Flow of data
      RU                                                CL
                                                                                            CD-ROM
          Flash ROM                                          RU message file
             Basic part
           Backup memory                                                                       FD
           Log data
                                                               RU-specific data
                                                                Log data
           SDRAM
FR6H3061.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [1] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    A message appears, asking whether you really want to start execution.
              (2) Choose “1” (YES).
                    The system then performs the data copy process. When the process ends normally,
                    the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
[1-1-3] CLEAR
■ Procedure
              (1) [1] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [3] [ENT]
                    A message appears, asking whether you really want to start execution.
              (2) Choose “1” (YES).
                    The system then deletes the error log. When the deletion process ends normally, the
                    display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
[1-2-1] DISPLAY
        CAUTION
        This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular
        servicing purposes).
Saves the trace logs stored in the RU’s CPU memory into the CL’s FTP server.
■ Procedure
             (1) [1] [ENT] → [2] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    A message appears, asking whether you really want to start execution.
             (2) Choose “1” (YES).
                    The system then performs the trace log copy process. When the process ends nor-
                    mally, the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
[2] VERSION
           Displays the version information about the RU software on screen or loads the RU software
           or configuration information from the CL’s FTP server into the RU.
■ Flow of data
           The following data flow diagram shows how data is loaded from the CL’s FTP server to the
           RU.
          RU                                                CL
                                                                                             CD-ROM
               Flash ROM                                         RU message file
                    Basic part
                    RU OS
FR6H3062.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [2] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The version information then appears on the display.
■ Display
                       VER> 1                                                        (1)
                       CR-IR346RU Application Software : 114Y5436002A00
                       Software Resource Version                RU software version
                        MAIN CPU IPL       :     Z45N5436001A01
                                                                      RU control software
                        MAIN CPU APPL      :     Z45N5436002A00
                        SUB CPU IPL        :     Z45N5436101A01
                                                                      RU image software
                        SUB CPU APPL       :     Z45N5436102B02
                        SCN CPU APPL       :     Z45N5436202A00       Scanner software
                       Hardware Type(VER_REG)
                        CPU12A             :               00      [01,00]
                        SNS12A             :               00      [00]
                        DRV12A             :               00
                        SCN12A             :               00      [00]
                                                                             PC board installation program
                                                                                                   FR6H3054.EPS
[2-2] DETAIL
Loads the RU software or configuration data from the CL’s FTP server into the RU.
           CAUTION
           This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular
           servicing purposes).
           Loads the RU software from the CL’s FTP server into the flash ROM on the RU’s CPU12A
           board.
           CAUTION
           While the main CPU or sub-CPU OS is being loaded, do not turn OFF the power or perform
           a reset because the flash ROM on the CPU12A board becomes damaged, resulting in the
           RU’s inability to start up.
           Loads the RU configuration data (IRSET, IRSTATUS, NETMASK, and ROUTE) from the CL’s
           FTP server into the flash ROM on the RU’s CPU12A board.
[2-2-3] COMPARE SOFTWARE WITH FTP-SERV
           Compares the version of the software that is loaded in the flash ROM of the RU with the
           version of the RU software on the FTP server of the CL.
           The following software is to be compared:
           Menu item                                        Software to be compared
           [1] MAIN CPU IPL                                 Main CPU IPL (OS)
           [2] MAIN CPU APPL                                Main CPU application
           [3] SUB CPU FT                                   ✻✻✻✻✻
[3] TEST
           Conducts an IP conveyance/image reading test in the utility mode, removes dust from the
           scanner unit, or checks the network connection.
■ Function
[3-1] ROUTINE
           Performs an IP conveyance/image read operation in the utility mode. Also allows you to
           perform a read/erasure/image output process while displaying the sensor status (open or
           closed) and other information on screen.
               REFERENCE
           When “READING & ERASURE” and “MONITOR READING & ERASURE” are to be ex-
           ecuted, it is necessary to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
           illuminated).
           Unless the RU is ready for reading, IP conveyance will not start even when a cassette is set
           in position.
           Performs a regular image read operation, outputs an image, and deletes an image from the
           IP. Use this menu item when conducting IP conveyance and image read operations simulta-
           neously for testing purposes.
■ Procedure
              (1) Have a cassette on hand.
                    Have an exposed cassette on hand, depending on what to be checked.
              (2) Make the RU ready for reading.
                    Manipulate the CL to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
                    illuminated).
              (3) [3][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    The machine is made ready for IP conveyance and reading.
              (4) Set the cassette in position.
                    IP conveyance and reading are performed.
                    When the cassette is set again, IP conveyance and reading are performed succes-
                    sively.
              (5) [Ctrl] + [C] → [ENT]
                    The menu then closes.
■ Display
           Performs a regular image read operation to detect the dose received by the IP and effects IP
           erasure in accordance with the received dose. Since this menu item performs an image
           read operation to detect the amount of IP consumption, it does not output an image. Use
           this menu item when you check an image-reading conveyance operation only.
■ Procedure
              (1) Have a cassette on hand.
                    Have on hand a cassette to be erased.
              (2) [3][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [2][ENT]
                    The machine is ready for IP conveyance and erasure.
              (3) Set the cassette in position.
                    IP conveyance and erasure are performed.
                    When the cassette is set again, IP conveyance and erasure are performed succes-
                    sively.
              (4) [Ctrl] + [C] → [ENT]
                    The menu then closes.
■ Display
           Conveys the IP through the image read section without performing an image read operation
           and merely subjects the IP to secondary erasure. Use this menu item when you check the
           IP conveyance mechanism only.
           Performs the “READING & ERASURE” operation while displaying the sensor status (open or
           closed) and other information on screen. Use this menu item to locate a fault.
■ Procedure
              (1) Have a cassette on hand.
                    Have on hand a cassette to be erased.
              (2) Make the RU ready for reading.
                    Manipulate the CL to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
                    illuminated).
              (3) [3][ENT] → [1][ENT] → [4][ENT]
                    The machine is made ready for IP conveyance and erasure.
              (4) Set the cassette in position.
                    IP conveyance and erasure are performed, and a new line is displayed whenever the
                    sensor status changes.
              (5) [Ctrl] + [C] → [ENT]
                    The menu then closes.
■ Display
                    TST>RTN>4                                                                  (3)
                    Open:o/Close:x
                    SSSSSSSSSSSSSSLLL
                    AAAAABCCCCZZZZDDD
                    12345112342345SSS
                                  NNN
                                  123
           Performs a regular read operation, outputs an image, and deletes an image from the IP.
           Since the same IP is repeatedly conveyed, however, the machine reads an erased IP on the
           second and subsequent cycles.
               REFERENCE
           When “READING & ERASURE” is to be executed, it is necessary to make the RU ready for
           reading (with the cassette loading lamp illuminated).
           Unless the RU is ready for reading, IP conveyance will not start even when a cassette is set
           in position.
■ Procedure
              (1) Have a cassette on hand.
              (2) Make the RU ready for reading.
                    Manipulate the CL to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
                    illuminated).
              (3) [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    The display then prompts you to enter the number of times you want to perform IP
                    conveyance and reading.
              (4) [5][ENT]
                    The machine is then ready for performing IP conveyance and reading five times.
              (5) Set the cassette in position.
                    IP conveyance and reading are performed the number of times (five times) that has
                    been set in step (4).
              (6) [Ctrl] + [C] → [ENT]
                    The menu then closes.
■ Display
           Performs an image read operation to detect the dose received by the IP and effects IP
           erasure in accordance with the received dose. Since this menu item performs an image
           read operation to detect the amount of IP consumption, it does not output an image.
■ Procedure
              (1) Have a cassette on hand.
              (2) [3][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [2][ENT]
                    The display then prompts you to enter the number of times you want to perform IP
                    conveyance and erasure.
              (3) [5][ENT]
                    The machine is then ready for performing IP conveyance and erasure five times.
              (4) Set the cassette in position.
                    IP conveyance and erasure are performed the number of times (five times) that has
                    been set in step (3).
              (5) [Ctrl] + [C] → [ENT]
                    The menu then closes.
■ Display
           Conveys the IP without performing an image read operation and merely subjects the IP to
           secondary erasure.
           Rotates the light-collecting mirror axis to clean the light-collecting surface of the light-collect-
           ing guide.
           The function of this menu is the same as the scanner cleaning function in the User Utility.
■ Procedure
              (1) [3] [ENT] → [3] [ENT]
                    The machine then performs a scanner cleaning operation.
■ Display
[3-4] NETWORK
        CAUTION
        With software version A02 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be used.
           Transmits a message to all IP addresses entered in the configuration file to verify the net-
           work connection.
           Transmits a message form the CPU12A board of the RU to a specified address to verify the
           network connection.
■ Procedure
              (1) [3] [ENT] → [4] [ENT]
                    The display then prompts you to specify the IP address.
              (2) Enter an IP address.
                    The system then checks the connection to the entered IP address.
        CAUTIONS
        • With software version A02 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be used.
        • This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular
          servicing purposes).
Accesses the CL’s FTP server to verify that files can be accessed.
■ Function
           ● BARCODE TEST:
           Performs a barcode reader test.
■ Procedure
              (1) [4] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    The display then prompts you to enter the number of times you want to repeat the
                    testing cycle.
              (2) Enter “3” (for performing the testing process three times).
                    The system then repeats the PC board testing cycle the specified number of times
                    (three times). When the testing process ends normally, the display reads “RESULT:
                    OK”.
                    To abort the testing process during its execution, press the [Ctrl] and [C] keys simulta-
                    neously and then press the [ENT] key.
■ Display
[4-1-1] ALL
           Runs all the self-diagnostic checks between [4-1-2] and [4-1-6] (CPU12A, SCN12A, INV12A,
           SNS12A, DRV12A, and SUBCPU).
           You can repeat execution within a range of 1 to 99999.
[4-1-2] CPU12A
           Runs diagnostic checks on the following parts of the CPU12A board. You can repeat execu-
           tion within a range of 1 to 99999.
Appl-ROM
Image ROM
Boot-ROM
[4-1-3] SCN12A
           Runs diagnostic checks on the following parts of the SCN12A board. You can repeat execu-
           tion within a range of 1 to 99999.
H8CPU FR6H3056.EPS
[4-1-4] INV12A
           Runs diagnostic checks on the following parts of the INV12A board. You can repeat execu-
           tion within a range of 1 to 99999.
[4-1-5] SND12A
           Runs diagnostic checks on the following parts of the SND12A board. You can repeat execu-
           tion within a range of 1 to 99999.
DRV12A board
DC motor solenoid
Sensor/LED/driver section
FR6H3063.EPS
           Runs self-diagnostic checks on the following parts of the sub-CPU. You can repeat execu-
           tion within a range of 1 to 99999.
                                         FIFO/SRAM
            CPU12A board
           Conducts various PC board tests on an individual basis for self-diagnostic checkout of each
           functional block.
[4-2-1] CPU12A
[4-2-2] SCN12A
[4-2-3] SND12A
           Runs a self-diagnostic check on each functional block of the SND boards (SNS12A and
           DRV12A boards).
            [ 1 ] REGISTER (ETH) TEST:
                    Conducts a register test.
            [ 2 ] SENSOR TEST:
                    Tests the control signal output to a sensor.
            [ 3 ] LED TEST:
                    Tests the control signal output to an LED.
            [ 4 ] SOLENOID TEST:
                    Tests the control signal output to a solenoid.
            [ 5 ] PULSEMOTOR TEST:
                    Tests the control signal output to a motor.
            [ 6 ] INTERRUPT TEST:
                    Tests the interrupt control.
[4-2-4] INV12A
           Tests the SDRAM and FIFO memory of the sub-CPU (digital data processing CPU) on the
           CPU12A board. Also allows you to output a pattern image or generate an image re-output.
            [ 1 ] SDRAM TEST:
                    Tests the SDRAM.
            [ 2 ] FIFO TEST:
                    Tests the FIFO memory.
(3)
(1)
                                                                               (2)
                                                 (4)
           ● Procedure
              (1) Register the examination menu.
                    Select the menu on the CL and register it.
              (2) Make the RU ready for reading.
                    Manipulate the CL to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
                    illuminated).
              (3) [4][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [3][ENT]
                    A menu then opens, prompting you to select an output image size.
              (4) Enter “2” (14"x14").
                    The system then outputs an image presented below. When the image output process
                    ends normally, the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■Display
           ● Procedure
              (1) Register the examination menu and barcode.
                    Select the menu on the CL and manually register the barcode. It should be noted that
                    any barcode might be registered for this purpose.
              (2) [4][ENT] → [3][ENT] → [3][ENT]
                    A menu then opens, prompting you to select an output image size.
              (3) Enter “2” (14"x14").
                    A message appears on the CL to prompt you to enter the barcode.
              (4) Select the “IP# Input” button.
                    A dialog box appears to enter the barcode.
● Display
           Re-outputs an image.
           ◆ NOTE ◆
           After bootup, if “RE-OUTPUT IMAGE” is executed without performing the reading operation
           at all, the following error will occur.
           → Error code: 13011
           ● Procedure
              (1) Cancel the ready-for-reading state of the RU.
                    Manipulate the CL to cancel the ready-for-reading state of the RU (with the cassette
                    loading lamp not illuminated).
              (2) [4] [ENT] → [3] [ENT] → [4][ENT]
                    The system then outputs an image.
● Display
           Automatically checks all PC boards for blown fuses. Note, however, that this menu item may
           not work if the CPU12A board is faulty.
■ Procedure
              (1) [4] [ENT] → [4] [ENT]
                    The system then checks for blown fuses. When the fuse checkout process ends
                    normally, the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
Displays the settings of the DIP and slide switches on the CPU12A board.
■ Procedure
              (1) [4] [ENT] → [5] [ENT]
                    The system then checks and displays the switch settings.
■ Display
           ◆ NOTES ◆
           • If you conduct the “[4-6] BARCODE TEST” when the CPU12A board DIP switch is set so
             as not to use the optional barcode reader, the display always reads “RESULT: OK”.
           • Since the function of “[4-6-2] READ TEST” has been changed between version A02 or
             earlier and version A03 or later, their respective procedures should be performed as
             appropriate.
[4-6-1] COMMUNICATION
           Sends a control command to the barcode reader to check for a response.
■ Procedure
              (1) [4] [ENT] → [6] [ENT]
              (2) Choose “1” (COMMUNICATION).
                    The system then checks for a response from the barcode reader. When the checkout
                    process ends normally, the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
                       REFERENCES
                    • If the barcode cannot be read through a single conveyance, the IP is conveyed again
                      by setting the IP cassette into the IP set unit once again. If the barcode cannot still
                      be read, an error results.
                    • If “READ TEST” is executed with such DIP switch setting on the CPU12A board as
                      not to use the barcode, the display always reads “RESULT: OK”, no matter whether
                      the barcode is available or not.
■ Function
           ● INITIALIZE: Initializes the scanner.
[5-1] INITIALIZE
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The system then performs the scanner initialization process. When the process ends
                    normally, the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
[5-2] POLYGON
        CAUTION
        If the cover must be removed to gain access to the LED on the SCN12A board, turn OFF the
        HV switch before removing the cover.
        If the cover is removed with the HV switch in the ON position, the photomultiplier will be dam-
        aged.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [2] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    The polygon then turns ON and then the display reads “RESULT: OK”. If the polygon
                    ON signal LED on the SCN12A board does not come on in this instance, the SCN12A
                    board is faulty.
                                                                             Illuminated when
                                                                             the polygon turns ON
                                                                                     PMTD1G
                                                                     POLON
LIGHT
                                                       CN5
                            CN1     CN6    CN2 CN3             CN4           S1
                                            SCN12A
                                                                                              FR6H3082.EPS
■ Display
[5-3] LASER
        CAUTION
        While the laser is ON, do not turn OFF the polygon. If you turn OFF the polygon with the laser
        turned ON, the laser light may fall upon a single spot, causing a risk of machine failure or fire.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [3] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    This causes the laser and polygon to turn ON, and the display reads one of the follow-
                    ing values and “RESULT: OK”.
                    • LDIFINT:             LD amperage value at the time of shipping from factory
                    • LDIFNOW:             Current LD amperage value
                    • LDIFNOW/LDIFINT: Value indicative of how much the amperage value has dropped,
                                       since shipping from factory until now.
                      REFERENCE
                    When the value of LDIFNOW/LDIFINT drops below 0.6, an error code is displayed.
■ Display
        CAUTION
        This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular servic-
        ing purposes). If it is used inadvertently, install the machine shipment control data for the
        optical system.
[5-4-1] GET DATA FROM SCN, SAVE TO RAM & FLASH & FTP-SERV
           Acquires machine shipment control data from the scanner and sets the acquired values in
           the SDRAM, flash memory, and FTP server.
           Restores the machine shipment control data in the SDRAM, flash memory, and FTP server
           to the default values.
[5-5] HV STATUS
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [5] [ENT]
                    This causes the display to show the HV switch setting and then the message “RE-
                    SULT: OK”.
■ Display
[5-6] HV ON/OFF
        CAUTION
        Before turning ON the HV switch (software switch), check to see whether the cover is installed.
        If the HV switch is turned ON with the cover removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [6] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    This causes the display to show the HV switch setting and then the message “RE-
                    SULT: OK”.
■ Display
                    REFERENCE
               If the HV switch (hardware switch) on the SCN12A board is OFF, the displays reads “HV
               OFF and “RESULT: OK” even when the HV software switch turns ON.
               |SCN>HV>2                                                                                |
               |HV OFF                                                                                  |
               |RESULT : OK                                                                             |
[5-7] HV DATA
           When you enter an HV voltage value between 255 and 667 V, the system checks whether
           the command value output from the SCN12A board is equal to the entered value.
               REFERENCE
           If the HV switch (software or hardware switch) is OFF, the displays reads “HV OFF” and
           “RESULT: OK” even when you enter an HV voltage value.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [7] [ENT]
                    A message then appears to prompt for the input of an HV voltage value. If the HV
                    switch is OFF in this instance, the display reads “HV OFF” and then “RESULT: OK”.
              (2) Enter the value “300” (HV voltage).
■ Display
[5-8] FORMAT
           Fine-tunes the read start width (FREQ) and read start position (PIXEL).
               REFERENCE
           Use the “FORMAT” menu when the format needs to be fine-tuned in situations where the
           machine shipment control data is installed. You should also use this menu when inter-unit
           adjustments are needed due, for instance, to simultaneous replacement of the subscanning
           unit and side-positioning conveyor.
           ◆ NOTES ◆
           • Once the setting is changed, the result of that change becomes effective immediately.
           • Because the value that has been changed becomes ineffective when the machine is
             rebooted, you must perform “BACKUP” of the configuration if you want to keep the setup
             value effective after reboot or to save the setup value.
■ Function
           ● DEFAULT: Restores the settings of the read width (FREQ) and read start position (PIXEL)
             to their default values.
           ● FREQ ADJUST: Fine-tunes the read width (FREQ).
               It makes fine adjustments when the size of the output image is enlarged or reduced in the
               horizontal (main scan) direction.
           ● PIXEL ADJUST: Fine-tunes the read start position (PIXEL).
               It fine-tunes the image output position to the right or left when any horizontal white blank
               appears on the output image or when the image is cut off (when there is some non-
               outputted portion).
                    REFERENCES
               • When both the read width (FREQ) and read start position (PIXEL) are to be adjusted,
                 the read width should be first adjusted. If the read start position is first adjusted, it may
                 be necessary to adjust the read start position again as a result of the read width adjust-
                 ment.
               • The value that has been set in the “FORMAT” menu becomes ineffective when the
                 machine is rebooted. You must perform “BACKUP” of the configuration if you want to
                 keep the setup value effective after reboot.
[5-8-1] DEFAULT
           Restores the current settings for the read start position (PIXEL) and read width (FREQ) to
           the default values.
               REFFERENCE
           When you select the default settings, the system adjusts the output image position to make
           IP edges visible, indicating that the default settings are used.
■ Procedure: Example where both the read start position and read width are restored
  to the default values
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [8] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The system restores the read start position and read width to their default values and
                    the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
           Adjusts the read width (FREQ) over a range from -5.00 to +5.00%. Any entry outside the
           acceptable range will be invalidated.
                                                                                                a
                                                           Actual size of steel rule
                                                                                       Reduction factor
                                                                                                          x100=Adjustment value (%)
                                                                    Actual size of steel rule
                                  a
                       REFERENCE
                    The output image is reduced when a negative-quantity (“-” signed) read width is
                    entered, and enlarged when a positive-quantity (“+” signed) read width is entered.
              (6) Read one of the IPs provided in step (1), and output its image.
              (7) Measure the actual size of the 150-mm steel rule and the size of the white blank
                  portion, and make sure that there is no drift between them.
                    If there is any drift, reset the RU and then make adjustments again.
■ Display
                                                                  b
                                                           Reduction factor
                                                                              x10 =   Adjustment value (PIXEL)
FR6H3080.EPS
               REFERENCE
           The white blank portion of the output image is expanded when a negative-quantity (“-”
           signed) value is entered, and narrowed when a positive-quantity (“+” signed) value is en-
           tered.
              (6) Read one of the IPs provided in step (1), and output its image.
              (7) Make sure that there is no white blank portion and the image is not cut off.
■ Display
           Use this menu when you manually enter the machine shipment control data indicated on the
           scanning optics unit.
       CAUTION
       Use “OPTIC FORMAT” only when you manually enter the machine shipment control data
       indicated on the scanning optics unit.
■ Procedure
              (1) Take note of the following values indicated on the label attached on the scanning
                  optics unit top surface.
                    • “FREQ”: Read width
                    • “PIXO”: Read start position
              (2) Install the cover.
              (3) Start the M-Utility of the RU.
              (4) [5][ENT] → [8][ENT] → [4][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    A message then appears to prompt for the input of the read width.
              (5) Enter the read width (for example, “3”).
              (6) [2][ENT]
                    A message then appears to prompt for the input of the read start position.
              (7) Enter the read start position (for example, “150”).
                    The display reads “RESULT: OK”, and the machine shipment control data is updated.
               REFERENCE
           The value that has been set in the “FORMAT” menu becomes ineffective when the machine
           is rebooted. You must perform “BACKUP” of the scanning optics data if you want to keep the
           setup value effective after reboot.
■ Display
[5-9] SHADING/SENSITIVITY
           Makes shading and polygon corrections, or allows for the input of sensitivity data (S value).
               REFERENCE
           The value that has been set in the “SHADING/SENSITIVITY” menu becomes ineffective
           when the machine is rebooted. You must perform “BACKUP” of the light-collecting data if
           you want to keep the setup value effective after reboot.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [9] [ENT] → [1][ENT]
              (2) Choose “1” (ON).
                    The system then checks the setup. When the checkout process ends normally, the
                    display reads “RESULT: OK”.
           ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
           Once the setup has been completed, perform “BACKUP” of the light-collecting data to save
           the data that has been changed in a floppy disk.
           If the machine is powered OFF without saving, the setup that has been done will be lost.
■ Display
[5-9-2] CALCULATION
       CAUTION
       Pay attention to the following points when performing shading and polygon corrections.
       • Before performing any correction, remove the cassette from the RU. If the cassette remains
         loaded, no correction will be performed (regular reading is performed).
       • To perform corrections, be sure to use an IP of either 14"x14" (35cm x 35cm) or 14"x17"
         (35cm x 43cm) size. If an IP of any other size is used, an error results.
       • For IPs used for corrections, be sure to use IPs that have been exposed at a dose indicated in
         the Procedure.
         If an IP that has not been exposed is used, an error results.
■ Procedure
              (1) Uniformly expose an IP of 14"x14" (35cm x 35cm) or 14"x 17" (35cm x 43cm) size at
                  about 1 mR.
                    The X-ray dose at the time of exposure should be measured (in “mR”) by use of a
                    calibrated dosimeter.
              (2) [5][ENT] → [9][ENT] → [2][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    A message then appears to prompt for the input of the X-ray dose.
              (3) Enter the X-ray dose measured at the time of exposure (for example, “0.9”).
                    The system is then ready for calculation of correction data.
                    To abort the process during its execution, press the [Ctrl] and [C] keys simultaneously
                    and then press the [ENT] key.
              (4) Read the IP provided at step (1), using the “SENSITIVITY” menu of “TEST”.
                    Shading and polygon corrections are performed, and when they end normally, the
                    display reads “RESULT: OK”.
           ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
           Once the correction data calculation has been completed, perform “BACKUP” of the light-
           collecting data to save the data that has been changed in a floppy disk.
           If the machine is powered OFF without saving, the correction result will be lost.
■ Display
■ Procedure: Example where when the S value of the IP exposed at the reference
             dose reads “25”, adjustments are made so that it reads “30”
              (1) Have on hand an IP exposed at such a dose that the S value reads “25”.
                    Check the dose at the time of exposure by use of a calibrated dosimeter.
              (2) [5][ENT] → [9][ENT] → [3][ENT]
                    A message then appears to prompt for the input of the S value.
              (3) Enter the S value of the output image (for example, “25”).
                    A message then appears again to prompt for the input of the S value.
              (4) Enter the S value to be expected (for example, “30”).
                    The sensitivity data is then adjusted, and when it ends normally, the display reads
                    “RESULT: OK”.
                    To abort the process during its execution, press the [Ctrl] and [C] keys simultaneously
                    and then press the [ENT] key.
              (5) Read the IP provided in step (1).
                    Make sure that the S value on the output film reads “30”.
■ Display
[5-9-4] HV DATA
       CAUTION
       This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular servic-
       ing purposes).
       CAUTION
       This feature is for design analysis only. Do not use this feature in the market (for regular servic-
       ing purposes).
Saves the scanner data into the FTP server (CL) or loads the saved scanner data.
       CAUTION
       Never reset the RU or power it OFF while any submenu of “DATA MANAGEMENT” is being
       executed.
       During its execution, the RU panel blinks with an audible “beep, beep, beep, ...” alert sounded.
           Saves the scanner data stored in the main memory into the flash memory and FTP server
           (CL).
Loads the scanner data stored in the flash memory and FTP server into the main memory.
           Displays a list of files that have been saved in the FTP server (CL) during the time interval
           between machine power ON and “[10-3] DISPLAY SCN DATA ETC” execution.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [10] [ENT] → [3] [ENT] → [3] [ENT]
                    A file list then appears on the display.
■ Display
               |SCN>DTM>DISP>3                                                                             |
               |                                                                                           |
               |SCN_SHDG.DAT                                                                               |
               |SCN_POLY.DAT                                                                               |
               |SCN_ISEN.DAT                                                                               |
               |SCN_IFMT.DAT                                                                               |
               |SCN_OFMT.DAT                                                                               |
               |SCN_LDIF.DAT                                                                               |
               |RESULT : OK                                                                                |
[5-11] DIAGNOSTIC
               REFFERENCE
           The display of the Scanner Diagnostic Status window differs depending on the software
           version.
■ Procedure
              (1) [5] [ENT] → [11] [ENT]
                    The self-diagnostics result is displayed.
FR6H3084.EPS
                                         Detail code
                                  Error code                                      FR6H3090.EPS
■ Function
           ● LIGHT:
           Inputs the light of the LED on the PMT12A board through the light-collecting guide to output
           an image.
           It can be checked to see whether or not the cause of image abnormality is due to a failure of
           the scanner optics unit.
           ● LOG AMP:
           Causes the LOG AMP on the PMT board to generate and output image data.
           By using “LIGHT” and “SCN12A INPUT” in combination, it can be checked to see whether or
           not the cause of image abnormality is due to a failure of the light-collecting unit.
           ● SCN12A INPUT:
           Cause the scanner board to generate image data and send the image data to the sub-CPU
           on the CPU12A board.
           It can be checked to see whether or not the cause of image abnormality is due to an image
           processing error on the CPU board.
■ Procedure: Example where “LIGHT” is used to generate image data (For 1-to-1
  Connection)
              (1) Register the examination menu.
                    Select the menu on the CL and register it.
              (2) Make the RU ready for reading.
                    Manipulate the CL to make the RU ready for reading (with the cassette loading lamp
                    illuminated).
              (3) [5][ENT] → [12][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    A menu then appears to prompt you to select the LED’s luminescence quantity.
              (4) [1][ENT]
              (5) Set the cassette in position.
                    An image that is similar in cases where an IP exposed at the “Signal Level” dose
                    displayed on screen is read is outputted, and when the process ends normally, the
                    display reads “RESULT: OK”.
                    Output example: Uniform gray image
■ Display: Example where “LIGHT” is used to generate image data (For 1-to-1
  Connection)
■ Procedure: Example where “LIGHT” is used to generate image data (For N-to-N
  Connection)
           ◆ NOTE◆
           For an N-to-N connection setup, the following error will occur if the command is executed
           without entering the barcode.
           → Error code 11404
■ Display: Example where “LIGHT” is used to generate image data (For N-to-N
  Connection)
[5-12-1] LIGHT
           Directs the PMT12A board LED light toward the reader and reads the LED light entered from
           the light-collecting guide to generate an image.
           After the light is collected by a photomultiplier, the system performs image processing in the
           same manner as for a regular read operation.
           Causes the logarithmic amplifier on the PMT board to generate image data and send the
           image data to the scanner board.
           The scanner board and subsequent sections perform image processing in the same manner
           as for a regular read operation.
           Causes the scanner board to generate image data and send the image data to the sub-CPU
           on the CPU12A board.
           The sub-CPU and subsequent sections perform image processing in the same manner as
           for a regular read operation.
[6-1] MOTOR
                                            M
                                                                                  MB1: CW rotation for feed conveyance
                                                   CCW
                                                                                 M
                                                                                             Conveyance motor
                                                               CW
                                                                                 CW          MB1
CW
                          CCW                                                                Side-positioning
                                                                            CW
                                                                                             conveyor Unit C
                                                      T
                                                    ON
                                                  FR                                         MC3: CW rotation for
 Latch drive                                                                                 feed conveyance
                                                Latch                            CW
               Gear
                      CCW
                                                                             CCW
            Latch assembly
                                                                        M                    Side-positioning motor
                                                                                 M
                                                                            M
                                                                                            Conveyance motor
                                                                                            MC3
                                                                                            Grip release motor
                                                                                            MC2
                                                                                                       FR6H3057.EPS
                 REFERENCES
           • The motor drive parameters can be variously set for all motors. The entered settings
             remain effective while the power is ON.
           • When you choose “[6-1-2] DRIVE”, the system drives a motor in accordance with the
             parameter settings.
           • The parameters can be restored to the factory default settings by turning OFF the power or
             executing “[6-1-4] LOAD PARAMETER FROM FTP-SERV.”.
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The display then prompts for the selection of a motor.
              (2) Choose “1'” (MA1).
                    The display then prompts for the selection of a parameter.
              (3) Choose “1'” (rotation direction).
                    The display then prompts for the input of a rotation direction.
              (4) Choose “1” (CW).
                    The display then reads “RESULT: OK”, and the parameter that has been set becomes
                    effective.
              (5) [0] [ENT]
■ Display
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The display then prompts for the selection of a motor.
              (2) Choose “1'” (MA1).
              (3) Choose “1'” (DRIVE).
                    Motor drives.
              (4) [2] [ENT]
                    Motor stops.
              (5) [0] [ENT]
■ Display
Drives a motor.
               REFERENCES
           • The system drives a motor in accordance with the parameters, if they are set as described
             under “[6-1-1] Parameter setup”, or in accordance with the factory default parameters, if
             they are not set. The parameters that have been set remain effective until the system is
             powered OFF or reset.
           • If you want to forcefully stop the motor during its driving, select “[6-1-3] STOP”.
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                     The display then prompts for the selection of a motor.
              (2) Choose “1'” (MA1).
                     When the motor drives and stops in accordance with the parameters, the display reads
                     “RESULT: OK”.
                     If you want to forcefully stop the motor as in cases where the motor is driving for a long
                     time with any of the parameters changed, enter “[3][ENT]”.
              (3) [3] [ENT]
                     The motor then comes to a stop.
■ Display
Stops a motor.
■ Display
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [1] [ENT] → [4] [ENT]
                    A prompt then appears on the display, asking whether you want to download the
                    factory default settings for the parameters.
              (2) Choose “1'” (YES).
                    The system then downloads the default parameter settings and the display reads
                    “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
[6-2] ACTUATOR
           Drives and stops solenoids, pump, clutch, erasure lamps, and subscanning unit motors on
           an individual basis.
           The names and operating states of the actuators are shown below:
FR6H3072.EPS
                                                                                            M
       Cassette hold solenoid SolA1                      OFF
                     CW
                                                                                  M
     CCW                                     CCW                                            M
                          CCW                                                           M
              CW
                          FRONT
Sol : OFF
SolZ1 SZ4
FR6H3058.EPS
Drives an actuator.
               REFERENCE
           The erasure lamp automatically turns OFF 20 seconds after driving.
■ Display
BLANK PAGE
[6-3] SENSOR
Subscanning unit
Unit Z                                           IP stopper HP sensor                  IP sensor
                                                 SZ4                                   SC3
■ Display
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [3] [ENT] → [2] [ENT]
                    The system then presents the status information about all sensors and displays the
                    message “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
■ Display
                    MU>SNS>3                                                                  (1)
                    Open:o/Close:x
                    SSSSSSSSSSSSSSLLL
                    AAAAABCCCCZZZZDDD
                    12345112342345SSS
                                  NNN
                                  123
BLANK PAGE
[6-4] UNIT
The associated unit locations and operating I/Os are shown below:
        Suction cup drive motor          Cassette set unit                              Suction cup HP sensor
        MA1                              Unit A                                         SA4
                                                                                                    Leak valve
                                                                                                    SVA1
                                                                                                    Suction pump
                                                   M                                                PA1
                                                                                                    Suction sensor
                                                                                                    SA5
                                                                                        M
                                                                                                    Conveyance motor
                                                                                                    MB1
                                                                                                    IP sensor
                                                                                                    SB1
                                                                                                     Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                                                     Unit C
                                        M
                                                               M
                                                                                M
                                                                                        M
                                                                                    M
 Subscanning unit
 Unit Z                      IP stopper solenoid         IP stopper HP sensor
                             SolZ1                       SZ4                                                            FR6H3064.EPS
■ Display
                                                Side-positioning conveyor
                                                Unit C
FRONT
                                               Side-positioning HP sensor
                                               SC1
                               M               Side-positioning motor
                                       M       MC1
                                   M
                                                                  FR6H3065.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [4] [ENT] → [2] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The system then returns the side-positioning conveyor grip mechanism to its HP and
                    the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
                                                             O NT
                                                          FR
                MC1
SC1
FR6H3074.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] ENT] → [4] [ENT] → [3] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The system then returns the side-positioning mechanism of the side-positioning con-
                    veyor to the HP and the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
       CAUTION
       With software version A02 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be used.
                                                     M
                                                                   M
            Subscanning unit
            Unit Z                                                         FR6H3066.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] [ENT] → [4] [ENT] → [4] [ENT] → [1] [ENT]
                    The system then returns the grip mechanism of the subscanning unit to the HP and
                    the display reads “RESULT: OK”.
■ Display
       CAUTION
       With software version A04 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be used.
       If it is used, an error results, with error code “13011” displayed.
            Subscanning motor                     M
            MZ1
                                                                  M
                                                                                  M
                                                                                           M
                                                                                      M
                                                                                                      Conveyance motor
                                                                                                      MC3
         Subscanning unit
         Unit Z                                                                           IP sensor
                                                                                          SC3                            FR6H3067.EPS
■ Procedure
              (1) [6] ENT] → [4] [ENT] → [5] [ENT]
                    The subscanning unit then performs a read operation and the display reads “RESULT:
                    OK”.
■ Display
       CAUTION
       With software version A02 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be used.
                                                                      M
                                                                               Conveyance motor
                                                                               MB1
                                                                               Side-positioning conveyor
                                                                               Unit C
                                                              M
                                                                      M
                                                                  M
                                                                               Conveyance motor
                                                                               MC3
                                                                                                  FR6H3068.EPS
           CAUTION
           With software version A04 or earlier, this feature is not implemented, so it should not be
           used.
           Causes the axis of the light-collecting mirror to be rotated, thereby cleaning the light-collect-
           ing face of the light-collecting guide.
           The function of this menu is the same as the scanner cleaning function in the User Utility.
■ Function
       ● HOME POSITION
           Cleans the light-collecting face of the light-collecting guide by rotating the light-collecting
           mirror, and performs home-positioning operation.
       ● LOCK (ref. service manual)
           Rotates the light-collecting mirror to move it to a locked position. Use this function when
           moving the RU on a bumpy floor by use of the casters.
           If this menu is executed, the RU will not work normally. To reset the locked condition, power
           OFF the RU and then back ON.
FR6H3345.EPS
           Displays configuration information and temporarily changes information required for network
           connection.
[7-1]      DISPLAY CONFIGURATION
           Displays the contents of configuration information in the flash memory on the CPU12A
           board.
■ Function
FR6H3340.EPS
           Sets information required for network connection with the CL and FTP. By restarting the RU,
           the setup contents temporarily become effective.
           CAUTION
           When you change the IP address, connection between the RU and CL will not be estab-
           lished unless the CL has the same IP address as that of the RU.
■ Function
● READER UNIT NAME: Temporarily changes the unit name of the RU.
■ Display: Example where the unit name of the RU is temporarily changed (for version
  A04 or earlier)
               REFFERENCE
           To update the values in the FLASH-ROM, restart the RU.
■ Display: Example where the unit name of the RU is temporarily changed (for version
  A05 or later)
FR6H3096.EPS
Initializes the backup memory located on the CPU board of the RU.
■ Function
           Initializes the following three types of information.
       ● Scanner information
           Set “HV ON/OFF data (soft setup information)” and “Scanner initial drive current value
           (LDIF)” to their soft default values.
       ● Mech information
           Set “FFM speed data” to its soft default value. Also initialize “HISTORY LOG” collected since
           power-ON.
       ● Soft information
           Set “RU HOST NAME (SET)”, “RU IP ADDRESS”, “HOST (CL) IP ADDRESS”, “FTP-
           SERVER IP ADDRESS”, “INFO-HOST IP ADDRESS”, and “NETMASK” to their soft default
           values.
■ Procedure
              (1) [8][ENT] → [1][ENT]
                    The display prompts you to confirm whether the backup memory is to be initialized or
                    not.
              (2) [1][ENT]
                    The backup memory is initialized.
■ Display
       CAUTION
       Before turning ON the HV switch (software switch), check to see whether the cover is installed.
       If the HV switch is turned ON with the cover removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
■ Meaning of Display
           Display         Status
           HV ON      →    The HV switch is OFF.
           HV OFF     →    The HV switch is ON.
BLANK PAGE
       Control Sheet
        Issue date     Revision number               Reason              Pages affected
         10.10.2000   00                 New release(FM2753)   All pages
         06.20.2001   02                 Corrections(FM3057)   1, 2, 4 ∼ 11, 13, 15 ∼ 17, 19, 23, 25,
                                                               27, 29, 31 ∼ 33, 35, 37, 39 ∼ 49, 51,
                                                               53, 54, 56 ∼ 67
         02.20.2002   05                 Corrections(FM3327)   1, 13, 17, 21, 25, 31, 38, 39, 41, 53,
                                                               56 ∼ 67
010-051-05
02.20.2002 FM3327
                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                          SP - 1
Service Parts List                                                                                                      SP - 2
                                                                             ■ REF.NO.
How to Use Service
                                                                               REF. NO. is a parts number indicated in the
Parts List                                                                     Service Parts Exploded Views. For parts
                                                                               having different functions, they are clearly
                                                                               distinguished in the REMARKS and SERIAL
■ RANK                                                                         NUMBER columns.
  ● Handling RANK characters (parts that are
                                                                             ■ PART NUMBER
    handled in a special manner during parts
    operation, such as replacement)                                            PART NUMBER is a code number that is
                                                                               unique to each parts.
       It is assigned only to applicable parts.
         Character        Under Warranty           Out of Warranty
                                                                               An alphabetic letter at the right-most position
             R         Must be returned.         Repairable
                                                                               of the code number has the following mean-
                       Must be returned.
                                                                               ing.
             Q                                   Not repairable
                       (We use for analysis.)
                                                                               ❍ For hardware
                       Must be returned.
                       (Consumable part.                                       The alphabet denotes the version number of a
             T                                   Not repairable
                       Not applicable for free                                 part. If parts have different version numbers,
                       of change.)
                                                                               they are upward-compatible.
           without
           R, Q, T
                       Must Not be returned.     Not repairable                ❍ For software
                                                              TR1Z0002.EPS
                                                                               The alphabet denotes a difference in the
  ● Export regulation-applicable character                                     specifications. Parts differing in the suffix are
       (Parts without the following character are                              not compatible with each other. Although the
       not controlled by Export regulation.)                                   version is indicated by a number, it is omitted.
        Character                     Significance
                                                                             ■ PART NAME
             +        Parts applicable to export regulations.
                                                                               PART NAME represents a general name of a
                                                           TR1Z0003.EPS
                                                                               part.
  ● Fault RANK characters (which provide
    reference for determining the recom-                                     ■ QTY.
    mended stock quantity)                                                     ❍ QTY. denotes the quantity of parts used in
       All parts are assigned either A through E.                                each unit.
                                                                               ❍ A parts with -S assigned to the end of the
       Character                    Significance
                     Consumable parts or parts that will be
                                                                                 quantity represents a small part that is
            A
                     replaced at short intervals.                                shipped in packs of 50. (Even if such a part
            B
                     Parts that may become faulty accidentally                   is ordered in quantity of 1 , a pack con-
                     and have a relatively high failure rate.                    taining 50 pieces of that part is supplied.)
                     Parts that have a sufficiently long MTBF,
            C        but are expected to have a relatively high
                     failure rate.
                                                                             ■ REMARKS
            D        Parts that have a sufficiently long MTBF,                 The REMARKS column indicates a unique
                     but are expected to become faulty.
                                                                               name of a part of its relevant information of
                     Parts that are necessary for fault analysis,
                     or parts that may be needed in case of                    note.
            E        unexpected accidents such as man-induced
                     damage.                                                 ■ SERIAL NUMBER
                                                           TR1Z0004.EPS
■ REFER TO
    The "REFER TO" column shows the reference
    sections concerning the registered parts whose
    removal/installation procedures are set forth
    in the "Check, Replacement, and Adjustment"
     volume (MC).
    As regards the parts whose information is set
    forth in the "Check, Replacement, and
    Adjustment" volume (MC), the associated
    information about screws, E-rings, and the like
    is not presented within parts illustrations.
    To confirm the information about screws,
    E-rings, and the like, refer to the "Check,
    Replacement, and Adjustment" volume (MC).
    ❍ N=1
    Rank A = 1 + Q x 0.3
    Rank C = 1 + Q x 0.05
    Rank D = 1 + Q x 0.02
    ❍ 2≤N≤10
    Rank A = 2 + N x Q x 0.3
    Rank C = 2 + N x Q x 0.05
    Rank D = 1 + N x Q x 0.02
    ❍ 11≤N≤300
    Rank A = 3 + N x Q x 0.3
    Rank C = 3 + N x Q x 0.05
    Rank D = 3 + N x Q x 0.02
010-051-00
10.10.2000 FM2753
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual         SP - 3
サービスパーツリスト編/ Service Parts List                                                         SP - 4
FR6H5005.EPS
010-051-02
06.20.2001 FM3057
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                          SP - 4
サービスパーツリスト編/ Service Parts List                                           SP - 5
                    INDEX 13                      INDEX 14
● ネジ・座金類の表示記号一覧表                         ● 消耗品一覧表
  TABLE OF SCREWS /                        LIST OF QUICK WEARING
  WASHERS INDICATION                       PARTS
  SYMBOLS
FR6H5006.EPS
010-051-02
06.20.2001 FM3057
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual                             SP - 5
                                       カバー 1
    01A                                COVER 1
                                                                             2
                                                                                                                           FR6H5051.EPS
                   21
                                                                                                       X
                                                                                               2-BR4x8
                                                                                  2-BR4x8
                                                                                                                   6
                    19       20                                                                5
                                                               3
                                                     3-BR4x8
                                                                                  5
                                                                                           4
                                                                                 3-BR4x8
18
22
                                                                                                                             10
                                                                                                                               2-DT3x6
         17
                                                                                                                               6-DT3x6
                                                                                                   8                   X
                                                                                 12
                                                                                                           7
                                                                                                               9
                    DT3x8
16
                                  16   DT3x8
                                               W12
W12
                                                       13              W12
                                                                                      13
14
                                                                                                                             11
              15                                                                                                           FR6H5902.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                 SP - 6
06.20.2001 FM3057
                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                                      カバー 1
                                                                     COVER 1                01A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME              QTY.      REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   350Y1519          ネジカバー         Screw Cover             4
  E       2   350Y1496          上カバー          Top Cover               1                                 3.1
  E       3   356N8225B         ブラケット         Bracket                 1
  E       4   356N8226B         ブラケット         Bracket                 1
  E       5   356N8171A         ブラケット         Bracket                 2
  E       6   350N2244B         背面上カバー        Upper Rear Cover        1                                 3.1
  E       7   350N2245B/C       背面下カバー        Lower Rear Cover        1
  D       8   345N1493          シールド材         Shielding Tape          1
  D       9   345N1494A         シールド材         Shielding Tape          1
  E      10   352N0493A         パネル           Panel                   1
                                右側面カバーアセ Right-Hand Side Cover
  E      11   350Y1483                                                1                                 3.1
                                ンブリ      Assembly
  E      12   405N1770A         銘板            Label                   1
  E      13   356N8602          ブラケット         Bracket                 2
  E      14   898Y0713          キット           Kit                     1     Option
  E      15   350Y1530          前面カバー         Front Cover             1                                 3.1
  D      16   316S3098          ラッチ           Latch                   2
                                メカニカルフィル
  D      17   376N0198A                  Mechanical Filter            1
                                タ
  D      18   345N1280A         ルーバ           Louver                  1
  E      19   350N2059A         カバー           Cover                   4                                 3.1
   E     20   350N2243B         左側面カバー        Left-Hand Side Cover    1                                 3.1
                                左側面カバーアセ Left-Hand Side Cover
  E      21   350Y1482                                                1                                 3.1
                                ンブリ      Assembly
  E      22   308S0062          特殊ネジ          Screw                   1
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                       SP - 7
06.20.2001 FM3057
                               カバー 2
     01B                       COVER 2
                                                                                                                          FR6H5052.EPS
                                                                      1
                                                                  2
                                                                  4                            5
                                                                                                   7
                                                                                          6
28
                     13
                                                                                          10
                                                                                     29
                                                                                                                     10
                                                       27
12 9
                                         9                                                                  8
                    13
               12
                                                            14                                          11
                          13
                                                                                                                     9
                                        15
                9                                 16
                                                        9
13
                                BR4x8
           19
     20
                                                                                                                     13
                                         17            14
                                                                                                                     12
                         21                                                                                         13
                                                        14                                         12                      9
                                                                          15
                                                                                                                13
                                                  18         14
                                             22                                                                      13
                                                                           17
                                                                                                        9
26
                                                       23
          20
                                             24
25 FR6H5901.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                               SP - 8
06.20.2001 FM3057
                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                                           カバー 2
                                                                          COVER 2                      01B
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                   QTY.      REMARKS         SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  C       1    352Y0058B        パネルアセンブリ Panel Assembly                    1                                       5.1
  E      2.1   405Y0157C        銘板            Label                        1                                       5.1
  E      2.2 405Y0166           銘板            Label                        1     Japan Only(346V)                  5.1
  E      3.1   405N2644         銘板            Label                        1     INC                               5.1
  E      3.2   405N2645         銘板            Label                        1     MET                               5.1
  E       4    357N1271C        台             Base                         1                                       5.1
  D       5    113Y1469B        ボードアセンブリ Board Assembly                    1     LED12A                            5.1
  D       6    340N0170D        キートップ         Key Top                      1                                       5.1
  D       7    350N2387C        カバー           Cover                        1                                       5.1
  D       8    382N1221A        テープ           Tape                         2     W10 x L476
  D       9    382N1222A        テープ           Tape                         7     W10 x L171
  D      10    382N1225A        テープ           Tape                         2     W10 x L424
  D      11    382N1315A        テープ           Tape                         1     W10 x L429
  D      12    382N1219A        テープ           Tape                         4     W10 x L396
  D      13    382N1220A        テープ           Tape                         8     W10 x L333
  D      14    382N1217A        テープ           Tape                         4     W10 x L475
  D      15    382N1218A        テープ           Tape                         2     W10 x L580
  D      16    382N1224A        テープ           Tape                         1     W10 x L214
  D      17    382N1223A        テープ           Tape                         2     W10 x L164
  D      18    345N1481         シールド材         Shielding Tape               1
                                メカニカルフィル
  D      19    376N0215B                 Mechanical Filter                 1     T5 x W94 x L134
                                タ
                                メカニカルフィル
  D      20    376N0198A                 Mechanical Filter                 2
                                タ
010-051-03
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                  SP - 9
10.10.2001 FM3218
                                       フレーム
        02                             FRAME
FR6H5055.EPS
                                                                                         2-DT3x6    3-DT3x6
                                                                                                          BR3x6
                                                                         7
                                          2                                                                       8
                                                                                       DT3x6
                                              3
                    25                                                                         10             8
                          1
                                  25 21                                           12                                   10
        4                                                                                                                        DT3x6
22
                                                                                                              9
                                                               23
                                                          24
                                                                                                                  12
                                                                                       23
                                                     21
                     25
25
20
                                                             22
                                                           25                                                                13
                                                          21                                   A                             14
                                                                                                                            25
                                  18                                                                              25
                 17
            18
20 20
DETAIL A Na12
                          19
                                                                    16
15
FR6H5903.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                               SP - 10
06.20.2001 FM3057
                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                                  フレーム
                                                                   FRAME                  02
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   364S0006          ガード           Guard               1                                4.3
  D       2   119S0006          ファン           Fan                 1     FAN4                       4.3
  E       3   356N6923B         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                4.3
                                                                                                   4.1
  C       4   113Y1471D         INV12B        INV12B              1     INV12B
                                                                                                   4.4
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 SP - 11
06.20.2001 FM3057
                              カセッテセット部 1
      03A                     CASSETTE SET UNIT 1
                                                       DT3x6
  DETAIL A                                                      1
                                           2
                                       3
                                       4                             2                                                     FR6H5351.EPS
         10                        5                                 3
  C                                                                  4
 10
                               7
          8
                                           7       6
                                                                     6                  18            19                       20
                                                                         10
               9
                                                                          B
                                                           10
                                                                                   15
                                                          11
14
                                                                    17
                                               BR3x6
                                                                              16
                               C
          13
12
                                                                                                           17             11
                                                                                                                BR3x6
                                                                                                                    13
                                                                                                 12
FR6H5020.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                               SP - 12
10.10.2000 FM2753
                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                           カセッテセット部 1
                                        CASSETTE SET UNIT 1                        03A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME        QTY.   REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   356N6830B         ブラケット         Bracket           1                              5.9
  D       2   372N0098          管継手           Joint             2                              5.9
  A       3   375S0040          パッキン          Packing           2                              5.9
  E       4   315G311017        止め具           Clamp             2                              5.9
  E       5   356N8167C         ブラケット         Bracket           1                              5.9
  A       6   392N0009A         吸着盤           Suction Cup       2                              5.9
  D       7   388Y0014          板バネ           Leaf Spring       2
  E       8   341N0938H         アーム           Arm               1                              5.10
  E       9   356Y0187          ブラケット         Bracket           1                              5.9
  D      10   322SF178          軸受            Bearing           4                              5.10
  D      11   327N1103610D      平歯車           Spur Gear         2
  D      12   322N0037D         すべり軸受         Plain Bearing     2                              5.10
  E      13   341N0937B         アーム           Arm               2                              5.10
  D      14   388N3082C         ねじりコイルバネ Torsion Coil Spring    1
                                                                                               5.10
  E      15   346N1078D         補助板           Plate Support     1                              5.14
                                                                                               5.17
                                                                                               5.10
  E      16   319N3604A         軸             Shaft             1                              5.14
                                                                                               5.17
                                                                                               5.10
  E      17   322SF149          軸受            Bearing           2                              5.14
                                                                                               5.17
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                             SP - 13
02.20.2002 FM3327
                            カセッテセット部 2
    03B                     CASSETTESET UNIT 2
FR6H5352.EPS
                                                     8                      14
                        4                                9
                                                             10
     1
           2
                    3
                        5
                            6
                                7
                                    6   11
                                             12 13
                                                                  15
                                                                       16
                                                                                 13
                                                                                      12
                                                                                           17
18
FR6H5021.EPS
010-051-00                                                                       SP - 14
10.10.2000 FM2753
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                           カセッテセット部 2
                                        CASSETTE SET UNIT 2                                  03B
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                         5.11
  E       1   356N6832F         ブラケット         Bracket                   1
                                                                                                         5.12
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                       SP - 15
06.20.2001 FM3057
                              カセッテセット部 3
    03C                       CASSETTE SET UNIT 3
FR6H5355.EPS
                                                                      4
                                                         5
A 6
                    11
                         11
                                                                      6
                                                     6
                                                             12                    DT3x6
              10                                                  7
                                                                                    8
     DETAIL A                                                             9
                                                                              FR6H5022.EPS
010-051-02                                                                         SP - 16
06.20.2001 FM3057
                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                           カセッテセット部 3
                                        CASSETTE SET UNIT 3                           03C
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME       QTY.     REMARKS     SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D       1   363N2243D         ガイド板          Guide Plate      1                                  5.13
  D       2   363N2062G         ガイド板          Guide Plate      1                                  5.13
  D       3   332N0522D         ストッパ          Stopper          1                                  5.14
  D       4   332N0523D         ストッパ          Stopper          1                                  5.14
  E       5   366N0055E         アクチュエータ       Actuator         1                                  5.15
  D       6   146S0029          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor     3     SA2,SA3,SA4                  5.16
  D       7   388N2451          引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      1
  E       8   356N6829C         ブラケット         Bracket          1
  E       9   341N0940B         アーム           Arm              1
                                                                                                  5.17
  D      10   363N2065D         ガイド板          Guide Plate      4
                                                                                                  5.18
                                                                                                  5.17
  D      11   334N3513B         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    8
                                                                                                  5.18
  D      12   363N2388          ガイド           Guide            1                   #450~
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                SP - 17
02.20.2002 FM3327
                            カセッテセット部 4
    03D                     CASSETTE SET UNIT 4
        1    2-DT3x6
                                                       DETAIL A
2-DT3x6 FR6H5353.EPS
                                                                                                                9
                                                                                               8   2-BR3x10
                                                                  2
                                                                       7
                                                              3                        DT3x6
                                                          1
                                                   4                                                          10
                                                                                        11
                                                                      B3x4
                            5
                                                                                        12
                                                                                                   DT3x6
                                                                             15
                                                                                  14
                                                                                        13
                                                                                   16
                       A
                                                                                                              FR6H5023.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                    SP - 18
10.10.2000 FM2753
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                           カセッテセット部 4
                                        CASSETTE SET UNIT 4                               03D
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME             QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D
  E       1   387N0130D
              356N6830B         帯電防止材
                                ブラケ ト         Antistatic
                                              B k t Brush            2
                                                                     1                                5 9
                                                                                                      5.2
  D       2   388N3081B         ねじりコイルバネ Torsion Coil Spring         1                                5.2
  D       3   398N0059D         シャッタ          Shutter                1                                5.2
  D       4   146S0029          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor           1     SA1                        5.1
  E       5   345N1404D         遮板            Light Protect Plate    1                                5.1
  D       6   134Y0056B         電磁バルブ         Solenoid Valve         1     SVA1
  E       7   356N8168A         ブラケット         Bracket                1
  D       8   370N0256B         ホース           Hose                   1                                5.8
  A       9   133Y1031A         電動ポンプ         Pump                   1     PA1
  D      10   128S0392          スイッチ          Switch                 1     SA5                        5.8
  D      11   372S0050          管継手           Joint                  1
  E      12   356N8315A         ブラケット         Bracket                1
  D      13   372S0049          管継手           Joint                  1
  D      14   372S0053          管継手           Joint                  1
  E      15   316S0146          止め具           Clamp                  1
  D      16   370N0255B         ホース           Hose                   1
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                    SP - 19
06.20.2001 FM3057
                            カセッテセット部 5
    03E                     CASSETTE SET UNIT 5
                                                                                       3
                                                                                                                   FR6H5354.EPS
                                                                                   2
                                                                                           4
                                                                                                   5
                                                                               8
20 9
10
                                                   2
                                              12
                                          2
                                     14                      11
13
                                                                     15   16
                                 2
                                                       17
                                                                 2
18
19 FR6H5026.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                        SP - 20
10.10.2000 FM2753
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                           カセッテセット部 5
                                        CASSETTE SET UNIT 5                                   03E
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                 QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                           5.7
  D       1   363N2076C         ガイド           Guide                      1
                                                                                                          5.18
                                                                                                           5.4
  D       2   322SY066          すべり軸受         Plain Bearing              6
                                                                                                          5.18
                                                                                                           5.7
  D       3   332N0521B         ストッパ          Stopper                    1
                                                                                                          5.18
  E       4   356N6823D         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.18
  E       5   319N3601B         軸             Shaft                      1                                5.18
  E       6   356N6828B         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.18
  D       7   388N1157A         圧縮コイルバネ       Compression Coil Spring    1                                5.18
  E       8   356N6824C         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.18
  E       9   350N2496A         カバー           Cover                      1                                5.4
  E      10   319Y1161A         軸             Shaft                      1                                5.6
  E      11   356N6829C         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.6
  E      12   341N0936E         アーム           Arm                        1                                5.6
  D      13   388N2449          引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring                1                                5.6
  D      14   107Y0169A         ソレノイド         Solenoid                   1     SolA1                      5.5
  E      15   356N6825D         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.4
  D      16   363N1788A         ガイド           Guide                      1                                5.4
  E      17   319N3602B         軸             Shaft                      1                                5.4
  D      18   388N1158A         圧縮コイルバネ       Compression Coil Spring    1                                5.4
  E      19   356N6826B         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                5.4
  E      20   318F0174          コードクランプ       Cord Clamp                 1     EDS17L
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                        SP - 21
02.20.2002 FM3327
                               消去搬送部 1
    04A                        ERASURE CONVEYOR 1
                           1
FR6H5450.EPS
18
                                                                             16
                                                                                                               2-BR3x10
16 3
DETAIL A 8
                               19
                                                                9
                          12
                                                                         6
                                         11
        15          18
18 17
17
19 10
                                                  14       13
                                                                                                            FR6H5301.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                  SP - 22
10.10.2000 FM2753
                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                               消去搬送部 1
                                      ERASURE CONVEYOR 1                                    04A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME           QTY.      REMARKS      SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   358N0163D         ボックス          Box                  1                                    6.2
  E       2   358N0165F         ボックス          Box                  1                                    6.7
  D       3   345N1502          ルーバ           Louver               1
                                                                                                        6.2
  A       4   603N0182E         フィルタ          Filter               1                                    6.3
                                                                                                        6.4
                                                                                                        6.2
  D       5   120Y0078D         ソケット          Socket               1
                                                                                                        6.5
                                                                                                        6.2
  A       6   123N0007B         蛍光ランプ         Fluorescence Lamp    3
                                                                                                        6.4
                                                                                                        6.2
  D       7   120Y0079D         ソケット          Socket               1
                                                                                                        6.5
                                                                                                        6.2
  E       8   401N0778B         押え板           Counter Plate        2                                    6.3
                                                                                                        6.4
                                                                                                        6.2
  D       9   115Y0035B         サーミスタ         Thermo Switch        1     THB1
                                                                                                        6.6
                                                                                                        6.2
  E      15   356N6838C         ブラケット         Bracket              1                                    6.5
                                                                                                        6.6
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                      SP - 23
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                               消去搬送部 2
    04B                                        ERASURE CONVEYOR 2
                      3        10
      2                                                                                              2-DT3x6
11 FR6H5451.EPS
          4          5
                                                                          7
                 1
                                                                                                                                          2-BR3x6
                                                                                                                            31
       A
                                                                                                                                                                    12
                                          6                                                                                                         31         13
                                                                 9
                                                                      5
                                                                              A
                                                         8                                                                                14
                                                                                                                                14                       14
                                                                                                                                                                14
                                                                                                                           15
15
15 1 DT3x6
15
                                                                 16       16
                                                         1
                                                                                        DT3x6
                                                        DT3x6
                                                                                                                                     23
                                                                                       1
                                                        17   1
                                                                      DT3x6
                                                                  2-DT3x6
                          17
                1                         20
                                                                                                24
              DT3x6       2-DT3x6
                                     19
                                                             20                                                            24
                               4-DT3x6                                                               DT3x6                                      24
                                                                          21               DT3x6
                                                                                       DT3x6                                    4
                                                  22
                                                        BR3x6
                                                                                                                                     DT3x6
                          18                      1                                                              25
                                                                                                                                          DT3x6
                                                                                                         2-BR3x10
                                                                                                                      26
                                                                                                                            27
                                                                          29
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                     DT3x6
                                                                                           DT3x6
28
30
FR6H5302.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                                                               SP - 24
10.10.2000 FM2753
                                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                               消去搬送部 2
                                      ERASURE CONVEYOR 2                               04B
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                    6.8
  D       1   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    9
                                                                                                   6.14
                                                                                                   6.10
                                                                                                   6.13
  D      23   363N2068C         ガイド板          Guide plate         1
                                                                                                   6.14
                                                                                                   6.17
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 SP - 25
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                      消去搬送部 3
    04C                               ERASURE CONVEYOR 3
                                        DETAIL A
                                                     A
                                                                                     3
                                                                                          4
                                                          1
                                                                  2                                                                                                             FR6H5452.EPS
                                                                            3                                   5
                                       DETAIL B                                 4
                                                 B
                                                                                      3
                                                                                              4
                                                 7                                                                                                4
                                                                                                           6
                                                          1                                                                                                   3
                                                                                                                                                                      7
                                                                                                                                                                                8
                                                              2
                                                                       3                                                9
                                                                            4
                                       DETAIL C                                                                                  4
                                                                                                                                              3
                                                     C                                                                                                7
                                                                                10
                                                                                          3
                                                                                                  4                                                        4
                                                      1                                                    6                                                          3
                                                                                                                                                                            7
                                                                  3
                                                                       4                                            5
                                                                                                                                     4
                                      DETAIL D                                                                                            3
                                             D                                                                                                        7
                                                                                                                                                                  8
                                                                                     12
                                                                                          13           6                                                  4
                                                 1                                                                                                                3
                                                                                                                                                                          7
                                                         11
          E     B               17                                12
      A                                                                    13
                                                                                                               14           4
                                                                                                                                 3
                         C                                                                                                                7
                                     E                                                                                                                    2
                                                                                                      15
  E                                  DT3x6                                                                                                            13
                                                                                                                                                                  12
                                 21                                                                                                                                        7
                         D
                                                     20
      E                                                                                                                         13
                                                                                                                                         12
                                                                                                                                                  7
                                                                                                                                                              16
                     E
                                                                                                                                          B
          DETAIL E                                                                                                                        C
           E4
                18
                                                                                                                                          D
                         19
                                18                                              A
                                                                                                                                                                          FR6H5303.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                                                                     SP - 26
10.10.2000 FM2753
                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                               消去搬送部 3
                                      ERASURE CONVEYOR 3                            04C
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME       QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                6.11
                                タイミングベルト                                                        6.12
  D       1   324N3038C                  Timing Belt Pulley    4
                                車                                                               6.13
                                                                                                6.14
                                                                                                6.11
  D       2   388N2475C         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      3     L≒90mm                     6.12
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.11
  D       3   360N0360A         ハウジング         Housing         12                                6.12
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.11
  D       4   322SF145          軸受            Bearing         12                                6.12
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.11
  D       5   334N3507D         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    2
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.11
  D       6   334N3508C         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    3                                6.12
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.11
                                                                                                6.12
  D       7   327N1121608A      平歯車           Spur Gear        9
                                                                                                6.13
                                                                                                6.14
                                                                                                6.11
  D       8   388N2484C         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      2     L≒101mm
                                                                                                6.12
  D       9   334N3512D         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    1                                6.12
  D      10   388N2476C         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      1     L≒102mm                    6.13
  D      11   388N2498A         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      1     L≒91mm                     6.14
  D      12   360N0364A         ハウジング         Housing          4                                6.14
  D      13   322SF157          軸受            Bearing          4                                6.14
  D      14   334N3509D         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    1                                6.14
  D      15   334N3510D         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller    1                                6.14
  D      16   388N2497A         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring      1     L≒78mm                     6.14
  D      17   323S3251          タイミングベルト Timing Belt           1                                6.9
  D      18   322SF146          軸受            Bearing         10                                6.9
                                タイミングベルト
  D      19   324N1026A                  Timing Belt Pulley    5                                6.9
                                車
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                              SP - 27
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                   幅寄搬送部 1
    05A                            SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
1 2
                          DT3x6                                                                                                     FR6H5401.EPS
                           (BLK)
                                     6
                                         7    8
                                                       4
                      9
                          4
                          DT3x6
                           (BLK)
                                     3       E6
                              5                   10
2-DT3x6
                     11
                                                                          14
                                                  T                                 13        12
                                                ON
                                              FR
                                                            2-DT3x6
                                                                      15
                                                                      A
                                                                                     10
                NT                                                             16                 3                   5
            FRO                                                                          E6
                                                                                                      4
                                                                                                          8
                                         13
                                                                                                                      DT3x6
                                                                                                                  6   (BLK)
                                                                                17
                                                       18                                                                 9   19
                                                                                                      7                              21
                                                                                                      DT3x6
                                                                                                      (BLK)
                                                                                                              4                A
                                                                                              2
                                                                                                                                             20
FR6H5015.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                         SP - 28
10.10.2000 FM2753
                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                      幅寄搬送部 1
                    SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1                                     05A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME       QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D       1   323S3234          タイミングベルト Timing Belt           1                                7.2
                                                                                                7.3
  D       2   329N0149A         カム            Cam              2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  D       3   329N0146A         カム            Cam              2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  D       4   322SF146          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing     4
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  D       5   329N0148B         カム            Cam              2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  E       6   342N0105D         レバー           Lever            2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  E       7   347N1625A         スペーサ          Spacer           2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  E       8   342N0106B         レバー           Lever            2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  D       9   329N0145A         カム            Cam              2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.3
  D      10   322SF149          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing     2
                                                                                                7.4
                                                                                                7.7
  D      13   118SX167          モータ           Motor            2     MC2,MC3
                                                                                                7.8
                                タイミングベルト
  D      14   324N3041E                  Timing Belt Pulley    1                                7.8
                                車
  E      15   356N8169B         ブラケット         Bracket          1
  D      16   327S1103002A      平歯車           Spur Gear        1                                7.4
  D      17   327N0142A         平歯車           Spur Gear        1                                7.4
  D      18   327N0141A         平歯車           Spur Gear        1                                7.7
  D      19   327N0143C         平歯車           Spur Gear        1                                7.4
  E      20   356N8217C         ブラケット         Bracket          1                                7.4
  E      21   316S1122          クランプ          Clamp            1                                7.4
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                              SP - 29
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                 幅寄搬送部 2
    05B                          SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
                                 1
                                                  2
                                                      3
                                                            4
                                                                    5
                                                                         6
                                                                                 16
                    10                                                                     7
                                                                                                                                                                            FR6H5502.EPS
                         1           4
                                             5
                                                      6
                                                  4        15
                                                      5                      4
                                                            6
                                                                        15
                                                                                 4                                                        8
                         2
                             3
                                 4
                                         5
                                                 6
                                                      16
                                                                    7                                                9
                                                                                                                                              9
                                                                                           T
                                                                                        ON
                                                                                      FR
ニップローラ配置
FRONT
9 8
                                                                                                                                                      9
                                                                                                                                                      8
                                                                                                                     7
                                                                                                                                  16
                                                                                                                                              6
                                                                                                                                                  5
                                                                                                                                                      4
                                                                                                    4
                                                                                                                                                                  1
                         13
   14                                        11                                                         15       6
                                                                                                                         5
                                                                                                             7                    4
                                                                        11                                               16
                                                                                                                              6
        11                                                                                                                            5
                                 12                                                                                                       4
                         DT3x6
                                                                T
                                                           ON                                  4
                                                      FR                                           15
                                                                                                        6
                                                                                                             5
                                                                                                                     4                                                FR6H5016.EPS
                                                                                                                              1
010-051-00                                                                                                                                                               SP - 30
10.10.2000 FM2753
                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                      幅寄搬送部 2
                    SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2                                           05B
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS      SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       1   388N2472B         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring         7     L≒160mm
                                                                                                      7.6
                                タイミングベルト                                                              7.5
  D       2   324N3038C                  Timing Belt Pulley       2
                                車                                                                     7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  E       3   347N1669A         スペーサ          Spacer              2
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       4   322SF147          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing       12     F-W678AZZ1
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  E       5   347N1624A         スペーサ          Spacer              8
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       6   322SY233          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing        8     628ZZST
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       7   322SF153          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing        4     F-W688AT2ZZ1
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       8   334N3511C         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller       2
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  D       9   334N3524B         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller       2
                                                                                                      7.6
  D      10   388N2473B         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring         1     L≒116mm                       7.6
  D      11   363N2114C         ガイド           Guide               3                                   7.6
  D      12   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    1                                   7.6
  E      13   356N8476B         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                   7.6
  D      14   363N2110B         ガイド           Guide               1                                   7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  E      15   318N1065C         ブッシュ          Bushing             4
                                                                                                      7.6
                                                                                                      7.5
  E      16   318N1066A         ブッシュ          Bushing             4
                                                                                                      7.6
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                    SP - 31
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                幅寄搬送部 3
      05C                                       SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
DETAIL D
                                      0
                                                                                                                                                                       FR6H5505.EPS
識別印表示:0
DETAIL E
                                                                                          T
                                                                                      ON
                                                                                    FR
                   識別印表示:1
 DETAIL A                                            1
                                                              2
                            2                                          1
                                                                               E4                                                                                      B
                        1                            1
                                                             E4
                            7
                                                3
8 4
               9                                                           5                                      A
                                            5            6
                                      10            11
                       12
                                                                  10
                                                                                              14
           D
                                      17
                            18              13
                                      E4
                            C                                                                                                          DETAIL B
                                                         E        19
                                                                                                                       15
                                                                                                                                              E3
                                                                  20                                                         16
      21                                                                                      15
                                                                                                                                  15
                                                                                                   16                                                   24
                                                                               22                       15        E6
                                           34                          E4
                                                                                                                                  E6
                                                                                         23
                                                                                                                                                                  25
                                                                                               DETAIL C                 34
33 29
                                 31
                                                                                                                             28
                       32                                                                                                                27
                                                                                         30                                                        26
FR6H5013.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                                                          SP - 32
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                      幅寄搬送部 3
                    SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3                                                   05C
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                 QTY.     REMARKS       SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D       1   322SY093          すべり軸受         Plain Bearing              4     80B0605                        7.9
  D       2   334N0041A         ローラ           Roller                     2                                    7.9
  E       3   319N3624B         軸             Shaft                      2                                    7.9
  D       4   363N2115          ガイド           Guide                      1                                    7.9
  D       5   388N2447B         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring                2     L≒32mm                         7.9
                                                                                                               7.9
  E       6   356N8212B         ブラケット         Bracket                    1
                                                                                                              7.10
  D       7   328N0041C         爪             Claw                       1                                    7.9
  D       8   328N0042C         爪             Claw                       1                                    7.9
  D       9   363N2073B         ガイド           Guide                      1                                    7.9
  E      10   322N0052          軸受            Bearing                    2                                    7.9
  D      11   315S0013          止め輪           Nut                        2                                    7.9
  D      12   322N0050          軸受            Bearing                    1                                    7.9
  D      13   322N0051          軸受            Bearing                    1                                    7.9
  E      14   319N3623B         軸             Shaft                      2                                    7.9
                                                                                                               7.9
  D      15   322SY063          軸受            Bearing                    4     80F-0808
                                                                                                              7.10
                                                                                                               7.9
  D      16   388N1156B         圧縮コイルバネ       Compression Coil Spring    2     L≒57mm
                                                                                                              7.10
                                                                                                               7.9
  E      17   356N6848D         ブラケット         Bracket                    1
                                                                                                              7.10
                                                                               F
  D      18   322SF148          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing               1     FLWA676AT2ZZ1                  7.9
  E      19   341N0943C         アーム           Arm                        1                                    7.9
  D      20   327N0140A         平歯車           Spur Gear                  1                                    7.9
  D      21   322SY232          軸受            Bearing                    2                                    7.9
  D      22   327N0139B         平歯車           Spur Gear                  1                                    7.9
  D      23   327N0138A         平歯車           Spur Gear                  1                                    7.9
  D      24   328N0043C         爪             Claw                       2                                    7.11
  D      25   388N2448A         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring                2     L≒36mm                         7.11
  E      26   356N6850C         ブラケット         Bracket                    2                                    7.11
  E      27   319N3627B         軸             Shaft                      2                                    7.11
  D      28   146S0029          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor               1     SC1                            7.9
  E      29   356N6849C         ブラケット         Bracket                    1                                    7.9
  D      30   118SX164          モータ           Motor                      1     MC1                            7.9
  E      31   355N0550D         フレーム          Frame                      1                                    7.9
  E      32   316S1037          ブッシュ          Bushing                    3                                    7.9
  E      33   318F0174          コードクランプ       Cord Clamp                 1     EDS17L                         7.9
  E      34   318S1164          ブッシュ          Bushing                    3                                    7.9
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                            SP - 33
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                 幅寄搬送部 4
    05D                          SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
                                                   E4       1
                                                                 2                                                                       FR6H5503.EPS
                                       BR3x6
                                                   3
                                                        4
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                            E4
                                                                             6
                                                        5                        BR3x6
                                                                         6
                                                                 7
                                                                     DT3x6
                           16
                                          BR4x8
                                                                                                                          8
                  7
                      DT3x6
                       (BLK)
                                                                        BR4x8
     DT3x6                                                                                                                    2-BR3x10
                                          BR4x8
     (BLK)
                      15
                                                                                                   9                  DT3x6
                      13                                                                                         10
                                                            13
                  T                                                      BR4x8
               ON
             FR                     3-DT3x6
14
                                                                       12
                                                                                                                                    2-DT3x6
                                                                                                 2-BR3x10
                                                                                             8
                                                                                                                         11       17
                                                                                                                  17
                                                                                                                               FR6H5017.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                           SP - 34
10.10.2000 FM2753
                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                      幅寄搬送部 4
                    SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4                                        05D
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D       1   322SY249          軸受            Bearing             2     80B-0505                   7.12
  D       2   363N2113D         ガイド           Guide               1                                7.12
  E       3   341N0955B         アーム           Arm                 1                                7.12
  D       4   388N2471A         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring         1     L≒51mm                     7.12
  E       5   319N3629          軸             Shaft               1                                7.12
  D       6   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    2                                7.12
  D       7   363N2109C         ガイド           Guide               4                                7.13
  D       8   113Y1466          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor        2     SC3,SC4                    7.1
  E       9   356N8213C         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                7.4
  D      10   146S0029          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor        1     SC2                        7.4
  E      11   356N8216C         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                7.1
  E      12   313N1085B         ステー           Stay                2                                7.1
  D      13   363N2075B         ガイド           Guide               4                                7.1
  D      14   387N0136B         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    1                                7.1
  D      15   363N2111B         ガイド           Guide               1                                7.1
  E      16   313N1086B         ステー           Stay                2                                7.1
  E      17   318S1164          ブッシュ          Bushing             2
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 SP - 35
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                   幅寄搬送部 5
    05E                            SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
                               5
                                   9
                                        5
             10           E4
                                                                           1     B3x8
                                                 8
E6 FR6H5503.EPS
                                                                                                   12
                                   7
                                                                                                    2-DT3x6
                                             7
                                                                                                                   2
                                        E4
                                        5                                                                                          12
                                             6                                           13
                                                         5
                                                      4-DT3x6
                                                                                        DT3x6                 13
                                                                                                             3
                                                                  T
                                                               ON
                                                             FR
                                                                                                                       4
                                                                                         B3x8
                                                                                          1
13
                                                                                                               12
                    W5
              E4
13
11
                                                                           E4
                                                                                                        13
                                                     T
                                                 ON                   W5
                                             FR
                                                                                                   13
                                                                                13
                                                                                              13                           FR6H5018.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                           SP - 36
10.10.2000 FM2753
                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                      幅寄搬送部 5
                    SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5                                         05E
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   367S0045          ゴム脚           Rubber Ring         2                                7.1
  E       2   356N8214B         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                7.1
  D       3   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    1                                7.1
  E       4   356N8170D         ブラケット         Bracket             1                                7.1
  D       5   322SF146          ころがり軸受        Ball Bearing        4                                7.2
  D       6   324N1032A         平ベルト車         Flat Belt Wheel     1                                7.2
  D       7   322SY063          軸受            Bearing             2     80F-0808                   7.2
  E       8   341N0944C         アーム           Arm                 1                                7.2
  D       9   324N1026          平ベルト車         Flat Belt Wheel     1                                7.2
  D      10   388N2474A         引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring         1     L≒56mm                     7.2
  D      11   334Y0085          ローラ           Roller              1                                7.6
  E      12   318F0174          コードクランプ       Cord Clamp          3     EDS17L
  E      13   318S1164          ブッシュ          Bushing            14
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 SP - 37
06.20.2001 FM3057
                            光学部
        06                  SCANNING OPTICS UNIT
FR6H5650.EPS
                      VER : G∼
                                                                        1
                      ∼VER : F
                                                                                       TPネジ
                                                                        1
FR6H5501.EPS
                    VER : G以降の光学ユニットには、アース線が付いていない。
                    No ground wire is provided for scanning optics units of VER: G or later.
010-051-05                                                                                                SP - 38
02.20.2002 FM3327
                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                  光学部
                                    SCANNING OPTICS UNIT                                       06
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME              QTY.      REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  DR      1   839Y0035F/G/H/J/K   光学部         Scanning Optics Unit    1                                 8.1
   E      2   308S0062            特殊ネジ        Screw                   1     M4 x 6                      8.1
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                      SP - 39
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                     副走査部 1
    07A                              SUBSCANNING UNIT 1
                    1   2
FR6H5751.EPS
3 5
                                                          6
                                                                     6     7
       E5
                                     12
                                       11
      12
               13           E5
8 7
10 9 8
                                                                                14
                                                          PG3x4(3B)                  15
                                                                                          16                                     DETAIL A
                                                    PG3x4(3B)
                                                                14
                                                                      15
                                                                           16
17
                                                                                                                             15         PG3x4(3B)
                                                                                                                                  14
                                                                                     17
                                                   A                                                                        PG3x4(3B)
                                                                                                             15
                                                                                                                  14
22
                                                                                                         BR3x6
                                                                                               BR3x6
                                                                                               18
                                                                                                                  19
                                                                                                                             6         20
BR3x6
                                                                                               20
                                                                                                         6
                                                                                                                       21                   FR6H5601.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                                    SP - 40
06.20.2001 FM3057
                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                  副走査部 1
                                         SUBSCANNING UNIT 1                                   07A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                 QTY.     REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   350N2533A         カバー           Cover                      1                                10.5
  D       2   118YX214A         モータ           Motor                      1     MZ1                        10.5
  E       3   323N0033          ベルト           Belt                       1                                10.2
  D       4   305S0077          ナット           Nut                        1                                10.3
  D       5   337N0059C         ホイール          Flywheel                   1                                10.3
                                                                                                         10.11
  D       6   343N0039C         フック           Hook                       4
                                                                                                         10.12
                                                                                                         10.11
  D       7   388N2496          引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring                2     L≒39mm
                                                                                                         10.12
                                                                                                         10.11
  D      15   322SF156          軸受            Bearing                    4
                                                                                                         10.12
                                                                                                         10.11
  E      16   319N3598B         軸             Shaft                      2
                                                                                                         10.12
                                                                                                         10.11
  D      17   334N3506C         ゴムローラ         Rubber Roller              2
                                                                                                         10.12
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                        SP - 41
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                       副走査部 2
    07B                                SUBSCANNING UNIT 2
                                                                                                                                               FR6H5752.EPS
                                                                                       17                              DETAIL B
                                                                                                             17
                                                                                                                       18
           1             3
                     2
                             PK2.5x3(3B)
                                                                                                                                 17
                              4
                                                                                                 19
                                                10
                                                                                                            17
                3                                                12
                                                     11
                         5                                                        10
                             6                                                                                              20
                                 7                                                14
                                       8                  13
                                            9                               E3
                                                                      15
                                                                          DT3x6
                                                                          (BLK)
16
24
13 21
                                                                                                                 23
                                                                                                       22
                                                                                                                            25
                                                                                       B
                                       13                                                                                              26
                                                                                                                       27
                E3                                                                                                               BR3x6      28
               14
                                  11
                                                                      A                                                           13
               34
                 32
                                                          33                                                                8
                                 32                                                                                              29
                                                                                                      13
     35
                                                33
32 30
   DETAIL A                                                     31
                                                                                                                                         FR6H5602.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                                  SP - 42
06.20.2001 FM3057
                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                   副走査部 2
                                          SUBSCANNING UNIT 2                              07B
 RANK REF.           PART NO.                  PART NAME          QTY.     REMARKS     SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  D       1   118YX245           モータアセンブリ Motor Assembly           1     MZ3                          10.7
          2   ****
          3   ****
          4   ****
                                                                                                      10.8
  D       5   327N0135E          歯車            Gear                1
                                                                                                     10.13
                                                                                                      10.8
  E       6   319N3619           軸             Shaft               1
                                                                                                     10.13
                                                                                                      10.8
  D       7   327N0136B          歯車            Gear                1
                                                                                                     10.13
                                                                                                      10.8
  D       8   322SF155           軸受            Bearing             2                                 10.13
                                                                                                     10.14
                                                                                                      10.9
  D      14   322SF154           軸受            Bearing             2
                                                                                                     10.10
                                                                                                      10.9
  E      15   347N1700B          スペーサ          Spacer              1
                                                                                                     10.10
                                                                                                      10.9
  E      16   341N0934C          アーム           Arm                 1
                                                                                                     10.10
                                                                                                     10.13
  E      17   301S4990306        十字穴付き小ネジ Cross-recessed Screw     5
                                                                                                     10.14
                                                                                                     10.13
  D      18   387N0119C          帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush    1
                                                                                                     10.14
                                                                                                     10.13
  E      19   319N3599G          軸             Shaft               1
                                                                                                     10.14
                                                                                                     10.13
  D      20   602Y0123           ミラーアセンブリ Mirror Assembly          1
                                                                                                     10.14
                                                                                                      10.9
  E      33   319N3600B          軸             Shaft               2
                                                                                                     10.10
  E      34   341N0935D          アーム           Arm                 1                                 10.10
  E      35   356N6836B          ブラケット         Bracket             1                                  10.9
*参考:(3B)はゆるみ止め接着剤を使用する箇所である。
*REMARKS:
        (3B)indicates to use screw locking adhesive.
010-051-02
                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                   SP - 43
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                    副走査部 3
    07C                             SUBSCANNING UNIT 3
16
FR6H5753.EPS
16
                                                  16
                                                                      14
                                16
                                                                                                                                         14
         3-BR4x8
                                2
                                3    BR4x8
                                                                           B                                                       16
                            4                                                                                             16
                                                                                                                                             2-BR3x6
                                                                                                                               6
       18               BR4x8                                                               A                                                          16
                                                                                                                        15
                                                                                                                           BR3x6
                            17                         3-BR4x8                                                                                  16
                                                                                        BR4x8
                                     E4                               1            3                              16
                                             E4                                                               2   9       8                   7
                                                                                                                                    BR3x6
                                                                                    BR4x8
                                                                                                5
                                                                                                                       BR3x6            16
                                                                                        DT3x6
  B
                                                                                                         10
                                                                                                    E4
                                                                                   11
                   13
                                                            A
                                                                           E4
                                12
A FR6H5603.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                                          SP - 44
06.20.2001 FM3057
                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                  副走査部 3
                                         SUBSCANNING UNIT 3                           07C
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME    QTY.     REMARKS        SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   356N8121A         ブラケット         Bracket       2
                                                                                                   9.1
  E       2   347N1730          スペーサ          Spacer        2
                                                                                                  10.9
  D       3   309N0080          座金            Washer        2                                     10.1
  E       4   356N8123A         ブラケット         Bracket       1                                     10.1
  E       5   356N8122A         ブラケット         Bracket       1                                     10.1
  E       6   356N6834B         ブラケット         Bracket       1
  D       7   113Y1457C         ボードアセンブリ Board Assembly     1     SED12A
  E       8   356N6837B         ブラケット         Bracket       1
  E       9   356N8126B         ブラケット         Bracket       1
                                                                                                   9.1
  D      10   363N2057C         ガイド           Guide         4
                                                                                                  10.9
                                                                                                   9.1
  D      11   334Y0084          ローラ           Roller        1
                                                                                                  10.9
                                                                                                   9.1
  D      12   363N2056F         ガイド           Guide         1
                                                                                                  10.9
                                                                                                   9.1
  E      13   405N2670          銘板            Label         1
                                                                                                  10.9
  E      14   318F0145          ブッシュ          Bushing       2
  E      15   318F0174          コードクランプ       Cord Clamp    1     EDS17L
  E      16   318S1164          ブッシュ          Bushing      25
  D      17   363N2346A         ガイド           Guide         9                      #20061~
                                                                                                   9.1
  D      18   363Y0408          ガイドアセンブリ Guide Assembly     1     Without REF.13
                                                                                                  10.1
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                SP - 45
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                副走査部 4
      07D                       SUBSCANNING UNIT 4
FR6H5754.EPS
                                                                         1
                                                                                           2-DT3x6
                                                                             2-DT3x6
                                                                                                      2
               15 8             6                                                                     3-DT3x6
                                    7                                                  4
                                        6                                                  DT3x6
                                            7
                                                                     5
 12                    A                           6
                                                       7
A 10
DETAIL A 9
16
5-BR4x8
11
13
                                                                                                       FR6H5604.EPS
                                                                                               14
010-051-02                                                                                           SP - 46
06.20.2001 FM3057
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                  副走査部 4
                                         SUBSCANNING UNIT 4                                      07D
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME                   QTY.      REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   356N6813C         ブラケット         Bracket                      1                                10.12
  D       2   387N0137C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush             1                                10.12
  D       3   387N0120C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush             1                                10.12
  D       4   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush             1                                10.12
  E       5   405N1770A         銘板            Label                        3
  E       6   341N0933B         アーム           Arm                          3                                 10.4
  E       7   347N1731A         スペーサ          Spacer                       6                                 10.4
  E       8   356N6833F         ブラケット         Bracket                      1                                 10.4
  E       9   341N0932E         アーム           Arm                          1                                 10.4
  D      10   388N2436          引張りコイルバネ Extension Spring                  1                                 10.4
  E      11   319N3890          軸             Shaft                        1                                 10.4
  D      12   107Y0168          ソレノイド         Solenoid                     1     SolZ1                       10.4
  D      13   146S0029          フォトセンサ        Photo Sensor                 1     SZ4
  D      14   386Y0029          防振ゴム          Rubber Vibration Isolator    1                                 10.1
  E      15   318S1164          ブッシュ          Bushing                      1                                 10.4
  D      16   309S0037          ワッシャ          Washer                       1                                 10.4
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                           SP - 47
06.20.2001 FM3057
                             集光部
        08                   LIGHT-COLLECTING UNIT
                                                                                            1
                                                                                                            FR6H5350.EPS
                                        3
                                                4
                           BR3x12                       5
                    BR3x12                                  6
                                                                        2
                                                                                                7
                       4
                                                                        A
                                                    6
                                            4
                                    3
                                    BR3x12
                                                                    4
                                            BR3x12
3-BR3x6
                                                                    9
                                                                2-BR3x6
2-BR3x10
                                                                                       10
                                                                          A
11
                                                                                   12
                                                                               DT3x6        FR6H5701.EPS
010-051-02                                                                                                 SP - 48
06.20.2001 FM3057
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                  集光部
                                   LIGHT-COLLECTING UNIT                                 08
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME           QTY.   REMARKS   SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
                                                                                                  9.1
  E       1   345N1419B         シールド材         Cover                1
                                                                                                  9.2
                                                                                                  9.1
  C       2   113Y1456C         PMT12A        PMT12A               1
                                                                                                  9.2
  E       3   356N6990A         ブラケット         Bracket              2                              9.1
  E       4   347N1598A         スペーサ          Spacer               4                              9.1
  E       5   356N8389          ブラケット         Bracket              1                              9.1
  E       6   347N1599          スペーサ          Spacer               2                              9.1
  E       7   345N1532          シールド材         Cover                1                              9.1
  E       8   345N1456B         シールド材         Cover                1                              9.1
  E       9   356N8388          ブラケット         Bracket              1                              9.1
                                集光ガイドアセン Light-collecting Guide
  D      10   606Y0055A                                            1                              9.1
                                ブリ       Assembly
  E      11   405N0192          銘板            Label                1
  D      12   387N0138C         帯電防止材         Antistatic Brush     1
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                SP - 49
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                      制御部 1
    09A                               CONTROLLER 1
FR6H5950.EPS
BR3x6
                                                                          2-BR3x6
                                               2
                     5
BR3x6
                     A                                               16
                                                            17
18 4
        19
                                                                                                                                5
                                                                                                BR3x6
                                          15
             DETAIL A                                                               DETAIL B
                                  11                                                                        6
                                                                                                                    7
                                                                                                        8
                     12                                                                         9
                                 13
                           14
                                                                                            10
               10
                                                                                        BR3x6
             BR3x6
FR6H5A01.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                                                       SP - 50
10.10.2000 FM2753
                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                             制御部 1
                                                        CONTROLLER 1                   09A
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME       QTY.      REMARKS     SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  E       1   346N1095C         補助板           Plate Support    1                                   11.1
  E       2   346N1136B         補助板           Plate Support    1                                   11.1
  C       3   113Y1470A         CNN12A        CNN12A           1                                  11.10
  D       4   119S0008          ファン           Fan              2     FAN1,FAN2                    11.13
  E       5   364N0092C         ガード           Guard            2                                  11.13
  E       6   356N8487A         ブラケット         Bracket          1                                   11.9
  D       7   128Y0271C         スイッチ          Switch           1                                   11.9
  E       8   356N6996C         ブラケット         Bracket          1                                   11.9
  D       9   340N0171C         キートップ         Key Top          1                                   11.9
  E      10   356N6801D         ブラケット         Bracket          2                                   11.1
  E      11   356N6997D         ブラケット         Bracket          1                                  11.12
                                                                     SER-F-11-61-
  D      12   128Y0280          ブレーカ          Breaker          1                                  11.12
                                                                     10A-G
010-051-02
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 SP - 51
06.20.2001 FM3057
                                 制御部 2
    09B                          CONTROLLER 2
FR6H5951.EPS
13
                                                                 1
                                                                       10
                                      2
               3                                                            13
                             4
                                                                                          DETAIL A
                    5
                                                    SLOT1
                         6
                                                    SLOT2
                        7
                                                    SLOT3
                    12
                        A
     14                               9
          14
                                 13
14
                                                                      13
     A
11 13
                                                            13
                                                                                              FR6H5A02.EPS
010-051-00                                                                                         SP - 52
10.10.2000 FM2753
                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                                             制御部 2
                                                        CONTROLLER 2                     09B
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                  PART NAME       QTY.      REMARKS       SERIAL NO.   REFER TO
  C       1   352N0458D         パネル           Panel            1                                     11.7
  C       2   113Y1450D         MTH12A        MTH12A           1                                     11.7
  C       3   113Y1552A         DRV12A-1      DRV12A-1         1                                     11.4
  C       4   113Y1453D         DRV12A        DRV12A           1                                     11.6
  C       5   113Y1452D         SNS12A        SNS12A           1                                     11.5
  C       6   113Y1449G/H       SCN12A        SCN12A           1                                     11.3
  CR      7   113Y1451H/J       CPU12A        CPU12A           1                                     11.2
                                                                     With Cable
  CR      8   125Y0062G         電源            Power Supply     1                                     11.8
                                                                     Assembly
                                                                                                     11.7
  E       9   346N1096C         補助板           Plate Support    2
                                                                                                     11.8
                                                                     R452004 4A For
  AT     16   137S2096          ヒューズ          Fuse             1
                                                                     MTH12A
                                                                     R452003 3A For
  AT     17   137S2094          ヒューズ          Fuse             1     MTH12A
                                                                     DRV12A
                                                                     R452002 2A For
  AT     18   137S2092          ヒューズ          Fuse             1     MTH12A
                                                                     DRV 12A
                                                                     R45201.5 1.5A
  AT     19   137S2084          ヒューズ          Fuse             1     For SCN12A
                                                                     SNS12A
                                                                     R452001 1A For
  AT     20   137S2083          ヒューズ          Fuse             1
                                                                     SNS12A
                                                                     R452001 2A For
  AT     21   137S1220          ヒューズ          Fuse             1
                                                                     DRV12A
                                                                     R451.500 0.5A
  AT     22   137S1219          ヒューズ          Fuse             1
                                                                     For SNS12A
   E      -   114Y5436002A      CDR           CDR              1
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                   SP - 53
02.20.2002 FM3327
                           ケーブル
        10                 CABLE
                                                                                         CONNECTION
 RANK REF.          PART NO.                     PART NAME   QTY.      REMARKS
                                                                                          DIAGRAM
   E       1   136N0362         ケーブル             Cable        1     JPN,USA
   E       2   136N0363/0376    ケーブル             Cable        1     BSI
   E       3   136N0364/0377    ケーブル             Cable        1     CEE
   E       4   136N0365         ケーブル             Cable        1                         3/9
   E       5   136Y6773D        ケーブル             Cable        1                         3/9
   E       6   136Y6774C        ケーブル             Cable        1                         9/9
   E       7   136Y6775E        ケーブル             Cable        1                         9/9
   E       8   136Y6776F        ケーブル             Cable        1                         3/9
   E       9   136Y6777E        ケーブル             Cable        1                         3/9
                                                                    Including Ferrite
   E      10   136Y6780F        ケーブル             Cable        1                         8/9
                                                                    Bead
010-051-02                                                                                    SP - 54
06.20.2001 FM3057
                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual
サービスパーツリスト編                                      SP - 55
BLANK PAGE
                                                10
010-051-00
                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual    SP - 55
10.10.2000 FM2753
                                    1   2   3   4              5                 6                         7   8   9               10                     11
010-051-05
                                A                                                                                                                                         A
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                                                                                                                                              11
                                B                                                                                                                                         B
                                                    MTH12A
                                                    113Y1450
                                                                                                DRV12A
                                                                                                113Y1453
                                C                                                                                                                                         C
                                                                   CN 1   CN 1
                                                                                                                                                                              回路図
                                                                                     SNS12A
                                                                                     113Y1452
                                                                   CN 2   CN 2
                                                                          CN12
                                                                   CN 4
                                E                                                                                                                                         E
                                                                                                                                                                              CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
CN 5 CN1
                                                                                     CPU12A
                                                                                      113Y1451
                                                                   CN 6   CN2
F F
G G
                                                                                                                       機種      5436          ユニット   -
                                                                                                                        -
                                                                                                                       名称                    補助名称
                                                                                                                               回路図                  CCR
                                H                                                                                      対応コード   -                                          H
      SP - 56
                                                                                                                                                                  2
                                                                                                                                                                      9
                                    1   2   3   4              5                 6                         7   8   9               10                     11
                                            1                 2                            3                            4                        5                        6                         7                        8                               9                                      10                                 11
010-051-05
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    MTH12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      External
                                A                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                CNN12A                                 A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Ethernet cable
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   113Y1450
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             113Y1470 機外イーサネット
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Internal                                        (PC)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   CN-2           .
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         CN 5         CPU12A                          Ethernet cable
                                                                                                                                    α400                                                                                                                                             機内イーサネット
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     113Y1451                                                                               136Y6825
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CN-6     .                           .   CN-1
                                                                                                                                    125N0112                                                                                             CN 6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               136N0365                                External
                                                                                                                                                                                   UL1015 AWG16                                                                                                        Internal                        Serial cable
                                                                  *α400電源に使用する端子は全て                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Serial cable                    機外シリアル
                                                                                                                                                                                   136Y6770                                                                                                           機内シリアル
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CN-5     .                                            . .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       (PC)
                                                                   #250ファストン                                                                   +5V 1       A1       (+5V)
                                                                                                                                                       .                                 メイテンロック
                                B                                  175023−1                                                                        2       A1-GND   (+5V-GND)            1- 480702-0                                                                                           898Y0714                                                 B
                                                                                                                                                       .
                                                                                                                                                                                         350550-3(接触子)
                                                                   スリーブ                                                                                                                                                                             DF1E-2S-2.5C       UL1061 AWG26
                                                                                                                                                                                       RED    赤 (+5V)          1    CN-9         CN-10              DF1B2428SCA
                                                                   174817-1                                                                                                                              .                                                               128Y0271         MS1
                                                                                                                                                                                       BLK    黒 (+5V-GND)      3
                                                                                                                                                                                                         .                                1         EXTRSTL赤RED                    半田 COM                                 NO
                                                                                                                                               +5V 1       A2       (+5V)              BLK    黒 (+5V-GND)      2                                .                                     .                                               リセットスイッチ
                                                                                                                                                       .                                                 .                                2         GND_+5V黒BLK                    半田
                                                                                                                                                   2       A2-GND   (+5V-GND)          RED    赤 (+5V)          4                                .                                                        .                            Reset switch
                                                                                                                                                       .                                                   .
                                                                                                                                           +24V 1          B        (+24V)
                                C                                                                                                                      .                                                                                                                                                                                                C
                                                                                                                                                2          B-GND    (+24V-GND)                5557−10R
                                                                                                                                                       .                                      5556PBTL                           CN-11 1             RED 赤+24V
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                .             .                 119S0008
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    CN-8               2             BLK 黒 GND         FANG1    基板冷却
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                .                  .
                                                                                                                                                                                       ORN 橙      (+24V)       1
                                                                                                                                                                                                           .                                                                   Board cooling fan
                                                                                                                                                                                       BLK 黒 (+24V-GND)        6
                                                                                                                                                                                                           .
                                                                                                                                           +24V 1          C        (+24V)             ORN 橙      (+24V)       2
                                                                                                                                                       .                                                   .
                                                                                                                                                2          C-GND    (+24V-GND)         BLK 黒 (+24V-GND)        7
                                                                                                                                                       .                                                   .
                                                                                                                                                                                       BRN 茶      (+15V)       3
                                   欧州                                                                                           TB1
                                  Europe                                                                                    L         1
                                           丸端子FV2- 4(JST)                                                                       .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
                                 136N0376                                                                                   N         2
                                                                                                                                .
                                   英国                                                                                       E         3
                                                                                                                                .          +24V 1          E          (+24V)    黄 YEL              UL1015 AWG18
                                G England  インレットエコー電子                                                                                                  .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        G
                                           AC-PO03CS05                                                                                          2          E-GND      (+24V-GND)黒 BLK                136Y6772
                                 898Y0814                                                                  136Y6776                                    .
                                                                                                                           AC IN
                                 国内(患者環境) インレットASSYInlet Assy.                                         シールド線 AWG14         85∼265V                                                                                                                                       -     400-DRV12A 8
                                  JAPAN                                                                #250 ポジティブロック
                                                                                                       175023−1
                                                                                                       (ニュートラル
                                                                                                       174817-1(スリーブ)
                                                                                                        ライン174817-2(スリーブ))
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         機種              5436                    ユニット         -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         名称                                      補助名称         CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             DIAGRAM
                                H                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       対応コード                                                                           H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         コード                                                           Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Z22Y0005436                                            5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    9
     SP - 57
                                            1                 2                            3                            4                        5                        6                         7                        8                               9                                      10                                 11
                                        1                              2                                3                 4                                5                           6                          7                                         8                          9                                    10                                   11
                                                                                                                                                                                   UL2651
                                                                                                              UL1061AWG26(黄色)YEL                                                   簾ストレート(沖)
                                                                                                             858Y0252                                                                   136Y6810      ユニット AssyHIF3BA-20D-2.54R                                  LDD 12A
010-051-05
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Unit Assy                                      CN-1
                                         SCN12A                                                                                              CNE-1                                                                       +15AS                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 113Y1455
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    .
                                A                                                                                                                              +15AS                                                        AG                  2                                                                                                                             A
                                         113Y1449                                                                                             .        .                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                AG                                                       +15AS                  3
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                               +15AS                                                        AG                  4
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                                                                                                                                AG                                                       +15AS                  5
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            AG                  6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  11
                                                                                                                                                               LD1OKH                                                    +15AS                  7
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                               LD1OKL                                                       AG                  8
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .                                                                             ユニット Assy
                                                                                                                                                               LDIFH                                                     -1 5AS                 9
                                                                                                                                              .        .                                                                            .                                                                             Unit Assy
                                                                                                                                                               LDIFL                                                        AG                  10
                                                                      CN-1                                                                    .        .                                                                            .
                                    Signal              Signal                                                                                                                                                           -1 5AS                 11                                                              UL1061AWG26(黄色)YEL                            LDA 12A
                                    description         description                       +15AS                                                                                                                                     .
                                B                                                    .                                                                                                                                      AG                  12                                                                  136Y6809                                                  B
                                                  SCN12A                                   AG                                      HIF3BA-20D-2.54C HIF3BA--20PD-2.54R-MC                                                           .                                                                                                                         113Y1458
                                                                                     .                                             HIF3-2428SCA                                                                          LD1IDH                 13
                                       信号名         No.  信号名                               +15AS                                                                                                                                     .
                                                                                     .                                                                                                                                   LD1IDL                 14
                                     +15AS         1 2 AG                                  AG                                        Signal                      Signal                                                             .                                       CN-2   1           VCC_+VLD                                           1       CN-1
                                                                                     .                                                                                                                                                                                                     .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LD1ONH                  15                                                                               VCC_+VLD.
                                     +15AS         3 4 AG                                                                            description                 description                                                        .                                              2           VCC_+VLD                                           2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LD1ONL                  16                                                                               VCC_+VLD.
                                     +15AS         5 6 AG                                                                                             CNE1
                                                                                           GND                                                                                                                                      .                                              3           LDKTD1                            LDKTD1           3
                                     +15AS         7 8 AG                            .                                                  信号名            No.  信号名                                                         LD1OKH                  17                                         .                                               .
                                     -15AS         9 10 AG                                 SSL                                                                                                                                      .                                              4           LDKTD1                            LDKTD1           4
                                                                                     .                                                +15AS           1 2 AG                                                            LD1OKL                  18                                         .                                               .
                                     -15AS         11 12 AG                                SSH                                                                                                                                      .                                              5           PD                                PD               5
                                                                                     .                                                +15AS           3 4 AG                                                             LDIFH                  19                                         .                                               .
                                     LD1IDH        13 14 LD1IDL                            NC                                         +15AS           5 6 AG                                                                        .                                              6           VCC_+15AL                         VCC_+15AL        6
                                     NC            15 16 NC                          .                                                                                                                                   LDIFL                  20                                         .                                               .
                                                                                                                                      +15AS           7 8 AG                                                                        .                                              7           ID1H                              ID1H             7
                                     LD1ONH        17 18 LD1ONL                                                                       -15AS           9 10 AG                                                                                                                              .                                               .
                                     NC            19 20 NC                                                                                                                                                                                                                        8           GND_A                             GND_A            8
                                C                                                                                                     -15AS           11 12 AG                                                                                                                             .                                               .                                  C
                                     LD1OKH        21 22 LD1OKL                                                                       LD1IDH          13 14 LD1IDL
                                     LDIFH         23 24 LDIFL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  回路図
                                                                                                                                      LD1ONH          15 16 LD1ONL
                                     +15VAS        25 26 AG                                                                           LD1OKH          17 18 LD1OKL                                                                                                                             DF3-8S-2C                         DF3-8S-2C
                                     +5VAS         27 28 AG                               HIF3BA−40D−2
                                                                                                     .54C                                                                                                                                                                                      DF3-2428SCC                       DF3-2428SCC
                                                                                                                                      LDIFH           19 20 LDIFL
                                     -15VAS        29 30 AG                               HIF3-2428SCA
                                     +5VDS         31 32 GND
                                     SSL           33 34 SSH
                                     NC            35 36 NC
                                     NC            37 38 NC                                                                                                                                                           DF1B-10S−2.5R
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DF1B-2428SCA
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                UL1015AWG12(黒)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                FGZ1                               FGZ2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 (光学定盤カバー)                     (副走査側板)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      PHR-8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SPH-002T-P0.5S                                                             Optics top cover              Frame of sub-scanning unit
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         CN-1                                    丸端子(JST)                        丸端子(JST)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           +24PS                     1                                           FV5.5-3                         FV5.5-4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           GND_P                     2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           POKL                      3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           PONL                      4          POL 12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           GND_P                     5                                                                      136Y6819
                                F                                                                                UL1061AWG26(黄色)YEL                                                                                                         .                                                                                                                                 F
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           PIDXL                     6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          .
                                                                                                                858Y0252                                                                                                                    .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     7                                                   UL1015AWG12(黒)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            .
                                                                                                                                                                 SCN12A-SED12A 7                                                                     8                                                             BLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               NC           .                                               (副走査側板)                     (スキャナ部台)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Frame of sub-scanning unit    Scanner unit base
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            丸端子(JST)                    丸端子(JST)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            FV5.5-4                     FV5.5-4
                                                                CN-2 1                    GND
                                                                                 .
                                                                     2                    VCC                                                                                                                                                   136Y6819
                                                                                 .                                                                                                                          *3個使い                                                                                                           136Y6819
                                                                     3                   SED1L
                                                                                 .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      .
                                                                     4                   SED2L
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          .
                                G                                                .                                                                                                                                             UL1015AWG12(黒)                                                                                                                                 G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     UL1015AWG12(黒)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                           (スキャナ部台取り付け金具近傍筐体)                  (スキャナ部台)                                        BLK
                                                                                         DF1E-4S−2.5C                                                                                                                                                          (スキャナ部台取り付け金具近傍筐体)                   (スキャナ部台 )
                                                                                         DF1B-2428SCA                                                                                                        Housing nearscanner unit base   Scanner unit base   
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Housing nearscanner unit base    Scanner unit base
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    丸端子(JST)                   丸端子(JST)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    FV5.5-4                    FV5.5-4                  丸端子(JST)                    丸端子(JST)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        FV5.5-4                     FV5.5-4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        機種          5436                ユニット          -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        名称                              補助名称          CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       DIAGRAM
                                H                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       対応コード                                                                 H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        コード                                                    Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   Z22Y0005436                                        5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      4
      SP - 58
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          9
                                        1                              2                                3                 4                                5                           6                          7                                         8                          9                                    10                                   11
                                    1     2                   3                          4   5              6                         7               8                       9                            10                   11
010-051-05
                                A                                                                                                                                                                                                                A
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                B                                                                                                                                                     PMT12A                                                     B
113Y1456
                                        SCN12A
                                        113Y1449
                                                                                                         UL2651簾ストレート(沖)
                                                                                                           858Y0252
                                                                                                 Signal         Signal
                                C                                                                description    description                                                                                                                      C
                                                                                                       SCN12A←→PMT-CN1
                                                                                                  HVVOKH                HVVOKL
                                                                                                  +15VOKH       3 4     +15VOKL                                 HVVOKH                CN-1
                                                   CN-4                HVVOKH                     HVSH          5 6     HVSL                                              .
                                                                  .                                                                                             HVVOKH
                                                                       HVVOKH                     NC            7 8     NC                                                .
                                                                  .                               +15AS         9 10    AG(HV)                                  +15VOKL
                                                                       +15VOKL                                                     注釈                                     .
                                                                  .                               +15AS         11 12   AG(HV)                                  +15VOKL
                                                                                                                                   N.Cはハーネスが接続
                                                                                                                                               1 2
                                                                                                                                          信号名   No.
                                                                                                  VIONH         33 34   VIONL
                                                                                                                                              信号名
                                E                                                                                                                                                                                                                E
                                                                                                                  UL1553-1.5D-2V
                                F                                                                                 日立電線                                                                                                                           F
                                                          .
                                                                                                                                                                                      .
                                                   CN-5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
G G
                                                                                                                                                                                                 機種    5436          ユニット   -
                                                                                                                                                                                                          回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                 名称                  補助名称   CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                       CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                       DIAGRAM
                                                                                                                                                                                                       -
                                H                                                                                                                                                            対応コード                                               H
                                                                                                                                                                                                 コード                              Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     11
                                                                                                                                                                                                       Z22Y0005436                       5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         5
     SP - 59
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             9
                                    1     2                   3                          4   5              6                         7               8                       9                            10                   11
                                    1              2                            3                 4                    5     6                               7                           8                       9                             10                 11
010-051-05
                                A                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  A
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       11
                                        SNS12A                                                                                                                                       -       SNS12A-INV12B9
                                        113Y1452       CN-6     1       +5VINV
                                                                     .                                  858Y0252
                                                                2       STBL1L
                                                                     .                            UL1061AWG26(単線黄色)YEL
                                                                3       ONL1L
                                                                     .
                                                                4       FAN3ONL
                                B                                    .                                                                                                                                                                                                             B
                                                                5       FAN4ONL
                                                                     .
                                                                6       LAMPREQH
                                                                     .
                                                                7       LDSN1H
                                                                     .
                                                                8       LDSN2H
                                                                     .
                                                                9       LDSN3H
                                                                     .
                                                               10       FAN3REQH
                                                                     .
                                                               11       FAN3ERRH
                                                                     .
                                                               12       FAN4ERRH
                                                                     .
                                                               13       THB1ERRH
                                                                     .
                                                               14       HTMPERRH
                                C                                    .                                                                                                                                                                                                             C
                                                               15       TSWB1ERRH
                                                                     .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       回路図
                                                               16       GND
                                                                     .
                                                               17       STBL2L
                                                                     .
                                                               18       ONL2L
                                                                     .
                                                               19       STBL3L
                                                                     .                                                                           CNBCR-1
                                                               20       ONL3L
                                                                     .
                                                               21       TXD                                                               RTS      1               (CTS) 青 BLU                                                                 BCR
                                                                     .                                                                           .           .
                                E                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
                                                                                                UL1061AWG26(単線黄色)YEL                                                             UL1061AWG26(単線黄色)YEL
                                                                                                       858Y0252                                                                      858Y0255
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LED12A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           113Y1469
                                                                                                                                                 CNA-4                                                                                  CN-1
                                                        CN-5     1             +5VLED                                                               1            +5VLED                                               +5VLED          1
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 2              LED1L                                                               2            LED1L                                                 LED1L          2
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                F                                3              LED2L                                                               3            LED2L                                                 LED2L          3                                            F
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 4              LED3L                                                               4            LED3L                                                 LED3L          4
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 5              LED4L                                                               5            LED4L                                                 LED4L          5
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 6              LED5L                                                               6            LED5L                                                 LED5L          6
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 7             +5VLED                                                               7            +5VLED                                               +5VLED          7
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 8             LED6L                                                                8            LED6L                                                LED6L           8
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                 9             LED7L                                                                9            LED7L                                                LED7L           9
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                10              SW1L                                                             10              SW1L                                                  SW1L           10
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                11            BUZZ ON L                                                          11              BUZZ ON L                                           BUZZ ON L        11
                                                                         .                                                                        .   .                                                                          .
                                                                12              GND                                                              12              GND                                                   GND            12
                                                                         .                                                                       .       .                                                                       .
                                G                                                                                                DF1B-12DEP                         DF1B-12DES                                DF1B-12S-2.5R                                                        G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 機種      5436          ユニット   -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 名称                    補助名称   CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         DIAGRAM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         -
                                H                                                                                                                                                                                             対応コード                                                H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 コード                                Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         Z22Y0005436                       5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           6
      SP - 60
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               9
                                    1              2                            3                 4                    5     6                               7                           8                       9                             10                 11
                                      1                            2                       3      4                     5               6                          7                                 8                9                      10                         11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   UL1061 AWG26黄色YEL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       136Y6795      Cassette ejection sensor
010-051-05
                                                                 HIF3BA-50D−2.54C                                                                                                                                 CNA-1
                                                                 HIF3-2428SCA                                                                                                                                                                       SUPSA1 1        SA1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1   SUPSA1                              .
                                A
                                    SNS12A                                                                                                                                                                        .   .                             SINSA1H   2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         A
                                                                       UL1061 AWG26黄色YEL                                                                                        Side-positioning                    2   SINSA1H                             .    146S0029
                                    113Y1452                                                                                                                                    HP sensor                         .   .                             GND       3
                                                                          858Y0252                                                                                                                                  3   GND                                 .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  .   .                                         カセッテ排出 検出
                                                                                                 *PIは、SZ・SA・SC(SA5・SZ1は除く)                                   SUPSC1             1    SC1                            4   SUPSA2
                                                                                                                                                                     .                                            .   .
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                               CN-4                                                                                                          SINSC1H            2                                   5   SINSA2H                                  Cassette IN sensor
                                                         1       SUPSA1                          全て、                                                                 .             146S0029                       .   .
                                                       .     .                                                                                               GND                3                                   6   GND
                                                         2       SINSA1H                         179228−3(CT)                                                             .                                       .   .                             SUPSA2 1
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                    幅寄せHP検出                           7   SUPSA3                              .      SA2
                                                         3       GND                                                                                                                                              .   .                             SINSA2H   2
                                                       .     .                                   179518−1(接触子)                                                                                                      8   SINSA3H                             .    146S0029
                                                         4       SUPSA2                                                                                                          Grip HP sensor                   .   .                             GND       3
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                                                      9   GND                                 .
                                                         5       SINSA2H                                                                                                                                          .       .                                     カセッテIN検出
                                                       .     .                                                                                               SUPSC2             1
                                                         6       GND                                                                                                 .                SC2
                                                       .     .                                                                                               SINSC2H            2                         DF1B−9EP      DF1B−9ES                             Cassette hold sensor
                                                         7       SUPSA3                                                                                              .             146S0029               DF1−PD2428SCB DF1B−2428SCA
                                B                      .     .                                                                                               GND                3                                                                                                        B
                                                         8       SINSA3H                                                                                                  .                                                                         SUPSA3 1
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                    ニップ解除HP検出                                                                .       SA3
                                                         9       GND                                                                                                                                                                                SINSA3H   2
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                                                                                              .
                                                      10         SUPSA4                                                                                                              IP sensor                                                      GND       3 146S0029
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                                                                                              .
                                                      11         SINSA4H                                                                                                                                                                                        カセッテホールド検出
                                                       .     .                                                                                               SUPSC4             1
                                                      12         GND                                                                                                 .              SC4
                                                       .     .                                                                     UL1061 AWG26黄色YEL         SINSC4H            2                                                   UL1061 AWG26黄色YEL
                                                      13         NC (SUPSA5)                                                                                         .            133Y1466
                                                       .     .                                                                        136Y6787               GND                3                                                      136Y6796
                                                      14         SINSA5H                                                                                                  .                                                                                  Suction cup HP sensor
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                    消去位置決めIP検出
                                                      15         GND                                                                                                                                              CNA-2
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                                                                                       SUPSA4 1
                                                      16         SUPSB1                                    CNC-1                                                                                                    1   SUPSA4                               .     SA4
                                                       .     .                                                                                                                      IP sensor                     .   .                              SINSA4H   2
                                                      17         SINSB1H                                      1      SUPSC1                                                                                         2   SINSA4H                              .
                                C                      .     .                                              .   .                                                                                                 .   .                               GND      3 146S0029                C
                                                      18         GND                                          2      SINSC1H                                 SUPSC3             1                                   3    GND                                 .
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                    .              SC3                           .   .                                          吸盤HP検出
                                                      19         SUPSC1                                       3      GND                                     SINSC3H            2                                   4    N.C
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                    .            136Y1466                        .   .
                                                      20         SINSC1H                                      4      SUPSC2                                  GND                3                                   5   SINSA5H                                    Suction sensor
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                         .                                       .   .
                                                      21         GND                                          5      SINSC2H                                                      幅寄せ位置決めIP検出                       6    GND
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                                                                 .       .
                                                      22         SUPSC2                                       6      GND                                                                                                                             SINSA5H       1     SA5
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                         Driving-side grip sensor                                                           .
                                                      23         SINSC2H                                      7      SUPSC4                                                                               DF1B−6EP      DF1B−6ES                      GND          2
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                                                         DF1−PD2428SCB DF1B−2428SCA                         .
                                                      24         GND                                          8      SINSC4H                                  SUPSZ2 1                                                                                                 128S0392
                                                       .     .                                              .   .                                                     .     SZ2
                                                                                                            .   .                                                         .
                                                                                                                                                                                            118YX214
                                                                                                           13       SUP OK                                    M0 L              6
                                                                                                            .   .                                                         .
                                G                                                                          14       OK L                                                                                                                                                                 G
                                                                                                            .   .                             PHR−6(日圧)
                                                                                                           15       +5VSEN                    SPH-002T-P0.5L(接触子)
                                                                                                            .   .
                                                                                                           16       START L
                                                                                                            .   .
                                                                                                           17       CWL
                                                                                                            .   .
                                                                                                           18       M0 L                              IP leading-edge sensor
                                                                                                            .   .
                                      4SCN12A-SED12A                                                       19        GND
                                                                                                            .   .                            GND        1
                                                                                                           20        VCC                          .           SZ-1
                                                                                                            .   .                            VCC        2
                                                                                                           21        SED1L                        .           113Y1457
                                                                                                            .   .                            SED1L      3                                                                     機種      5436              ユニット       -
                                                                                                           22        SED2L                        .           (SED 12A)
                                                                                                           .    .                            SED2L      4                                                                                回路図
                                                                                                                                                  .         IP先端検出                                                            名称                        補助名称       CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DIAGRAM
                                H                                                              DF1B−22DEP           DF1B−22DES                                                                                                対応コード                                                      H
                                                                                               DF1−PD2428SCB        DF1B−2428SCA                 179228−4(CT)                                                                 コード                                        Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             11
                                                                                                                                                 179                                                                                  Z22Y0005436                                  5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   7 9
     SP - 61
                                      1                            2                       3      4                     5               6                          7                                 8                9                      10                         11
                                              1                                 2                             3                  4                        5                           6                                    7                  8                        9                                     10                                     11
010-051-05
                                                                        113Y1453                          5557−12R                                                                                                               1                                             1   赤 RED MA1A
                                                                                                          5556PBTL                                                                                                             .   .                                         .   .   .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 4                    136Y6817                 4   青 BLU MA1B
                                                                                           1       MA1A                                                                                                                        .   .                                         .   .   .
                                A                                                              .                                                                                                                                 2                   UL1007AWG22(単線)           2   黒 BLK COM                                                                          A
                                                                             CN3           7       MA1B                                                                                                                        .   .                                         .   .   .                                                             118SX167
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                 5                                             5   白 WHT COM
                                                                      CN-2                 2       COM                                                                                                                         .   .    5559−06P                    5557−06R.    .   .                                          MA1
                                                                                               .                                                                                                  5557−06R                       3      5558PBTL                               3   黄 YEL MA1AL                                                     吸盤駆動モーター
                                                   -                                                                                                                                                                           .   .
                                    3 400-DRV12A                                           8       COM                                                                                                                                                              5556PBTL .   .   .
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                              +24V                     1                       .                             UL1007AWG22(単線)                                                      5556PBTL                       6                                             6   橙 ORN MA1BL
                                                                  .                        3       MA1AL                                                                                                                       .   .                                               .         .       .
                                              PGND                     2                       .                                858Y0253
                                                                  .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          11
                                                                                           9       MA1BL                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Suction cupdriving motor
                                              +24V                     3                       .
                                     5557−08R                     .                        4       MB1A                                                                                                                        CN-MB1
                                     5556PBTL PGND                     4                       .                                                                                                                                                          Transport motor
                                                                  .                       10       MB1B                                                                                                                          1   赤 RED   MB1A
                                              +15V                     5                       .                                                                                                                               .   .          .
                                                                  .                        5       COM                                                                                                                           4   青 BLU   MB1B
                                              PGND                     6                       .                                                                                                                               .   .          .
                                                                  .                       11       COM                                                                                                                           2   黒 BLK   COM
                                                                       7                       .                                                                                                  5557−06R                     .   .          .
                                                                  .                        6       MB1AL                                                                                          5556PBTL                       5   白 WHT   COM
                                B                                      8                       .                                                                                                                               .   .          .           MB1 118SX167 CN-MC1                                                                                         B
                                                                  .                       12       MB1BL                                                                                                                         3   黄 YEL   MB1AL            IP搬送モータ
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .          .                                      1           赤 RED                MC1A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 6   橙 ORN   MB1BL                                 .         .      .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               .   .          .                                      4           青 BLU                MC1B
                                                                                                          5557−12R                                                                                                                                                                 .         .      .
                                     UL1007                                                               5556PBTL                                                                                                                                                                   2           黒 BLK                COM
                                     AWG18(黒)                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      .         .      .                                               118SX164
                                                                                    CN51           MC1A                                                                                                                        CNC-10                          5557−06R              5           白 WHT                COM
                                                       .
                                          BLK                                                  .                                                                                                                                                               5556PBTL            .         .      .                           MC1
                                                           FGG1                         7          MC1B                                                                                                                          1                                                   3           黄 YEL                MC1AL                         幅寄せモータ
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                               .         .      .
                                                                                        2          COM                                                                                                 5557−12R                  7           5559−12P                                6           橙 ORN                MC1BL
                                     (制御ラック)  Board rack                                       .                                                                                                       5556PBTL                .   .         5558PBTL                              .         .           .
                                                                                        8          COM                                                                                                                           2
                                         丸端子(JST)                                              .                   UL1007AWG22(単線)                                                                                             .   .                                                                                            Side-positioning motor
                                         FV1.25-4                                       3          MC1AL                                                                                                                         8                                                CN-MC2
                                                                                               .                        858Y0253                                                                                               .   .
                                                                                        9          MC1BL                                                                                                                         3                UL1007AWG22(単線)                   1   赤 RED                         MC2A
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                              .   .    .
                                                                                        4          MC2A                                                                                                                          9                    136Y6816                      4   青 BLU                         MC2B
                                C                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     C
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                              .   .    .
                                                                                       10          MC2B                                                                                                                          4                                                  2   黒 BLK                         COM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          回路図
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                              .   .    .                                                        118SX167
                                                                                        5          COM                                                                                                                         10                                                   5   白 WHT                         COM
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                              .   .    .                                    MC2
                                                                                       11          COM                                                                                                                           5                                                  3   黄 YEL                         MC2AL                         ニップ解除モータ
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                              .   .    .
                                                                                        6          MC2AL                                                                                                                       11                              5557−06R             6   橙 ORN                         MC2BL
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                           5556PBTL            .         .           .
                                                                                       12          MC2BL                                                                                                                         6
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                               .   .                                                                                            Grip motor
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               12
                                                                                                          5557−06R                                                                                                             .   .
                                                                                                          5556PBTL                                                                                                                                                                CN-MC3
                                                                                                          5557−10R                                            858Y0253
                                                                                                          5556PBTL                                                                                                                                                                                                              Transport motor
                                                                             CN-7          1       +24V
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                                   CN-SOLA1
                                                                                           6       DRVH
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                                +24V 1    赤                   RED
                                                                                           2       NC                                                                                                                                                                                .  .                     .
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                               DRVH 3     黄                   YEL                  107Y0169
                                                                                           7       DRVL                                                                                                                                                                              .  .                     .   SOLA1
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                                NC 2                          BLK                  カセッテホールド
                                                                                           3       DRVPA1                                                                                                                                                                            .  .                         .
                                E                                                              .                                                                                                                                                                               DRVL 4     黒                                                                           E
                                                                                           8       PGND                                                                                                                                                                                  .       .
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                                                                       Cassettehold solenoid
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
                                                                                           4       DRVSVA1                                                                                                                                                         5557−04R
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                   5556PBTL
                                                                                           9       PGND
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                               CN-PA1
                                                                                           5       DRVCLA1
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                        DRVPA1 1      赤 RED
                                                                                          10       PGND                                                                                                                                                                         .   .   .            133Y1031
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                           PGND 3     黒 BLK PA1 IP吸着
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                .   .   .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2
                                                                                                                                                                                  CN-MZ2                                                                           5557−04R     .   .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   5556PBTLNC     4        Suction pump
                                                                                                                                                  UL1007AWG20(単線)           MZ2DRV 1    赤 RED                                                                                            .       .
                                                                                                                                                                                   .  .   .                        118YX216
                                                                                                                                                   136Y6792                   PGND 2    黒 BLK MZ2                  ニップ解除
                                                                                                                                        CNZ-11                                        .   .        .
                                                                                                      UL1007AWG20(単線)                                                                                                                                                              CN-SVA1
                                F                                                                                                         1                                                                                                                                                                                                                           F
                                                                                               5557−08R 858Y0253                        .   .                                                          Grip driving motor                                                   DRVSVA1 1     赤 RED
                                                                                                                                          4                                 5557−02R                                                                                                .  .    .        134Y0056
                                                                                               5556PBTL                                 .   .                                                                                                                                  PGND 2
                                                                                                                                          2                                 5556PBTL                                                                                                     .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          黒 BLK SVA 1IPリーク
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 .                .
                                                                                    CN-6 1         MZ2DRV                               .   .
                                                                                               .                                          5                                                                                                                        5557−02R
                                                                                         5         PGND                                 .   .                                     CN-MZ3                                                                           5556PBTL                     Leak valve
                                                                                               .                                          3                                                                                                                                        CN-CLA1
                                                                                         2         MZ3DRV1                              .   .                              MZ3DRV1 1    赤 RED
                                                                                               .                                          6                       RED              .  .   .                        118SX217                                                 DRVCLA1 1     赤 RED
                                                                                         6         MZ3DRV2                              .   .                              MZ3DRV2 2    黒 BLK MZ3                                                                                   .  .    .            106Y0005
                                                                                               .                                                                  YEL                 .   .        .               ほこり除去                                                       PGND 2     黒 BLK CLA1 クラッチ
                                                                                         3         +24V                                                                                                                                                                                  .       .                .
                                                                                               .                                                                  BLK
                                                                                         7         DRVH                   5557−06R         5559−06P                                                    Dust removal motor                                          5557−02R
                                                                                               .                          5556PBTL         5558PBTL                         5557−02R                                                                               5556PBTL                                             Cassette ejection clutch
                                                                                         4         NC                                                                       5556PBTL
                                                                                               .                                  CN-SOLZ1
                                                                                         8         DRVL
                                                                                               .                               +24V 1     赤  RED
                                G                                                                                                   .   .                                                     .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      G
                                                                                                                              DRVH 3      黄  YEL                                                                107Y0168
                                                                                                                                    .   .                                                     .        SOLZ1
                                                                                                                                      2                                                                         ストッパー駆動
                                                                                                                                    .   .                                                     .
                                                                                                                              DRVL 4      黒  BLK
                                                                                                                                        .   .                                                          IP stopper solenoid
                                                                                               DF1E−4S-2.5C                5557−04R              5559−04P
                                                                                               DF1B-2428SCA                5556PBTL              5558PBTL
                                                                             CN-8          1       PGND                                                                                       FFM12A
                                                                                               .                                                      UL1007AWG24       PHR-4(日圧)
                                                                                           2       +5V                                                                                            118YX214                                                                             機種            5436                         ユニット         -
                                                                                               .                                                          136Y6780      SPH-002T-P0.5L
                                                                                           3       PGND                                 CNZ-10                                                                                                                                                         回路図
                                                                                               .                                                                                                                                                                                       名称                                         補助名称         CCR
                                                                                           4       +15V                                   1                              黄 YEL   +15V     1       CN-1                                                                                               CIRCUIT
                                                                                               .                                        .   .                                         .                                                                                                              DIAGRAM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     -
                                H                                                                                                         2                              黄 YEL   PGND     2                                                                                       対応コード                                                                               H
                                                                                                                                        .   .                                         .
                                                                                                                                          3                              黄 YEL   +5V      3                                                                                            コード                                                           Rev.
                                                                                                                                        .   .                                         .                                                                                                              Z22Y0005436                                              5
                                                                                                       858Y0253                           4                              黄 YEL   PGND     4
                                                                                                                                        .   .                                         .                                                                                                                                                                           頁
                                                                                                     UL1007AWG24
                                                                                                                       DF1B−4EP-2.5RC            DF1B−4ES-2.5RC                                                                                                                                                                                               8
      SP - 62
                                                                                                                       DF1-PD2428SCB             DF1B-2428SCA                                                                                                                                                                                                     9
                                              1                                 2                             3                  4                        5                           6                                    7                  8                        9                                     10                                     11
                                            1                     2                                 3                         4                             5                   6                         7                             8                               9                               10                               11
010-051-05
                                A                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        A
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                                                                                                                                      INV12A                                     120Y0079
                                                                                                                                                                               5557−10R
                                                                                                                                                      104N0016                 5556PBTL
                                                                                                                                   5557−08R
                                                                                                        3 MTH12A-INV12A   -        5556PBTL                      CN-11 1            L1-1 白 WHT
                                                                                                                                                      CN-1                 .
                                                                                                                                                                       6            L1-2 白 WHT
                                                                                                                                                                           .
                                                                                                                                   RED   +24V 赤       1                2
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .
                                                                                                                                   BLK   GND 黒        5                7             N.C
                                B                                                                                                                 .                        .                                                                                                                                                                             B
                                                                                                                                   RED   +24V 赤       2                3            L2-1 白 WHT
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .
                                                                                                                                   BLK   GND 黒        6                8            L2-2 白 WHT
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .
                                                                                                                                   RED   +24V 赤       3                4
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .
                                                                                                                                   BLK   GND 黒        7                9             N.C                              FX-1000                                  FX-1000                                         FX-1000
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .
                                                                                                                                   RED   +24V 赤       4                5            L3-1 白 WHT
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .                                             L1-1                                       L2-1                                          L3-1
                                                                                                                                   BLK   GND 黒        8               10            L3-2 白 WHT                                1.                                         1.                                            1.
                                                                                                                                                  .                        .                                             L1-2        LAMB1                          L2-2        LAMB2                             L3-2        LAMB3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2.     123N0007
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         2.     123N0007
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       2.     123N0007
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         L1-3                                       L2-3                                          L3-3
                                                                           INV12B                                                                                                                                             1.    消去ランプ                                1.    消去ランプ                                   1.     消去ランプ
                                                                                                                     UL1061 AWG22                                CN-12 1        L1-3    白 WHT                            L1-4       (蛍光面)                           L2-4       (蛍光面)                              L3-4        (蛍光面)
                                                                                                                                                                           .                                                  2.                                         2.                                            2.
                                C                                                                                                                                      4        L1-4    白 WHT                                                                                                                                                            C
                                                                                                                                                                           .
                                                                          104N1471 1                     +24V_GND                   +5V         1                                                                     FX-1000                                                                                  FX-1000
                                                                                        .       .                       136Y6775              .       .                2        L2-3    白 WHT                                      Erasure lamp                FX-1000        Erasurelamp                                   Erasurelamp
                                                                                         2               +24V_GND                   LAMP STB1 2                            .
                                                                                 CN-5 .         .                                             .       .   CN-6         5        L2-4    白 WHT
                                                                                         3               +24V                       LAMP STB2 3                            .
                                                                                       .        .                                             .       .                3        L3-3    白 WHT
                                                                                         4               +24V_GND                   LAMP STB3 4                            .
                                                                                       .        .                                             .       .                6        L3-4    白 WHT
                                                                                         5               +24V                       LAMP ON1 5                             .                     120Y0078
                                                                                       .        .                                             .       .
                                                                                         6               FUOPEN3                    LAMP ON2 6
                                                                                       .        .                                             .       .
                                                                                         7               FUOPEN2                    LAMP ON3 7
                                                                                       .        .                                             .       .                        5557−06R
                                                                      .
                                                        YEL黄 STBL3L       19
                                                                      .
                                G                       YEL黄 ONL3L        20                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             G
                                                                      .
                                                                                   CN-3
                                                         XADRP-20V(日圧)
                                                         SXA-001GW-P0.6                     1            +24V 赤                                                                                          RED 赤 +24V
                                                                                                .                                                                                                                .        119S0009
                                                                                            2             GND 黒                                                                                          BLK 黒 GND  
                                                                                                .                                                                                                                .
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    FANG3 消去冷却
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Erasure unit cooling fan
                                                                                                         DF3AA-2EP-2C
                                                                                                         DF3-EP2428PC                                                                                                                                                                      機種    5436                       ユニット    -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    回路図
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           名称                               補助名称    CCR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     DIAGRAM
                                H                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      対応コード                                                             H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           コード                                            Rev.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 Z22Y0005436                                     5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     頁
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 9
     SP - 63
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     9
                                            1                     2                                 3                         4                             5                   6                         7                             8                               9                               10                               11
                            部品番号検索表
        12                  PARTS NOS. SEARCH TABLE
部品番号                INDEX No.- 図番         部品番号          INDEX No.- 図番   部品番号        INDEX No.- 図番
010-051-05                                                                              SP - 64
02.20.2002 FM3327
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                        部品番号検索表
                            PARTS NOS. SEARCH TABLE                              12
部品番号                INDEX No.- 図番         部品番号       INDEX No.- 図番   部品番号        INDEX No.- 図番
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                     SP - 65
02.20.2002 FM3327
                            部品番号検索表
        12                  PARTS NOS. SEARCH TABLE
部品番号                INDEX No.- 図番         部品番号        INDEX No.- 図番   部品番号        INDEX No.- 図番
010-051-05                                                                            SP - 66
02.20.2002 FM3327
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual
                                        部品番号検索表
                            PARTS NOS. SEARCH TABLE                           12
部品番号                INDEX No.- 図番         部品番号        INDEX No.- 図番    部品番号   INDEX No.- 図番
010-051-05
                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                  SP - 67
02.20.2002 FM3327
                                ネジ・座金類の表示記号一覧表
         13                     TABLE OF SCREWS / WASHERS INDICATION SYMBOLS
       Cross-recessed hexagon-
                                                                                     Hexagon-headed screw           Hexagon-headed bolt
  5 headed screw with spring                 BR      BR 4 x 25      M4 x 25                                         Q
       and plain washers                                                             with spring and plain washer
                                                                                     BR
                                                                                     7.                              8.
  6 Hexagon-headed bolt                          Q   Q3 x 20        M3 x 20
9. 10.
                                                                    Nominal
 14 E ring                                       E   E6             diameter 6
 * : Self-tapping screw with a noncircular end
 ✶: Stainless-made
       : Painted black                                                                                                             TR1Z0041.PCT
010-051-00
                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                                              SP - 68
10.10.2000 FM2753
                                      消耗品一覧表
                     LIST OF QUICK WEARING PARTS                               14
List Of Quick Wearing Parts
 1 Fixing plug
                                            1.             2.             3.
 2 Binding band
                                             Fixing plug   Binding band   N.K. clamp
 3 N.K. clamp
                                            4.                            5.
4 Edging
TR1Z0042.EPS
010-051-00
10.10.2000 FM2753
                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                        SP - 69
CR-IR346RU Service Manual
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                   Reason                             Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)                      All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Support for software version A05 (FM3058) PM-1, 2, 5, 8, 10–13, 15–17, 19,
                                                                                    25, 32–36, 44, 49, 50, 56
010-051-00
010-051-01                                                CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                    PM - 2
10.10.2000 FM3058
08.30.2001 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                  PM - 3
     A
                                                                                                       FR6H6059.EPS
      A
                                                                                         Removal only
          10.2 Side-Positioning Conveyor (Removing the Shock Absorbers)                  for maintenance
                                                                                         after first year
                                                                                    1Y   of operation
          10.3 Side-Positioning Conveyor (Cleaning the Guides/Conveyance Rollers)
    END
                                                                                                   FR6H6060.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                             PM - 5
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                  PM - 6
(3) Press the [Windows] key to display the Start menu of Windows.
Press
Windows Update
Programs
Favorites
Documents
Settings
Search
Help
                            Run...
                                                                            #1
                                                                            [Click]
                            Log Off Administrator...
                                               Run                                                                  ?
EXECUTE EXECUTE
FR6H6011.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                  PM - 7
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (3)
                  (1)
                                                                                                                        PM - 8
EXECUTE EXECUTE
                                         C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                                                          _
                                          [Ru0] login : cr ir346                  #2 [Type/ENT]
                                         Password :                               #3 [Type/ENT]
                                                                                       _
                                                                                    [cr ir346]
                #4 [Type/ENT]            -> mutl
                                         0. QUIT
                                         1. LOG
                                         2. VERSION
                                         3. TEST
                                         4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                                         5. SCANNER UTILITY
                                         6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                                         7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                                         8. BACKUP MEMORY
                                         9. HV OFF
                                         >
TR6H6080.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                              PM - 8
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                             PM - 9
                           REFERENCE
                    If no error logs exist, the following message appears.
                    THE LOG IS EMPTY.
                    RESULT: OK
                    C:WINNT\System32\telnet.exe
                        0. QUIT
                        1. LOG
                        2. VERSION
                        3. TEST
                        4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY
                        5. SCANNER UTILITY
                        6. MECHANICAL UTILITY
                        7. SOFTWARE UTILITY
                        8. BACKUP MEMORY
                        9. HV OFF
                        > 1              #1 [Type/ENT]
                        0. QUIT
                        1. ERROR LOG
                        2. TRACE LOGS
                        LOG > 1                 #2 [Type/ENT]
                        0. QUIT
                        1. DISPLAY
                        2. SAVE TO FTP-SERV
                        3. CLEAR
                        LOG > ELG > 1                     #3 [Type/ENT]
                        0. QUIT
                        1. ALL
                        2. SUMMARY
                        LOG > ELG > DSP > 1                         #4 [Type/ENT]
                        0. QUIT
                        1. FATAL
                        2. WARNING
                        3. BOTH
                        LOG > ELG > DSP > ALL > 3                            #5 [Type/ENT]
TR6H6015.EPS
                    UNINSTALL                   RESET
                                                 PREVIOUS VERSION       VERSION UP SINCE 2000          10    10
All IP SIZES 16
ERASURE LAMP
                                                                                                   (3) #2 [Click]
                                                                                                                  FR6H6079.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                PM - 10
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                 PM - 11
■ Preparation Procedures
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    • Use IPs of all sizes used in the hospital for checking the image/conveyance.
                      Note, however, that the IP type to be used should be the VI type.
                    • Make sure that no important data has been exposed on the IP to be used.
              (1) Erase the natural radiation and image accumulated on the IP to be used.
                        “RU Instruction Manual/2.4 When Only Image Erasure is to be Performed
                        (Primary Erasure)”
(2) Place a steel rule (150-mm) on the cassette and expose it at 1 mR.
Cassette
                                            Steel rule
                                                              Exposure face
FR6H6085.EPS
                    ◆ NOTE ◆
                    If the IP cannot be exposed at 1 mR, it should be exposed at a level equivalent to 1
                    mR, with reference to the following exposure conditions.
                    Note, however, that those conditions are for standard IP setup reference.
                              Distance: 1.8 m
                              Voltage:   80 kV
                              Amperage: 50 mA
                              Time:      0.013 sec
010-051-01
010-051-00                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                  PM - 11
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                  PM - 12
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                              PM - 12
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                   PM - 13
                                         Measure
                                                          Image frame
FR6H6018.EPS
                    ◆ CHECK ◆
                    • Make sure that the white blank portion is 2 mm or less.
                    • When the dimension of the white blank portion of the steel rule is converted to its
                       actual dimension, the difference between the resulting value and the actual steel rule
                       should be 2% or less.
                    If anything abnormal is found, see [Troubleshooting Volume].
010-051-01
010-051-00                                         CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       PM - 13
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                                                                              PM - 14
                           REFERENCE
                    The details of output characters and the character display locations are as follows.
                                   (1) Hospital name (medical institution name)
                                                                            (4) Patient ID
                                                                            (5) Patient name                                  (10) Film mark
                                    (13) Image processing conditions
                                                                                                                              (7) Sex
                                                                                                                              (8) Age or date of birth
                        G 1.0G#0.7+0.50R5Q0.5                                                              R->L                                    G1.0G#0.7+0.50R5Q1.0
                        SKULL GENERAL
                        L 4.0 S200C✼1.2✼1.0AP                            0000000001 John Smith              [M]      23
                                                                             1992. 11. 27 [17:43]       SCALE: 50%   RT-04
Machine
                                                                                   [Loosen]
                                                                                   Na12 (x4)
Caster
Adjustable foot
FR6H6069.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               PM - 15
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                       PM - 16
                           #1
[Remove] Bolt 12x20, W12 (x2)
                    #3
        [Move] Machine
Mashine
                                                                                  #2
                                                                                  [Loosen] Adjustable foot
                                                   Caster
                                                                                           4 or 2-Na12
Adjustable foot
FR6H6065.EPS
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    When securing the adjustable feet, pay attention to the following points.
                    •The four adjustable feet should be evenly loaded.
                      However, if there is too little space on the right and left sides in the machine installa-
                      tion place to secure the adjustable feet on the rear side, the two adjustable feet on
                      the front side should be secured in place. In this case, the two adjustable feet and
                      two casters should be evenly loaded.
                    • When the adjustable feet are secured, the casters should be detached from the floor.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                 PM - 16
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                                 PM - 17
Table
                                                        #3
                                            [Move] Machine
                      #1
     [Remove] T6x12 (x2)
Bracket
Machine
                                                                       #2
                                                                       [Loosen] Adjustable foot
                                   Caster
                                                                              4 or 2-Na12
                                                             Adjustable foot
                                                                                                  FR6H6066.EPS
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    When securing the adjustable feet, pay attention to the following points.
                    • The four adjustable feet should be evenly loaded.
                      However, if there is too little space on the right and left sides in the machine installa-
                      tion place to secure the adjustable feet on the rear side, the two adjustable feet on
                      the front side should be secured in place. In this case, the two adjustable feet and
                      two casters should be evenly loaded.
                    • When the adjustable feet are secured, the casters should be detached from the floor.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                    CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                          PM - 17
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                     PM - 18
                                    #2
                           [Disconnect]
                        Interface cable
                                                               #1
                                                               [Disconnect] Power cable
                                                                                      FR6H6068.EPS
                                   #3
                                   [Remove] T4x8 (x4)
                                          Left-hand side cover
                                                                     Top cover
                                                                                             Upper rear cover
                                                                                #6
                                                                                [Loosen]                        #7
                                                                                T4x12 (x4)                      [Remove] DT3x6 (x4)
                                                                                             X
                #3
[Remove] T4x6 (x4)
                          #4
          [Remove] T4x6 (x6)
                          Upper                                                                         #2
                   light protect                                                                        [Remove] T4x12 (x6)
                           plate
010-051-01
010-051-00                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                              PM - 19
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                                 PM - 20
                        When one year has passed or when 30,000 IPs have been processed
              1Y        → The air filters should be cleaned.
                        When two years have passed or when 60,000 IPs have been processed
              2Y        → The air filters should be replaced.
                                                                Sponge filter
                                                                       [Clean]        [Replace]
1Y 2Y
                                                                                             [Clean/Replace]
                                                                                             Air filter
                        [Clean]
                        Air filter
                                                                                 HHS Label
                                                                                 No.2
                                                                                                  FR6H6021.EPS
                                                                                    High-voltage
                                                                                      switch S1
                                                                        S1
                                                                                     ON      OFF
                                                                                       ■ S1
                                                                                             FR6H6022.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    When installing or removing the suction cup assembly, support the IP removal arm by
                    hand.
                    If the procedures are performed without supporting it, the IP removal arm may be bent
                    or otherwise damaged.
                        REFERENCE
                    Move the IP removal arm to the IP suction position before proceeding to the next step.
                                                 IP removal arm
                                                                  Cassette set unit
FRONT
FR6H6076.EPS
                                #2 [Remove]
                                 DT3x6 (x2)
                                   PUSH
                              #1 [Remove] Lid opening bracket
FR6H6024.EPS
FR6H6025.EPS
Roller
9.          Erasure Conveyor
            To gain access to the locations to be cleaned, each section of the erasure conveyor should
            be removed.
                     (2)
     [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                 ONT
                                                                                              FR
                                                                                            Cleaning roller
                                                                                            assembly
INV12B board
CN14
                                                                                                   (6) #2
                                                                                                   [Disconnect]
                                                                                                   Connector
                                                  (6) #1
                                               [Release]               CN13 CN12 CN11
                                                  Clamp
                                                                                  INV12A board
                                                                                         FRONT
                                                                         T
                                                                    ON
                                                                  FR
                                                                                (7)
                                                                                [Remove] BR3x6
                                                                                                      Light protect
                                                                                                      plate
                                                                                                    (5)
                               Yellow filter
                                                                                                    [Remove]
                                                                                                    T4x6 (x2)
                              Lamp assembly                                                          (4)
                                                                                                     [Remove]
                                                                                                     BR4x8
                                                                   Box
SFR6H6029.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                         PM - 25
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                                        PM - 26
Reflection guide
                                            #1
                           [Remove] Guide (x4)                                      #3
                                            #2                                      [Clean] Moistened cloth
                        [Clean] Moistened cloth                                     Reflection surface
                                                                                                         FR6H6030.EPS
                                 When one year has passed or when 30,000 IPs have been processed
                        1Y       → The cleaning rollers should be cleaned.
FR6H6078.EPS
When two years have passed or when 60,000 IPs have been processed
                                                       #3
                                       [Remove] Spur gear                                                  #5
                                                                                                           [Replace] Cleaning roller
                                                                        E6
                                                                             Bearing
                                         #1
                             [Remove] DT3x6
                                                        Bearing
                                 Antistatic brush
Bracket
Box
                                                              #2                                                      Bearing
                                                              [Remove] DT3x6
                                                                                                                           #4
                                                                                                                  [Remove] E6
FR6H6031.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                   PM - 27
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (2)
                  (1)
                                                                                                        PM - 28
                               When one year has passed or when the lamps have been lit for about 900
                               hours
                        1Y
                               → The erasure lamps should be cleaned.
                               When two years have passed or when 1,800 hours have been exceeded, the
                        2Y     erasure lamps should be replaced.
                    If the lamp-on time has exceeded 1,800 hours or if two years have passed since the
                    start of use, the lamps should be replaced with new ones.
Rib
                                                                                 T
                                                                              ON
                                                                            FR
               (1) #1
  [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)
Yellow filter
                                                                            (1) #3
                                         (2)                                [Remove] Lamp
                             [Clean] Ethanol            (1) #2              (1) #4
                                                [Remove] Filter             [Clean]
                                                                            Moistened cloth   Holder plate
                                                                                    (1) #1
                                                                       [Remove] DT3x6 (x2)                FR6H6032.EPS
(3) Reassemble the erasure lamp assembly by reversing the procedures of step (2).
010-051-00
010-051-00                                      CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               PM - 28
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (2)
                  (1)
                                                                                                    PM - 29
                         #2
      [Disconnect] Connector
                     CNBCR
                           #1
               [Remove] DT3x6
FR6H6033.EPS
FR6H6034.EPS
(3) Reinstall the antistatic bracket assembly by reversing the procedures of step (1).
DETAIL A DETAIL B
                                                                 #2
                                                                 [Remove]
                                           #2                    BR4x8 (x2)
                                           [Remove] BR4x8 (x2)
                                           #1
                                           [Disconnect]
                                           Connector CNC1
                                                                              #1
                                                                              [Disconnect] Connector CNMC3
                                                                            #1
                                                                            [Disconnect] Connector CNC10
                                                                    P
                                                               TO
Side-positioning conveyor
FR6H6075.EPS
Movable guide
                                                                            #2
                                                                            [Remove]
                                                                            BR3x6 (x2)
                           #1
                   [Remove]
             Extension spring
FR6H6040.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                             CR-IR346RU Service Manual                             PM - 32
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                PM - 33
              (2) Release the grip of the conveyance rollers.
[Rotate] Gear
                            #2
       [Clean] Moistened cloth
                   Cloth roller
         Anti-static bracket assembly
                       #1
                [Remove]
               BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                 FR6H6039.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                          PM - 33
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                PM - 34
              (4) Clean the conveyance rollers and guides with a moistened cloth.
FR6H6042.EPS
              (5) Reinstall the movable guide, antistatic bracket assembly, and cloth roller by reversing
                  their removal procedures.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                CR-IR346RU Service Manual                              PM - 34
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                      PM - 35
Arm
FR6H6083.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                PM - 35
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                   PM - 36
                                                                  (1)
                                                                  [Loosen] DT3x6 (x2)   HHS Label No.2
            Cleaning brush
                 assembly
                                            (2)
                        [Clean] Vacuum cleaner
                            Cleaning brush (x2)
FR6H6044.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                        CR-IR346RU Service Manual                         PM - 36
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                    PM - 37
                                                      (2) [Clean]
                                                      Moistened cloth       HHS Label No.2
                                                      Grip roller (upper)
Hook Hook
                               (1) #2                                                            (1) #2
                               [Remove]                                                      [Remove]
                               Extension                                                     Extension
                               spring                          HHS Label No.2                   spring
                               L=50 mm                                                        L=39 mm
CHECK
FR6H6045.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                PM - 37
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (2)
                  (1)
                                                                                                          PM - 38
                                                                          #1
                                                                          [Remove] Extension spring 76 mm
                                                                                      #3
                                                                                      [Clean]
                                                                                      Moistened cloth
                                                                                      Kapton® belt
                                                #2
                                    [Shift] Bracket
                                                                                                FR6H6502.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
                    ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                    Use care not to damage the surface in contact with the Kapton® belt.
Driving shaft
                  HHS Label
                       No.2
Allen wrench
                                                                           #2
                                                                           [Clean] Ethanol
                                                                           Flywheel
                                                                                             #1
                                                                                             [Remove] Na20
FR6H6053.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                PM - 39
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (2)
                  (1)
                                                                                                PM - 40
                        HHS Label
                        No.2                                    HHS Label
                                                                No.2
                                                                                        Spacer
                                       #1                                                  Gear (large)
                                       [Remove]
                                       Spring
Gear (small)
                                                                                  #2
                                                                      [Remove] BR3x12
                                                    HHS Label
                                                         No.2
           #3
           [Remove]
           V3x6 (x2)
Light-collecting mirror
FR6H6058.EPS
[Rotate] Guide A
FR6H6046.EPS
                    CAUTIONS
                    • Do not wipe the light-collecting mirror with a dry cloth. If so, the light-collecting mirror
                      may be scratched or otherwise damaged.
                    • If the lens cleaning paper becomes soiled, replace it with a new one.
                    • Wipe the light-collecting mirror until the lens cleaning paper becomes no longer
                      soiled.
              (4) Using the lens cleaning paper moistened with ethanol, clean the reflection surface of
                  the light-collecting mirror.
Light-collecting mirror
                                [Clean] Ethanol
                              Reflection surface
FR6H6047.EPS
                         REFERENCE
                    To clean the light-collecting mirror, two sheets of lens cleaning paper should be folded
                    in four and then moistened with ethanol.
FR6H6048.EPS
■ Removal Procedures
              (1) Remove the after-reading conveyor cover.
                             Spacer
                        After-reading                                                HHS Label No.2
                        conveyor cover
                                                                     Spacer
  #2
  [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                #1
                                                                         [Remove]
                                                                        DT3x8 (x2)
                                                                                            FR6H6054.EPS
                    ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                    The light-collecting guide should be removed along the rails.
                                                                           #1            PMT12A board
                                                                  [Disconnect]
                                                               Connector PMT2
                         Light-collecting section                          #1
                                                                                          Light-collecting
                                                                  [Disconnect]
                                                                                          guide assembly
                                                               Connector PMT1
         #2
         [Remove] BR3x6 (x2)
        DETAIL A
                                                                                                             B
       #3 [Remove] BR3x10
                                                        HHS Label No.2
FRONT
FR6H6086.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       PM - 44
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                  (1)
                                                                                                      PM - 45
                    CAUTIONS
                    • Do not wipe the light-collecting guide with a dry cloth. If so, the light-collecting guide
                      may be scratched or otherwise damaged.
                    • If the lens cleaning paper becomes soiled, replace it with a new one.
                    • Wipe the light-collecting surface of the light-collecting guide until the lens cleaning
                      paper becomes no longer soiled.
                          REFERENCE
                    To clean the light-collecting guide, two sheets of lens cleaning paper should be folded
                    in four and then moistened with ethanol.
                                                                        FRONT
                        Light-collecting guide assembly
                            [Clean] Ethanol
                    Light-collecting surface
                                                                       FR6H6050.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                          CR-IR346RU Service Manual                         PM - 45
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (2)
                  (1)
                                                                                                             PM - 46
                    CAUTION
                    The rubber belt should not be removed.
Moistened cloth
FR6H6061.EPS
(2) Clean the driving-shaft grip roller (upper) with a moistened cloth.
                                                                                 HHS Label
                                                                                      No.2
Hook
Hook
                        (1)
                        [Remove]
                        Extension                      (2)
                        spring                         [Clean] Moistened cloth
                        L=39 mm                        Grip roller (upper)
                                                                                             (1)
                                                                                             [Remove]
                                                                                             Extension spring
                                                                                             L=50 mm
FR6H6063.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-00                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                               PM - 47
10.10.2000
10.10.2000 FM2887
           FM2887 (3)
                  (1)
                                                                                                               PM - 48
              (3) Using a moistened cloth, clean the driving-shaft grip roller (lower) and the IP running
                  surface (guide) on the driving-shaft side.
                                                                       HHS Label
                                                                            No.2
                          [Clean] Moistened cloth
                        IP running surface (guide)
FR6H6055.EPS
                                 HHS Label
                                 No.2
                                                                                 Peep hole
                                                                                 φ 4mm hole
                                                                                                FR6H6082.EPS
                                                                       #4            PMT12A board
                                                                 [Connect]
                                                           Connector PMT2
                        Light-collecting section                      #4
                                                                [Connect]           Light-collecting
                                                          Connector PMT1            guide assembly
         #3
         [Secure] BR3x6 (x2)
                                                                                                       B
         DETAIL A
FRONT
FR6H6049.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       PM - 49
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                PM - 50
              (3) Reinstall the after-reading conveyor cover.
                    ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                    The gear (large) and gear (small) should be mounted in place as illustrated below.
FRONT
Pinionless section
              (6) Reverse the procedures for removing the driven shaft grip roller (upper).
              (7) Reverse the procedures for removing the cleaning brush.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                            PM - 50
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                 PM - 51
              (8) Reverse the procedures for removing the flywheel.
                    ◆ INSTRUCTIONS ◆
                    • The Kapton® belt should be mounted with its date indicating side up, so that the
                      arrow mark faces the side plate.
                    • After mounting the Kapton® belt, manually rotate the flywheel to verify that the
                      Kapton belt does not come off.
                                                         Side plate
                                                                            5
                                                            0   9
                                                         03              Rotation mark
                                                    00
                                                             Date
                                  Kapton® belt
                                                                              FR6H6062.EPS
Side-positioning unit
DETAIL A DETAIL B
                                                  #1
                                                  [Secure]
                                                  BR4x8 (x2)
                                              #2
                                              [Connect]
                                              Connector CNC1                   #1 [Secure]
                                                                               BR4x8 (x2)
                                                                             #2
                                                                             [Connect] Connector CNMC3
                                                                         #2
                                                                         [Connect] Connector CNC10
                                                                                                       FR6H6056.EPS
                                                        SCN12A board
                                                                             LED is lit when in the
                                                                             ON position.
                                                                                      High-voltage
                                                                       S1              switch S1
                                                                                      ON      OFF
                                                                                        ■ S1
                                                                                             FR6H6057.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    Before reinstalling the covers, make sure that the high-voltage switch of the SCN12A
                    board is in the ON position.
                                        UNINSTALL                 RESET
                                                                   PREVIOUS VERSION       VERSION UP SINCE 2000          10   10
All IP SIZES 16
ERASURE LAMP
                                                                                                                     (3) #2 [Click]
                                                                                                                                   FR6H6079.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                         PM - 56
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                    PM - 57
BLANK PAGE
   Installation (IN)
                                                                                                                                              0.1
          Control Sheet
           Issue date   Revision number                   Reason                              Pages affected
          10/10/2000    00                New release (FM2887)                      All pages
          08/30/2001    01                Support for software version A05 (FM3058) IN-5, 6, 12–14, 17–19, 21.1–21.2,
                                                                                    23, 24–29, 31–35, 38
          12/20/2001    03                Corrections (FM3277)                      IN-1, 9
          02/20/2002    05                Corrections (FM3328)                      IN-1, 4, 5
                                                                                    Appx IN-1-1–Appx IN-1-3
          04/20/2002    06                Corrections (FM3386)                      IN-1, 7–14
1. Specifications of Machine
■ Product Code
            CR-IR346RU
■ Dimensions
            W550 x D515 x H1065 (mm)
1065
                        550
                                                  515
                                                        Unit: mm
                                                        FR6H7645.EPS
■ Weight
            155 kg approx.
■ Installation Space
            REFERENCE
        The machine may be installed with its left/right sides and its rear adjacent to the wall.
        Note, however, that adequate space around the machine should be required so that the
        distance from its front to the wall is 1,000 mm or greater and there is enough room to allow the
        machine to rotate.
800 800
Machine
800
1,000
             ● Minimum space for installation                   ● Minimum space for table (full option)
                                                                  installation
Machine Machine
                                                                  Table                      Table
                              1,000                                                1,000
       ✻ : Make sure that servicing space is secured.       ✻ : Make sure that servicing space is secured. Unit: mm
                                                                                                          FR6H7004.EPS
START
3.2 Unloading
3.3 Transfer
4. Installation Procedures
              A
                                                                                 FR6H7001.EPS
            END
                                                                              FR6H7005.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                             IN - 6
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                 IN - 7
3.2 Unloading
       CAUTION
       When unloading or transferring the machine, use care not to incline the machine.
       Because the machine is not fixed to the carrier pallet, the machine may topple down.
       ◆ NOTE ◆
       Before unloading the machine, secure a proper machine transfer route.
              (1) Move down the machine together with the carrier pallet from the load-carrying platform
                  of the truck.
              (2) Remove the three slats from the top of the crate.
                                                         [Remove] Slat x3
                                                             Nail
                                                                                  F
                                                                                  R
                                                                                  O
                                                                                  N
                                                                                  T
                                                     T
                                                R ON
                                              F                             FR6H7815.EPS
                                                                         [Remove] Slat x6
                                                                              Nail
                         T
                      ON
                    FR                                                            FRONT
FR6H7816.EPS
[Remove] Crate x2
Nail
                                               O  NT                  FRONT
                                             FR
                                                                              FR6H7819.EPS
                                                               #3
                                                               [Remove] Top machine-wrapping protective material
                                                                       #1
                                     #4                               [Remove] PP band (x4)
                          [Remove] Tray
                       #5 [Remove]
Machine-wrapping protective material
                                                                                              Machine-wrapping
                                                                                              protective material
                                                         Carrier pallet
FR6H7E01.EPS
                    ◆ INSTRUCTION ◆
                    During the winter season, allow the machine to stand under its packaged condition for
                    sufficient time before unpacking it.
                    If the machine is unpacked immediately after it is carried into the room, moisture
                    condensation may occur on the machine.
Carrier pallet
FR6H7652.EPS
                    CAUTION
                    To remove the four nuts that secure the machine retaining base and carrier pallet,
                    loosen the four nuts evenly one by one, and then remove them.
Nut
                                                                                           #4          Machine retaining
                                                                                           [Remove]    base
                                                                                           Na10 (x4)        Carrier pallet
                                                    T                                     #3
                                                ON            #1
                                              FR              [Remove] PP band            [Remove] Machine retaining
                                    #2                                                    corrugated board
                                    [Remove] Displacement prevention member                                          FR6H7602.EPS
Slope
                                                   Slope                                                    #2
                                                                                               [Shift] Fitting
                                                              Na6 removed at #1 should be used at #3.
                                                                                                           FR6H7619.EPS
                                                     T
                                                ON
                                              FR
[Attach] Slope
FR6H7606.EPS
                      REFERENCE
                    The slope may be attached only to the front side of the machine.
                    WARNING
                    When unloading the machine from the carrier pallet, two persons should cooperate to
                    do so using care to prevent it from toppling down.
                    In this case, the two persons should be positioned, one at the right-hand side and the
                    other at the left-hand side of the machine.
                    CAUTION
                    The adjustable feet should be raised all the way up to their upper limit.
                                 ONT
                              FR
Slope
Carrier pallet
FR6H7605.EPS
3.3 Transfer
                    CAUTIONS
                    • When transferring the machine by use of its casters, raise the adjustable feet of the
                      machine all the way up to their upper limit.
                    • When bringing the machine into the installation place, support it so that it will not
                      topple down.
                    • When the machine should be moved over some step or bump, move it as slowly as
                      possible to avoid shock to it. Note that the step over which the machine may move is
                      about 10 mm high at most.
800
                                        Rear
                                                                       800
                       800                                                            800
                                                 Machine
                                        Front
                                                              800
                                                                                              Unit : mm
                                                                                              FR6H7006.EPS
                      REFERENCE
                    When there is enough space (800 mm around the machine) to allow the machine to
                    rotate, installation procedures may be performed only if 1,000 mm or greater in space
                    is secured on one side of the machine.
Machine
Caster
Adjustable foot
FR6H7013.EPS
■ Accessories
■ Optional Items
4.          Installation Procedures
4.1         Removing the Machine-Wrapping Packing Materials
              (1) Remove the packing materials.
                                                                        #1
                                                             [Remove] Tape
                                                                        #2
                                                 [Remove] Retaining member
                                                                       #3
                                                            [Remove] Tape
                                                                                    #5
                                                #4                                  [Remove] Tape
                    [Remove] Tape (x2)/front cover
                                                                             #6
                                                                             [Remove] Tape
FR6H7607.EPS
                                                             Upper light
                                                             protect plate
FR6H7657.EPS
                                           #1                                               [Reposition]
                               [Remove/Secure]                                              Retaining member
                                  BR4x10 (x3)
                                                    Retaining member
                                                      #3                                              #5
                                                      [Loosen] BR4x10                                 [Secure]
                                                                                                      BR4x10 (x2)
                                #2                                                     #4
                                [Remove] BR4x10             [Reposition] Retaining member
FR6H7609.EPS
                        REFERENCE
                    One screw for each of the right and left retaining members removed at step #2 should
                    be used at step #5.
010-051-00
010-051-01                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                IN - 17
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                         IN - 18
5. Shelf 6. Bracket
FR6H7701.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                   IN - 18
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                             IN - 19
FR6H7748.EPS
16. Bolt 12x20 (x4), W12 (x4) 17. Bolt 10x20 (x4)
FR6H7710.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                        IN - 19
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                         IN - 20
■ Assembly Procedures
              (1) Attach the rear pipe.
Rear pipe
Pillar (left)
                                                         Pillar (right)
                                                                          FR6H7717.EPS
FR6H7718.EPS
                                    Bracket
                                                                     FR6H7719.EPS
[Attach] Shelf
Shelf
FR6H7720.EPS
                                                                            Pillar (right)
                           Pillar (left)
                                                                               Shock
                           Shock                                            absorbing
                           absorbing                                         material
                           material
                                                                                  10mm
                          10mm
FR6H7749.EPS
FR6H7750.EPS
BLANK PAGE
                    CAUTION
                    Before handling the board, wear the wristband.
FR6H7658.EPS
BT1
                                                                                             J4
                                                                                                          S3
                                         CN6       CN5             TP1
                                                              S1
                                                                                                  S2
                                           ON
                                            1      2   3      4    5   6   7   8
                                                                                            Remote       Local
                                           OFF
                   S1 settings
                                                                                                                      Default
                    bit                          Description                        ON            OFF
                                                                                                                 (factory preset)
                        1     Service terminal connection enable/disable             –               –              ON (fixed)
                        2     For design analysis                                    –               –              OFF (fixed)
                                                                                                                         OFF
                                                                                                               (It varies depending
                        3     Cassette type selection                              Metric         INCH         on the specifications
                                                                                                                 prior to shipment.)
                        4     Barcode reader availability selection            With BCR Without BCR                     ON
                        5     For design analysis                                    –               –              OFF (fixed)
                        6     Not used                                                                              OFF (fixed)
                        7     Not used                                                                              OFF (fixed)
                        8     For design analysis                                    –               –              OFF (fixed)
                   S2 settings
                                                Description                        Remote         Local               Default
                            Interlink with CL                                        –               –             Local (fixed)
                                                                                                                           FR6H7659.EPS
010-051-00
010-051-01                                               CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                 IN - 23
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                                                   IN - 24
                    WARNING
                    Before measuring the resistance value, make sure that the power plug is unplugged
                    from the outlet.
(1)
                                                                                                                       [Connect]
                                                                                                                       Power cable
                        (2)
                        ON
                                                                                                     CHECK
                                                                 Breaker switch
FR6H7638.EPS
<For use in Japan and the US> <For use in Europe> <For use in the UK, etc.>
                                                                                   E                           E
                                                             E
                                                             L                          N
                                                         N                          L                              N
                                                                                                           L
FR6H7007.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                       CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                                        IN - 24
08.30.2001 FM3058
10.10.2000 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                  IN - 25
                    CAUTION
                    A telephone cable should not be plugged into the I/F cable connector.
                    The type of cable compatible with this machine is an IEC950/UL1950-listed cable only.
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    • Either the UTP type or STP type of the I/F cable may be connected to the CR-
                      IR346RU. However, even when the I/F cable is of shielded type (STP type), a ferrite
                      bead should be attached to it.
                    • Make sure that 50 to 80 mm of the cable protrudes from the ferrite bead (on the side
                      you will install into the RU).
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                             IN - 25
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                      IN - 26
                    ◆ NOTE ◆
                    For the I/F cable used for direct connection, a cross cable should be used.
I/F cable
                                       #2
                        [Secure] Cable tie
                                                                     50–80mm
                                                 #1
                              [Attach] Ferrite bead                        FR6H7810.EPS
              (2) Connect the I/F cable to the I/F cable connector of the RU.
                          REFERENCE
                    The I/F cable should be connected with its ferrite bead end on the RU side.
Ferrite bead
                                                I/F cable
                                   I/F cable    connector
FR6H7725.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                            CR-IR346RU Service Manual                       IN - 26
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                                             IN - 27
                    ◆ NOTE ◆
                    For the I/F cable used for network connection, a straight cable should be used.
I/F cable
                                       #2
                        [Secure] Cable tie
                                                                         50–80mm
                                                   #1
                                [Attach] Ferrite bead                           FR6H7810.EPS
              (2) Connect the I/F cable to the I/F cable connector of the RU.
                           REFERENCE
                    The I/F cable should be connected with its ferrite bead end on the RU side.
Ferrite bead
                                              I/F cable
                                 I/F cable    connector
                                                                                                Power cable
                                                         Ferrite bead
I/F cable
                                                               Switching hub
                                                             (100 BASE - T or
                                                               10 BASE - T)                    Network
                                                                                                              FR6H7725.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                              CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                            IN - 27
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                          IN - 28
FR6H7801.EPS
9.          CL Installation Procedures
              (1) Perform the CL installation procedures.
                        CL Service Manual "A. Installation/Chapters 3-7"
010-051-00
010-051-01                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                      IN - 28
10.10.2000
08.30.2001 FM2887
           FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                         IN - 29
Machine
Caster
Adjustable foot
FR6H7724.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                   IN - 29
10.10.2000 FM3058
08.30.2001 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                            IN - 30
                        REFERENCE
                    When determining the locations for embedding the anchor nuts, temporarily install the
                    machine and retainers in place, and then mark the locations.
                    At that time, adjust the height of the adjustable foot so that the positional relationship
                    between the retainer and the adjustable foot nut and spacer is as shown below.
Nut
                    Retainer
                                                            Spacer
Adjustable foot
FR6H7600.EPS
                    Marking location
                    x4
                        F
                        R
                        O
                        N
                        T
                                       Retainer                                              FR6H7613.EPS
                                                                                       #2
                                                                                       [Embed] Anchor nut
                                              18φ
                                                                                            #1 [Attach]/#3 [Remove]
                                                                                            Bolt 12x20 (x4)
                                                                Anchor nut                  W12 (x4)
                                                                    Na12
                    52mm
FR6H7723.EPS
                                              #4
                   [Secure] Bolt 12x20, W12 (x2)
                                    #3
                        [Move] Machine                                                #2
                                                                                      [Secure] Bolt 12x20, W12 (x2)
                                                                                 #1
                                                                                 [Secure] Adjustble foot
                                                                                          Na12 (x4 or x2)
FR6H7614.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                     CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                    IN - 31
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                        IN - 32
Table
                                                            #2
                                                [Move] Machine
                              #4
             [Secure] T6x12 (x2)
                                                                           #1
                        Bracket                      [Secure] Adjustable foot
Bracket Bracket
                                                                                        #3
                                                                            [Secure] Na12
                                                                                (x4 or x2)
                                                         F
                                                         R
                                                         O
                                                         N
                                                         T     Adjustable foot (machine)
FR6H7617.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                  IN - 32
10.10.2000 FM3058
08.30.2001 FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                           IN - 33
                   Table
                                                          [Remove]
                                                          Adjustable foot (x4)
                                                                            FR6H7610.EPS
                        Table
                                                                                           Retainer
FR6H7611.EPS
                    ◆ NOTE ◆
                    Before drilling holes for embedding the anchor nuts, wear protective goggles.
                          REFERENCE
                    When determining the locations for embedding the anchor nuts, perform temporary
                    installation with the retainers attached to the table, and then mark the locations.
010-051-01
010-051-00                                  CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                     IN - 33
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                                         IN - 34
              (2) Determine the locations for embedding the anchor nuts.
                                         525.2 (reference value)
                                                                           Table leg
98.5
244
Retainer
Marking location x4
                                                                         Unit: mm
                                                                         FR6H7612.EPS
              (3) Drill holes for embedding the anchor nuts, and then embed the anchor nuts.
                                                                                        #2
                                                                                        [Embed] Anchor nut
                                                   18φ
                                                                                            #1 [Attach]/#3 [Remove]
                                                                                            Bolt 12x20 (x4)
                                                                     Anchor nut             W12 (x4)
                                                                         Na12
                    52mm
FR6H7723.EPS
Table
FR6H7615.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                           CR-IR346RU Service Manual                           IN - 34
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                                                        IN - 35
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    • The four adjustable feet should be evenly loaded.
                      However, if there is too little space on the right and left sides in the machine installa-
                      tion place to secure the adjustable feet on the rear side, the two adjustable feet on
                      the front side should be secured in place. In this case, the two adjustable feet and
                      two casters should be evenly loaded.
                    • When the adjustable feet are secured, the casters should be detached from the floor.
                    • After securing the bracket, make sure that the bracket does not interfere with the
                      machine. If they interfere with each other, adjust the position of the machine as
                      appropriate.
Table
                                                          #1
                                              [Move] Machine
                           #3
          [Secure] T6x12 (x2)
Bracket
                                                               Bracket
                                                                                                      Bracket
                                                                                       #2
                                                                           [Secure] Na12
                                                                               (x4 or x2)
                                                      F
                                                      R
                                                      O
                                                      N
                                                      T
                                                               Adjustable foot (machine)
FR6H7616.EPS
010-051-01
010-051-00                                   CR-IR346RU Service Manual                                 IN - 35
08.30.2001
10.10.2000 FM3058
           FM2887 (1)
                                                                                    IN - 36
CL
ON
FR6H7747.EPS
ON
FR6H7746.EPS
■ Preparation Procedures
                    ◆ NOTES ◆
                    • For the IP used for image/conveyance checks, an IP of the maximum size used in the
                      hospital should be employed.
                    • Make sure that the IP to be used does not contain any important image data
                      exposed.
(2) Place a steel rule (150mm) on the cassette and expose it at 1 mR.
Cassette
Steel rule
FR6H7009.EPS
                        REFERENCE
                    If the IP cannot be exposed at 1 mR, it should be exposed at a level equivalent to 1
                    mR, with reference to the following exposure conditions.
                    Note, however, that those conditions are for standard IP setup reference.
                        Distance:    1.8 m
                        Voltage:     80 kV
                        Amperage: 50 mA
                        Time:        0.013 sec
010-051-01
010-051-00                                 CR-IR346RU Service Manual                            IN - 38
08.30.2001 FM2887
10.10.2000 FM3058 (1)
                                                                             IN - 39
                        OFF
                                                           FR6H7656.EPS
(1) Attach the cassette handling precaution label above the cassette size indication.
[Attach] Label
FR6H7644.EPS
       CAUTIONS
       • The procedures described in this appendix should be used only for on-site relocation and not
         for purposes of moving the machine out of the institution by use of a truck or the like.
       • When the machine is to be moved out of the institution by use of a truck or the like, use
         appropriate clamping materials to pack the machine and transport it under the same condition
         as when it was originally shipped. If it were transported under different conditions than when
         it was shipped, the machine would be damaged or its quality could not be guaranteed.
       ◆ NOTE ◆
       The procedures described in this appendix are based on the assumption that RU software
       version A07 or later (PC-MUTL software version 1.2 or later) is used.
START
            END
                                                                     FR6H7811.EPS
       CAUTION
       If shocks or vibrations caused by any bump on the floor are possibly transmitted to the machine
       during its transfer, be sure to secure the light-collecting mirror in place. Otherwise, the light-
       collecting mirror might be broken by such vibrations.
FR6H7813.EPS
       CAUTIONS
       • When relocating the machine by use of its casters, raise the adjustable feet of the machine all
         the way up to their upper limit.
       • When moving the machine, support it so that it will not topple down.
       • When the machine should be moved over some step or bump, move it as slowly as possible
         to avoid shock to it.
       • If a step or bump over which the machine should be moved is 10 mm or higher, place a rigid
         steel plate or the like over such a step or bump.